]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blob - gdb/doc/gdb.texinfo
b218769c1b1e3a07618e020f7d5b0196af902b0b
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 @node Sample Session
545 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
546
547 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
548 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
549 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
550
551 @iftex
552 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
553 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
554 @end iftex
555
556 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
557 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
558
559 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
560 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
561 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
562 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
563 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
564 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
565 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
566 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
567 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
568
569 @smallexample
570 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
571 $ @b{./m4}
572 @b{define(foo,0000)}
573
574 @b{foo}
575 0000
576 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
577
578 @b{bar}
579 0000
580 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
581
582 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
583 @b{baz}
584 @b{Ctrl-d}
585 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
586 @end smallexample
587
588 @noindent
589 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
590
591 @smallexample
592 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
593 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
594 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
595 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
596 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
597 the conditions.
598 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
599 for details.
600
601 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
602 (@value{GDBP})
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
607 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
608 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
609 that examples fit in this manual.
610
611 @smallexample
612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
617 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
618 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
619 @code{break} command.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
623 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
628 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
629 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
633 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
634 @b{define(foo,0000)}
635
636 @b{foo}
637 0000
638 @end smallexample
639
640 @noindent
641 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
642 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
643 context where it stops.
644
645 @smallexample
646 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
647
648 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
649 at builtin.c:879
650 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
655 the next line of the current function.
656
657 @smallexample
658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
659 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
660 : nil,
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
665 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
666 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
667 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
668
669 @smallexample
670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
671 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
672 at input.c:530
673 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
678 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
679 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
680 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
681 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
682 stack frame for each active subroutine.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
686 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
687 at input.c:530
688 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
689 at builtin.c:882
690 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
691 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
692 at macro.c:71
693 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
694 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
699 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
700 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
704 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
706 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
707 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
709 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
710 : xstrdup(rq);
711 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
712 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
713 @end smallexample
714
715 @noindent
716 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
717 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
718 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
719 (@code{print}) to see their values.
720
721 @smallexample
722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
723 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
725 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
726 @end smallexample
727
728 @noindent
729 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
730 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
731 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
732
733 @smallexample
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
735 533 xfree(rquote);
736 534
737 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
738 : xstrdup (lq);
739 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
740 : xstrdup (rq);
741 537
742 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
743 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
744 540 @}
745 541
746 542 void
747 @end smallexample
748
749 @noindent
750 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
751 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
752
753 @smallexample
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
755 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
757 540 @}
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
759 $3 = 9
760 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
761 $4 = 7
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
766 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
767 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
768 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
769 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
770 assignments.
771
772 @smallexample
773 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
774 $5 = 7
775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
776 $6 = 9
777 @end smallexample
778
779 @noindent
780 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
781 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
782 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
783 example that caused trouble initially:
784
785 @smallexample
786 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
787 Continuing.
788
789 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
790
791 baz
792 0000
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
797 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
798 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
799
800 @smallexample
801 @b{Ctrl-d}
802 Program exited normally.
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
807 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
808 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
809
810 @smallexample
811 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
812 @end smallexample
813
814 @node Invocation
815 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
816
817 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
818 The essentials are:
819 @itemize @bullet
820 @item
821 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
822 @item
823 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
824 @end itemize
825
826 @menu
827 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
828 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
829 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
830 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
831 @end menu
832
833 @node Invoking GDB
834 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
835
836 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
837 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
838
839 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
840 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
841
842 The command-line options described here are designed
843 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
844 options may effectively be unavailable.
845
846 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
847 specifying an executable program:
848
849 @smallexample
850 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
851 @end smallexample
852
853 @noindent
854 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
855 specified:
856
857 @smallexample
858 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
859 @end smallexample
860
861 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
862 to debug a running process:
863
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
866 @end smallexample
867
868 @noindent
869 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
870 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
871
872 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
873 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
874 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
875 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
876 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
877
878 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
879 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
880 option processing.
881 @smallexample
882 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
883 @end smallexample
884 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
885 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
886
887 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
888 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
889
890 @smallexample
891 @value{GDBP} -silent
892 @end smallexample
893
894 @noindent
895 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
896 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
897
898 @noindent
899 Type
900
901 @smallexample
902 @value{GDBP} -help
903 @end smallexample
904
905 @noindent
906 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
907 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
908
909 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
910 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
911 @samp{-x} option is used.
912
913
914 @menu
915 * File Options:: Choosing files
916 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
917 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
918 @end menu
919
920 @node File Options
921 @subsection Choosing Files
922
923 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
924 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
925 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
926 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
927 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
928 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
929 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
930 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
931 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
932 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
933 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
934 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
935 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
936
937 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
938 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
939 argument and ignore it.
940
941 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
942 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
943 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
944 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
945 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
946
947 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
948 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
949 @c it.
950
951 @table @code
952 @item -symbols @var{file}
953 @itemx -s @var{file}
954 @cindex @code{--symbols}
955 @cindex @code{-s}
956 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
957
958 @item -exec @var{file}
959 @itemx -e @var{file}
960 @cindex @code{--exec}
961 @cindex @code{-e}
962 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
963 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
964
965 @item -se @var{file}
966 @cindex @code{--se}
967 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
968 file.
969
970 @item -core @var{file}
971 @itemx -c @var{file}
972 @cindex @code{--core}
973 @cindex @code{-c}
974 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
975
976 @item -pid @var{number}
977 @itemx -p @var{number}
978 @cindex @code{--pid}
979 @cindex @code{-p}
980 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
981
982 @item -command @var{file}
983 @itemx -x @var{file}
984 @cindex @code{--command}
985 @cindex @code{-x}
986 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
987 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
988 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
989
990 @item -eval-command @var{command}
991 @itemx -ex @var{command}
992 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
993 @cindex @code{-ex}
994 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
995
996 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
997 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
998
999 @smallexample
1000 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1001 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1002 @end smallexample
1003
1004 @item -init-command @var{file}
1005 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1006 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1007 @cindex @code{-ix}
1008 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1009 after loading gdbinit files).
1010 @xref{Startup}.
1011
1012 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1013 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1014 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1015 @cindex @code{-iex}
1016 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1017 after loading gdbinit files).
1018 @xref{Startup}.
1019
1020 @item -directory @var{directory}
1021 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1022 @cindex @code{--directory}
1023 @cindex @code{-d}
1024 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1025
1026 @item -r
1027 @itemx -readnow
1028 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1029 @cindex @code{-r}
1030 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1031 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1032 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1033
1034 @end table
1035
1036 @node Mode Options
1037 @subsection Choosing Modes
1038
1039 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1040 batch mode or quiet mode.
1041
1042 @table @code
1043 @anchor{-nx}
1044 @item -nx
1045 @itemx -n
1046 @cindex @code{--nx}
1047 @cindex @code{-n}
1048 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1049 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1050
1051 @table @code
1052 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1053 This is the system-wide init file.
1054 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1055 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1056 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1057 have been processed.
1058 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1059 This is the init file in your home directory.
1060 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1061 command options have been processed.
1062 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1063 This is the init file in the current directory.
1064 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1065 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1066 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1067 @end table
1068
1069 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1070 For documentation on how to write command files,
1071 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1072
1073 @anchor{-nh}
1074 @item -nh
1075 @cindex @code{--nh}
1076 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1077 in your home directory.
1078 @xref{Startup}.
1079
1080 @item -quiet
1081 @itemx -silent
1082 @itemx -q
1083 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1084 @cindex @code{--silent}
1085 @cindex @code{-q}
1086 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1087 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1088
1089 @item -batch
1090 @cindex @code{--batch}
1091 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1092 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1093 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1094 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1095 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1096 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1097 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1098
1099 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1100 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1101 make this more useful, the message
1102
1103 @smallexample
1104 Program exited normally.
1105 @end smallexample
1106
1107 @noindent
1108 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1109 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1110 mode.
1111
1112 @item -batch-silent
1113 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1114 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1115 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1116 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1117 for an interactive session.
1118
1119 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1120 messages, for example.
1121
1122 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1123 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1124
1125 @item -return-child-result
1126 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1127 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1128 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1129
1130 @itemize @bullet
1131 @item
1132 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1133 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1134 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1135 @item
1136 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1137 @item
1138 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1139 the exit code will be -1.
1140 @end itemize
1141
1142 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1143 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1144 interface.
1145
1146 @item -nowindows
1147 @itemx -nw
1148 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1149 @cindex @code{-nw}
1150 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1151 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1152 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1153
1154 @item -windows
1155 @itemx -w
1156 @cindex @code{--windows}
1157 @cindex @code{-w}
1158 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1159 used if possible.
1160
1161 @item -cd @var{directory}
1162 @cindex @code{--cd}
1163 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1164 instead of the current directory.
1165
1166 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1167 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1168 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1169 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1170 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1171
1172 @item -fullname
1173 @itemx -f
1174 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1175 @cindex @code{-f}
1176 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1177 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1178 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1179 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1180 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1181 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1182 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1183 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1184 frame.
1185
1186 @item -annotate @var{level}
1187 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1188 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1189 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1190 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1191 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1192 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1193 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1194 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1195 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1196
1197 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1198 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1199
1200 @item --args
1201 @cindex @code{--args}
1202 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1203 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1204 This option stops option processing.
1205
1206 @item -baud @var{bps}
1207 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1208 @cindex @code{--baud}
1209 @cindex @code{-b}
1210 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1211 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1212
1213 @item -l @var{timeout}
1214 @cindex @code{-l}
1215 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1216 for remote debugging.
1217
1218 @item -tty @var{device}
1219 @itemx -t @var{device}
1220 @cindex @code{--tty}
1221 @cindex @code{-t}
1222 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1223 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1224
1225 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1226 @item -tui
1227 @cindex @code{--tui}
1228 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1229 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1230 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1231 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1232 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1233 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1234
1235 @c @item -xdb
1236 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1237 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1238 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1239 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1240 @c systems.
1241
1242 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1243 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1244 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1245 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1246 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1247 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1248
1249 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1250 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1251 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1252 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1253 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1254 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1255
1256 @item -write
1257 @cindex @code{--write}
1258 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1259 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1260 (@pxref{Patching}).
1261
1262 @item -statistics
1263 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1264 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1265 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1266
1267 @item -version
1268 @cindex @code{--version}
1269 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1270 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1271
1272 @item -configuration
1273 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1274 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1275 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1276 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1277
1278 @end table
1279
1280 @node Startup
1281 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1282 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1283
1284 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1285
1286 @enumerate
1287 @item
1288 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1289 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1290
1291 @item
1292 @cindex init file
1293 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1294 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1295 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1296 that file.
1297
1298 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1299 @item
1300 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1301 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1302 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1303 that file.
1304
1305 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1306 @item
1307 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1308 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1309 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1310 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1311 gets loaded.
1312
1313 @item
1314 Processes command line options and operands.
1315
1316 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1317 @item
1318 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1319 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1320 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1321 This is only done if the current directory is
1322 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1323 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1324 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1325 @value{GDBN}.
1326
1327 @item
1328 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1329 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1330 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1331 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1332
1333 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1334 you must do something like the following:
1335
1336 @smallexample
1337 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1338 @end smallexample
1339
1340 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1341 off too late.
1342
1343 @item
1344 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1345 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1346 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1347
1348 @item
1349 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1350 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1351 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1352 @end enumerate
1353
1354 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1355 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1356 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1357 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1358 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1359 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1360
1361 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1362 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1363
1364 @cindex init file name
1365 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1366 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1367 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1368 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1369 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1370 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1371 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1372 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1373
1374
1375 @node Quitting GDB
1376 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1377 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1378 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1379
1380 @table @code
1381 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1382 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1383 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1384 @itemx q
1385 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1386 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1387 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1388 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1389 error code.
1390 @end table
1391
1392 @cindex interrupt
1393 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1394 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1395 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1396 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1397 until a time when it is safe.
1398
1399 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1400 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1401 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1402
1403 @node Shell Commands
1404 @section Shell Commands
1405
1406 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1407 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1408 just use the @code{shell} command.
1409
1410 @table @code
1411 @kindex shell
1412 @kindex !
1413 @cindex shell escape
1414 @item shell @var{command-string}
1415 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1416 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1417 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1418 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1419 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1420 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1421 @end table
1422
1423 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1424 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1425 @value{GDBN}:
1426
1427 @table @code
1428 @kindex make
1429 @cindex calling make
1430 @item make @var{make-args}
1431 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1432 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1433 @end table
1434
1435 @node Logging Output
1436 @section Logging Output
1437 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1438 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1439
1440 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1441 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1442
1443 @table @code
1444 @kindex set logging
1445 @item set logging on
1446 Enable logging.
1447 @item set logging off
1448 Disable logging.
1449 @cindex logging file name
1450 @item set logging file @var{file}
1451 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1452 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1453 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1454 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1455 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1456 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1457 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1458 @kindex show logging
1459 @item show logging
1460 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1461 @end table
1462
1463 @node Commands
1464 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1465
1466 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1467 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1468 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1469 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1470 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1471
1472 @menu
1473 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1474 * Completion:: Command completion
1475 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1476 @end menu
1477
1478 @node Command Syntax
1479 @section Command Syntax
1480
1481 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1482 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1483 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1484 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1485 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1486 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1487
1488 @cindex abbreviation
1489 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1490 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1491 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1492 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1493 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1494 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1495 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1496
1497 @cindex repeating commands
1498 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1499 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1500 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1501 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1502 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1503 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1504 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1505
1506 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1507 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1508 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1509
1510 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1511 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1512 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1513 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1514 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1515
1516 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1517 @cindex comment
1518 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1519 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1520 Files,,Command Files}).
1521
1522 @cindex repeating command sequences
1523 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1524 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1525 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1526 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1527 for editing.
1528
1529 @node Completion
1530 @section Command Completion
1531
1532 @cindex completion
1533 @cindex word completion
1534 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1535 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1536 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1537 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1538
1539 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1540 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1541 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1542 enter it). For example, if you type
1543
1544 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1545 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1546 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1547 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1548 @smallexample
1549 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1550 @end smallexample
1551
1552 @noindent
1553 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1554 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1555
1556 @smallexample
1557 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1558 @end smallexample
1559
1560 @noindent
1561 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1562 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1563 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1564 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1565 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1566 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1567
1568 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1569 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1570 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1571 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1572 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1573 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1574 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1575 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1576 example:
1577
1578 @smallexample
1579 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1580 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1581 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1582 make_abs_section make_function_type
1583 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1584 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1585 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1586 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1587 @end smallexample
1588
1589 @noindent
1590 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1591 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1592 command.
1593
1594 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1595 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1596 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1597 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1598 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1599
1600 @cindex quotes in commands
1601 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1602 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1603 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1604 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1605 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1606 @value{GDBN} commands.
1607
1608 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1609 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1610 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1611 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1612 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1613 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1614 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1615 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1616 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1617 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1618 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1619
1620 @smallexample
1621 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1622 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1623 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1624 @end smallexample
1625
1626 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1627 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1628 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1629 place:
1630
1631 @smallexample
1632 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1633 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1634 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1635 @end smallexample
1636
1637 @noindent
1638 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1639 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1640 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1641
1642 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1643 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1644 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1645 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1646
1647 @cindex completion of structure field names
1648 @cindex structure field name completion
1649 @cindex completion of union field names
1650 @cindex union field name completion
1651 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1652 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1653 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1654 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1655 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1656 left-hand-side:
1657
1658 @smallexample
1659 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1660 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1661 to_data to_isatty to_write
1662 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1663 to_flush to_read
1664 @end smallexample
1665
1666 @noindent
1667 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1668 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1669 follows:
1670
1671 @smallexample
1672 struct ui_file
1673 @{
1674 int *magic;
1675 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1676 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1677 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1678 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1679 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1680 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1681 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1682 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1683 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1684 void *to_data;
1685 @}
1686 @end smallexample
1687
1688
1689 @node Help
1690 @section Getting Help
1691 @cindex online documentation
1692 @kindex help
1693
1694 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1695 using the command @code{help}.
1696
1697 @table @code
1698 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1699 @item help
1700 @itemx h
1701 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1702 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1703
1704 @smallexample
1705 (@value{GDBP}) help
1706 List of classes of commands:
1707
1708 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1709 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1710 data -- Examining data
1711 files -- Specifying and examining files
1712 internals -- Maintenance commands
1713 obscure -- Obscure features
1714 running -- Running the program
1715 stack -- Examining the stack
1716 status -- Status inquiries
1717 support -- Support facilities
1718 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1719 stopping the program
1720 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1721
1722 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1723 commands in that class.
1724 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1725 documentation.
1726 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1727 (@value{GDBP})
1728 @end smallexample
1729 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1730
1731 @item help @var{class}
1732 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1733 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1734 help display for the class @code{status}:
1735
1736 @smallexample
1737 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1738 Status inquiries.
1739
1740 List of commands:
1741
1742 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1743 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1744 info -- Generic command for showing things
1745 about the program being debugged
1746 show -- Generic command for showing things
1747 about the debugger
1748
1749 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1750 documentation.
1751 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1752 (@value{GDBP})
1753 @end smallexample
1754
1755 @item help @var{command}
1756 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1757 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1758
1759 @kindex apropos
1760 @item apropos @var{args}
1761 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1762 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1763 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1764
1765 @smallexample
1766 apropos alias
1767 @end smallexample
1768
1769 @noindent
1770 results in:
1771
1772 @smallexample
1773 @c @group
1774 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1775 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1776 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1777 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1778 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1779 @c @end group
1780 @end smallexample
1781
1782 @kindex complete
1783 @item complete @var{args}
1784 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1785 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1786 command you want completed. For example:
1787
1788 @smallexample
1789 complete i
1790 @end smallexample
1791
1792 @noindent results in:
1793
1794 @smallexample
1795 @group
1796 if
1797 ignore
1798 info
1799 inspect
1800 @end group
1801 @end smallexample
1802
1803 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1804 @end table
1805
1806 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1807 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1808 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1809 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1810 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1811 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1812 Index}.
1813
1814 @c @group
1815 @table @code
1816 @kindex info
1817 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1818 @item info
1819 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1820 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1821 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1822 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1823 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1824 @w{@code{help info}}.
1825
1826 @kindex set
1827 @item set
1828 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1829 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1830 @code{set prompt $}.
1831
1832 @kindex show
1833 @item show
1834 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1835 @value{GDBN} itself.
1836 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1837 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1838 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1839 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1840
1841 @kindex info set
1842 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1843 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1844 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1845 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1846 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1847 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1848 @end table
1849 @c @end group
1850
1851 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1852 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1853
1854 @table @code
1855 @kindex show version
1856 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1857 @item show version
1858 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1859 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1860 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1861 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1862 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1863 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1864 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1865 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1866 @value{GDBN}.
1867
1868 @kindex show copying
1869 @kindex info copying
1870 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1871 @item show copying
1872 @itemx info copying
1873 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1874
1875 @kindex show warranty
1876 @kindex info warranty
1877 @item show warranty
1878 @itemx info warranty
1879 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1880 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1881
1882 @kindex show configuration
1883 @item show configuration
1884 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1885 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1886 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1887 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1888 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1889 your report.
1890
1891 @end table
1892
1893 @node Running
1894 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1895
1896 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1897 debugging information when you compile it.
1898
1899 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1900 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1901 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1902 kill a child process.
1903
1904 @menu
1905 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1906 * Starting:: Starting your program
1907 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1908 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1909
1910 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1911 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1912 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1913 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1914
1915 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1916 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1917 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1918 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1919 @end menu
1920
1921 @node Compilation
1922 @section Compiling for Debugging
1923
1924 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1925 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1926 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1927 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1928 and addresses in the executable code.
1929
1930 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1931 the compiler.
1932
1933 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1934 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1935 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1936 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1937 executables containing debugging information.
1938
1939 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1940 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1941 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1942 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1943 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1944
1945 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1946 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1947 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1948
1949 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1950 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1951 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1952 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1953 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1954 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1955
1956 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1957 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1958 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1959
1960 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1961 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1962 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1963 format in @value{GDBN}.
1964
1965 @need 2000
1966 @node Starting
1967 @section Starting your Program
1968 @cindex starting
1969 @cindex running
1970
1971 @table @code
1972 @kindex run
1973 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1974 @item run
1975 @itemx r
1976 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1977 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1978 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1979 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1980 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1981
1982 @end table
1983
1984 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1985 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1986 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1987 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1988 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1989 message like this one:
1990
1991 @smallexample
1992 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1993 Try "help target" or "continue".
1994 @end smallexample
1995
1996 @noindent
1997 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1998 first (@pxref{load}).
1999
2000 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2001 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2002 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2003 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2004 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2005 divided into four categories:
2006
2007 @table @asis
2008 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2009 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2010 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2011 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2012 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2013 the arguments.
2014 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2015 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2016 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2017 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2018 below for details).
2019
2020 @item The @emph{environment.}
2021 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2022 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2023 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2024 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2025
2026 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2027 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2028 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2029 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2030
2031 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2032 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2033 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2034 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2035 set a different device for your program.
2036 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2037
2038 @cindex pipes
2039 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2040 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2041 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2042 wrong program.
2043 @end table
2044
2045 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2046 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2047 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2048 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2049 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2050
2051 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2052 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2053 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2054 your current breakpoints.
2055
2056 @table @code
2057 @kindex start
2058 @item start
2059 @cindex run to main procedure
2060 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2061 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2062 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2063 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2064 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2065 procedure, depending on the language used.
2066
2067 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2068 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2069 the @samp{run} command.
2070
2071 @cindex elaboration phase
2072 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2073 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2074 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2075 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2076 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2077 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2078 will remain to halt execution.
2079
2080 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2081 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2082 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2083 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2084 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2085
2086 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2087 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2088 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2089 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2090 elaboration code before running your program.
2091
2092 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2093 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2094 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2095 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2096 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2097 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2098 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2099 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2100 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2101 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2102 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2103 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2104
2105 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2106 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2107 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2108 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2109
2110 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2111 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2112 environment:
2113
2114 @smallexample
2115 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2116 (@value{GDBP}) run
2117 @end smallexample
2118
2119 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2120 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2121
2122 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2123 @item set startup-with-shell
2124 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2125 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2126 @itemx show set startup-with-shell
2127 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2128 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2129 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2130 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2131 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2132 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2133 startup failures such as:
2134
2135 @smallexample
2136 (@value{GDBP}) run
2137 Starting program: ./a.out
2138 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2139 @end smallexample
2140
2141 @noindent
2142 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2143 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2144 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2145 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2146 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2147 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2148
2149 @kindex set disable-randomization
2150 @item set disable-randomization
2151 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2152 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2153 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2154 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2155 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2156
2157 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2158 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2159
2160 @smallexample
2161 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2162 @end smallexample
2163
2164 @item set disable-randomization off
2165 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2166 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2167 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2168 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2169 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2170 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2171
2172 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2173 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2174 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2175 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2176 a code at its expected addresses.
2177
2178 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2179 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2180 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2181 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2182 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2183 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2184 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2185 a randomly chosen address.
2186
2187 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2188 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2189 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2190 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2191 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2192
2193 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2194 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2195
2196 @item show disable-randomization
2197 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2198 the virtual address space of the started program.
2199
2200 @end table
2201
2202 @node Arguments
2203 @section Your Program's Arguments
2204
2205 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2206 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2207 @code{run} command.
2208 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2209 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2210 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2211 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2212 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2213
2214 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2215 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2216 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2217 the program, not by the shell.
2218
2219 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2220 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2221
2222 @table @code
2223 @kindex set args
2224 @item set args
2225 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2226 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2227 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2228 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2229 it again without arguments.
2230
2231 @kindex show args
2232 @item show args
2233 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2234 @end table
2235
2236 @node Environment
2237 @section Your Program's Environment
2238
2239 @cindex environment (of your program)
2240 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2241 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2242 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2243 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2244 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2245 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2246 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2247
2248 @table @code
2249 @kindex path
2250 @item path @var{directory}
2251 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2252 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2253 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2254 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2255 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2256 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2257 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2258
2259 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2260 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2261 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2262 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2263 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2264 @var{directory} to the search path.
2265 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2266 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2267
2268 @kindex show paths
2269 @item show paths
2270 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2271 environment variable).
2272
2273 @kindex show environment
2274 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2275 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2276 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2277 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2278 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2279
2280 @kindex set environment
2281 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2282 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2283 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2284 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may be any string; the
2285 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2286 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2287 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2288 null value.
2289 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2290 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2291
2292 For example, this command:
2293
2294 @smallexample
2295 set env USER = foo
2296 @end smallexample
2297
2298 @noindent
2299 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2300 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2301 are not actually required.)
2302
2303 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2304 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2305 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2306 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2307 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2308
2309 @kindex unset environment
2310 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2311 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2312 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2313 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2314 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2315 @end table
2316
2317 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2318 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2319 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2320 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2321 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2322 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2323 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2324 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2325 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2326 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2327
2328 @node Working Directory
2329 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2330
2331 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2332 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2333 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2334 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2335 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2336 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2337
2338 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2339 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2340 Specify Files}.
2341
2342 @table @code
2343 @kindex cd
2344 @cindex change working directory
2345 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2346 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2347 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2348
2349 @kindex pwd
2350 @item pwd
2351 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2352 @end table
2353
2354 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2355 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2356 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2357 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2358 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2359 current working directory of the debuggee.
2360
2361 @node Input/Output
2362 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2363
2364 @cindex redirection
2365 @cindex i/o
2366 @cindex terminal
2367 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2368 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2369 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2370 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2371 running your program.
2372
2373 @table @code
2374 @kindex info terminal
2375 @item info terminal
2376 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2377 program is using.
2378 @end table
2379
2380 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2381 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2382
2383 @smallexample
2384 run > outfile
2385 @end smallexample
2386
2387 @noindent
2388 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2389
2390 @kindex tty
2391 @cindex controlling terminal
2392 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2393 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2394 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2395 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2396 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2397
2398 @smallexample
2399 tty /dev/ttyb
2400 @end smallexample
2401
2402 @noindent
2403 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2404 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2405 that as their controlling terminal.
2406
2407 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2408 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2409 terminal.
2410
2411 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2412 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2413 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2414 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2415
2416 @cindex inferior tty
2417 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2418 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2419 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2420 program.
2421
2422 @table @code
2423 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2424 @kindex set inferior-tty
2425 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2426
2427 @item show inferior-tty
2428 @kindex show inferior-tty
2429 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2430 @end table
2431
2432 @node Attach
2433 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2434 @kindex attach
2435 @cindex attach
2436
2437 @table @code
2438 @item attach @var{process-id}
2439 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2440 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2441 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2442 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2443 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2444
2445 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2446 executing the command.
2447 @end table
2448
2449 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2450 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2451 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2452 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2453
2454 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2455 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2456 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2457 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2458 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2459 Specify Files}.
2460
2461 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2462 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2463 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2464 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2465 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2466 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2467 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2468
2469 @table @code
2470 @kindex detach
2471 @item detach
2472 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2473 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2474 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2475 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2476 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2477 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2478 executing the command.
2479 @end table
2480
2481 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2482 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2483 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2484 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2485 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2486 Messages}).
2487
2488 @node Kill Process
2489 @section Killing the Child Process
2490
2491 @table @code
2492 @kindex kill
2493 @item kill
2494 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2495 @end table
2496
2497 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2498 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2499 is running.
2500
2501 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2502 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2503 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2504 outside the debugger.
2505
2506 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2507 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2508 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2509 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2510 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2511 breakpoint settings).
2512
2513 @node Inferiors and Programs
2514 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2515
2516 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2517 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2518 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2519 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2520 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2521 from multiple executables.
2522
2523 @cindex inferior
2524 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2525 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2526 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2527 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2528 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2529 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2530 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2531 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2532 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2533 threads running in it.
2534
2535 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2536 inferiors}}:
2537
2538 @table @code
2539 @kindex info inferiors
2540 @item info inferiors
2541 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2542
2543 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2544
2545 @enumerate
2546 @item
2547 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2548
2549 @item
2550 the target system's inferior identifier
2551
2552 @item
2553 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2554
2555 @end enumerate
2556
2557 @noindent
2558 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2559 indicates the current inferior.
2560
2561 For example,
2562 @end table
2563 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2564
2565 @smallexample
2566 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2567 Num Description Executable
2568 2 process 2307 hello
2569 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2570 @end smallexample
2571
2572 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2573
2574 @table @code
2575 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2576 @item inferior @var{infno}
2577 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2578 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2579 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2580 @end table
2581
2582
2583 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2584 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2585 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2586 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2587 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2588 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2589
2590 @table @code
2591 @kindex add-inferior
2592 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2593 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2594 executable. @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2595 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2596 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2597 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2598
2599 @kindex clone-inferior
2600 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2601 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2602 @var{infno}. @var{n} defaults to 1. @var{infno} defaults to the
2603 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2604 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2605
2606 @smallexample
2607 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2608 Num Description Executable
2609 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2610 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2611 Added inferior 2.
2612 1 inferiors added.
2613 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2614 Num Description Executable
2615 2 <null> helloworld
2616 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2617 @end smallexample
2618
2619 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2620
2621 @kindex remove-inferiors
2622 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2623 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2624 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2625 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2626
2627 @end table
2628
2629 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2630 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2631 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2632 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2633
2634 @table @code
2635 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2636 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2637 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2638 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2639 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2640 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2641
2642 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2643 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2644 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2645 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2646 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2647 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2648 @end table
2649
2650 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2651 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2652 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2653 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2654
2655
2656 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2657 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2658
2659 @table @code
2660 @kindex set print inferior-events
2661 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2662 @item set print inferior-events
2663 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2664 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2665 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2666 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2667 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2668 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2669
2670 @kindex show print inferior-events
2671 @item show print inferior-events
2672 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2673 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2674 @end table
2675
2676 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2677 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2678 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2679
2680
2681 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2682 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2683 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2684 info program-spaces}} command.
2685
2686 @table @code
2687 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2688 @item maint info program-spaces
2689 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2690 @value{GDBN}.
2691
2692 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2693
2694 @enumerate
2695 @item
2696 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2697
2698 @item
2699 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2700 the @code{file} command.
2701
2702 @end enumerate
2703
2704 @noindent
2705 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2706 indicates the current program space.
2707
2708 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2709 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2710 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2711
2712 @smallexample
2713 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2714 Id Executable
2715 2 goodbye
2716 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2717 * 1 hello
2718 @end smallexample
2719
2720 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2721 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2722 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2723 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2724 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2725
2726 @smallexample
2727 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2728 Id Executable
2729 * 1 vfork-test
2730 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2731 @end smallexample
2732
2733 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2734 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2735 @end table
2736
2737 @node Threads
2738 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2739
2740 @cindex threads of execution
2741 @cindex multiple threads
2742 @cindex switching threads
2743 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2744 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2745 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2746 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2747 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2748 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2749 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2750
2751 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2752 programs:
2753
2754 @itemize @bullet
2755 @item automatic notification of new threads
2756 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2757 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2758 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2759 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2760 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2761 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2762 messages on thread start and exit.
2763 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2764 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2765 isn't compatible with the program.
2766 @end itemize
2767
2768 @quotation
2769 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2770 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2771 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2772 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2773 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2774 like this:
2775
2776 @smallexample
2777 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2778 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2779 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2780 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2781 @end smallexample
2782 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2783 @c doesn't support threads"?
2784 @end quotation
2785
2786 @cindex focus of debugging
2787 @cindex current thread
2788 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2789 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2790 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2791 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2792 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2793
2794 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2795 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2796 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2797 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2798 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2799 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2800 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2801 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2802 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2803 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2804
2805 @smallexample
2806 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2807 @end smallexample
2808
2809 @noindent
2810 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2811 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2812 further qualifier.
2813
2814 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2815 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2816 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2817 @c program?
2818 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2819 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2820 @c threads ab initio?
2821
2822 @cindex thread number
2823 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2824 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2825 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2826
2827 @table @code
2828 @kindex info threads
2829 @item info threads @r{[}@var{id}@dots{}@r{]}
2830 Display a summary of all threads currently in your program. Optional
2831 argument @var{id}@dots{} is one or more thread ids separated by spaces, and
2832 means to print information only about the specified thread or threads.
2833 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2834
2835 @enumerate
2836 @item
2837 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2838
2839 @item
2840 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2841
2842 @item
2843 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
2844 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
2845 program itself.
2846
2847 @item
2848 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2849 @end enumerate
2850
2851 @noindent
2852 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2853 indicates the current thread.
2854
2855 For example,
2856 @end table
2857 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2858
2859 @smallexample
2860 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2861 Id Target Id Frame
2862 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2863 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2864 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2865 at threadtest.c:68
2866 @end smallexample
2867
2868 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2869 Solaris-specific command:
2870
2871 @table @code
2872 @item maint info sol-threads
2873 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2874 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2875 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2876 @end table
2877
2878 @table @code
2879 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2880 @item thread @var{threadno}
2881 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2882 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2883 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2884 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2885 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2886
2887 @smallexample
2888 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2889 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
2890 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
2891 8 printf ("hello\n");
2892 @end smallexample
2893
2894 @noindent
2895 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2896 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2897 threads.
2898
2899 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2900 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_thread} contains the number
2901 of the current thread. You may find this useful in writing breakpoint
2902 conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth. See
2903 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2904 information on convenience variables.
2905
2906 @kindex thread apply
2907 @cindex apply command to several threads
2908 @item thread apply [@var{threadno} | all] @var{command}
2909 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2910 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2911 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2912 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2913 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2914 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2915 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2916
2917 @kindex thread name
2918 @cindex name a thread
2919 @item thread name [@var{name}]
2920 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
2921 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
2922 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
2923
2924 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
2925 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
2926 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
2927 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
2928 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
2929
2930 @kindex thread find
2931 @cindex search for a thread
2932 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
2933 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
2934 matches the supplied regular expression.
2935
2936 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
2937 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
2938 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
2939 is the LWP id.
2940
2941 @smallexample
2942 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
2943 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
2944 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
2945 Id Target Id Frame
2946 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
2947 @end smallexample
2948
2949 @kindex set print thread-events
2950 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2951 @item set print thread-events
2952 @itemx set print thread-events on
2953 @itemx set print thread-events off
2954 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2955 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2956 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2957 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2958 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2959
2960 @kindex show print thread-events
2961 @item show print thread-events
2962 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2963 have started and exited.
2964 @end table
2965
2966 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2967 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2968 programs with multiple threads.
2969
2970 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2971 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2972
2973 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
2974 @table @code
2975 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
2976 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
2977 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
2978 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
2979 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
2980 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
2981 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
2982 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
2983 macro.
2984
2985 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
2986 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
2987 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2988 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
2989 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
2990 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
2991
2992 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2993 refers to the default system directories that are
2994 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
2995 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
2996 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
2997
2998 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2999 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3000 was loaded in the inferior process.
3001
3002 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3003 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3004 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3005 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3006 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3007 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3008 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3009
3010 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3011 only on some platforms.
3012
3013 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3014 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3015 Display current libthread_db search path.
3016
3017 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3018 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3019 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3020 @item set debug libthread-db
3021 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3022 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3023 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3024 @end table
3025
3026 @node Forks
3027 @section Debugging Forks
3028
3029 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3030 @cindex multiple processes
3031 @cindex processes, multiple
3032 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3033 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3034 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3035 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3036 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3037 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3038 will cause it to terminate.
3039
3040 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3041 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3042 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3043 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3044 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3045 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3046 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3047 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3048 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3049 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3050
3051 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
3052 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
3053 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
3054 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
3055
3056 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3057 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3058
3059 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3060 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3061
3062 @table @code
3063 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3064 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3065 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3066 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3067 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3068
3069 @table @code
3070 @item parent
3071 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3072 unimpeded. This is the default.
3073
3074 @item child
3075 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3076 unimpeded.
3077
3078 @end table
3079
3080 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3081 @item show follow-fork-mode
3082 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3083 @end table
3084
3085 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3086 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3087 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3088
3089 @table @code
3090 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3091 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3092 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3093 retain debugger control over them both.
3094
3095 @table @code
3096 @item on
3097 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3098 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3099 independently. This is the default.
3100
3101 @item off
3102 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3103 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3104 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3105 is held suspended.
3106
3107 @end table
3108
3109 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3110 @item show detach-on-fork
3111 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3112 @end table
3113
3114 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3115 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3116 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3117 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3118 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3119 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3120
3121 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3122 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3123 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3124 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3125 and Programs}.
3126
3127 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3128 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3129 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3130 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3131 the child process's @code{main}.
3132
3133 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3134 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3135
3136 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3137 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3138 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3139 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3140 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3141 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3142 command.
3143
3144 @table @code
3145 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3146 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3147
3148 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3149 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3150
3151 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3152
3153 @table @code
3154 @item new
3155 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3156 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3157 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3158 original inferior.
3159
3160 For example:
3161
3162 @smallexample
3163 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3164 (gdb) info inferior
3165 Id Description Executable
3166 * 1 <null> prog1
3167 (@value{GDBP}) run
3168 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3169 Program exited normally.
3170 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3171 Id Description Executable
3172 * 2 <null> prog2
3173 1 <null> prog1
3174 @end smallexample
3175
3176 @item same
3177 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3178 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3179 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3180 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3181 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3182
3183 For example:
3184
3185 @smallexample
3186 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3187 Id Description Executable
3188 * 1 <null> prog1
3189 (@value{GDBP}) run
3190 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3191 Program exited normally.
3192 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3193 Id Description Executable
3194 * 1 <null> prog2
3195 @end smallexample
3196
3197 @end table
3198 @end table
3199
3200 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3201 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3202 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3203
3204 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3205 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3206
3207 @cindex checkpoint
3208 @cindex restart
3209 @cindex bookmark
3210 @cindex snapshot of a process
3211 @cindex rewind program state
3212
3213 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3214 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3215 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3216 later.
3217
3218 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3219 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3220 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3221 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3222 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3223
3224 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3225 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3226 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3227 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3228 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3229 start again from there.
3230
3231 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3232 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3233
3234 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3235
3236 @table @code
3237 @kindex checkpoint
3238 @item checkpoint
3239 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3240 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3241 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3242
3243 @kindex info checkpoints
3244 @item info checkpoints
3245 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3246 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3247 listed:
3248
3249 @table @code
3250 @item Checkpoint ID
3251 @item Process ID
3252 @item Code Address
3253 @item Source line, or label
3254 @end table
3255
3256 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3257 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3258 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3259 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3260 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3261 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3262 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3263
3264 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3265 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3266 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3267 the debugger.
3268
3269 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3270 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3271 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3272
3273 @end table
3274
3275 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3276 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3277 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3278 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3279 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3280 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3281 previously read data can be read again.
3282
3283 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3284 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3285 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3286 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3287 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3288 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3289
3290 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3291 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3292 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3293 different execution path this time.
3294
3295 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3296 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3297 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3298 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3299 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3300 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3301 potentially pose a problem.
3302
3303 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3304
3305 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3306 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3307 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3308 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3309 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3310 next.
3311
3312 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3313 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3314 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3315 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3316 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3317
3318 @node Stopping
3319 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3320
3321 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3322 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3323 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3324
3325 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3326 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3327 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3328 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3329 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3330 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3331 explicitly request this information at any time.
3332
3333 @table @code
3334 @kindex info program
3335 @item info program
3336 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3337 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3338 @end table
3339
3340 @menu
3341 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3342 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3343 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3344 Skipping over functions and files
3345 * Signals:: Signals
3346 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3347 @end menu
3348
3349 @node Breakpoints
3350 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3351
3352 @cindex breakpoints
3353 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3354 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3355 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3356 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3357 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3358 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3359 program.
3360
3361 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3362 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
3363 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
3364 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
3365 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
3366 call).
3367
3368 @cindex watchpoints
3369 @cindex data breakpoints
3370 @cindex memory tracing
3371 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3372 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3373 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3374 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3375 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3376 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3377 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3378 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3379 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3380 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3381 same commands.
3382
3383 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3384 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3385 Automatic Display}.
3386
3387 @cindex catchpoints
3388 @cindex breakpoint on events
3389 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3390 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3391 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3392 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3393 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3394 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3395 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3396
3397 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3398 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3399 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3400 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3401 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3402 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3403 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3404 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3405 enable it again.
3406
3407 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3408 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3409 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3410 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3411 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3412 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3413 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3414
3415 @menu
3416 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3417 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3418 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3419 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3420 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3421 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3422 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3423 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3424 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3425 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3426 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3427 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3428 @end menu
3429
3430 @node Set Breaks
3431 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3432
3433 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3434 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3435 @c
3436 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3437
3438 @kindex break
3439 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3440 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3441 @cindex latest breakpoint
3442 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3443 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3444 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3445 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3446 convenience variables.
3447
3448 @table @code
3449 @item break @var{location}
3450 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3451 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3452 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3453 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3454 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3455
3456 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3457 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3458 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3459 that situation.
3460
3461 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3462 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3463 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3464
3465 @item break
3466 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3467 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3468 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3469 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3470 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3471 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3472 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3473 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3474 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3475 inside loops.
3476
3477 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3478 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3479 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3480 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3481 existed when your program stopped.
3482
3483 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3484 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3485 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3486 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3487 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3488 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3489 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3490
3491 @kindex tbreak
3492 @item tbreak @var{args}
3493 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
3494 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3495 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3496 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3497
3498 @kindex hbreak
3499 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3500 @item hbreak @var{args}
3501 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
3502 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3503 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3504 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3505 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3506 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3507 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3508 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3509 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3510 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3511 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3512 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3513 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3514 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3515 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3516 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3517 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3518 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3519
3520 @kindex thbreak
3521 @item thbreak @var{args}
3522 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
3523 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3524 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3525 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3526 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3527 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3528 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3529 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3530
3531 @kindex rbreak
3532 @cindex regular expression
3533 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3534 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3535 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3536 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3537 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3538 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3539 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3540 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3541 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3542
3543 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3544 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3545 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3546 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3547 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3548 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3549
3550 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3551 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3552 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3553 classes.
3554
3555 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3556 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3557 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3558
3559 @smallexample
3560 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3561 @end smallexample
3562
3563 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3564 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3565 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3566 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3567 every function in a given file:
3568
3569 @smallexample
3570 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3571 @end smallexample
3572
3573 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3574 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3575
3576 @kindex info breakpoints
3577 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3578 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3579 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3580 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3581 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3582 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3583 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3584
3585 @table @emph
3586 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3587 @item Type
3588 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3589 @item Disposition
3590 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3591 @item Enabled or Disabled
3592 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3593 that are not enabled.
3594 @item Address
3595 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3596 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3597 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3598 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3599 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3600 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3601 @item What
3602 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3603 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3604 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3605 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3606 @end table
3607
3608 @noindent
3609 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3610 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3611 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3612 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3613 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3614 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3615
3616 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3617 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3618 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3619 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3620
3621 @noindent
3622 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3623 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3624 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3625 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3626 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3627
3628 @noindent
3629 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3630 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3631 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3632 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3633 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3634 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3635
3636 @noindent
3637 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3638 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3639
3640 @end table
3641
3642 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3643 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3644 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3645 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3646
3647 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3648 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3649 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3650 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3651
3652 @itemize @bullet
3653 @item
3654 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3655
3656 @item
3657 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3658 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3659
3660 @item
3661 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3662 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3663
3664 @item
3665 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3666 several places where that function is inlined.
3667 @end itemize
3668
3669 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3670 the relevant locations.
3671
3672 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3673 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3674 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3675 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3676 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3677 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3678 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3679
3680 For example:
3681
3682 @smallexample
3683 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3684 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3685 stop only if i==1
3686 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3687 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3688 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3689 @end smallexample
3690
3691 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3692 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3693 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3694 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3695 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3696 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3697 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3698 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3699 that belong to that breakpoint.
3700
3701 @cindex pending breakpoints
3702 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3703 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3704 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3705 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3706 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3707 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3708 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3709 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3710 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3711 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3712 is not yet resolved.
3713
3714 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3715 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3716 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3717 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3718 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3719 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3720
3721 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3722 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3723 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3724 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3725
3726 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3727 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3728 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3729
3730 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3731 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3732 address specification to an address:
3733
3734 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3735 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3736 @table @code
3737 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3738 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3739 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3740
3741 @item set breakpoint pending on
3742 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3743 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3744
3745 @item set breakpoint pending off
3746 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3747 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3748 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3749
3750 @item show breakpoint pending
3751 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3752 @end table
3753
3754 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3755 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3756 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3757
3758 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3759 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3760 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3761 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3762 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3763 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3764 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3765 breakpoints.
3766
3767 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3768
3769 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3770 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3771 @table @code
3772 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3773 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3774 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3775 breakpoint must be used.
3776
3777 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3778 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3779 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3780 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3781 @end table
3782
3783 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3784 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3785 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3786 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3787 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3788 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3789 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3790 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3791 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3792
3793 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3794 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3795 @table @code
3796 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3797 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3798 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3799 removed from the target when it stops.
3800
3801 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3802 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3803 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3804 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3805 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3806
3807 @cindex non-stop mode, and @code{breakpoint always-inserted}
3808 @item set breakpoint always-inserted auto
3809 This is the default mode. If @value{GDBN} is controlling the inferior
3810 in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), gdb behaves as if
3811 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is on. If @value{GDBN} is
3812 controlling the inferior in all-stop mode, @value{GDBN} behaves as if
3813 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is off.
3814 @end table
3815
3816 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3817 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
3818 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3819
3820 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3821 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3822
3823 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
3824
3825 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
3826 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
3827 @table @code
3828 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
3829 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
3830 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
3831 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
3832 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
3833
3834 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
3835 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
3836 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
3837 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
3838 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
3839 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
3840 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
3841 that is only known to the host. Examples include
3842 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
3843 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
3844 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
3845 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
3846 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
3847
3848 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
3849 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
3850 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
3851 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
3852 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
3853 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
3854 @end table
3855
3856
3857 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3858 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3859 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3860 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3861 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3862 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3863 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3864 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3865
3866
3867 @node Set Watchpoints
3868 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3869
3870 @cindex setting watchpoints
3871 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3872 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3873 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3874 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3875 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3876
3877 @itemize @bullet
3878 @item
3879 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3880
3881 @item
3882 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3883 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3884 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3885
3886 @item
3887 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3888 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3889 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3890 @end itemize
3891
3892 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3893 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3894 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3895 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3896 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3897 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3898 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3899 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3900 the expression changes.
3901
3902 @cindex software watchpoints
3903 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3904 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3905 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3906 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3907 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3908 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3909 culprit.)
3910
3911 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3912 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3913 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3914
3915 @table @code
3916 @kindex watch
3917 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3918 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3919 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3920 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3921 to watch the value of a single variable:
3922
3923 @smallexample
3924 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3925 @end smallexample
3926
3927 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3928 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3929 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3930 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3931 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3932 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3933
3934 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
3935 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
3936 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
3937 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
3938 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
3939 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
3940 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
3941 error.
3942
3943 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
3944 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
3945 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
3946 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
3947 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
3948 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
3949 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
3950 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
3951 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
3952 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
3953 Examples:
3954
3955 @smallexample
3956 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
3957 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
3958 @end smallexample
3959
3960 @kindex rwatch
3961 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3962 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3963 by the program.
3964
3965 @kindex awatch
3966 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3967 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3968 or written into by the program.
3969
3970 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3971 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3972 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
3973 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3974 @end table
3975
3976 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
3977 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
3978 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
3979 a never-changing value:
3980
3981 @smallexample
3982 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
3983 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
3984 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
3985 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
3986 @end smallexample
3987
3988 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3989 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3990 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3991 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3992 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3993 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3994
3995 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3996 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3997 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3998 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3999 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4000 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4001 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4002 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4003
4004 @table @code
4005 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4006 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4007 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4008
4009 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4010 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4011 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4012 @end table
4013
4014 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4015 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4016 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4017
4018 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4019
4020 @smallexample
4021 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4022 @end smallexample
4023
4024 @noindent
4025 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4026
4027 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4028 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4029 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4030 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4031 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4032 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4033 will print a message like this:
4034
4035 @smallexample
4036 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4037 @end smallexample
4038
4039 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4040 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4041 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4042 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4043 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4044 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4045 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4046 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4047
4048 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4049 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4050 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4051 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4052 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4053 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4054
4055 @smallexample
4056 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4057 @end smallexample
4058
4059 @noindent
4060 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4061
4062 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4063 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4064 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4065 expression with separately allocated resources.
4066
4067 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4068 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4069 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4070
4071 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4072 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4073 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4074 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4075 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4076 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4077 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4078 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4079 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4080
4081 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4082 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4083 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4084 watched expression from every thread.
4085
4086 @quotation
4087 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4088 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4089 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4090 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4091 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4092 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4093 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4094 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4095 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4096 @end quotation
4097
4098 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4099
4100 @node Set Catchpoints
4101 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4102 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4103 @cindex exception handlers
4104 @cindex event handling
4105
4106 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4107 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4108 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4109
4110 @table @code
4111 @kindex catch
4112 @item catch @var{event}
4113 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
4114
4115 @table @code
4116 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4117 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4118 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4119 @kindex catch throw
4120 @kindex catch rethrow
4121 @kindex catch catch
4122 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4123 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4124
4125 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4126 regular expression will be caught.
4127
4128 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4129 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4130 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4131 exception being thrown.
4132
4133 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4134 @value{GDBN}:
4135
4136 @itemize @bullet
4137 @item
4138 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4139 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4140 supported.
4141
4142 @item
4143 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4144 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4145 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4146 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4147 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4148 built.
4149
4150 @item
4151 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4152 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4153
4154 @item
4155 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4156 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4157 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4158 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4159
4160 @item
4161 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4162 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4163 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4164 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4165 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4166 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4167 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4168 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4169 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4170
4171 @item
4172 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4173
4174 @item
4175 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4176 @end itemize
4177
4178 @item exception
4179 @kindex catch exception
4180 @cindex Ada exception catching
4181 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4182 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4183 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4184 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4185 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4186
4187 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4188 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4189 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4190 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4191 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4192 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4193 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4194 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4195
4196 @item exception unhandled
4197 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4198 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4199
4200 @item assert
4201 @kindex catch assert
4202 A failed Ada assertion.
4203
4204 @item exec
4205 @kindex catch exec
4206 @cindex break on fork/exec
4207 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4208 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4209
4210 @item syscall
4211 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
4212 @kindex catch syscall
4213 @cindex break on a system call.
4214 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4215 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4216 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4217 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4218 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4219 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4220 will be caught.
4221
4222 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4223 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4224 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4225 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4226
4227 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4228 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4229 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4230 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4231
4232 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4233 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4234 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4235 available choices.
4236
4237 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4238 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4239 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4240 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4241 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4242 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4243 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4244 behind the OS upgrades).
4245
4246 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4247 arguments to it:
4248
4249 @smallexample
4250 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4251 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4252 (@value{GDBP}) r
4253 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4254
4255 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4256 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4257 (@value{GDBP}) c
4258 Continuing.
4259
4260 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4261 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4262 (@value{GDBP})
4263 @end smallexample
4264
4265 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4266
4267 @smallexample
4268 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4269 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4270 (@value{GDBP}) r
4271 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4272
4273 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4274 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4275 (@value{GDBP}) c
4276 Continuing.
4277
4278 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4279 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4280 (@value{GDBP})
4281 @end smallexample
4282
4283 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4284 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4285 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4286
4287 @smallexample
4288 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4289 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4290 (@value{GDBP}) r
4291 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4292
4293 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4294 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4295 (@value{GDBP}) c
4296 Continuing.
4297
4298 Program exited normally.
4299 (@value{GDBP})
4300 @end smallexample
4301
4302 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4303 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4304 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4305 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4306
4307 @smallexample
4308 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4309 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4310 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4311 (@value{GDBP})
4312 @end smallexample
4313
4314 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4315 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4316 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4317 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4318 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4319 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4320
4321 @smallexample
4322 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4323 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4324 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4325 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4326 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4327 (@value{GDBP})
4328 @end smallexample
4329
4330 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4331
4332 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4333 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4334
4335 @smallexample
4336 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4337 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4338 @end smallexample
4339
4340 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4341
4342 @item fork
4343 @kindex catch fork
4344 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4345 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4346
4347 @item vfork
4348 @kindex catch vfork
4349 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4350 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4351
4352 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4353 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4354 @kindex catch load
4355 @kindex catch unload
4356 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4357 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4358 matches one of the affected libraries.
4359
4360 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4361 @kindex catch signal
4362 The delivery of a signal.
4363
4364 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4365 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4366 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4367
4368 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4369 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4370 signal names.
4371
4372 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4373 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4374 will be caught.
4375
4376 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4377 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4378 catchpoint.
4379
4380 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4381 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4382 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4383 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4384 commands.
4385
4386 @end table
4387
4388 @item tcatch @var{event}
4389 @kindex tcatch
4390 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4391 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4392
4393 @end table
4394
4395 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4396
4397
4398 @node Delete Breaks
4399 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4400
4401 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4402 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4403 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4404 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4405 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4406 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4407
4408 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4409 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4410 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4411 their breakpoint numbers.
4412
4413 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4414 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4415 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4416
4417 @table @code
4418 @kindex clear
4419 @item clear
4420 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4421 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4422 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4423 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4424
4425 @item clear @var{location}
4426 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4427 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4428 most useful ones are listed below:
4429
4430 @table @code
4431 @item clear @var{function}
4432 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4433 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4434
4435 @item clear @var{linenum}
4436 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4437 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4438 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4439 @end table
4440
4441 @cindex delete breakpoints
4442 @kindex delete
4443 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4444 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4445 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4446 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4447 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4448 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4449 @end table
4450
4451 @node Disabling
4452 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4453
4454 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4455 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4456 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4457 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4458 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4459
4460 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4461 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4462 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4463 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4464 do not know which numbers to use.
4465
4466 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4467 affects all of its locations.
4468
4469 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4470 different states of enablement:
4471
4472 @itemize @bullet
4473 @item
4474 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4475 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4476 @item
4477 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4478 @item
4479 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4480 disabled.
4481 @item
4482 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4483 N times, then becomes disabled.
4484 @item
4485 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4486 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4487 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4488 @end itemize
4489
4490 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4491 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4492
4493 @table @code
4494 @kindex disable
4495 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4496 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4497 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4498 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4499 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4500 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4501 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4502
4503 @kindex enable
4504 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4505 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4506 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4507
4508 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4509 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4510 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4511
4512 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{range}@dots{}
4513 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4514 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4515 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4516 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4517 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4518 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4519
4520 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4521 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4522 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4523 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4524 @end table
4525
4526 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4527 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4528 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4529 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4530 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4531 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4532 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4533 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4534 Stepping}.)
4535
4536 @node Conditions
4537 @subsection Break Conditions
4538 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4539 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4540
4541 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4542 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4543 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4544 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4545 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4546 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4547 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4548 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4549
4550 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4551 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4552 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4553 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4554 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4555
4556 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4557 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4558 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4559 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4560 one.
4561
4562 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4563 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4564 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4565 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4566 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4567 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4568 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4569 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4570 conditions for the
4571 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4572 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4573
4574 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4575 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4576 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4577 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4578 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4579 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4580
4581 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4582 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4583 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4584 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4585 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4586
4587 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4588 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4589 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4590 with the @code{condition} command.
4591
4592 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4593 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4594 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4595 catchpoint.
4596
4597 @table @code
4598 @kindex condition
4599 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4600 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4601 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4602 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4603 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4604 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4605 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4606 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4607 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4608 prints an error message:
4609
4610 @smallexample
4611 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4612 @end smallexample
4613
4614 @noindent
4615 @value{GDBN} does
4616 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4617 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4618 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4619
4620 @item condition @var{bnum}
4621 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4622 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4623 @end table
4624
4625 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4626 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4627 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4628 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4629 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4630 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4631 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4632 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4633 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4634 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4635 your program reaches it.
4636
4637 @table @code
4638 @kindex ignore
4639 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4640 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4641 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4642 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4643 takes no action.
4644
4645 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4646 a count of zero.
4647
4648 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4649 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4650 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4651 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4652
4653 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4654 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4655 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4656
4657 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4658 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4659 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4660 Variables}.
4661 @end table
4662
4663 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4664
4665
4666 @node Break Commands
4667 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4668
4669 @cindex breakpoint commands
4670 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4671 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4672 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4673 enable other breakpoints.
4674
4675 @table @code
4676 @kindex commands
4677 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4678 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4679 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4680 @itemx end
4681 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4682 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4683 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4684
4685 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4686 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4687
4688 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4689 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4690 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4691 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4692 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4693 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4694 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4695 Expressions}).
4696 @end table
4697
4698 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4699 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4700
4701 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4702 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4703 that resumes execution.
4704
4705 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4706 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4707 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4708 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4709 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4710
4711 @kindex silent
4712 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4713 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4714 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4715 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4716 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4717 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4718
4719 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4720 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4721 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4722
4723 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4724 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4725
4726 @smallexample
4727 break foo if x>0
4728 commands
4729 silent
4730 printf "x is %d\n",x
4731 cont
4732 end
4733 @end smallexample
4734
4735 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4736 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4737 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4738 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4739 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4740 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4741 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4742
4743 @smallexample
4744 break 403
4745 commands
4746 silent
4747 set x = y + 4
4748 cont
4749 end
4750 @end smallexample
4751
4752 @node Dynamic Printf
4753 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4754
4755 @cindex dynamic printf
4756 @cindex dprintf
4757 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4758 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4759 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4760 having to recompile it.
4761
4762 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4763 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4764 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4765 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4766 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4767 redirects to files and so forth.
4768
4769 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4770 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4771 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4772 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4773 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4774 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4775 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4776
4777 @table @code
4778 @kindex dprintf
4779 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4780 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4781 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4782 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4783
4784 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4785 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4786 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4787 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4788 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4789 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4790
4791 @item gdb
4792 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
4793 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4794
4795 @item call
4796 @kindex dprintf-style call
4797 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4798 @code{printf}).
4799
4800 @item agent
4801 @kindex dprintf-style agent
4802 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
4803 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
4804 support running commands on the target.
4805
4806 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
4807 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
4808 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
4809 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
4810 command.
4811
4812 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
4813 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
4814 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
4815 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
4816 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
4817 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
4818
4819 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
4820 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
4821 you could do the following:
4822
4823 @example
4824 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
4825 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
4826 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
4827 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
4828 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
4829 (gdb) info break
4830 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
4831 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
4832 continue
4833 (gdb)
4834 @end example
4835
4836 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
4837 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
4838 the variable settings.
4839
4840 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
4841 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
4842 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
4843 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
4844 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
4845 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
4846
4847 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
4848 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
4849 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
4850
4851 @end table
4852
4853 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
4854 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
4855 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
4856 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
4857 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
4858 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
4859
4860 @node Save Breakpoints
4861 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
4862
4863 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
4864 breakpoints}} command.
4865
4866 @table @code
4867 @kindex save breakpoints
4868 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
4869 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
4870 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
4871 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
4872 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
4873 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
4874 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
4875 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
4876 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
4877 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
4878 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
4879 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
4880 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
4881 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
4882 that can no longer be recreated.
4883 @end table
4884
4885 @node Static Probe Points
4886 @subsection Static Probe Points
4887
4888 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
4889 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
4890 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
4891 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations. They are
4892 usable from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages. See
4893 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
4894 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.
4895
4896 Currently, @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
4897 @acronym{SDT} probes are supported on ELF-compatible systems. See
4898 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
4899 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT} probes
4900 in your applications.
4901
4902 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
4903 Some probes have an associated semaphore variable; for instance, this
4904 happens automatically if you defined your probe using a DTrace-style
4905 @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore, @value{GDBN} will
4906 automatically enable it when you specify a breakpoint using the
4907 @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a breakpoint at a probe's
4908 location by some other method (e.g., @code{break file:line}), then
4909 @value{GDBN} will not automatically set the semaphore.
4910
4911 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
4912 probes}, with optional arguments:
4913
4914 @table @code
4915 @kindex info probes
4916 @item info probes stap @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
4917 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
4918 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
4919 probes from all providers are listed.
4920
4921 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
4922 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
4923 considered when deciding whether to display them.
4924
4925 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
4926 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
4927 given, all object files are considered.
4928
4929 @item info probes all
4930 List the available static probes, from all types.
4931 @end table
4932
4933 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
4934 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
4935 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
4936 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
4937 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
4938 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. Each probe argument is
4939 an integer of the appropriate size; types are not preserved. The
4940 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
4941 at the current probe point.
4942
4943 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
4944 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
4945 an error message.
4946
4947
4948 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
4949 @node Error in Breakpoints
4950 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4951
4952 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
4953 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
4954
4955 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
4956 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
4957 @smallexample
4958 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
4959 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
4960 @end smallexample
4961
4962 @noindent
4963 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
4964 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
4965 watchpoints it needs to insert.
4966
4967 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
4968 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
4969
4970 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
4971 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4972 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
4973
4974 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
4975 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
4976 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
4977 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
4978
4979 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
4980 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
4981 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
4982 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
4983 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
4984 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
4985 first in the bundle.
4986
4987 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
4988 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
4989 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
4990 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
4991 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
4992 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
4993 is hit.
4994
4995 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
4996 that's been subject to address adjustment:
4997
4998 @smallexample
4999 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5000 @end smallexample
5001
5002 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5003 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5004 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5005 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5006 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5007 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5008 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5009 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5010
5011 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5012 adjusted breakpoints:
5013
5014 @smallexample
5015 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5016 to 0x00010410.
5017 @end smallexample
5018
5019 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5020 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5021 frequently than expected.
5022
5023 @node Continuing and Stepping
5024 @section Continuing and Stepping
5025
5026 @cindex stepping
5027 @cindex continuing
5028 @cindex resuming execution
5029 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5030 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5031 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5032 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5033 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5034 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5035 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5036 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
5037
5038 @table @code
5039 @kindex continue
5040 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5041 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5042 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5043 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5044 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5045 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5046 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5047 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5048 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5049 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5050
5051 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5052 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5053 @code{continue} is ignored.
5054
5055 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5056 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5057 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5058 @code{continue}.
5059 @end table
5060
5061 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5062 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5063 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5064 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5065
5066 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5067 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5068 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5069 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5070 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5071 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5072
5073 @table @code
5074 @kindex step
5075 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5076 @item step
5077 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5078 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5079 abbreviated @code{s}.
5080
5081 @quotation
5082 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5083 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5084 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5085 @c distinction here.
5086 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5087 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5088 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5089 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5090 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5091 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5092 below.
5093 @end quotation
5094
5095 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5096 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5097 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5098 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5099 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5100 called within the line.
5101
5102 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5103 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5104 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5105 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5106 was any debugging information about the routine.
5107
5108 @item step @var{count}
5109 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5110 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5111 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5112
5113 @kindex next
5114 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5115 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5116 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5117 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5118 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5119 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5120 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5121 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5122
5123 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5124
5125
5126 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5127 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5128 @c
5129 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5130 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5131 @c function are executed without stopping.
5132
5133 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5134 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5135 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5136
5137 @kindex set step-mode
5138 @item set step-mode
5139 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5140 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5141 @itemx set step-mode on
5142 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5143 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5144 information rather than stepping over it.
5145
5146 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5147 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5148 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5149
5150 @item set step-mode off
5151 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5152 debug information. This is the default.
5153
5154 @item show step-mode
5155 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5156 source line debug information.
5157
5158 @kindex finish
5159 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5160 @item finish
5161 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5162 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5163 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5164
5165 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5166 ,Returning from a Function}).
5167
5168 @kindex until
5169 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5170 @cindex run until specified location
5171 @item until
5172 @itemx u
5173 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5174 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5175 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5176 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5177 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5178 than the address of the jump.
5179
5180 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5181 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5182 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5183 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5184 through the next iteration.
5185
5186 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5187 stack frame.
5188
5189 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5190 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5191 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5192 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5193 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5194
5195 @smallexample
5196 (@value{GDBP}) f
5197 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5198 206 expand_input();
5199 (@value{GDBP}) until
5200 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5201 @end smallexample
5202
5203 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5204 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5205 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5206 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5207 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5208 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5209 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5210
5211 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5212 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5213 argument.
5214
5215 @item until @var{location}
5216 @itemx u @var{location}
5217 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
5218 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
5219 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5220 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5221 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5222 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5223 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5224 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5225 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5226 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5227 invocations have returned.
5228
5229 @smallexample
5230 94 int factorial (int value)
5231 95 @{
5232 96 if (value > 1) @{
5233 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5234 98 @}
5235 99 return (value);
5236 100 @}
5237 @end smallexample
5238
5239
5240 @kindex advance @var{location}
5241 @item advance @var{location}
5242 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5243 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5244 @ref{Specify Location}.
5245 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5246 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5247 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5248 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5249
5250
5251 @kindex stepi
5252 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5253 @item stepi
5254 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5255 @itemx si
5256 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5257
5258 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5259 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5260 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5261 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5262
5263 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5264
5265 @need 750
5266 @kindex nexti
5267 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5268 @item nexti
5269 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5270 @itemx ni
5271 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5272 proceed until the function returns.
5273
5274 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5275
5276 @end table
5277
5278 @anchor{range stepping}
5279 @cindex range stepping
5280 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5281 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5282 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5283 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5284 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5285 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5286 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5287 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5288 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5289 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5290 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5291 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5292 if necessary:
5293
5294 @table @code
5295 @kindex set range-stepping
5296 @kindex show range-stepping
5297 @item set range-stepping
5298 @itemx show range-stepping
5299 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5300
5301 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5302 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5303 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5304 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5305 default is @code{on}.
5306
5307 @end table
5308
5309 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5310 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5311 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5312
5313 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5314 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} comand lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5315 skip a function or all functions in a file when stepping.
5316
5317 For example, consider the following C function:
5318
5319 @smallexample
5320 101 int func()
5321 102 @{
5322 103 foo(boring());
5323 104 bar(boring());
5324 105 @}
5325 @end smallexample
5326
5327 @noindent
5328 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5329 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5330 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5331 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5332
5333 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5334 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5335 is called from many places.
5336
5337 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5338 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5339 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5340 @code{foo}.
5341
5342 You can also instruct @value{GDBN} to skip all functions in a file, with, for
5343 example, @code{skip file boring.c}.
5344
5345 @table @code
5346 @kindex skip function
5347 @item skip @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5348 @itemx skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5349 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5350 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5351 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5352
5353 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5354 will be skipped.
5355
5356 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5357 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5358
5359 @kindex skip file
5360 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5361 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5362 will be skipped over when stepping.
5363
5364 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5365 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5366 @end table
5367
5368 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5369 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5370
5371 @table @code
5372 @kindex info skip
5373 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5374 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5375 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5376 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5377
5378 @table @emph
5379 @item Identifier
5380 A number identifying this skip.
5381 @item Type
5382 The type of this skip, either @samp{function} or @samp{file}.
5383 @item Enabled or Disabled
5384 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}. Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5385 @item Address
5386 For function skips, this column indicates the address in memory of the function
5387 being skipped. If you've set a function skip on a function which has not yet
5388 been loaded, this field will contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Once a shared library
5389 which has the function is loaded, @code{info skip} will show the function's
5390 address here.
5391 @item What
5392 For file skips, this field contains the filename being skipped. For functions
5393 skips, this field contains the function name and its line number in the file
5394 where it is defined.
5395 @end table
5396
5397 @kindex skip delete
5398 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5399 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5400 skips.
5401
5402 @kindex skip enable
5403 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5404 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5405 skips.
5406
5407 @kindex skip disable
5408 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5409 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5410 skips.
5411
5412 @end table
5413
5414 @node Signals
5415 @section Signals
5416 @cindex signals
5417
5418 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5419 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5420 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5421 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5422 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5423 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5424 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5425 requested an alarm).
5426
5427 @cindex fatal signals
5428 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5429 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5430 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5431 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5432 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5433 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5434
5435 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5436 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5437 signal.
5438
5439 @cindex handling signals
5440 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5441 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5442 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5443 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5444 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5445
5446 @table @code
5447 @kindex info signals
5448 @kindex info handle
5449 @item info signals
5450 @itemx info handle
5451 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5452 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5453 the defined types of signals.
5454
5455 @item info signals @var{sig}
5456 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5457
5458 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5459
5460 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5461 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5462 for details about this command.
5463
5464 @kindex handle
5465 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5466 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
5467 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5468 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5469 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5470 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5471 say what change to make.
5472 @end table
5473
5474 @c @group
5475 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5476 Their full names are:
5477
5478 @table @code
5479 @item nostop
5480 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5481 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5482
5483 @item stop
5484 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5485 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5486
5487 @item print
5488 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5489
5490 @item noprint
5491 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5492 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5493
5494 @item pass
5495 @itemx noignore
5496 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5497 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5498 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5499
5500 @item nopass
5501 @itemx ignore
5502 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5503 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5504 @end table
5505 @c @end group
5506
5507 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5508 program until you
5509 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5510 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5511 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5512 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5513 program sees that signal when you continue.
5514
5515 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5516 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5517 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5518 erroneous signals.
5519
5520 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5521 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5522 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5523 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5524 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5525 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5526 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5527 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5528 Program a Signal}.
5529
5530 @cindex extra signal information
5531 @anchor{extra signal information}
5532
5533 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5534 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5535 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5536 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5537 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5538 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5539 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5540 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5541 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5542 system header.
5543
5544 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5545 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5546
5547 @smallexample
5548 @group
5549 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5550 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5551 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5552 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5553 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5554 type = struct @{
5555 int si_signo;
5556 int si_errno;
5557 int si_code;
5558 union @{
5559 int _pad[28];
5560 struct @{...@} _kill;
5561 struct @{...@} _timer;
5562 struct @{...@} _rt;
5563 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5564 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5565 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5566 @} _sifields;
5567 @}
5568 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5569 type = struct @{
5570 void *si_addr;
5571 @}
5572 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5573 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5574 @end group
5575 @end smallexample
5576
5577 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5578
5579 @node Thread Stops
5580 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5581
5582 @cindex stopped threads
5583 @cindex threads, stopped
5584
5585 @cindex continuing threads
5586 @cindex threads, continuing
5587
5588 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5589 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5590 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5591 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5592 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5593 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5594 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5595 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5596 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5597
5598 @menu
5599 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5600 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5601 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
5602 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
5603 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
5604 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
5605 @end menu
5606
5607 @node All-Stop Mode
5608 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5609
5610 @cindex all-stop mode
5611
5612 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5613 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5614 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5615 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5616 underfoot.
5617
5618 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5619 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5620 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5621
5622 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5623 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5624 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5625 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5626 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5627 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
5628 stops.
5629
5630 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
5631 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
5632 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
5633 first thread completes whatever you requested.
5634
5635 @cindex automatic thread selection
5636 @cindex switching threads automatically
5637 @cindex threads, automatic switching
5638 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
5639 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
5640 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
5641 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
5642 thread.
5643
5644 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
5645 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
5646
5647 @table @code
5648 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
5649 @cindex scheduler locking mode
5650 @cindex lock scheduler
5651 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
5652 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
5653 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
5654 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
5655 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
5656 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
5657 Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
5658 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
5659 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
5660 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
5661 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
5662 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
5663
5664 @item show scheduler-locking
5665 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
5666 @end table
5667
5668 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
5669 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
5670 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
5671 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
5672 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
5673 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
5674 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
5675 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
5676 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
5677 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
5678 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
5679 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
5680 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
5681 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
5682
5683 @table @code
5684 @kindex set schedule-multiple
5685 @item set schedule-multiple
5686 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
5687 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
5688 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
5689 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
5690 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
5691 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
5692
5693 @item show schedule-multiple
5694 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5695 multiple processes.
5696 @end table
5697
5698 @node Non-Stop Mode
5699 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
5700
5701 @cindex non-stop mode
5702
5703 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5704 @c with more details.
5705
5706 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5707 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5708 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5709 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5710 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5711 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5712
5713 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5714 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5715 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5716 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5717 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5718 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5719 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5720 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5721 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5722 independently and simultaneously.
5723
5724 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5725 or attach to your program:
5726
5727 @smallexample
5728 # Enable the async interface.
5729 set target-async 1
5730
5731 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5732 set pagination off
5733
5734 # Finally, turn it on!
5735 set non-stop on
5736 @end smallexample
5737
5738 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
5739
5740 @table @code
5741 @kindex set non-stop
5742 @item set non-stop on
5743 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
5744 @item set non-stop off
5745 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
5746 @kindex show non-stop
5747 @item show non-stop
5748 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
5749 @end table
5750
5751 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
5752 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
5753 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
5754 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
5755 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
5756 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
5757 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
5758 default.
5759
5760 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
5761 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
5762 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
5763
5764 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
5765 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
5766 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
5767 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
5768 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
5769
5770 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
5771 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
5772 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
5773 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
5774 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
5775
5776 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
5777
5778 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
5779 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
5780 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
5781 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
5782 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
5783 previously current thread.
5784
5785 @node Background Execution
5786 @subsection Background Execution
5787
5788 @cindex foreground execution
5789 @cindex background execution
5790 @cindex asynchronous execution
5791 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
5792
5793 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
5794 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
5795 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
5796 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
5797 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
5798 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
5799
5800 You need to explicitly enable asynchronous mode before you can use
5801 background execution commands. You can use these commands to
5802 manipulate the asynchronous mode setting:
5803
5804 @table @code
5805 @kindex set target-async
5806 @item set target-async on
5807 Enable asynchronous mode.
5808 @item set target-async off
5809 Disable asynchronous mode.
5810 @kindex show target-async
5811 @item show target-async
5812 Show the current target-async setting.
5813 @end table
5814
5815 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
5816 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
5817
5818 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
5819 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
5820 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
5821 are:
5822
5823 @table @code
5824 @kindex run&
5825 @item run
5826 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
5827
5828 @item attach
5829 @kindex attach&
5830 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
5831
5832 @item step
5833 @kindex step&
5834 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
5835
5836 @item stepi
5837 @kindex stepi&
5838 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
5839
5840 @item next
5841 @kindex next&
5842 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
5843
5844 @item nexti
5845 @kindex nexti&
5846 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
5847
5848 @item continue
5849 @kindex continue&
5850 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
5851
5852 @item finish
5853 @kindex finish&
5854 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
5855
5856 @item until
5857 @kindex until&
5858 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
5859
5860 @end table
5861
5862 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
5863 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
5864 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
5865 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
5866 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
5867 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
5868
5869 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
5870 using the @code{interrupt} command.
5871
5872 @table @code
5873 @kindex interrupt
5874 @item interrupt
5875 @itemx interrupt -a
5876
5877 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
5878 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
5879 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
5880 use @code{interrupt -a}.
5881 @end table
5882
5883 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5884 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5885
5886 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
5887 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
5888 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
5889
5890 @table @code
5891 @cindex breakpoints and threads
5892 @cindex thread breakpoints
5893 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
5894 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
5895 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
5896 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
5897 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
5898 specify some source line.
5899
5900 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
5901 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
5902 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
5903 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
5904 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
5905
5906 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
5907 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
5908 program.
5909
5910 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
5911 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before or
5912 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
5913
5914 @smallexample
5915 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
5916 @end smallexample
5917
5918 @end table
5919
5920 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
5921 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
5922 thread list. For example:
5923
5924 @smallexample
5925 (@value{GDBP}) c
5926 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
5927 @end smallexample
5928
5929 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
5930 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
5931 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
5932 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
5933 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
5934 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
5935 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
5936 command.
5937
5938 @node Interrupted System Calls
5939 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
5940
5941 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
5942 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
5943 @cindex premature return from system calls
5944 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
5945 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
5946 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
5947 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
5948 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
5949 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
5950 stop execution.
5951
5952 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
5953 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
5954 style anyways.
5955
5956 For example, do not write code like this:
5957
5958 @smallexample
5959 sleep (10);
5960 @end smallexample
5961
5962 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
5963 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
5964
5965 Instead, write this:
5966
5967 @smallexample
5968 int unslept = 10;
5969 while (unslept > 0)
5970 unslept = sleep (unslept);
5971 @end smallexample
5972
5973 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
5974 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
5975 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
5976 @value{GDBN}.
5977
5978 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
5979 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
5980 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
5981 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
5982
5983 @node Observer Mode
5984 @subsection Observer Mode
5985
5986 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
5987 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
5988 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
5989 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
5990 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
5991
5992 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
5993 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
5994 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
5995 mode.
5996
5997 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
5998 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
5999 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6000 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6001 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6002
6003 @table @code
6004
6005 @kindex observer
6006 @item set observer on
6007 @itemx set observer off
6008 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6009 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6010 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6011 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6012
6013 @item show observer
6014 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6015
6016 @kindex may-write-registers
6017 @item set may-write-registers on
6018 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6019 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6020 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6021 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6022
6023 @item show may-write-registers
6024 Show the current permission to write registers.
6025
6026 @kindex may-write-memory
6027 @item set may-write-memory on
6028 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6029 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6030 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6031 defaults to @code{on}.
6032
6033 @item show may-write-memory
6034 Show the current permission to write memory.
6035
6036 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6037 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6038 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6039 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6040 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6041 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6042
6043 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6044 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6045
6046 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6047 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6048 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6049 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6050 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6051 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6052 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6053
6054 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6055 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6056
6057 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6058 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6059 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6060 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6061 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6062 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6063 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6064
6065 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6066 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6067
6068 @kindex may-interrupt
6069 @item set may-interrupt on
6070 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6071 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6072 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6073 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6074 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6075
6076 @item show may-interrupt
6077 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6078
6079 @end table
6080
6081 @node Reverse Execution
6082 @chapter Running programs backward
6083 @cindex reverse execution
6084 @cindex running programs backward
6085
6086 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6087 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6088 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6089 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6090
6091 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6092 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6093 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6094 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6095 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6096 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6097
6098 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6099 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6100 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6101 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6102 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6103 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6104 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6105 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6106 prior values@footnote{
6107 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6108 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6109 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6110
6111 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6112 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6113 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6114 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6115 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6116 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6117 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6118 }.
6119
6120 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6121 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6122
6123 @table @code
6124 @kindex reverse-continue
6125 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6126 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6127 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6128 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6129 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6130 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6131 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6132
6133 @kindex reverse-step
6134 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6135 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6136 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6137 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6138
6139 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6140 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6141 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6142 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6143 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6144 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6145
6146 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6147 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6148
6149 @kindex reverse-stepi
6150 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6151 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6152 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6153 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6154 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6155 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6156 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6157
6158 @kindex reverse-next
6159 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6160 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6161 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6162 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6163 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6164 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6165 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6166 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6167 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6168 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6169
6170 @kindex reverse-nexti
6171 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6172 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6173 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6174 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6175 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6176 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6177 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6178 frame) is reached.
6179
6180 @kindex reverse-finish
6181 @item reverse-finish
6182 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6183 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6184 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6185 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6186
6187 @kindex set exec-direction
6188 @item set exec-direction
6189 Set the direction of target execution.
6190 @item set exec-direction reverse
6191 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6192 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6193 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6194 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6195 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6196 @item set exec-direction forward
6197 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6198 This is the default.
6199 @end table
6200
6201
6202 @node Process Record and Replay
6203 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6204 @cindex process record and replay
6205 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6206
6207 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6208 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6209 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6210
6211 @cindex replay mode
6212 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6213 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6214 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6215 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6216 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6217 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6218 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6219 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6220 execution log.
6221
6222 @cindex record mode
6223 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6224 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6225 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6226 for future replay.
6227
6228 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6229 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6230 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6231 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6232 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6233 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6234
6235 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6236 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6237 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6238 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6239
6240 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6241 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6242
6243 @table @code
6244 @kindex target record
6245 @kindex target record-full
6246 @kindex target record-btrace
6247 @kindex record
6248 @kindex record full
6249 @kindex record btrace
6250 @kindex rec
6251 @kindex rec full
6252 @kindex rec btrace
6253 @item record @var{method}
6254 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6255 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6256 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6257 recording methods are available:
6258
6259 @table @code
6260 @item full
6261 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6262 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6263 execution.
6264
6265 @item btrace
6266 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6267 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6268 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited replay and
6269 reverse execution.
6270
6271 This recording method may not be available on all processors.
6272 @end table
6273
6274 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6275 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6276 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6277 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6278
6279 Both @code{record @var{method}} and @code{rec @var{method}} are
6280 aliases of @code{target record-@var{method}}.
6281
6282 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6283 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6284 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6285 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6286 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6287
6288 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6289 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6290 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6291 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6292 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6293 does not support these two modes.
6294
6295 @kindex record stop
6296 @kindex rec s
6297 @item record stop
6298 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6299 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6300 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6301
6302 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6303 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6304 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6305 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6306 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6307
6308 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6309 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6310 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6311 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6312 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6313
6314 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6315 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6316
6317 @kindex record goto
6318 @item record goto
6319 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6320 ways to specify the location to go to:
6321
6322 @table @code
6323 @item record goto begin
6324 @itemx record goto start
6325 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6326
6327 @item record goto end
6328 Go to the end of the execution log.
6329
6330 @item record goto @var{n}
6331 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6332 @end table
6333
6334 @kindex record save
6335 @item record save @var{filename}
6336 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6337 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6338 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6339
6340 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6341
6342 @kindex record restore
6343 @item record restore @var{filename}
6344 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6345 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6346
6347 @kindex set record full
6348 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6349 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6350 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6351 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6352
6353 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6354 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6355 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6356 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6357 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6358 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6359 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6360 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6361
6362 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6363 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6364 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6365
6366 @kindex show record full
6367 @item show record full insn-number-max
6368 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6369 recording method.
6370
6371 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6372 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6373 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6374 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6375 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6376 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6377 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6378 oldest one to be deleted.
6379
6380 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6381 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6382
6383 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6384 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6385
6386 @item set record full memory-query
6387 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6388 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6389 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6390 case.
6391
6392 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6393 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6394 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6395 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6396 results.
6397
6398 @item show record full memory-query
6399 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6400
6401 @kindex info record
6402 @item info record
6403 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6404 method:
6405
6406 @table @code
6407 @item full
6408 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6409 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6410
6411 @itemize @bullet
6412 @item
6413 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6414 @item
6415 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6416 @item
6417 Highest recorded instruction number.
6418 @item
6419 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6420 @item
6421 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6422 @item
6423 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6424 @end itemize
6425
6426 @item btrace
6427 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows the number of
6428 instructions that have been recorded and the number of blocks of
6429 sequential control-flow that is formed by the recorded instructions.
6430 @end table
6431
6432 @kindex record delete
6433 @kindex rec del
6434 @item record delete
6435 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6436 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6437 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6438 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6439
6440 @kindex record instruction-history
6441 @kindex rec instruction-history
6442 @item record instruction-history
6443 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6444 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6445 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6446 are printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify
6447 what part of the execution log to disassemble:
6448
6449 @table @code
6450 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6451 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6452 @var{insn}.
6453
6454 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6455 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6456 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6457 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
6458 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6459 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6460
6461 @item record instruction-history
6462 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
6463
6464 @item record instruction-history -
6465 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
6466
6467 @item record instruction-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6468 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
6469 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
6470 number @var{end} is included.
6471 @end table
6472
6473 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6474
6475 @kindex set record
6476 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
6477 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
6478 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6479 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
6480 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
6481
6482 @kindex show record
6483 @item show record instruction-history-size
6484 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6485 instruction-history} command.
6486
6487 @kindex record function-call-history
6488 @kindex rec function-call-history
6489 @item record function-call-history
6490 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
6491 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
6492 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
6493 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
6494 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
6495 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
6496 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
6497 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
6498 given together.
6499
6500 @smallexample
6501 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
6502 1 void foo (void)
6503 2 @{
6504 3 @}
6505 4
6506 5 void bar (void)
6507 6 @{
6508 7 ...
6509 8 foo ();
6510 9 ...
6511 10 @}
6512 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
6513 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
6514 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
6515 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
6516 @end smallexample
6517
6518 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
6519 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
6520 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
6521 to print:
6522
6523 @table @code
6524 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
6525 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
6526
6527 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
6528 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
6529 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
6530 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
6531 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
6532
6533 @item record function-call-history
6534 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
6535
6536 @item record function-call-history -
6537 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
6538
6539 @item record function-call-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6540 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
6541 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
6542 @end table
6543
6544 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6545
6546 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
6547 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
6548 Define how many lines to print in the
6549 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
6550 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
6551
6552 @item show record function-call-history-size
6553 Show how many lines to print in the
6554 @code{record function-call-history} command.
6555 @end table
6556
6557
6558 @node Stack
6559 @chapter Examining the Stack
6560
6561 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
6562 stopped and how it got there.
6563
6564 @cindex call stack
6565 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
6566 is generated.
6567 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
6568 the arguments of the call,
6569 and the local variables of the function being called.
6570 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
6571 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
6572 stack}.
6573
6574 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
6575 stack allow you to see all of this information.
6576
6577 @cindex selected frame
6578 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
6579 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
6580 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
6581 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
6582 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
6583 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6584
6585 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
6586 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
6587 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
6588
6589 @menu
6590 * Frames:: Stack frames
6591 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
6592 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
6593 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
6594 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
6595
6596 @end menu
6597
6598 @node Frames
6599 @section Stack Frames
6600
6601 @cindex frame, definition
6602 @cindex stack frame
6603 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
6604 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
6605 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
6606 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
6607 which the function is executing.
6608
6609 @cindex initial frame
6610 @cindex outermost frame
6611 @cindex innermost frame
6612 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
6613 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
6614 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
6615 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
6616 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
6617 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
6618 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
6619 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
6620
6621 @cindex frame pointer
6622 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
6623 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
6624 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
6625 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
6626 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
6627 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
6628
6629 @cindex frame number
6630 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
6631 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
6632 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
6633 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
6634 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
6635
6636 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
6637 @c underflow problems.
6638 @cindex frameless execution
6639 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6640 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
6641 @smallexample
6642 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
6643 @end smallexample
6644 generates functions without a frame.)
6645 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
6646 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
6647 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
6648 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
6649 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
6650 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
6651 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
6652
6653 @table @code
6654 @kindex frame@r{, command}
6655 @cindex current stack frame
6656 @item frame @var{args}
6657 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
6658 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
6659 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
6660 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
6661
6662 @kindex select-frame
6663 @cindex selecting frame silently
6664 @item select-frame
6665 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
6666 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
6667 @code{frame}.
6668 @end table
6669
6670 @node Backtrace
6671 @section Backtraces
6672
6673 @cindex traceback
6674 @cindex call stack traces
6675 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
6676 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
6677 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
6678 stack.
6679
6680 @anchor{backtrace-command}
6681 @table @code
6682 @kindex backtrace
6683 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
6684 @item backtrace
6685 @itemx bt
6686 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
6687 frames in the stack.
6688
6689 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
6690 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
6691
6692 @item backtrace @var{n}
6693 @itemx bt @var{n}
6694 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
6695
6696 @item backtrace -@var{n}
6697 @itemx bt -@var{n}
6698 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
6699
6700 @item backtrace full
6701 @itemx bt full
6702 @itemx bt full @var{n}
6703 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
6704 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
6705 number of frames to print, as described above.
6706
6707 @item backtrace no-filters
6708 @itemx bt no-filters
6709 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
6710 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
6711 @itemx bt no-filters full
6712 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
6713 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
6714 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
6715 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
6716 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
6717 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
6718 support.
6719 @end table
6720
6721 @kindex where
6722 @kindex info stack
6723 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
6724 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
6725
6726 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
6727 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
6728 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
6729 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
6730 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
6731 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
6732 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
6733 multi-threaded program.
6734
6735 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
6736 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
6737 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
6738 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
6739 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
6740 line number.
6741
6742 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
6743 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
6744
6745 @smallexample
6746 @group
6747 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6748 at builtin.c:993
6749 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
6750 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
6751 at macro.c:71
6752 (More stack frames follow...)
6753 @end group
6754 @end smallexample
6755
6756 @noindent
6757 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
6758 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
6759 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
6760
6761 @noindent
6762 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
6763 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
6764 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
6765 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
6766 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
6767
6768 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
6769 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
6770 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
6771 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
6772 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
6773 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
6774 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
6775 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
6776 such a backtrace might look like:
6777
6778 @smallexample
6779 @group
6780 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6781 at builtin.c:993
6782 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
6783 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
6784 at macro.c:71
6785 (More stack frames follow...)
6786 @end group
6787 @end smallexample
6788
6789 @noindent
6790 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
6791 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
6792
6793 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
6794 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
6795 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
6796
6797 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
6798 @cindex program entry point
6799 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
6800 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
6801 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
6802 @code{main}@footnote{
6803 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
6804 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
6805 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
6806 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
6807 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
6808 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
6809
6810 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
6811 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
6812
6813 @table @code
6814 @item set backtrace past-main
6815 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
6816 @kindex set backtrace
6817 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
6818
6819 @item set backtrace past-main off
6820 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
6821 default.
6822
6823 @item show backtrace past-main
6824 @kindex show backtrace
6825 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
6826
6827 @item set backtrace past-entry
6828 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
6829 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
6830 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
6831 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
6832
6833 @item set backtrace past-entry off
6834 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
6835 application. This is the default.
6836
6837 @item show backtrace past-entry
6838 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
6839
6840 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
6841 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
6842 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
6843 @cindex backtrace limit
6844 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
6845 or zero means unlimited levels.
6846
6847 @item show backtrace limit
6848 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
6849 @end table
6850
6851 You can control how file names are displayed.
6852
6853 @table @code
6854 @item set filename-display
6855 @itemx set filename-display relative
6856 @cindex filename-display
6857 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
6858
6859 @item set filename-display basename
6860 Display only basename of a filename.
6861
6862 @item set filename-display absolute
6863 Display an absolute filename.
6864
6865 @item show filename-display
6866 Show the current way to display filenames.
6867 @end table
6868
6869 @node Frame Filter Management
6870 @section Management of Frame Filters.
6871 @cindex managing frame filters
6872
6873 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
6874 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
6875
6876 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
6877 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
6878
6879 @table @code
6880 @kindex info frame-filter
6881 @item info frame-filter
6882 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
6883 their name, priority and enabled status.
6884
6885 @kindex disable frame-filter
6886 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
6887 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
6888 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
6889 @var{filter-dictionary}, or @code{all}, and @var{filter-name}.
6890 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
6891 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
6892 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
6893 across all dictionaries are disabled. @var{filter-name} is the name
6894 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
6895 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
6896 may be enabled again later.
6897
6898 @kindex enable frame-filter
6899 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
6900 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
6901 @var{filter-dictionary}, or @code{all}, and @var{filter-name}.
6902 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
6903 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
6904 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
6905 all dictionaries are enabled. @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
6906 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
6907 @var{filter-dictionary}.
6908
6909 Example:
6910
6911 @smallexample
6912 (gdb) info frame-filter
6913
6914 global frame-filters:
6915 Priority Enabled Name
6916 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
6917 100 Yes Reverse
6918
6919 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
6920 Priority Enabled Name
6921 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
6922
6923 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
6924 Priority Enabled Name
6925 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
6926
6927 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
6928 (gdb) info frame-filter
6929
6930 global frame-filters:
6931 Priority Enabled Name
6932 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
6933 100 Yes Reverse
6934
6935 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
6936 Priority Enabled Name
6937 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
6938
6939 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
6940 Priority Enabled Name
6941 999 No BuildProgramFilter
6942
6943 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
6944 (gdb) info frame-filter
6945
6946 global frame-filters:
6947 Priority Enabled Name
6948 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
6949 100 Yes Reverse
6950
6951 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
6952 Priority Enabled Name
6953 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
6954
6955 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
6956 Priority Enabled Name
6957 999 No BuildProgramFilter
6958 @end smallexample
6959
6960 @kindex set frame-filter priority
6961 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
6962 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
6963 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
6964 @var{filter-name}. @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
6965 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
6966 dictionary resides. @var{priority} is an integer.
6967
6968 @kindex show frame-filter priority
6969 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
6970 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
6971 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
6972 @var{filter-name}. @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
6973 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
6974 dictionary resides.
6975
6976 Example:
6977
6978 @smallexample
6979 (gdb) info frame-filter
6980
6981 global frame-filters:
6982 Priority Enabled Name
6983 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
6984 100 Yes Reverse
6985
6986 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
6987 Priority Enabled Name
6988 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
6989
6990 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
6991 Priority Enabled Name
6992 999 No BuildProgramFilter
6993
6994 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
6995 (gdb) info frame-filter
6996
6997 global frame-filters:
6998 Priority Enabled Name
6999 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7000 50 Yes Reverse
7001
7002 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7003 Priority Enabled Name
7004 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7005
7006 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7007 Priority Enabled Name
7008 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7009 @end smallexample
7010 @end table
7011
7012 @node Selection
7013 @section Selecting a Frame
7014
7015 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7016 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7017 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7018 of the stack frame just selected.
7019
7020 @table @code
7021 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7022 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7023 @item frame @var{n}
7024 @itemx f @var{n}
7025 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7026 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7027 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7028 @code{main}.
7029
7030 @item frame @var{addr}
7031 @itemx f @var{addr}
7032 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7033 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7034 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7035 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7036 switches between them.
7037
7038 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
7039 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
7040
7041 On the @acronym{MIPS} and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
7042 pointer and a program counter.
7043
7044 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
7045 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
7046
7047 @kindex up
7048 @item up @var{n}
7049 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
7050 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
7051 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
7052
7053 @kindex down
7054 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7055 @item down @var{n}
7056 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
7057 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
7058 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
7059 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7060 @end table
7061
7062 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7063 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7064 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7065 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7066
7067 @need 1000
7068 For example:
7069
7070 @smallexample
7071 @group
7072 (@value{GDBP}) up
7073 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7074 at env.c:10
7075 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7076 @end group
7077 @end smallexample
7078
7079 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7080 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7081 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7082 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7083 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7084 for details.
7085
7086 @table @code
7087 @kindex down-silently
7088 @kindex up-silently
7089 @item up-silently @var{n}
7090 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7091 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7092 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7093 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7094 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7095 distracting.
7096 @end table
7097
7098 @node Frame Info
7099 @section Information About a Frame
7100
7101 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7102 stack frame.
7103
7104 @table @code
7105 @item frame
7106 @itemx f
7107 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7108 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7109 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7110 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7111 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7112
7113 @kindex info frame
7114 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7115 @item info frame
7116 @itemx info f
7117 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7118 including:
7119
7120 @itemize @bullet
7121 @item
7122 the address of the frame
7123 @item
7124 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7125 @item
7126 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7127 @item
7128 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7129 @item
7130 the address of the frame's arguments
7131 @item
7132 the address of the frame's local variables
7133 @item
7134 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7135 @item
7136 which registers were saved in the frame
7137 @end itemize
7138
7139 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7140 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7141 the usual conventions.
7142
7143 @item info frame @var{addr}
7144 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7145 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7146 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7147 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7148 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7149 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7150
7151 @kindex info args
7152 @item info args
7153 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7154
7155 @item info locals
7156 @kindex info locals
7157 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7158 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7159 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7160
7161 @end table
7162
7163
7164 @node Source
7165 @chapter Examining Source Files
7166
7167 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7168 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7169 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7170 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7171 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7172 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7173 source files by explicit command.
7174
7175 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7176 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7177 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7178
7179 @menu
7180 * List:: Printing source lines
7181 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7182 * Edit:: Editing source files
7183 * Search:: Searching source files
7184 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7185 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7186 @end menu
7187
7188 @node List
7189 @section Printing Source Lines
7190
7191 @kindex list
7192 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7193 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7194 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7195 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7196 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7197
7198 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7199
7200 @table @code
7201 @item list @var{linenum}
7202 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7203 current source file.
7204
7205 @item list @var{function}
7206 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7207 @var{function}.
7208
7209 @item list
7210 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7211 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7212 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7213 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7214 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7215
7216 @item list -
7217 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7218 @end table
7219
7220 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7221 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7222 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7223
7224 @table @code
7225 @kindex set listsize
7226 @item set listsize @var{count}
7227 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7228 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7229 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7230 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7231
7232 @kindex show listsize
7233 @item show listsize
7234 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7235 @end table
7236
7237 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7238 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7239 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7240 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7241 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7242
7243 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7244 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
7245 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7246 to specify some source line.
7247
7248 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7249
7250 @table @code
7251 @item list @var{linespec}
7252 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
7253
7254 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7255 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7256 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
7257 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
7258 the same source file as the first linespec.
7259
7260 @item list ,@var{last}
7261 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7262
7263 @item list @var{first},
7264 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7265
7266 @item list +
7267 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7268
7269 @item list -
7270 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7271
7272 @item list
7273 As described in the preceding table.
7274 @end table
7275
7276 @node Specify Location
7277 @section Specifying a Location
7278 @cindex specifying location
7279 @cindex linespec
7280
7281 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7282 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7283 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
7284 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
7285
7286 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
7287 @value{GDBN} understands:
7288
7289 @table @code
7290 @item @var{linenum}
7291 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7292
7293 @item -@var{offset}
7294 @itemx +@var{offset}
7295 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7296 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7297 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7298 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7299 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7300 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7301 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7302 linespec.
7303
7304 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7305 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7306 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7307 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7308 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7309 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7310 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7311
7312 @item @var{function}
7313 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7314 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7315
7316 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7317 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7318
7319 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7320 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7321 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7322 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7323 functions in different source files.
7324
7325 @item @var{label}
7326 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears.
7327 @value{GDBN} searches for the label in the function corresponding to
7328 the currently selected stack frame. If there is no current selected
7329 stack frame (for instance, if the inferior is not running), then
7330 @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7331
7332 @item *@var{address}
7333 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
7334 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
7335 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
7336 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7337 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7338 source files.
7339
7340 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7341 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7342 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7343 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
7344 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
7345 of @var{address}:
7346
7347 @table @code
7348 @item @var{expression}
7349 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7350
7351 @item @var{funcaddr}
7352 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7353 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7354 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7355 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7356 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7357 (although the Pascal form also works).
7358
7359 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7360 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7361
7362 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
7363 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7364 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7365 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7366 functions with identical names in different source files.
7367 @end table
7368
7369 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7370 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7371 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7372 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7373 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7374 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7375
7376 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7377 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7378 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7379 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7380 each one of those probes.
7381
7382 @end table
7383
7384
7385 @node Edit
7386 @section Editing Source Files
7387 @cindex editing source files
7388
7389 @kindex edit
7390 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7391 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7392 The editing program of your choice
7393 is invoked with the current line set to
7394 the active line in the program.
7395 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7396 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7397
7398 @table @code
7399 @item edit @var{location}
7400 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
7401 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7402 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7403 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7404 command most commonly used:
7405
7406 @table @code
7407 @item edit @var{number}
7408 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7409
7410 @item edit @var{function}
7411 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7412 @end table
7413
7414 @end table
7415
7416 @subsection Choosing your Editor
7417 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
7418 @footnote{
7419 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
7420 following command-line syntax:
7421 @smallexample
7422 ex +@var{number} file
7423 @end smallexample
7424 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
7425 the file where to start editing.}.
7426 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
7427 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
7428 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
7429 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
7430 @smallexample
7431 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
7432 export EDITOR
7433 gdb @dots{}
7434 @end smallexample
7435 or in the @code{csh} shell,
7436 @smallexample
7437 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
7438 gdb @dots{}
7439 @end smallexample
7440
7441 @node Search
7442 @section Searching Source Files
7443 @cindex searching source files
7444
7445 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
7446 regular expression.
7447
7448 @table @code
7449 @kindex search
7450 @kindex forward-search
7451 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
7452 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
7453 @itemx search @var{regexp}
7454 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
7455 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
7456 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
7457 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
7458 @code{fo}.
7459
7460 @kindex reverse-search
7461 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
7462 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
7463 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
7464 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
7465 this command as @code{rev}.
7466 @end table
7467
7468 @node Source Path
7469 @section Specifying Source Directories
7470
7471 @cindex source path
7472 @cindex directories for source files
7473 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
7474 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
7475 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
7476 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
7477 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
7478 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
7479 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
7480
7481 For example, suppose an executable references the file
7482 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
7483 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
7484 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
7485 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
7486 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
7487 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
7488 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
7489 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
7490 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
7491 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
7492
7493 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
7494 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
7495 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
7496 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
7497 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
7498 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
7499
7500 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
7501 source files.
7502
7503 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
7504 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
7505 each line is in the file.
7506
7507 @kindex directory
7508 @kindex dir
7509 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
7510 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
7511 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
7512
7513 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
7514 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
7515
7516 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
7517 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
7518 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
7519 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
7520 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
7521 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
7522 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
7523 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
7524 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
7525 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
7526 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
7527 name to look up the sources.
7528
7529 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
7530 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
7531 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
7532 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
7533 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
7534 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
7535 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
7536 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
7537
7538 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
7539 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
7540 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
7541 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
7542 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
7543 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
7544 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
7545
7546 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
7547 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
7548 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
7549 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
7550 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
7551 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
7552 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
7553 command.
7554
7555 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
7556 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
7557 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
7558 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
7559 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
7560 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
7561 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
7562
7563 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
7564 @cindex default source path substitution
7565 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
7566 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
7567 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
7568 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
7569 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
7570 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
7571 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
7572 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
7573 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
7574 together.
7575
7576 @table @code
7577 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
7578 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
7579 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
7580 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
7581 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
7582 part of absolute file names) or
7583 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
7584 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
7585
7586 @kindex cdir
7587 @kindex cwd
7588 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
7589 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
7590 @cindex compilation directory
7591 @cindex current directory
7592 @cindex working directory
7593 @cindex directory, current
7594 @cindex directory, compilation
7595 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
7596 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
7597 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
7598 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
7599 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
7600 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
7601
7602 @item directory
7603 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
7604
7605 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
7606 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
7607
7608 @item set directories @var{path-list}
7609 @kindex set directories
7610 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
7611 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
7612
7613 @item show directories
7614 @kindex show directories
7615 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
7616
7617 @anchor{set substitute-path}
7618 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
7619 @kindex set substitute-path
7620 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
7621 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
7622 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
7623
7624 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
7625 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
7626
7627 @smallexample
7628 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
7629 @end smallexample
7630
7631 @noindent
7632 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
7633 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
7634 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
7635
7636 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
7637 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
7638 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
7639 the substitution.
7640
7641 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
7642
7643 @smallexample
7644 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
7645 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
7646 @end smallexample
7647
7648 @noindent
7649 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
7650 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
7651 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
7652 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
7653
7654
7655 @item unset substitute-path [path]
7656 @kindex unset substitute-path
7657 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
7658 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
7659 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
7660
7661 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
7662
7663 @item show substitute-path [path]
7664 @kindex show substitute-path
7665 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
7666 which would rewrite that path, if any.
7667
7668 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
7669 rules.
7670
7671 @end table
7672
7673 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
7674 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
7675 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
7676
7677 @enumerate
7678 @item
7679 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
7680
7681 @item
7682 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
7683 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
7684 directories in one command.
7685 @end enumerate
7686
7687 @node Machine Code
7688 @section Source and Machine Code
7689 @cindex source line and its code address
7690
7691 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
7692 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
7693 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
7694 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
7695 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
7696 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
7697 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
7698 well as hex.
7699
7700 @table @code
7701 @kindex info line
7702 @item info line @var{linespec}
7703 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
7704 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
7705 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
7706 @end table
7707
7708 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
7709 the object code for the first line of function
7710 @code{m4_changequote}:
7711
7712 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
7713 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
7714 @smallexample
7715 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
7716 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
7717 @end smallexample
7718
7719 @noindent
7720 @cindex code address and its source line
7721 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
7722 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
7723 @smallexample
7724 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
7725 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
7726 @end smallexample
7727
7728 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
7729 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
7730 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
7731 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
7732 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
7733 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
7734 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
7735 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
7736 Variables}).
7737
7738 @table @code
7739 @kindex disassemble
7740 @cindex assembly instructions
7741 @cindex instructions, assembly
7742 @cindex machine instructions
7743 @cindex listing machine instructions
7744 @item disassemble
7745 @itemx disassemble /m
7746 @itemx disassemble /r
7747 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
7748 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
7749 the @code{/m} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex as well as
7750 in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r}.
7751 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
7752 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
7753 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
7754 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
7755 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
7756 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
7757
7758 @table @code
7759 @item @var{start},@var{end}
7760 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
7761 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
7762 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
7763 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
7764 @end table
7765
7766 @noindent
7767 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
7768 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
7769
7770 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
7771 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
7772
7773 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
7774 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
7775 @end table
7776
7777 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
7778 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
7779
7780 @smallexample
7781 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
7782 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
7783 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
7784 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
7785 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
7786 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
7787 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
7788 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
7789 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
7790 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
7791 End of assembler dump.
7792 @end smallexample
7793
7794 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86, when the
7795 program is stopped just after function prologue:
7796
7797 @smallexample
7798 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
7799 Dump of assembler code for function main:
7800 5 @{
7801 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
7802 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
7803 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
7804 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
7805 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
7806
7807 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
7808 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
7809 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
7810
7811 7 return 0;
7812 8 @}
7813 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
7814 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
7815 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
7816
7817 End of assembler dump.
7818 @end smallexample
7819
7820 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
7821
7822 @smallexample
7823 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
7824 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
7825 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
7826 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
7827 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
7828 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
7829 End of assembler dump.
7830 @end smallexample
7831
7832 Addresses cannot be specified as a linespec (@pxref{Specify Location}).
7833 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
7834 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
7835 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
7836
7837 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
7838 mnemonics or other syntax.
7839
7840 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
7841 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
7842 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
7843 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
7844 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
7845
7846 @table @code
7847 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
7848 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
7849 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
7850 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
7851 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
7852 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
7853
7854 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
7855 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
7856 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
7857 assemblers for x86-based targets.
7858
7859 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
7860 @item show disassembly-flavor
7861 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
7862 @end table
7863
7864 @table @code
7865 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
7866 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
7867 @item set disassemble-next-line
7868 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
7869 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
7870 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
7871 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
7872 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
7873 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
7874 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
7875 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
7876 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
7877 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
7878 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
7879 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
7880 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
7881 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
7882 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
7883 instruction.
7884 @end table
7885
7886
7887 @node Data
7888 @chapter Examining Data
7889
7890 @cindex printing data
7891 @cindex examining data
7892 @kindex print
7893 @kindex inspect
7894 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7895 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
7896 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
7897 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
7898 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
7899 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
7900
7901 @table @code
7902 @item print @var{expr}
7903 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
7904 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
7905 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
7906 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
7907 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
7908 Formats}.
7909
7910 @item print
7911 @itemx print /@var{f}
7912 @cindex reprint the last value
7913 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
7914 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
7915 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
7916 @end table
7917
7918 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
7919 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
7920 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
7921
7922 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
7923 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
7924 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7925 Table}.
7926
7927 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
7928 @kindex explore
7929 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
7930 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
7931 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
7932 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
7933 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
7934 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
7935 embedded in the higher level data types.
7936
7937 @table @code
7938 @item explore @var{arg}
7939 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
7940 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
7941 @end table
7942
7943 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
7944 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
7945 C program as
7946
7947 @smallexample
7948 struct SimpleStruct
7949 @{
7950 int i;
7951 double d;
7952 @};
7953
7954 struct ComplexStruct
7955 @{
7956 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
7957 int arr[10];
7958 @};
7959 @end smallexample
7960
7961 @noindent
7962 followed by variable declarations as
7963
7964 @smallexample
7965 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
7966 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
7967 @end smallexample
7968
7969 @noindent
7970 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
7971 @code{explore} command as follows.
7972
7973 @smallexample
7974 (gdb) explore cs
7975 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
7976 the following fields:
7977
7978 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
7979 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
7980
7981 Enter the field number of choice:
7982 @end smallexample
7983
7984 @noindent
7985 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
7986 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
7987 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
7988 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
7989 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
7990 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
7991 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
7992 field will be explored as if it were an array.
7993
7994 @smallexample
7995 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
7996 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
7997 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
7998 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
7999
8000 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8001 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8002
8003 Press enter to return to parent value:
8004 @end smallexample
8005
8006 @noindent
8007 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8008 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8009 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8010 to explore.
8011
8012 @smallexample
8013 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8014 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8015
8016 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8017
8018 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8019
8020 Press enter to return to parent value:
8021 @end smallexample
8022
8023 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8024 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8025 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8026 level data structure).
8027
8028 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8029 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8030 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8031 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8032 same example as above, your can explore the type
8033 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8034 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8035
8036 @smallexample
8037 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8038 @end smallexample
8039
8040 @noindent
8041 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8042 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8043 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8044 example.
8045
8046 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8047 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8048 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8049 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8050 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8051
8052 @table @code
8053 @item explore value @var{expr}
8054 @cindex explore value
8055 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8056 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8057 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8058 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8059 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8060
8061 @item explore type @var{arg}
8062 @cindex explore type
8063 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8064 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8065 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8066 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8067 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8068 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8069 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8070 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8071 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8072 @end table
8073
8074 @menu
8075 * Expressions:: Expressions
8076 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8077 * Variables:: Program variables
8078 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8079 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8080 * Memory:: Examining memory
8081 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8082 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8083 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8084 * Value History:: Value history
8085 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8086 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8087 * Registers:: Registers
8088 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8089 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8090 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8091 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8092 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8093 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8094 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8095 character set than GDB does
8096 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8097 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8098 @end menu
8099
8100 @node Expressions
8101 @section Expressions
8102
8103 @cindex expressions
8104 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8105 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8106 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8107 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8108 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8109 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8110 @ref{Compilation}.
8111
8112 @cindex arrays in expressions
8113 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8114 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8115 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8116 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8117 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8118 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8119
8120 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8121 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8122 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8123 languages.
8124
8125 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8126 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8127
8128 @cindex casts, in expressions
8129 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8130 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8131 at that address in memory.
8132 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8133
8134 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8135 to programming languages:
8136
8137 @table @code
8138 @item @@
8139 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8140 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8141
8142 @item ::
8143 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8144 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8145
8146 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8147 @cindex type casting memory
8148 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8149 @cindex casts, to view memory
8150 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8151 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8152 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
8153 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
8154 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
8155 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8156 @end table
8157
8158 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8159 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8160 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8161
8162 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8163 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8164 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8165 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8166 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8167 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8168 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8169
8170 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8171 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8172 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8173 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8174 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8175 as well.
8176
8177 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8178 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8179 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8180 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8181 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8182 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8183 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8184 choices.
8185
8186 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8187 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8188 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8189
8190 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8191 @smallexample
8192 @group
8193 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8194 [0] cancel
8195 [1] all
8196 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8197 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8198 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8199 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8200 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8201 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8202 > 2 4 6
8203 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8204 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8205 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8206 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8207 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8208 breakpoints.
8209 (@value{GDBP})
8210 @end group
8211 @end smallexample
8212
8213 @table @code
8214 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8215 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8216 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8217
8218 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8219 is ambiguous.
8220
8221 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8222 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8223 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8224 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8225 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8226 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8227 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8228 in the use of the menu.
8229
8230 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8231 when an ambiguity is detected.
8232
8233 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8234 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8235
8236 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8237 @item show multiple-symbols
8238 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8239 @end table
8240
8241 @node Variables
8242 @section Program Variables
8243
8244 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8245 in your program.
8246
8247 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8248 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8249
8250 @itemize @bullet
8251 @item
8252 global (or file-static)
8253 @end itemize
8254
8255 @noindent or
8256
8257 @itemize @bullet
8258 @item
8259 visible according to the scope rules of the
8260 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8261 @end itemize
8262
8263 @noindent This means that in the function
8264
8265 @smallexample
8266 foo (a)
8267 int a;
8268 @{
8269 bar (a);
8270 @{
8271 int b = test ();
8272 bar (b);
8273 @}
8274 @}
8275 @end smallexample
8276
8277 @noindent
8278 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8279 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8280 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8281 the block where @code{b} is declared.
8282
8283 @cindex variable name conflict
8284 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8285 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8286 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8287 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
8288 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
8289 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8290 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8291
8292 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8293 @ifnotinfo
8294 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8295 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8296 @end ifnotinfo
8297 @smallexample
8298 @var{file}::@var{variable}
8299 @var{function}::@var{variable}
8300 @end smallexample
8301
8302 @noindent
8303 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
8304 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
8305 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
8306 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
8307
8308 @smallexample
8309 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
8310 @end smallexample
8311
8312 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
8313 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
8314 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
8315 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
8316 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
8317
8318 @smallexample
8319 void
8320 foo (int a)
8321 @{
8322 if (a < 10)
8323 bar (a);
8324 else
8325 process (a); /* Stop here */
8326 @}
8327
8328 int
8329 bar (int a)
8330 @{
8331 foo (a + 5);
8332 @}
8333 @end smallexample
8334
8335 @noindent
8336 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
8337 here is what you might see
8338 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
8339
8340 @smallexample
8341 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8342 $1 = 10
8343 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8344 $2 = 5
8345 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
8346 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
8347 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8348 $3 = 5
8349 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8350 $4 = 0
8351 @end smallexample
8352
8353 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
8354 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
8355 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
8356 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
8357 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
8358
8359 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
8360 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
8361 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
8362 @code{some_global}.
8363
8364 @smallexample
8365 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
8366 $1 = 23
8367 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
8368 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
8369 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
8370 $2 = 27
8371 @end smallexample
8372
8373 @cindex wrong values
8374 @cindex variable values, wrong
8375 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
8376 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
8377 @quotation
8378 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
8379 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
8380 scope, and just before exit.
8381 @end quotation
8382 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
8383 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
8384 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
8385 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
8386 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
8387 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
8388 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
8389 variable definitions may be gone.
8390
8391 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
8392 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
8393 when compiling.
8394
8395 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
8396 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
8397 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
8398 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
8399 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
8400 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
8401 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
8402
8403 @smallexample
8404 No symbol "foo" in current context.
8405 @end smallexample
8406
8407 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
8408 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
8409 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
8410 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
8411 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
8412
8413 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
8414 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
8415 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
8416 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
8417
8418 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
8419 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
8420 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
8421 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
8422 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
8423
8424 @smallexample
8425 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
8426 29 i++;
8427 (gdb) next
8428 30 e (i);
8429 (gdb) print i
8430 $1 = 31
8431 (gdb) print i@@entry
8432 $2 = 30
8433 @end smallexample
8434
8435 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
8436 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
8437 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
8438 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
8439 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
8440 For program code
8441
8442 @smallexample
8443 char var0[] = "A";
8444 signed char var1[] = "A";
8445 @end smallexample
8446
8447 You get during debugging
8448 @smallexample
8449 (gdb) print var0
8450 $1 = "A"
8451 (gdb) print var1
8452 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
8453 @end smallexample
8454
8455 @node Arrays
8456 @section Artificial Arrays
8457
8458 @cindex artificial array
8459 @cindex arrays
8460 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
8461 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
8462 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
8463 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
8464 program.
8465
8466 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
8467 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
8468 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
8469 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
8470 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
8471 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
8472 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
8473 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
8474 example. If a program says
8475
8476 @smallexample
8477 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
8478 @end smallexample
8479
8480 @noindent
8481 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
8482
8483 @smallexample
8484 p *array@@len
8485 @end smallexample
8486
8487 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
8488 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
8489 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
8490 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
8491 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
8492
8493 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
8494 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
8495 The value need not be in memory:
8496 @smallexample
8497 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
8498 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8499 @end smallexample
8500
8501 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
8502 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
8503 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
8504 @smallexample
8505 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
8506 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8507 @end smallexample
8508
8509 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
8510 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
8511 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
8512 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
8513 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8514 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
8515 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
8516 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
8517 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
8518 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
8519
8520 @smallexample
8521 set $i = 0
8522 p dtab[$i++]->fv
8523 @key{RET}
8524 @key{RET}
8525 @dots{}
8526 @end smallexample
8527
8528 @node Output Formats
8529 @section Output Formats
8530
8531 @cindex formatted output
8532 @cindex output formats
8533 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
8534 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
8535 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
8536 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
8537 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
8538
8539 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
8540 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
8541 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
8542 letters supported are:
8543
8544 @table @code
8545 @item x
8546 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
8547 hexadecimal.
8548
8549 @item d
8550 Print as integer in signed decimal.
8551
8552 @item u
8553 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
8554
8555 @item o
8556 Print as integer in octal.
8557
8558 @item t
8559 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
8560 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
8561 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
8562 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
8563
8564 @item a
8565 @cindex unknown address, locating
8566 @cindex locate address
8567 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
8568 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
8569 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
8570
8571 @smallexample
8572 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
8573 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
8574 @end smallexample
8575
8576 @noindent
8577 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
8578 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
8579
8580 @item c
8581 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
8582 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
8583 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
8584 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
8585
8586 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
8587 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
8588 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
8589 data.
8590
8591 @item f
8592 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
8593 using typical floating point syntax.
8594
8595 @item s
8596 @cindex printing strings
8597 @cindex printing byte arrays
8598 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
8599 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
8600 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
8601 natural types.
8602
8603 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
8604 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
8605 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
8606 array.
8607
8608 @item z
8609 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
8610 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
8611 to the size of the integer type.
8612
8613 @item r
8614 @cindex raw printing
8615 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
8616 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
8617 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
8618 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
8619 pretty-printer which might exist.
8620 @end table
8621
8622 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
8623
8624 @smallexample
8625 p/x $pc
8626 @end smallexample
8627
8628 @noindent
8629 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
8630 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
8631
8632 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
8633 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
8634 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
8635
8636 @node Memory
8637 @section Examining Memory
8638
8639 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
8640 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
8641
8642 @cindex examining memory
8643 @table @code
8644 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
8645 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
8646 @itemx x @var{addr}
8647 @itemx x
8648 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
8649 @end table
8650
8651 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
8652 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
8653 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
8654 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
8655 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
8656
8657 @table @r
8658 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
8659 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
8660 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
8661 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
8662 @c 4.1.2.
8663
8664 @item @var{f}, the display format
8665 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
8666 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
8667 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
8668 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
8669 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
8670
8671 @item @var{u}, the unit size
8672 The unit size is any of
8673
8674 @table @code
8675 @item b
8676 Bytes.
8677 @item h
8678 Halfwords (two bytes).
8679 @item w
8680 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
8681 @item g
8682 Giant words (eight bytes).
8683 @end table
8684
8685 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
8686 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
8687 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
8688 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
8689 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
8690 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
8691 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
8692 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
8693 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
8694 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
8695 be altered.
8696
8697 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
8698 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
8699 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
8700 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
8701 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
8702 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
8703 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
8704 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
8705 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
8706 a value from memory).
8707 @end table
8708
8709 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
8710 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
8711 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
8712 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
8713 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
8714
8715 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
8716 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
8717 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
8718 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
8719 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
8720
8721 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
8722 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
8723 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
8724 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
8725 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
8726 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
8727 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
8728 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
8729 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
8730
8731 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
8732 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
8733 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
8734 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
8735 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
8736 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
8737 for successive uses of @code{x}.
8738
8739 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
8740 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
8741
8742 @smallexample
8743 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
8744 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
8745 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
8746 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
8747 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
8748 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
8749 @end smallexample
8750
8751 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
8752 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
8753 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
8754 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
8755 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
8756 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
8757 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
8758 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
8759 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
8760
8761 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
8762 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
8763 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
8764
8765 @cindex remote memory comparison
8766 @cindex verify remote memory image
8767 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
8768 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
8769 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
8770 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
8771 situations.
8772
8773 @table @code
8774 @kindex compare-sections
8775 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
8776 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
8777 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
8778 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
8779 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
8780 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
8781 remote request.
8782 @end table
8783
8784 @node Auto Display
8785 @section Automatic Display
8786 @cindex automatic display
8787 @cindex display of expressions
8788
8789 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
8790 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
8791 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
8792 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
8793 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
8794 The automatic display looks like this:
8795
8796 @smallexample
8797 2: foo = 38
8798 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
8799 @end smallexample
8800
8801 @noindent
8802 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
8803 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
8804 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
8805 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
8806 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
8807 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
8808
8809 @table @code
8810 @kindex display
8811 @item display @var{expr}
8812 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
8813 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8814
8815 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
8816
8817 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
8818 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
8819 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
8820 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
8821 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
8822
8823 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
8824 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
8825 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
8826 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
8827 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8828 @end table
8829
8830 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
8831 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
8832 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
8833
8834 @table @code
8835 @kindex delete display
8836 @kindex undisplay
8837 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
8838 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8839 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
8840 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
8841 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
8842 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
8843 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8844
8845 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
8846 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
8847
8848 @kindex disable display
8849 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8850 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
8851 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
8852 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
8853 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
8854 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
8855 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
8856 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8857
8858 @kindex enable display
8859 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8860 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
8861 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
8862 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
8863 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
8864 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
8865 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8866
8867 @item display
8868 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
8869 done when your program stops.
8870
8871 @kindex info display
8872 @item info display
8873 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
8874 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
8875 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
8876 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
8877 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
8878 @end table
8879
8880 @cindex display disabled out of scope
8881 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
8882 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
8883 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
8884 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
8885 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
8886 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
8887 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
8888 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
8889 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
8890 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
8891
8892 @node Print Settings
8893 @section Print Settings
8894
8895 @cindex format options
8896 @cindex print settings
8897 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
8898 and symbols are printed.
8899
8900 @noindent
8901 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
8902
8903 @table @code
8904 @kindex set print
8905 @item set print address
8906 @itemx set print address on
8907 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
8908 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
8909 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
8910 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
8911 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
8912 @code{set print address on}:
8913
8914 @smallexample
8915 @group
8916 (@value{GDBP}) f
8917 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
8918 at input.c:530
8919 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
8920 @end group
8921 @end smallexample
8922
8923 @item set print address off
8924 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
8925 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
8926
8927 @smallexample
8928 @group
8929 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
8930 (@value{GDBP}) f
8931 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
8932 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
8933 @end group
8934 @end smallexample
8935
8936 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
8937 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
8938 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
8939 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
8940
8941 @kindex show print
8942 @item show print address
8943 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
8944 @end table
8945
8946 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
8947 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
8948 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
8949 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
8950 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
8951 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
8952 it prints a symbolic address:
8953
8954 @table @code
8955 @item set print symbol-filename on
8956 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
8957 @cindex symbol, source file and line
8958 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
8959 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
8960
8961 @item set print symbol-filename off
8962 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
8963 default.
8964
8965 @item show print symbol-filename
8966 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
8967 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
8968 @end table
8969
8970 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
8971 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
8972 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
8973
8974 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
8975 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
8976
8977 @table @code
8978 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
8979 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
8980 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
8981 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
8982 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
8983 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
8984 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
8985 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
8986
8987 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
8988 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
8989 symbolic address.
8990 @end table
8991
8992 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
8993 @cindex pointer, finding referent
8994 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
8995 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
8996 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
8997 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
8998 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
8999 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9000
9001 @smallexample
9002 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9003 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9004 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9005 @end smallexample
9006
9007 @quotation
9008 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9009 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9010 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9011 @end quotation
9012
9013 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9014 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9015
9016 @table @code
9017 @item set print symbol on
9018 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9019 one exists.
9020
9021 @item set print symbol off
9022 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9023 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9024 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9025
9026 @item show print symbol
9027 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9028 address.
9029 @end table
9030
9031 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9032
9033 @table @code
9034 @item set print array
9035 @itemx set print array on
9036 @cindex pretty print arrays
9037 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9038 but uses more space. The default is off.
9039
9040 @item set print array off
9041 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9042
9043 @item show print array
9044 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9045 arrays.
9046
9047 @cindex print array indexes
9048 @item set print array-indexes
9049 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9050 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9051 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9052 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9053
9054 @item set print array-indexes off
9055 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9056
9057 @item show print array-indexes
9058 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9059 arrays.
9060
9061 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9062 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9063 @cindex number of array elements to print
9064 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9065 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9066 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9067 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9068 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9069 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9070 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9071 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9072
9073 @item show print elements
9074 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9075 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9076
9077 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9078 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9079 @cindex printing frame argument values
9080 @cindex print all frame argument values
9081 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9082 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9083 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9084 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9085 values are:
9086
9087 @table @code
9088 @item all
9089 The values of all arguments are printed.
9090
9091 @item scalars
9092 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9093 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9094 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9095 only scalar arguments are shown:
9096
9097 @smallexample
9098 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9099 at frame-args.c:23
9100 @end smallexample
9101
9102 @item none
9103 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9104 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9105
9106 @smallexample
9107 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9108 at frame-args.c:23
9109 @end smallexample
9110 @end table
9111
9112 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9113 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9114 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9115 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9116 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9117 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9118 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9119 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9120 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9121 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9122
9123 @item show print frame-arguments
9124 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9125
9126 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9127 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9128
9129 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9130 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9131 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9132 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9133 This is the default.
9134
9135 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9136 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9137
9138 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9139 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9140 @kindex set print entry-values
9141 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9142 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9143 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9144 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9145 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9146
9147 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9148 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9149 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9150 @code{no} setting.
9151
9152 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9153 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
9154 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9155 this information.
9156
9157 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9158
9159 @table @code
9160 @item no
9161 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9162 point.
9163 @smallexample
9164 #0 equal (val=5)
9165 #0 different (val=6)
9166 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9167 #0 born (val=10)
9168 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9169 @end smallexample
9170
9171 @item only
9172 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9173 values are never printed.
9174 @smallexample
9175 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9176 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9177 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9178 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9179 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9180 @end smallexample
9181
9182 @item preferred
9183 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9184 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9185 value for such parameter.
9186 @smallexample
9187 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9188 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9189 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9190 #0 born (val=10)
9191 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9192 @end smallexample
9193
9194 @item if-needed
9195 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9196 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9197 parameter.
9198 @smallexample
9199 #0 equal (val=5)
9200 #0 different (val=6)
9201 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9202 #0 born (val=10)
9203 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9204 @end smallexample
9205
9206 @item both
9207 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9208 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9209 optimizations.
9210 @smallexample
9211 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9212 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9213 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9214 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9215 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9216 @end smallexample
9217
9218 @item compact
9219 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9220 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9221 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9222 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9223 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9224 @smallexample
9225 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9226 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9227 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9228 #0 born (val=10)
9229 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9230 @end smallexample
9231
9232 @item default
9233 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9234 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9235 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9236 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9237 @smallexample
9238 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9239 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9240 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9241 #0 born (val=10)
9242 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9243 @end smallexample
9244 @end table
9245
9246 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9247 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9248
9249 @item show print entry-values
9250 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9251 entry.
9252
9253 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9254 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
9255 @cindex repeated array elements
9256 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9257 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9258 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9259 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9260 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9261 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9262 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
9263 is 10.
9264
9265 @item show print repeats
9266 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9267 elements.
9268
9269 @item set print null-stop
9270 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
9271 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
9272 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
9273 contain only short strings.
9274 The default is off.
9275
9276 @item show print null-stop
9277 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
9278 @sc{null} character.
9279
9280 @item set print pretty on
9281 @cindex print structures in indented form
9282 @cindex indentation in structure display
9283 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
9284 per line, like this:
9285
9286 @smallexample
9287 @group
9288 $1 = @{
9289 next = 0x0,
9290 flags = @{
9291 sweet = 1,
9292 sour = 1
9293 @},
9294 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
9295 @}
9296 @end group
9297 @end smallexample
9298
9299 @item set print pretty off
9300 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
9301
9302 @smallexample
9303 @group
9304 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
9305 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
9306 @end group
9307 @end smallexample
9308
9309 @noindent
9310 This is the default format.
9311
9312 @item show print pretty
9313 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
9314
9315 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
9316 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
9317 @cindex octal escapes in strings
9318 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
9319 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
9320 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
9321 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
9322 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
9323
9324 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
9325 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
9326 international character sets, and is the default.
9327
9328 @item show print sevenbit-strings
9329 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
9330
9331 @item set print union on
9332 @cindex unions in structures, printing
9333 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
9334 and other unions. This is the default setting.
9335
9336 @item set print union off
9337 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
9338 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
9339 instead.
9340
9341 @item show print union
9342 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
9343 structures and other unions.
9344
9345 For example, given the declarations
9346
9347 @smallexample
9348 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
9349 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
9350 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
9351 Bug_forms;
9352
9353 struct thing @{
9354 Species it;
9355 union @{
9356 Tree_forms tree;
9357 Bug_forms bug;
9358 @} form;
9359 @};
9360
9361 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
9362 @end smallexample
9363
9364 @noindent
9365 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
9366
9367 @smallexample
9368 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
9369 @end smallexample
9370
9371 @noindent
9372 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
9373
9374 @smallexample
9375 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
9376 @end smallexample
9377
9378 @noindent
9379 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
9380 and in Pascal.
9381 @end table
9382
9383 @need 1000
9384 @noindent
9385 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
9386
9387 @table @code
9388 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
9389 @item set print demangle
9390 @itemx set print demangle on
9391 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
9392 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
9393 linkage. The default is on.
9394
9395 @item show print demangle
9396 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
9397
9398 @item set print asm-demangle
9399 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
9400 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
9401 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
9402 The default is off.
9403
9404 @item show print asm-demangle
9405 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
9406 or demangled form.
9407
9408 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
9409 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
9410 @kindex set demangle-style
9411 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
9412 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
9413 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
9414
9415 @table @code
9416 @item auto
9417 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
9418 This is the default.
9419
9420 @item gnu
9421 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
9422
9423 @item hp
9424 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
9425
9426 @item lucid
9427 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
9428
9429 @item arm
9430 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
9431 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
9432 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
9433 require further enhancement to permit that.
9434
9435 @end table
9436 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
9437
9438 @item show demangle-style
9439 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
9440
9441 @item set print object
9442 @itemx set print object on
9443 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
9444 @cindex display derived types
9445 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
9446 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
9447 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
9448 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
9449 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
9450 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
9451 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
9452
9453 @item set print object off
9454 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
9455 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
9456
9457 @item show print object
9458 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
9459
9460 @item set print static-members
9461 @itemx set print static-members on
9462 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
9463 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
9464
9465 @item set print static-members off
9466 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
9467
9468 @item show print static-members
9469 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
9470
9471 @item set print pascal_static-members
9472 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
9473 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
9474 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
9475 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
9476
9477 @item set print pascal_static-members off
9478 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
9479
9480 @item show print pascal_static-members
9481 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
9482
9483 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
9484 @item set print vtbl
9485 @itemx set print vtbl on
9486 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
9487 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
9488 @cindex VTBL display
9489 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
9490 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9491 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9492
9493 @item set print vtbl off
9494 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
9495
9496 @item show print vtbl
9497 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
9498 @end table
9499
9500 @node Pretty Printing
9501 @section Pretty Printing
9502
9503 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
9504 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
9505 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
9506
9507 @menu
9508 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
9509 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
9510 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
9511 @end menu
9512
9513 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
9514 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
9515
9516 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
9517 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
9518 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
9519
9520 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
9521 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
9522 pretty-printers with their names.
9523 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
9524 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
9525 Each such subprinter has its own name.
9526 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
9527
9528 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
9529 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
9530 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
9531 do anything special.
9532
9533 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
9534
9535 @itemize @bullet
9536 @item
9537 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
9538 all inferiors.
9539
9540 @item
9541 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
9542 when debugging that program.
9543 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
9544
9545 @item
9546 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
9547 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
9548 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
9549 @end itemize
9550
9551 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
9552 pretty-printers are selected,
9553
9554 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
9555 for new types.
9556
9557 @node Pretty-Printer Example
9558 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
9559
9560 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
9561
9562 @smallexample
9563 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9564 $1 = @{
9565 static npos = 4294967295,
9566 _M_dataplus = @{
9567 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
9568 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
9569 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
9570 @},
9571 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
9572 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
9573 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
9574 @}
9575 @}
9576 @end smallexample
9577
9578 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
9579
9580 @smallexample
9581 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9582 $2 = "abcd"
9583 @end smallexample
9584
9585 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
9586 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
9587 @cindex pretty-printer commands
9588
9589 @table @code
9590 @kindex info pretty-printer
9591 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9592 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
9593 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
9594
9595 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
9596 whose pretty-printers to list.
9597 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
9598 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
9599 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
9600 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
9601 looks up a printer from these three objects.
9602
9603 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
9604 to list.
9605
9606 @kindex disable pretty-printer
9607 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9608 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9609 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
9610
9611 @kindex enable pretty-printer
9612 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9613 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9614 @end table
9615
9616 Example:
9617
9618 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
9619 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
9620 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
9621 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
9622
9623 @smallexample
9624 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9625 library1.so:
9626 foo
9627 library2.so:
9628 bar
9629 bar1
9630 bar2
9631 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9632 library2.so:
9633 bar
9634 bar1
9635 bar2
9636 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
9637 1 printer disabled
9638 2 of 3 printers enabled
9639 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9640 library1.so:
9641 foo [disabled]
9642 library2.so:
9643 bar
9644 bar1
9645 bar2
9646 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
9647 1 printer disabled
9648 1 of 3 printers enabled
9649 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9650 library1.so:
9651 foo [disabled]
9652 library2.so:
9653 bar
9654 bar1 [disabled]
9655 bar2
9656 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
9657 1 printer disabled
9658 0 of 3 printers enabled
9659 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9660 library1.so:
9661 foo [disabled]
9662 library2.so:
9663 bar [disabled]
9664 bar1 [disabled]
9665 bar2
9666 @end smallexample
9667
9668 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
9669 as can each individual subprinter.
9670
9671 @node Value History
9672 @section Value History
9673
9674 @cindex value history
9675 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
9676 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
9677 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
9678 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
9679 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
9680 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
9681 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
9682 symbol table.
9683
9684 @cindex @code{$}
9685 @cindex @code{$$}
9686 @cindex history number
9687 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
9688 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
9689 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
9690 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
9691 history number.
9692
9693 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
9694 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
9695 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
9696 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
9697 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
9698 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
9699 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
9700
9701 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
9702 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
9703
9704 @smallexample
9705 p *$
9706 @end smallexample
9707
9708 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
9709 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
9710
9711 @smallexample
9712 p *$.next
9713 @end smallexample
9714
9715 @noindent
9716 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
9717 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
9718
9719 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
9720 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
9721
9722 @smallexample
9723 print x
9724 set x=5
9725 @end smallexample
9726
9727 @noindent
9728 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
9729 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
9730
9731 @table @code
9732 @kindex show values
9733 @item show values
9734 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
9735 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
9736 values} does not change the history.
9737
9738 @item show values @var{n}
9739 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
9740
9741 @item show values +
9742 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
9743 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
9744 @end table
9745
9746 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
9747 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
9748
9749 @node Convenience Vars
9750 @section Convenience Variables
9751
9752 @cindex convenience variables
9753 @cindex user-defined variables
9754 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
9755 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
9756 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
9757 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
9758 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
9759
9760 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
9761 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
9762 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9763 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
9764 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
9765
9766 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
9767 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
9768 For example:
9769
9770 @smallexample
9771 set $foo = *object_ptr
9772 @end smallexample
9773
9774 @noindent
9775 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
9776 @code{object_ptr}.
9777
9778 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
9779 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
9780 value with another assignment at any time.
9781
9782 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
9783 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
9784 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
9785 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
9786
9787 @table @code
9788 @kindex show convenience
9789 @cindex show all user variables and functions
9790 @item show convenience
9791 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
9792 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
9793 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
9794
9795 @kindex init-if-undefined
9796 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
9797 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
9798 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
9799 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
9800 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
9801 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
9802 override default values used in a command script.
9803
9804 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
9805 any side-effects do not occur.
9806 @end table
9807
9808 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
9809 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
9810 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
9811
9812 @smallexample
9813 set $i = 0
9814 print bar[$i++]->contents
9815 @end smallexample
9816
9817 @noindent
9818 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
9819
9820 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
9821 values likely to be useful.
9822
9823 @table @code
9824 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
9825 @item $_
9826 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
9827 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
9828 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
9829 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
9830 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
9831 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
9832 to the type of @code{$__}.
9833
9834 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
9835 @item $__
9836 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
9837 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
9838 to match the format in which the data was printed.
9839
9840 @item $_exitcode
9841 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
9842 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
9843 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
9844 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
9845
9846 @item $_exitsignal
9847 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
9848 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
9849 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
9850 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
9851
9852 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
9853 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
9854 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
9855 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
9856 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
9857
9858 @smallexample
9859 #include <signal.h>
9860
9861 int
9862 main (int argc, char *argv[])
9863 @{
9864 raise (SIGALRM);
9865 return 0;
9866 @}
9867 @end smallexample
9868
9869 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
9870 or signalled would be:
9871
9872 @smallexample
9873 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
9874 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
9875 End with a line saying just ``end''.
9876 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
9877 >echo The program has exited\n
9878 >else
9879 >echo The program has signalled\n
9880 >end
9881 >end
9882 (@value{GDBP}) run
9883 Starting program:
9884
9885 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
9886 The program no longer exists.
9887 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
9888 The program has signalled
9889 @end smallexample
9890
9891 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
9892 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
9893 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
9894 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
9895
9896 @smallexample
9897 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
9898 The program has exited
9899 @end smallexample
9900
9901 @item $_exception
9902 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
9903 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
9904
9905 @item $_probe_argc
9906 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
9907 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
9908
9909 @item $_sdata
9910 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
9911 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
9912 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
9913 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
9914 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
9915
9916 @item $_siginfo
9917 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
9918 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
9919 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
9920 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
9921 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
9922
9923 @item $_tlb
9924 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
9925 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
9926 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
9927 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
9928 @xref{General Query Packets}.
9929 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
9930
9931 @end table
9932
9933 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
9934 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
9935 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
9936
9937 @node Convenience Funs
9938 @section Convenience Functions
9939
9940 @cindex convenience functions
9941 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
9942 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
9943 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
9944 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
9945 @value{GDBN}.
9946
9947 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
9948 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
9949
9950 @table @code
9951
9952 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
9953 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
9954 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
9955 returns zero.
9956
9957 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
9958 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
9959 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
9960 it is @code{void}:
9961
9962 @smallexample
9963 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
9964 $1 = void
9965 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
9966 $2 = 1
9967 (@value{GDBP}) run
9968 Starting program: ./a.out
9969 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
9970 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
9971 $3 = 0
9972 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
9973 $4 = 0
9974 @end smallexample
9975
9976 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
9977 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
9978 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
9979 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
9980 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
9981 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
9982 anymore.
9983
9984 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
9985 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
9986
9987 @smallexample
9988 void
9989 foo (void)
9990 @{
9991 @}
9992 @end smallexample
9993
9994 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
9995
9996 @smallexample
9997 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
9998 $1 = void
9999 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10000 $2 = 1
10001 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10002 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10003 $3 = void
10004 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10005 $4 = 1
10006 @end smallexample
10007
10008 @end table
10009
10010 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10011 @code{Python} support.
10012
10013 @table @code
10014
10015 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10016 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10017 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10018 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10019 Otherwise it returns zero.
10020
10021 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10022 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10023 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10024 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10025 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10026 regular expression support.
10027
10028 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10029 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10030 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10031 Otherwise it returns zero.
10032
10033 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10034 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10035 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10036
10037 @end table
10038
10039 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10040 convenience functions.
10041
10042 @table @code
10043 @item help function
10044 @kindex help function
10045 @cindex show all convenience functions
10046 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10047 @end table
10048
10049 @node Registers
10050 @section Registers
10051
10052 @cindex registers
10053 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10054 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10055 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10056 your machine.
10057
10058 @table @code
10059 @kindex info registers
10060 @item info registers
10061 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10062 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10063
10064 @kindex info all-registers
10065 @cindex floating point registers
10066 @item info all-registers
10067 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10068 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10069
10070 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10071 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10072 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10073 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10074 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10075 @end table
10076
10077 @cindex stack pointer register
10078 @cindex program counter register
10079 @cindex process status register
10080 @cindex frame pointer register
10081 @cindex standard registers
10082 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10083 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10084 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10085 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10086 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10087 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10088 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10089 you could print the program counter in hex with
10090
10091 @smallexample
10092 p/x $pc
10093 @end smallexample
10094
10095 @noindent
10096 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10097
10098 @smallexample
10099 x/i $pc
10100 @end smallexample
10101
10102 @noindent
10103 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10104 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10105 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10106 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10107 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10108 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10109 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10110
10111 @smallexample
10112 set $sp += 4
10113 @end smallexample
10114
10115 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10116 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10117 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10118 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10119 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10120 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10121 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10122
10123 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10124 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
10125 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10126 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
10127 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10128 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10129 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10130
10131 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
10132 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10133 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10134 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10135 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10136 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
10137 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10138 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10139 prints the data in both formats.
10140
10141 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
10142 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
10143 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10144 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
10145 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10146 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
10147 registers in @code{struct} notation:
10148
10149 @smallexample
10150 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10151 $1 = @{
10152 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10153 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10154 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10155 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10156 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10157 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10158 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10159 @}
10160 @end smallexample
10161
10162 @noindent
10163 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
10164 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
10165 value to a @code{struct} member:
10166
10167 @smallexample
10168 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
10169 @end smallexample
10170
10171 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
10172 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
10173 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
10174 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
10175 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
10176 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
10177
10178 @cindex caller-saved registers
10179 @cindex call-clobbered registers
10180 @cindex volatile registers
10181 @cindex <not saved> values
10182 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
10183 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
10184 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
10185 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
10186 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
10187 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
10188 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
10189 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
10190 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
10191 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
10192 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
10193 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
10194 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
10195 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
10196 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
10197 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
10198 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
10199 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
10200 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
10201 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
10202 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
10203 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
10204 represent the value the register had just before the call.
10205
10206 @node Floating Point Hardware
10207 @section Floating Point Hardware
10208 @cindex floating point
10209
10210 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
10211 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
10212
10213 @table @code
10214 @kindex info float
10215 @item info float
10216 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
10217 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
10218 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
10219 the ARM and x86 machines.
10220 @end table
10221
10222 @node Vector Unit
10223 @section Vector Unit
10224 @cindex vector unit
10225
10226 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
10227 more information about the status of the vector unit.
10228
10229 @table @code
10230 @kindex info vector
10231 @item info vector
10232 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
10233 layout vary depending on the hardware.
10234 @end table
10235
10236 @node OS Information
10237 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
10238 @cindex OS information
10239
10240 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
10241 you debug your program.
10242
10243 @cindex auxiliary vector
10244 @cindex vector, auxiliary
10245 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
10246 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
10247 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
10248 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
10249 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
10250 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
10251 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
10252 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
10253 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
10254 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
10255 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
10256
10257 @table @code
10258 @kindex info auxv
10259 @item info auxv
10260 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
10261 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
10262 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
10263 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
10264 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
10265 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
10266 an unrecognized tag.
10267 @end table
10268
10269 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
10270 information and show it to you. The types of information available
10271 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
10272 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
10273 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
10274 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
10275 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
10276
10277 @table @code
10278 @kindex info os
10279 @item info os @var{infotype}
10280
10281 Display OS information of the requested type.
10282
10283 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
10284
10285 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
10286 @table @code
10287 @kindex info os processes
10288 @item processes
10289 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
10290 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
10291 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
10292 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
10293 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
10294 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
10295
10296 @kindex info os procgroups
10297 @item procgroups
10298 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
10299 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
10300 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
10301 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
10302 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
10303 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
10304 and the process group leader is listed first.
10305
10306 @kindex info os threads
10307 @item threads
10308 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
10309 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
10310 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
10311 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
10312 process is not listed.
10313
10314 @kindex info os files
10315 @item files
10316 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
10317 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
10318 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
10319 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
10320
10321 @kindex info os sockets
10322 @item sockets
10323 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
10324 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
10325 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
10326 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
10327 connection.
10328
10329 @kindex info os shm
10330 @item shm
10331 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
10332 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
10333 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
10334 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
10335 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
10336 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
10337 attached to, detach from, and changed.
10338
10339 @kindex info os semaphores
10340 @item semaphores
10341 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
10342 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
10343 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
10344 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
10345 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
10346
10347 @kindex info os msg
10348 @item msg
10349 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
10350 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
10351 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
10352 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
10353 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
10354 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
10355 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
10356 the message queue was last changed.
10357
10358 @kindex info os modules
10359 @item modules
10360 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
10361 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
10362 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
10363 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
10364 in memory.
10365 @end table
10366
10367 @item info os
10368 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
10369 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
10370 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
10371 types, this command will report an error.
10372 @end table
10373
10374 @node Memory Region Attributes
10375 @section Memory Region Attributes
10376 @cindex memory region attributes
10377
10378 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
10379 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
10380 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
10381 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
10382 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
10383 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
10384 user can override the fetched regions.
10385
10386 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
10387 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
10388 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
10389 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
10390 all memory.
10391
10392 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
10393 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
10394
10395 @table @code
10396 @kindex mem
10397 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
10398 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
10399 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
10400 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
10401 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
10402 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
10403
10404 @item mem auto
10405 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
10406 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
10407
10408 @kindex delete mem
10409 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10410 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
10411 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
10412
10413 @kindex disable mem
10414 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10415 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10416 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
10417 It may be enabled again later.
10418
10419 @kindex enable mem
10420 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10421 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10422
10423 @kindex info mem
10424 @item info mem
10425 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
10426 for each region:
10427
10428 @table @emph
10429 @item Memory Region Number
10430 @item Enabled or Disabled.
10431 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
10432 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
10433
10434 @item Lo Address
10435 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
10436
10437 @item Hi Address
10438 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
10439
10440 @item Attributes
10441 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
10442 @end table
10443 @end table
10444
10445
10446 @subsection Attributes
10447
10448 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
10449 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
10450 write accesses to a memory region.
10451
10452 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
10453 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
10454 etc.@: from accessing memory.
10455
10456 @table @code
10457 @item ro
10458 Memory is read only.
10459 @item wo
10460 Memory is write only.
10461 @item rw
10462 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
10463 @end table
10464
10465 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
10466 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
10467 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
10468 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
10469 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
10470
10471 @table @code
10472 @item 8
10473 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
10474 @item 16
10475 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
10476 @item 32
10477 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
10478 @item 64
10479 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
10480 @end table
10481
10482 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
10483 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10484 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
10485 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
10486 @c
10487 @c @table @code
10488 @c @item hwbreak
10489 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
10490 @c @item swbreak (default)
10491 @c @end table
10492
10493 @subsubsection Data Cache
10494 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
10495 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
10496 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
10497 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
10498 registers.
10499
10500 @table @code
10501 @item cache
10502 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
10503 @item nocache
10504 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
10505 @end table
10506
10507 @subsection Memory Access Checking
10508 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
10509 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
10510 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
10511 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
10512
10513 @table @code
10514 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
10515 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
10516 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
10517 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
10518 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
10519 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
10520 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
10521 The default value is @code{on}.
10522 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
10523 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
10524 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
10525 @end table
10526
10527
10528 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
10529 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10530 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
10531 @c
10532 @c @table @code
10533 @c @item verify
10534 @c @item noverify (default)
10535 @c @end table
10536
10537 @node Dump/Restore Files
10538 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
10539 @cindex dump/restore files
10540 @cindex append data to a file
10541 @cindex dump data to a file
10542 @cindex restore data from a file
10543
10544 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
10545 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
10546 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
10547 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
10548 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
10549 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
10550 files.
10551
10552 @table @code
10553
10554 @kindex dump
10555 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10556 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10557 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10558 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
10559
10560 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
10561 @table @code
10562 @item binary
10563 Raw binary form.
10564 @item ihex
10565 Intel hex format.
10566 @item srec
10567 Motorola S-record format.
10568 @item tekhex
10569 Tektronix Hex format.
10570 @end table
10571
10572 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
10573 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
10574 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
10575 form.
10576
10577 @kindex append
10578 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10579 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10580 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10581 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
10582 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
10583
10584 @kindex restore
10585 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
10586 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
10587 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
10588 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
10589 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
10590
10591 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
10592 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
10593 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
10594 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
10595 from that location.
10596
10597 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
10598 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
10599 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
10600 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
10601
10602 @end table
10603
10604 @node Core File Generation
10605 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
10606 @cindex dump core from inferior
10607
10608 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
10609 image of a running process and its process status (register values
10610 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
10611 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
10612 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
10613 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
10614 the post-mortem debugging mode.
10615
10616 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
10617 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
10618 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
10619
10620 @table @code
10621 @kindex gcore
10622 @kindex generate-core-file
10623 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
10624 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
10625 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
10626 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
10627 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
10628 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
10629
10630 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
10631 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
10632 @end table
10633
10634 @node Character Sets
10635 @section Character Sets
10636 @cindex character sets
10637 @cindex charset
10638 @cindex translating between character sets
10639 @cindex host character set
10640 @cindex target character set
10641
10642 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
10643 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
10644 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
10645 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
10646 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
10647 @dfn{target character set}.
10648
10649 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
10650 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
10651 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
10652 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
10653 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
10654 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
10655 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
10656 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
10657 character and string literals in expressions.
10658
10659 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
10660 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
10661 target-charset} command, described below.
10662
10663 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
10664 support:
10665
10666 @table @code
10667 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
10668 @kindex set target-charset
10669 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
10670 list of supported target character sets, type
10671 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
10672
10673 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
10674 @kindex set host-charset
10675 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
10676
10677 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
10678 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
10679 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
10680 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
10681 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
10682
10683 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
10684 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
10685 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
10686
10687 @item set charset @var{charset}
10688 @kindex set charset
10689 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
10690 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
10691 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
10692 for both host and target.
10693
10694 @item show charset
10695 @kindex show charset
10696 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
10697
10698 @item show host-charset
10699 @kindex show host-charset
10700 Show the name of the current host character set.
10701
10702 @item show target-charset
10703 @kindex show target-charset
10704 Show the name of the current target character set.
10705
10706 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
10707 @kindex set target-wide-charset
10708 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
10709 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
10710 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
10711 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
10712
10713 @item show target-wide-charset
10714 @kindex show target-wide-charset
10715 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
10716 @end table
10717
10718 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
10719 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
10720 @file{charset-test.c}:
10721
10722 @smallexample
10723 #include <stdio.h>
10724
10725 char ascii_hello[]
10726 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
10727 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
10728 char ibm1047_hello[]
10729 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
10730 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
10731
10732 main ()
10733 @{
10734 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
10735 @}
10736 @end smallexample
10737
10738 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
10739 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
10740 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
10741
10742 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
10743
10744 @smallexample
10745 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
10746 $ gdb -nw charset-test
10747 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
10748 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
10749 @dots{}
10750 (@value{GDBP})
10751 @end smallexample
10752
10753 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
10754 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
10755 strings:
10756
10757 @smallexample
10758 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
10759 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
10760 (@value{GDBP})
10761 @end smallexample
10762
10763 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
10764 initial character set:
10765 @smallexample
10766 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
10767 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
10768 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
10769 (@value{GDBP})
10770 @end smallexample
10771
10772 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
10773 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
10774 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
10775 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
10776 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
10777
10778 @smallexample
10779 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
10780 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
10781 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
10782 $2 = 72 'H'
10783 (@value{GDBP})
10784 @end smallexample
10785
10786 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
10787 literals you use in expressions:
10788
10789 @smallexample
10790 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
10791 $3 = 43 '+'
10792 (@value{GDBP})
10793 @end smallexample
10794
10795 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
10796 character.
10797
10798 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
10799 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
10800 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
10801
10802 @smallexample
10803 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
10804 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
10805 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
10806 $5 = 200 '\310'
10807 (@value{GDBP})
10808 @end smallexample
10809
10810 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
10811 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
10812
10813 @smallexample
10814 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
10815 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
10816 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
10817 @end smallexample
10818
10819 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
10820 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
10821 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
10822 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
10823 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
10824
10825 @smallexample
10826 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
10827 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
10828 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
10829 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
10830 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
10831 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
10832 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
10833 $7 = 72 '\110'
10834 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
10835 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
10836 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
10837 $9 = 200 'H'
10838 (@value{GDBP})
10839 @end smallexample
10840
10841 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
10842 string literals you use in expressions:
10843
10844 @smallexample
10845 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
10846 $10 = 78 '+'
10847 (@value{GDBP})
10848 @end smallexample
10849
10850 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
10851 character.
10852
10853 @node Caching Target Data
10854 @section Caching Data of Targets
10855 @cindex caching data of targets
10856
10857 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
10858 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
10859 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
10860 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
10861 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
10862 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
10863 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
10864 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
10865 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
10866 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
10867 is executing.
10868 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
10869 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
10870 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
10871 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
10872 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
10873 in the code segment.
10874 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
10875 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
10876
10877 @table @code
10878 @kindex set remotecache
10879 @item set remotecache on
10880 @itemx set remotecache off
10881 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
10882 with old scripts.
10883
10884 @kindex show remotecache
10885 @item show remotecache
10886 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
10887
10888 @kindex set stack-cache
10889 @item set stack-cache on
10890 @itemx set stack-cache off
10891 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
10892 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
10893
10894 @kindex show stack-cache
10895 @item show stack-cache
10896 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
10897
10898 @kindex set code-cache
10899 @item set code-cache on
10900 @itemx set code-cache off
10901 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
10902 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
10903 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
10904
10905 @kindex show code-cache
10906 @item show code-cache
10907 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
10908 accesses.
10909
10910 @kindex info dcache
10911 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
10912 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
10913 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
10914 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
10915 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
10916 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
10917
10918 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
10919 printed in hex.
10920
10921 @item set dcache size @var{size}
10922 @cindex dcache size
10923 @kindex set dcache size
10924 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
10925
10926 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
10927 @cindex dcache line-size
10928 @kindex set dcache line-size
10929 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
10930 Must be a power of 2.
10931
10932 @item show dcache size
10933 @kindex show dcache size
10934 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
10935
10936 @item show dcache line-size
10937 @kindex show dcache line-size
10938 Show default size of dcache lines.
10939
10940 @end table
10941
10942 @node Searching Memory
10943 @section Search Memory
10944 @cindex searching memory
10945
10946 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
10947 @code{find} command.
10948
10949 @table @code
10950 @kindex find
10951 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
10952 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
10953 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
10954 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
10955 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
10956 @end table
10957
10958 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
10959 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
10960
10961 @table @r
10962 @item @var{s}, search query size
10963 The size of each search query value.
10964
10965 @table @code
10966 @item b
10967 bytes
10968 @item h
10969 halfwords (two bytes)
10970 @item w
10971 words (four bytes)
10972 @item g
10973 giant words (eight bytes)
10974 @end table
10975
10976 All values are interpreted in the current language.
10977 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
10978 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
10979
10980 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
10981 value's type in the current language.
10982 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
10983 pattern as a mixture of types.
10984 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
10985 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
10986 which is typically four bytes.
10987
10988 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
10989 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
10990 @end table
10991
10992 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
10993 (@code{"}).
10994 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
10995 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
10996
10997 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
10998 number of matches found.
10999
11000 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11001 @samp{$_}.
11002 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11003
11004 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11005
11006 @smallexample
11007 void
11008 hello ()
11009 @{
11010 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11011 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11012 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11013 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11014 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11015 @}
11016 @end smallexample
11017
11018 @noindent
11019 you get during debugging:
11020
11021 @smallexample
11022 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11023 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11024 1 pattern found
11025 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11026 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11027 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11028 2 patterns found
11029 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11030 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11031 1 pattern found
11032 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11033 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11034 1 pattern found
11035 (gdb) print $numfound
11036 $1 = 1
11037 (gdb) print $_
11038 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11039 @end smallexample
11040
11041 @node Optimized Code
11042 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11043 @cindex optimized code, debugging
11044 @cindex debugging optimized code
11045
11046 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
11047 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11048 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
11049 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11050 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
11051 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11052 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11053
11054 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
11055 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11056 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
11057 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11058
11059 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11060 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11061 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11062 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
11063 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11064 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11065
11066 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11067 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
11068 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11069 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11070 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11071
11072 @menu
11073 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11074 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11075 @end menu
11076
11077 @node Inline Functions
11078 @section Inline Functions
11079 @cindex inline functions, debugging
11080
11081 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
11082 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
11083 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
11084 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
11085 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
11086 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
11087 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
11088 @code{info frame} command.
11089
11090 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
11091 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
11092 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
11093 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
11094 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
11095 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
11096 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
11097 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
11098 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
11099 local variables in the caller.
11100
11101 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
11102 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
11103 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
11104 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
11105 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
11106 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
11107 instructions are executed.
11108
11109 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
11110 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
11111 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
11112 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
11113
11114 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
11115 function calls are the same as normal calls:
11116
11117 @itemize @bullet
11118 @item
11119 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
11120 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
11121 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
11122 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
11123 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
11124 or inside the inlined function instead.
11125
11126 @item
11127 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
11128 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
11129 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
11130 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
11131
11132 @end itemize
11133
11134 @node Tail Call Frames
11135 @section Tail Call Frames
11136 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
11137
11138 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
11139 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
11140 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
11141 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
11142 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
11143
11144 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
11145 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
11146 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
11147 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
11148 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
11149 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
11150 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
11151
11152 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
11153 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
11154 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
11155 this information.
11156
11157 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
11158 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
11159
11160 @smallexample
11161 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
11162 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
11163 (gdb) info frame
11164 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
11165 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
11166 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
11167 source language c++.
11168 Arglist at unknown address.
11169 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
11170 @end smallexample
11171
11172 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
11173 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
11174 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
11175 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
11176 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
11177 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
11178
11179 @table @code
11180 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
11181 @item set debug entry-values
11182 @kindex set debug entry-values
11183 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
11184 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
11185 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
11186 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
11187 result.
11188
11189 @item show debug entry-values
11190 @kindex show debug entry-values
11191 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
11192 values at function entry and tail calls.
11193 @end table
11194
11195 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
11196 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
11197 reference by variable @code{x}):
11198
11199 @smallexample
11200 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
11201 void (*x) (void) = c;
11202 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11203 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
11204 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
11205
11206 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find
11207 DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main
11208 a () at t.c:3
11209 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11210 (gdb) bt
11211 #0 a () at t.c:3
11212 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
11213 @end smallexample
11214
11215 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
11216
11217 @smallexample
11218 int i;
11219 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
11220 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
11221 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
11222 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
11223 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
11224 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
11225 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
11226 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
11227
11228 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
11229 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
11230 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
11231 (gdb) bt
11232 #0 f () at t.c:2
11233 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
11234 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
11235 @end smallexample
11236
11237 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
11238 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
11239
11240 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
11241 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11242 @set ARROW @click{}
11243 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
11244 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
11245 @end ifset
11246 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11247 @set ARROW ->
11248 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
11249 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
11250 @end ifclear
11251
11252 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
11253 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
11254 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
11255
11256 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
11257 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
11258 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
11259 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
11260 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
11261 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
11262
11263 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
11264 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
11265 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
11266 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
11267 omitted.
11268
11269 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
11270 entry may fail:
11271
11272 @smallexample
11273 int v;
11274 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
11275 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
11276 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
11277 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
11278 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
11279 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
11280
11281 (gdb) bt
11282 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
11283 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found
11284 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
11285 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
11286 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
11287 @end smallexample
11288
11289 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
11290 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
11291 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
11292 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
11293 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
11294
11295 @node Macros
11296 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
11297
11298 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
11299 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
11300 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
11301 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
11302 where it was defined.
11303
11304 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
11305 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
11306 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
11307 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
11308
11309 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
11310 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
11311 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
11312 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
11313 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
11314 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
11315 see @ref{List}.
11316
11317 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
11318 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
11319 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
11320
11321 @table @code
11322
11323 @kindex macro expand
11324 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
11325 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
11326 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
11327 @item macro expand @var{expression}
11328 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
11329 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
11330 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
11331 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
11332 it can be any string of tokens.
11333
11334 @kindex macro exp1
11335 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
11336 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
11337 @cindex expand macro once
11338 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
11339 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
11340 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
11341 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
11342 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
11343 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
11344 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
11345 can be any string of tokens.
11346
11347 @kindex info macro
11348 @cindex macro definition, showing
11349 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
11350 @cindex macros, from debug info
11351 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
11352 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
11353 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
11354 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
11355 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
11356 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
11357
11358 @kindex info macros
11359 @item info macros @var{linespec}
11360 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
11361 by @var{linespec}, and describe the source location or compiler
11362 command-line where those definitions were established.
11363
11364 @kindex macro define
11365 @cindex user-defined macros
11366 @cindex defining macros interactively
11367 @cindex macros, user-defined
11368 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
11369 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
11370 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
11371 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
11372 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
11373 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
11374 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
11375 @var{arglist}.
11376
11377 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
11378 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
11379 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
11380 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
11381 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
11382
11383 @kindex macro undef
11384 @item macro undef @var{macro}
11385 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
11386 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
11387 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
11388 in the program being debugged.
11389
11390 @kindex macro list
11391 @item macro list
11392 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
11393 @end table
11394
11395 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
11396 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
11397 show our source files:
11398
11399 @smallexample
11400 $ cat sample.c
11401 #include <stdio.h>
11402 #include "sample.h"
11403
11404 #define M 42
11405 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11406
11407 main ()
11408 @{
11409 #define N 28
11410 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11411 #undef N
11412 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11413 #define N 1729
11414 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11415 @}
11416 $ cat sample.h
11417 #define Q <
11418 $
11419 @end smallexample
11420
11421 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
11422 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
11423 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
11424 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
11425 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
11426 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
11427 information.
11428
11429 @smallexample
11430 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
11431 $
11432 @end smallexample
11433
11434 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
11435
11436 @smallexample
11437 $ gdb -nw sample
11438 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
11439 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11440 GDB is free software, @dots{}
11441 (@value{GDBP})
11442 @end smallexample
11443
11444 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
11445 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
11446 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
11447
11448 @smallexample
11449 (@value{GDBP}) list main
11450 3
11451 4 #define M 42
11452 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11453 6
11454 7 main ()
11455 8 @{
11456 9 #define N 28
11457 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11458 11 #undef N
11459 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11460 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
11461 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
11462 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11463 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
11464 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
11465 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
11466 #define Q <
11467 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
11468 expands to: (42 + 1)
11469 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
11470 expands to: once (M + 1)
11471 (@value{GDBP})
11472 @end smallexample
11473
11474 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
11475 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
11476 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
11477 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
11478
11479 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
11480 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
11481
11482 @smallexample
11483 (@value{GDBP}) break main
11484 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
11485 (@value{GDBP}) run
11486 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
11487
11488 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
11489 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11490 (@value{GDBP})
11491 @end smallexample
11492
11493 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
11494
11495 @smallexample
11496 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11497 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
11498 #define N 28
11499 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11500 expands to: 28 < 42
11501 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11502 $1 = 1
11503 (@value{GDBP})
11504 @end smallexample
11505
11506 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
11507 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
11508 thereof) in force at each point:
11509
11510 @smallexample
11511 (@value{GDBP}) next
11512 Hello, world!
11513 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11514 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11515 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
11516 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
11517 (@value{GDBP}) next
11518 We're so creative.
11519 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11520 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11521 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
11522 #define N 1729
11523 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11524 expands to: 1729 < 42
11525 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11526 $2 = 0
11527 (@value{GDBP})
11528 @end smallexample
11529
11530 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
11531 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
11532 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
11533 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
11534
11535 @smallexample
11536 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
11537 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
11538 -D__STDC__=1
11539 (@value{GDBP})
11540 @end smallexample
11541
11542
11543 @node Tracepoints
11544 @chapter Tracepoints
11545 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
11546 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
11547
11548 @cindex tracepoints
11549 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
11550 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
11551 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
11552 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
11553 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
11554 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
11555 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
11556
11557 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
11558 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
11559 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
11560 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
11561 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
11562 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
11563 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
11564 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
11565 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
11566 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
11567 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
11568
11569 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
11570 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
11571 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
11572 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
11573 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
11574 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
11575 Packets}.
11576
11577 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
11578 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
11579 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
11580
11581 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
11582
11583 @menu
11584 * Set Tracepoints::
11585 * Analyze Collected Data::
11586 * Tracepoint Variables::
11587 * Trace Files::
11588 @end menu
11589
11590 @node Set Tracepoints
11591 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
11592
11593 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
11594 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
11595 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
11596 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
11597 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
11598 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
11599 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
11600
11601 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
11602 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
11603 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
11604 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
11605 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
11606 tracepoint was hit.
11607
11608 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
11609 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
11610 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
11611 either.
11612
11613 @cindex fast tracepoints
11614 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
11615 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
11616 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
11617
11618 @cindex static tracepoints
11619 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
11620 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
11621 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
11622 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
11623 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
11624 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
11625 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
11626 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
11627 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
11628 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
11629 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
11630 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
11631 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
11632 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
11633 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
11634 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
11635 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
11636 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
11637 static tracepoint marker.
11638
11639 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
11640 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
11641
11642 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
11643 conditions and actions.
11644
11645 @menu
11646 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
11647 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
11648 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
11649 * Tracepoint Conditions::
11650 * Trace State Variables::
11651 * Tracepoint Actions::
11652 * Listing Tracepoints::
11653 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
11654 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
11655 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
11656 @end menu
11657
11658 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
11659 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
11660
11661 @table @code
11662 @cindex set tracepoint
11663 @kindex trace
11664 @item trace @var{location}
11665 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
11666 Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
11667 an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
11668 @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
11669 target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
11670 data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
11671 changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
11672 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
11673 in tracing}).
11674 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
11675 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
11676 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
11677 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
11678 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
11679 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
11680 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
11681 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
11682 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
11683 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
11684 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
11685 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
11686
11687 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
11688
11689 @smallexample
11690 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
11691
11692 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
11693
11694 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
11695
11696 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
11697
11698 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
11699 @end smallexample
11700
11701 @noindent
11702 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
11703
11704 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
11705 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
11706 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
11707 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
11708 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
11709 information on tracepoint conditions.
11710
11711 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
11712 @cindex set fast tracepoint
11713 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
11714 @kindex ftrace
11715 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
11716 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
11717 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
11718 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
11719 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
11720 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
11721 message.
11722
11723 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
11724 @code{trace}.
11725
11726 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
11727 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
11728 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
11729 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
11730 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
11731 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
11732 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
11733 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
11734
11735 @example
11736 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
11737 @end example
11738
11739 @noindent
11740 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
11741 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
11742
11743 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
11744 @cindex set static tracepoint
11745 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
11746 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
11747 @kindex strace
11748 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
11749 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
11750 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
11751 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
11752 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
11753
11754 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
11755 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
11756 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
11757 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
11758 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
11759 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
11760 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
11761 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
11762 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
11763 tracing engine:
11764
11765 @smallexample
11766 main ()
11767 @{
11768 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
11769 @}
11770 @end smallexample
11771
11772 @noindent
11773 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
11774 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
11775
11776 @smallexample
11777 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
11778 Cnt Enb ID Address What
11779 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
11780 Data: "str %s"
11781 [etc...]
11782 @end smallexample
11783
11784 @noindent
11785 so you may probe the marker above with:
11786
11787 @smallexample
11788 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
11789 @end smallexample
11790
11791 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
11792 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
11793 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
11794 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
11795 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
11796 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
11797 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
11798 the @samp{Data:} field.
11799
11800 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
11801 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
11802 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
11803
11804 @vindex $tpnum
11805 @cindex last tracepoint number
11806 @cindex recent tracepoint number
11807 @cindex tracepoint number
11808 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
11809 of the most recently set tracepoint.
11810
11811 @kindex delete tracepoint
11812 @cindex tracepoint deletion
11813 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11814 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
11815 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
11816 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
11817
11818 Examples:
11819
11820 @smallexample
11821 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
11822
11823 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
11824 @end smallexample
11825
11826 @noindent
11827 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
11828 @end table
11829
11830 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
11831 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
11832
11833 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
11834
11835 @table @code
11836 @kindex disable tracepoint
11837 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11838 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
11839 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
11840 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
11841 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
11842 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
11843 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
11844 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
11845 next trace experiment.
11846
11847 @kindex enable tracepoint
11848 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11849 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
11850 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
11851 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
11852 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
11853 next time a trace experiment is run.
11854 @end table
11855
11856 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
11857 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
11858
11859 @table @code
11860 @kindex passcount
11861 @cindex tracepoint pass count
11862 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
11863 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
11864 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
11865 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
11866 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
11867 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
11868 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
11869 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
11870 user.
11871
11872 Examples:
11873
11874 @smallexample
11875 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
11876 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
11877
11878 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
11879 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
11880 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
11881 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
11882 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
11883 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
11884 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
11885 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
11886 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
11887 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
11888 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
11889 @end smallexample
11890 @end table
11891
11892 @node Tracepoint Conditions
11893 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
11894 @cindex conditional tracepoints
11895 @cindex tracepoint conditions
11896
11897 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
11898 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
11899 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
11900 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
11901 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
11902 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
11903 is true.
11904
11905 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
11906 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
11907 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
11908 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
11909 just as with breakpoints.
11910
11911 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
11912 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
11913 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
11914 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
11915 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
11916 accesses, and so forth.
11917
11918 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
11919 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
11920 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
11921 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
11922 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
11923 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
11924 search through.
11925
11926 @smallexample
11927 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
11928 @end smallexample
11929
11930 @node Trace State Variables
11931 @subsection Trace State Variables
11932 @cindex trace state variables
11933
11934 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
11935 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
11936 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
11937 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
11938 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
11939 integers.
11940
11941 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
11942 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
11943 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
11944 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
11945
11946 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
11947 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
11948 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
11949 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
11950 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
11951 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
11952 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
11953 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
11954 variable with the same name.
11955
11956 @table @code
11957
11958 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
11959 @kindex tvariable
11960 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
11961 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
11962 @var{expression}. @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
11963 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
11964 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
11965 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
11966 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
11967 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
11968 value. The default initial value is 0.
11969
11970 @item info tvariables
11971 @kindex info tvariables
11972 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
11973 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
11974 currently running.
11975
11976 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
11977 @kindex delete tvariable
11978 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
11979 are specified.
11980
11981 @end table
11982
11983 @node Tracepoint Actions
11984 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
11985
11986 @table @code
11987 @kindex actions
11988 @cindex tracepoint actions
11989 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11990 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
11991 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
11992 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
11993 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
11994 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
11995 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
11996 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
11997 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
11998 @code{while-stepping}.
11999
12000 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12001 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12002 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12003
12004 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12005 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12006 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12007
12008 @smallexample
12009 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12010
12011 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12012
12013 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12014 @end smallexample
12015
12016 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12017 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12018 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12019 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12020 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12021 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12022 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12023 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12024
12025 @smallexample
12026 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12027 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12028 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12029 > collect bar,baz
12030 > collect $regs
12031 > while-stepping 12
12032 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12033 > end
12034 end
12035 @end smallexample
12036
12037 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12038 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12039 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12040 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12041 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12042 special arguments are supported:
12043
12044 @table @code
12045 @item $regs
12046 Collect all registers.
12047
12048 @item $args
12049 Collect all function arguments.
12050
12051 @item $locals
12052 Collect all local variables.
12053
12054 @item $_ret
12055 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
12056 of a backtrace.
12057
12058 @item $_probe_argc
12059 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12060 tracepoint is located.
12061 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12062
12063 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12064 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
12065 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12066 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12067
12068 @item $_sdata
12069 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12070 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
12071 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
12072 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
12073 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
12074 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
12075 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
12076 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
12077 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
12078
12079 @smallexample
12080 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
12081 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
12082 @end smallexample
12083
12084 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
12085 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
12086 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
12087 @value{GDBN}.
12088 @end table
12089
12090 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
12091 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
12092 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
12093
12094 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
12095 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
12096 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
12097 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
12098 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
12099 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
12100 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
12101 @samp{mystr}.
12102
12103 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
12104 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
12105
12106 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
12107 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12108 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
12109 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
12110 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
12111 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
12112 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
12113 action were used.
12114
12115 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
12116 @item while-stepping @var{n}
12117 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
12118 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
12119 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
12120 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
12121
12122 @smallexample
12123 > while-stepping 12
12124 > collect $regs, myglobal
12125 > end
12126 >
12127 @end smallexample
12128
12129 @noindent
12130 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
12131 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
12132 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
12133 @code{stepping}.
12134
12135 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12136 @kindex set default-collect
12137 @cindex default collection action
12138 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
12139 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
12140 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
12141 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
12142 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
12143 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
12144
12145 @item show default-collect
12146 @kindex show default-collect
12147 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
12148 tracepoint hit.
12149
12150 @end table
12151
12152 @node Listing Tracepoints
12153 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
12154
12155 @table @code
12156 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12157 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12158 @cindex information about tracepoints
12159 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
12160 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
12161 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
12162 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
12163 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
12164 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
12165
12166 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
12167 tracing:
12168
12169 @itemize @bullet
12170 @item
12171 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
12172
12173 @item
12174 the state about installed on target of each location
12175 @end itemize
12176
12177 @smallexample
12178 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
12179 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
12180 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
12181 while-stepping 20
12182 collect globfoo, $regs
12183 end
12184 collect globfoo2
12185 end
12186 pass count 1200
12187 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
12188 collect $eip
12189 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12190 installed on target
12191 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12192 installed on target
12193 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
12194 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
12195 not installed on target
12196 (@value{GDBP})
12197 @end smallexample
12198
12199 @noindent
12200 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
12201 @end table
12202
12203 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12204 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12205
12206 @table @code
12207 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
12208 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
12209 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
12210 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
12211 program.
12212
12213 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
12214
12215 @table @emph
12216 @item Count
12217 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
12218 stable identifier.
12219 @item ID
12220 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
12221 @item Enabled or Disabled
12222 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
12223 that are not enabled.
12224 @item Address
12225 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
12226 @item What
12227 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
12228 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
12229 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
12230 will be left blank.
12231 @end table
12232
12233 @noindent
12234 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
12235
12236 @table @emph
12237 @item Data
12238 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
12239 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
12240 marker call.
12241 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
12242 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
12243 @end table
12244
12245 @smallexample
12246 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12247 Cnt ID Enb Address What
12248 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
12249 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
12250 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
12251 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
12252 Data: str %s
12253 (@value{GDBP})
12254 @end smallexample
12255 @end table
12256
12257 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12258 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12259
12260 @table @code
12261 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
12262 @cindex start a new trace experiment
12263 @cindex collected data discarded
12264 @item tstart
12265 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
12266 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
12267 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
12268 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
12269 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
12270 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
12271 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
12272 information, and so forth.
12273
12274 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
12275 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
12276 @item tstop
12277 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
12278 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
12279 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
12280 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
12281 needs to be stopped quickly.
12282
12283 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
12284 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
12285 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
12286
12287 @kindex tstatus
12288 @cindex status of trace data collection
12289 @cindex trace experiment, status of
12290 @item tstatus
12291 This command displays the status of the current trace data
12292 collection.
12293 @end table
12294
12295 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
12296
12297 @smallexample
12298 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
12299 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12300 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
12301 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
12302 > while-stepping 11
12303 > collect $regs
12304 > end
12305 > end
12306 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12307 [time passes @dots{}]
12308 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
12309 @end smallexample
12310
12311 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
12312 @cindex disconnected tracing
12313 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
12314 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
12315 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
12316 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
12317 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
12318 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
12319 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
12320 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
12321
12322 @table @code
12323 @item set disconnected-tracing on
12324 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
12325 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
12326 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
12327 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
12328 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
12329 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
12330 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
12331
12332 @item show disconnected-tracing
12333 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
12334 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
12335
12336 @end table
12337
12338 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
12339 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
12340 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
12341 it will continue after reconnection.
12342
12343 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
12344 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
12345 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
12346 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
12347 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
12348 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
12349 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
12350 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
12351 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
12352 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
12353
12354 @cindex circular trace buffer
12355 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
12356 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
12357 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
12358 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
12359 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
12360 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
12361 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
12362 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
12363 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
12364 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
12365 the next run.
12366
12367 @table @code
12368 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
12369 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
12370 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
12371 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
12372 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
12373 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
12374 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
12375
12376 @item show circular-trace-buffer
12377 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
12378 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
12379 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
12380 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
12381 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
12382
12383 @end table
12384
12385 @table @code
12386 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
12387 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
12388 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
12389 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
12390 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
12391 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
12392 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
12393 likes. This is also the default.
12394
12395 @item show trace-buffer-size
12396 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
12397 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
12398 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
12399 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
12400 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
12401 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
12402 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
12403 @end table
12404
12405 @table @code
12406 @item set trace-user @var{text}
12407 @kindex set trace-user
12408
12409 @item show trace-user
12410 @kindex show trace-user
12411
12412 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
12413 @kindex set trace-notes
12414 Set the trace run's notes.
12415
12416 @item show trace-notes
12417 @kindex show trace-notes
12418 Show the trace run's notes.
12419
12420 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
12421 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
12422 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
12423 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
12424 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
12425
12426 @item show trace-stop-notes
12427 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
12428 Show the trace run's stop notes.
12429
12430 @end table
12431
12432 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
12433 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
12434
12435 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
12436 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
12437 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
12438 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
12439 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
12440 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
12441 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
12442 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
12443 mentioned here.
12444
12445 @itemize @bullet
12446
12447 @item
12448 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
12449 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
12450 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
12451 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
12452 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
12453 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
12454 cannot be collected either.
12455
12456 @item
12457 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
12458 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
12459 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
12460 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
12461 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
12462 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
12463 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
12464 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
12465 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
12466 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
12467
12468 @item
12469 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
12470 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
12471 in a misleading way.
12472
12473 @item
12474 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
12475 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
12476 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
12477 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
12478 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
12479 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
12480 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
12481 by @code{ptr}.
12482
12483 @item
12484 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
12485 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
12486 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
12487 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
12488 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
12489 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
12490 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
12491 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
12492 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
12493 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
12494 invalid address.
12495
12496 @item
12497 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
12498 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
12499 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
12500 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
12501 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
12502 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
12503 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
12504 it to zero.
12505
12506 @end itemize
12507
12508 @node Analyze Collected Data
12509 @section Using the Collected Data
12510
12511 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
12512 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
12513 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
12514 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
12515 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
12516 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
12517 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
12518 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
12519 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
12520 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
12521 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
12522 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
12523 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
12524 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
12525 the buffer will fail.
12526
12527 @menu
12528 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
12529 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
12530 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
12531 @end menu
12532
12533 @node tfind
12534 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
12535
12536 @kindex tfind
12537 @cindex select trace snapshot
12538 @cindex find trace snapshot
12539 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
12540 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
12541 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
12542 snapshot is selected.
12543
12544 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
12545
12546 @table @code
12547 @item tfind start
12548 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
12549 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
12550
12551 @item tfind none
12552 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
12553
12554 @item tfind end
12555 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
12556
12557 @item tfind
12558 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
12559
12560 @item tfind -
12561 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
12562 retracing earlier steps.
12563
12564 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
12565 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
12566 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
12567 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
12568 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
12569
12570 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
12571 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
12572 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
12573 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
12574 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
12575
12576 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12577 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
12578 addresses (exclusive).
12579
12580 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12581 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
12582 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
12583
12584 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
12585 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
12586 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
12587 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
12588 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
12589 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
12590 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
12591 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
12592 @end table
12593
12594 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
12595 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
12596 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
12597 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
12598 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
12599 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
12600 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
12601 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
12602 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
12603 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
12604 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
12605 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
12606 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
12607 tracepoint as the current one.
12608
12609 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
12610 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
12611 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
12612 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
12613 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
12614
12615 @smallexample
12616 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12617 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
12618 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
12619 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
12620 > tfind
12621 > end
12622
12623 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
12624 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
12625 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
12626 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
12627 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
12628 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
12629 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
12630 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
12631 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
12632 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
12633 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
12634 @end smallexample
12635
12636 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
12637 the buffer:
12638
12639 @smallexample
12640 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12641 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
12642 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
12643 > tfind line
12644 > end
12645
12646 Frame 0, X = 1
12647 Frame 7, X = 2
12648 Frame 13, X = 255
12649 @end smallexample
12650
12651 @node tdump
12652 @subsection @code{tdump}
12653 @kindex tdump
12654 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
12655 @cindex tracepoint data, display
12656
12657 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
12658 the current trace snapshot.
12659
12660 @smallexample
12661 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
12662 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12663 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
12664 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
12665 > end
12666
12667 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12668
12669 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
12670 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
12671 at gdb_test.c:444
12672 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
12673
12674 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
12675 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
12676 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
12677 d1 0x18 24
12678 d2 0x80 128
12679 d3 0x33 51
12680 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
12681 d5 0x22 34
12682 d6 0xe0 224
12683 d7 0x380035 3670069
12684 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
12685 a1 0x3000668 50333288
12686 a2 0x100 256
12687 a3 0x322000 3284992
12688 a4 0x3000698 50333336
12689 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
12690 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
12691 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
12692 ps 0x0 0
12693 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
12694 fpcontrol 0x0 0
12695 fpstatus 0x0 0
12696 fpiaddr 0x0 0
12697 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
12698 p1 = (void *) 0x11
12699 p2 = (void *) 0x22
12700 p3 = (void *) 0x33
12701 p4 = (void *) 0x44
12702 p5 = (void *) 0x55
12703 p6 = (void *) 0x66
12704 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
12705
12706 (@value{GDBP})
12707 @end smallexample
12708
12709 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
12710 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
12711 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
12712 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
12713
12714 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
12715 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
12716 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
12717 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
12718 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
12719 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
12720 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
12721 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
12722 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
12723 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
12724
12725 @node save tracepoints
12726 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
12727 @kindex save tracepoints
12728 @kindex save-tracepoints
12729 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
12730
12731 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
12732 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
12733 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
12734 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
12735 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
12736 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
12737
12738 @node Tracepoint Variables
12739 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
12740 @cindex tracepoint variables
12741 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
12742
12743 @table @code
12744 @vindex $trace_frame
12745 @item (int) $trace_frame
12746 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
12747 snapshot is selected.
12748
12749 @vindex $tracepoint
12750 @item (int) $tracepoint
12751 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
12752
12753 @vindex $trace_line
12754 @item (int) $trace_line
12755 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
12756
12757 @vindex $trace_file
12758 @item (char []) $trace_file
12759 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
12760
12761 @vindex $trace_func
12762 @item (char []) $trace_func
12763 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
12764 @end table
12765
12766 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
12767 use @code{output} instead.
12768
12769 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
12770 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
12771 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
12772 which are managed by the target.
12773
12774 @smallexample
12775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12776
12777 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
12778 > output $trace_file
12779 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
12780 > tfind
12781 > end
12782 @end smallexample
12783
12784 @node Trace Files
12785 @section Using Trace Files
12786 @cindex trace files
12787
12788 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
12789 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
12790 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
12791 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
12792 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
12793
12794 @table @code
12795
12796 @kindex tsave
12797 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
12798 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
12799 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
12800 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
12801 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
12802 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
12803 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
12804 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
12805 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
12806 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
12807 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
12808 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save date in CTF
12809 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
12810 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
12811 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
12812
12813 @kindex target tfile
12814 @kindex tfile
12815 @kindex target ctf
12816 @kindex ctf
12817 @item target tfile @var{filename}
12818 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
12819 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
12820 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
12821 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
12822 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
12823 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
12824 @var{filename} or @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
12825 the host.
12826
12827 @smallexample
12828 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
12829 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
12830 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
12831 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
12832 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
12833 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
12834 i = 0
12835 a = 0
12836 b = 1 '\001'
12837 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
12838 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
12839 (@value{GDBP}) p b
12840 $1 = 1
12841 @end smallexample
12842
12843 @end table
12844
12845 @node Overlays
12846 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
12847 @cindex overlays
12848
12849 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
12850 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
12851 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
12852 use overlays.
12853
12854 @menu
12855 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
12856 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
12857 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
12858 mapped by asking the inferior.
12859 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
12860 @end menu
12861
12862 @node How Overlays Work
12863 @section How Overlays Work
12864 @cindex mapped overlays
12865 @cindex unmapped overlays
12866 @cindex load address, overlay's
12867 @cindex mapped address
12868 @cindex overlay area
12869
12870 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
12871 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
12872 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
12873 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
12874 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
12875
12876 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
12877 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
12878 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
12879 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
12880 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
12881 largest overlay as well.
12882
12883 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
12884 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
12885 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
12886 there.
12887
12888 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
12889 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
12890 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
12891
12892 @smallexample
12893 @group
12894 Data Instruction Larger
12895 Address Space Address Space Address Space
12896 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
12897 | | | | | |
12898 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
12899 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
12900 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
12901 | and heap | | | | | |
12902 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
12903 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
12904 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
12905 | | | | | |
12906 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
12907 address | | | | | |
12908 | overlay | <-' | | |
12909 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
12910 | | <---. | | load address
12911 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
12912 | | | |
12913 +-----------+ | |
12914 +-----------+
12915 | |
12916 +-----------+
12917
12918 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
12919 @end group
12920 @end smallexample
12921
12922 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
12923 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
12924 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
12925 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
12926 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
12927 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
12928 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
12929 program and the overlay area.
12930
12931 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
12932 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
12933 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
12934 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
12935 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
12936 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
12937 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
12938
12939 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
12940 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
12941 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
12942
12943 @itemize @bullet
12944
12945 @item
12946 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
12947 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
12948 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
12949 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
12950
12951 @item
12952 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
12953 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
12954 your program's performance.
12955
12956 @item
12957 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
12958 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
12959 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
12960 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
12961 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
12962 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
12963 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
12964
12965 @item
12966 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
12967 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
12968 instruction and data spaces.
12969
12970 @end itemize
12971
12972 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
12973 improved in many ways:
12974
12975 @itemize @bullet
12976
12977 @item
12978 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
12979 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
12980 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
12981 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
12982 area in the usual way.
12983
12984 @item
12985 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
12986 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
12987
12988 @item
12989 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
12990 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
12991 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
12992 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
12993 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
12994 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
12995 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
12996
12997 @end itemize
12998
12999
13000 @node Overlay Commands
13001 @section Overlay Commands
13002
13003 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13004 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13005 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13006 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13007 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13008 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13009
13010 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13011 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13012
13013 @table @code
13014 @item overlay off
13015 @kindex overlay
13016 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13017 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13018 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13019 overlay support is disabled.
13020
13021 @item overlay manual
13022 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13023 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13024 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13025 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13026 commands described below.
13027
13028 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13029 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13030 @cindex map an overlay
13031 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13032 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
13033 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13034 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
13035 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13036 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13037
13038 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13039 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13040 @cindex unmap an overlay
13041 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13042 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13043 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13044 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13045
13046 @item overlay auto
13047 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13048 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13049 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
13050 Overlay Debugging}.
13051
13052 @item overlay load-target
13053 @itemx overlay load
13054 @cindex reloading the overlay table
13055 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
13056 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13057 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13058 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
13059 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13060
13061 @item overlay list-overlays
13062 @itemx overlay list
13063 @cindex listing mapped overlays
13064 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13065 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13066
13067 @end table
13068
13069 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
13070 of the function the address falls in:
13071
13072 @smallexample
13073 (@value{GDBP}) print main
13074 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
13075 @end smallexample
13076 @noindent
13077 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
13078 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
13079 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
13080 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
13081
13082 @smallexample
13083 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13084 No sections are mapped.
13085 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13086 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
13087 @end smallexample
13088 @noindent
13089 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
13090 name normally:
13091
13092 @smallexample
13093 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13094 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
13095 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
13096 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13097 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
13098 @end smallexample
13099
13100 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
13101 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
13102 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
13103 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
13104 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
13105
13106 @itemize @bullet
13107 @item
13108 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
13109 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
13110 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
13111 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
13112 @item
13113 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
13114 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
13115 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
13116 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
13117 breakpoints properly.
13118 @end itemize
13119
13120
13121 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
13122 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
13123 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
13124
13125 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
13126 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
13127 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
13128 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
13129 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
13130 current state of the overlays.
13131
13132 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
13133 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
13134
13135 @table @asis
13136
13137 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
13138 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
13139
13140 @smallexample
13141 struct
13142 @{
13143 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
13144 unsigned long vma;
13145
13146 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
13147 unsigned long size;
13148
13149 /* The overlay's load address. */
13150 unsigned long lma;
13151
13152 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
13153 zero otherwise. */
13154 unsigned long mapped;
13155 @}
13156 @end smallexample
13157
13158 @item @code{_novlys}:
13159 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
13160 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
13161
13162 @end table
13163
13164 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
13165 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
13166 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
13167 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
13168 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
13169 currently mapped.
13170
13171 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
13172 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
13173 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
13174 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
13175 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
13176 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
13177 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
13178 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
13179 are not being executed.
13180
13181 @node Overlay Sample Program
13182 @section Overlay Sample Program
13183 @cindex overlay example program
13184
13185 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
13186 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
13187 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
13188 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
13189 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
13190 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
13191 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
13192
13193 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
13194 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
13195 suite. The program consists of the following files from
13196 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
13197
13198 @table @file
13199 @item overlays.c
13200 The main program file.
13201 @item ovlymgr.c
13202 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
13203 @item foo.c
13204 @itemx bar.c
13205 @itemx baz.c
13206 @itemx grbx.c
13207 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
13208 @item d10v.ld
13209 @itemx m32r.ld
13210 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
13211 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
13212 @end table
13213
13214 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
13215 cross-compiler like this:
13216
13217 @smallexample
13218 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
13219 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
13220 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
13221 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
13222 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
13223 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
13224 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
13225 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
13226 @end smallexample
13227
13228 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
13229 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
13230 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
13231
13232
13233 @node Languages
13234 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
13235 @cindex languages
13236
13237 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
13238 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
13239 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
13240 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
13241 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
13242 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
13243
13244 @cindex working language
13245 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
13246 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
13247 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
13248 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
13249 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
13250 language}.
13251
13252 @menu
13253 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
13254 * Show:: Displaying the language
13255 * Checks:: Type and range checks
13256 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
13257 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
13258 @end menu
13259
13260 @node Setting
13261 @section Switching Between Source Languages
13262
13263 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
13264 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
13265 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
13266 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
13267 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
13268 are printed, etc.
13269
13270 In addition to the working language, every source file that
13271 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
13272 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
13273 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
13274 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
13275 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
13276 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
13277 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
13278 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
13279 Displaying the Language}.
13280
13281 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
13282 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
13283 another language. In that case, make the
13284 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
13285 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
13286 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
13287
13288 @menu
13289 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
13290 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
13291 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
13292 @end menu
13293
13294 @node Filenames
13295 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
13296
13297 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
13298 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
13299
13300 @table @file
13301 @item .ada
13302 @itemx .ads
13303 @itemx .adb
13304 @itemx .a
13305 Ada source file.
13306
13307 @item .c
13308 C source file
13309
13310 @item .C
13311 @itemx .cc
13312 @itemx .cp
13313 @itemx .cpp
13314 @itemx .cxx
13315 @itemx .c++
13316 C@t{++} source file
13317
13318 @item .d
13319 D source file
13320
13321 @item .m
13322 Objective-C source file
13323
13324 @item .f
13325 @itemx .F
13326 Fortran source file
13327
13328 @item .mod
13329 Modula-2 source file
13330
13331 @item .s
13332 @itemx .S
13333 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
13334 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
13335 @end table
13336
13337 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
13338 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
13339
13340 @node Manually
13341 @subsection Setting the Working Language
13342
13343 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
13344 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
13345 your program.
13346
13347 @kindex set language
13348 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
13349 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
13350 a language, such as
13351 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
13352 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
13353
13354 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
13355 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
13356 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
13357 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
13358 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
13359 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
13360 command such as:
13361
13362 @smallexample
13363 print a = b + c
13364 @end smallexample
13365
13366 @noindent
13367 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
13368 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
13369 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
13370 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
13371
13372 @node Automatically
13373 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
13374
13375 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
13376 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
13377 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
13378 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
13379 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
13380 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
13381 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
13382 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
13383 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
13384
13385 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
13386 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
13387 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
13388 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
13389 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
13390
13391 @node Show
13392 @section Displaying the Language
13393
13394 The following commands help you find out which language is the
13395 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
13396
13397 @table @code
13398 @item show language
13399 @anchor{show language}
13400 @kindex show language
13401 Display the current working language. This is the
13402 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
13403 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
13404
13405 @item info frame
13406 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
13407 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
13408 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
13409 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
13410 information listed here.
13411
13412 @item info source
13413 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
13414 Display the source language of this source file.
13415 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
13416 information listed here.
13417 @end table
13418
13419 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
13420 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
13421 with a language explicitly:
13422
13423 @table @code
13424 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
13425 @kindex set extension-language
13426 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
13427 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
13428
13429 @item info extensions
13430 @kindex info extensions
13431 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
13432 @end table
13433
13434 @node Checks
13435 @section Type and Range Checking
13436
13437 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
13438 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
13439 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
13440 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
13441 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
13442 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
13443 errors when your program is running.
13444
13445 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
13446 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
13447 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
13448 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
13449
13450 @menu
13451 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
13452 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
13453 @end menu
13454
13455 @cindex type checking
13456 @cindex checks, type
13457 @node Type Checking
13458 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
13459
13460 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
13461 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
13462 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
13463 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
13464
13465 @smallexample
13466 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
13467
13468 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
13469 $1 = 2
13470 @exdent but
13471 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
13472 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
13473 @end smallexample
13474
13475 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
13476 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
13477
13478 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13479 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
13480 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
13481 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
13482 expressions like the second example above.
13483
13484 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
13485 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
13486 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
13487 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
13488 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
13489 little sense to evaluate anyway.
13490
13491 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
13492
13493 @kindex set check type
13494 @kindex show check type
13495 @table @code
13496 @item set check type on
13497 @itemx set check type off
13498 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
13499 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
13500 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
13501
13502 @item show check type
13503 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
13504 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
13505 @end table
13506
13507 @cindex range checking
13508 @cindex checks, range
13509 @node Range Checking
13510 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
13511
13512 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
13513 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
13514 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
13515 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
13516 not exceed the bounds of the array.
13517
13518 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13519 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
13520 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
13521 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
13522
13523 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
13524 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
13525 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
13526 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
13527 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
13528 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
13529
13530 @smallexample
13531 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
13532 @end smallexample
13533
13534 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
13535 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
13536 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
13537
13538 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
13539
13540 @kindex set check range
13541 @kindex show check range
13542 @table @code
13543 @item set check range auto
13544 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
13545 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
13546 each language.
13547
13548 @item set check range on
13549 @itemx set check range off
13550 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
13551 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
13552 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
13553 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
13554
13555 @item set check range warn
13556 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
13557 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
13558 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
13559 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
13560 systems).
13561
13562 @item show range
13563 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
13564 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
13565 @end table
13566
13567 @node Supported Languages
13568 @section Supported Languages
13569
13570 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran, Java,
13571 OpenCL C, Pascal, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
13572 @c This is false ...
13573 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
13574 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
13575 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
13576 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
13577 language.
13578
13579 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
13580 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
13581 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
13582 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
13583 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
13584 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
13585 language reference or tutorial.
13586
13587 @menu
13588 * C:: C and C@t{++}
13589 * D:: D
13590 * Go:: Go
13591 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
13592 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
13593 * Fortran:: Fortran
13594 * Pascal:: Pascal
13595 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
13596 * Ada:: Ada
13597 @end menu
13598
13599 @node C
13600 @subsection C and C@t{++}
13601
13602 @cindex C and C@t{++}
13603 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
13604
13605 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
13606 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
13607 together.
13608
13609 @cindex C@t{++}
13610 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
13611 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
13612 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
13613 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
13614 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
13615 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
13616 compiler (@code{aCC}).
13617
13618 @menu
13619 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
13620 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
13621 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
13622 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
13623 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
13624 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
13625 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
13626 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
13627 @end menu
13628
13629 @node C Operators
13630 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
13631
13632 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
13633
13634 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
13635 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
13636 often defined on groups of types.
13637
13638 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
13639
13640 @itemize @bullet
13641
13642 @item
13643 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
13644 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
13645
13646 @item
13647 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
13648 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
13649
13650 @item
13651 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
13652
13653 @item
13654 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
13655
13656 @end itemize
13657
13658 @noindent
13659 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
13660 in order of increasing precedence:
13661
13662 @table @code
13663 @item ,
13664 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
13665 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
13666 expression being the last expression evaluated.
13667
13668 @item =
13669 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
13670 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
13671
13672 @item @var{op}=
13673 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
13674 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
13675 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
13676 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
13677 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
13678
13679 @item ?:
13680 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
13681 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
13682 integral type.
13683
13684 @item ||
13685 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13686
13687 @item &&
13688 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
13689
13690 @item |
13691 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13692
13693 @item ^
13694 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13695
13696 @item &
13697 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
13698
13699 @item ==@r{, }!=
13700 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
13701 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
13702
13703 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
13704 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
13705 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
13706 and non-zero for true.
13707
13708 @item <<@r{, }>>
13709 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
13710
13711 @item @@
13712 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
13713
13714 @item +@r{, }-
13715 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
13716 pointer types.
13717
13718 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
13719 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
13720 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
13721 integral types.
13722
13723 @item ++@r{, }--
13724 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
13725 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
13726 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
13727 operation takes place.
13728
13729 @item *
13730 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
13731 @code{++}.
13732
13733 @item &
13734 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
13735
13736 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
13737 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
13738 to examine the address
13739 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
13740 stored.
13741
13742 @item -
13743 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
13744 precedence as @code{++}.
13745
13746 @item !
13747 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
13748 @code{++}.
13749
13750 @item ~
13751 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
13752 @code{++}.
13753
13754
13755 @item .@r{, }->
13756 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
13757 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
13758 pointer based on the stored type information.
13759 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
13760
13761 @item .*@r{, }->*
13762 Dereferences of pointers to members.
13763
13764 @item []
13765 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
13766 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
13767
13768 @item ()
13769 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
13770
13771 @item ::
13772 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
13773 and @code{class} types.
13774
13775 @item ::
13776 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
13777 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
13778 above.
13779 @end table
13780
13781 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
13782 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
13783 predefined meaning.
13784
13785 @node C Constants
13786 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
13787
13788 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
13789
13790 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
13791 following ways:
13792
13793 @itemize @bullet
13794 @item
13795 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
13796 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
13797 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
13798 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
13799 @code{long} value.
13800
13801 @item
13802 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
13803 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
13804 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
13805 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
13806 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
13807 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
13808 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
13809 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
13810 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
13811 constant.
13812
13813 @item
13814 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
13815 integral equivalents.
13816
13817 @item
13818 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
13819 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
13820 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
13821 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
13822 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
13823 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
13824 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
13825 @samp{\n} for newline.
13826
13827 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
13828 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
13829 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
13830 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
13831
13832 @item
13833 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
13834 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
13835 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
13836 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
13837 characters.
13838
13839 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
13840 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
13841 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
13842
13843 @item
13844 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
13845 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
13846
13847 @item
13848 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
13849 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
13850 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
13851 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
13852 @end itemize
13853
13854 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
13855 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
13856
13857 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
13858 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
13859
13860 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
13861 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
13862 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
13863 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
13864 @quotation
13865 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
13866 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
13867 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
13868 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
13869 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
13870 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
13871 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
13872 code. @xref{Compilation}.
13873 @end quotation
13874
13875 @enumerate
13876
13877 @cindex member functions
13878 @item
13879 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
13880
13881 @smallexample
13882 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
13883 @end smallexample
13884
13885 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
13886 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
13887 @item
13888 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
13889 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
13890 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
13891 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
13892 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
13893
13894 @cindex call overloaded functions
13895 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
13896 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
13897 @item
13898 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
13899 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
13900 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
13901 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
13902 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
13903 default arguments.
13904
13905 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
13906 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
13907 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
13908 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
13909 number of function arguments.
13910
13911 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
13912 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
13913 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
13914
13915 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
13916 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
13917 @smallexample
13918 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
13919 @end smallexample
13920
13921 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
13922 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
13923
13924 @cindex reference declarations
13925 @item
13926 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
13927 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
13928 dereferenced.
13929
13930 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
13931 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
13932 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
13933 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
13934 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
13935
13936 @item
13937 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
13938 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
13939 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
13940 necessary, for example in an expression like
13941 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
13942 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
13943 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
13944
13945 @item
13946 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
13947 specification.
13948 @end enumerate
13949
13950 @node C Defaults
13951 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
13952
13953 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
13954
13955 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
13956 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
13957 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
13958 selects the working language.
13959
13960 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
13961 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
13962 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
13963 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
13964 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
13965 for further details.
13966
13967 @node C Checks
13968 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
13969
13970 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
13971
13972 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
13973 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
13974 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
13975 constants to pointers.
13976
13977 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
13978 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
13979 that is not itself an array.
13980
13981 @node Debugging C
13982 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
13983
13984 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
13985 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
13986 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
13987 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
13988
13989 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
13990 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
13991 ,Expressions}.
13992
13993 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
13994 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
13995
13996 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
13997
13998 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
13999 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14000
14001 @table @code
14002 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14003 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14004 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14005 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14006 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14007 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14008
14009 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14010 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14011 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14012 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14013 classes.
14014 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14015
14016 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14017 @item catch throw
14018 @itemx catch rethrow
14019 @itemx catch catch
14020 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14021 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14022
14023 @cindex inheritance
14024 @item ptype @var{typename}
14025 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14026 @var{typename}.
14027 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14028
14029 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14030 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14031 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
14032 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14033 multiple inheritance is in use.
14034
14035 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14036 @item set print demangle
14037 @itemx show print demangle
14038 @itemx set print asm-demangle
14039 @itemx show print asm-demangle
14040 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14041 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14042 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14043
14044 @item set print object
14045 @itemx show print object
14046 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14047 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14048
14049 @item set print vtbl
14050 @itemx show print vtbl
14051 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14052 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14053 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14054 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14055
14056 @kindex set overload-resolution
14057 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14058 @item set overload-resolution on
14059 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
14060 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14061 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14062 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14063 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
14064 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
14065
14066 @item set overload-resolution off
14067 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
14068 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14069 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
14070 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
14071 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14072 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
14073 argument types.
14074
14075 @kindex show overload-resolution
14076 @item show overload-resolution
14077 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
14078
14079 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
14080 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
14081 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
14082 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
14083 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
14084 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
14085 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
14086 @end table
14087
14088 @node Decimal Floating Point
14089 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
14090 @cindex decimal floating point format
14091
14092 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
14093 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
14094 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
14095 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
14096
14097 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
14098 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
14099 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
14100 configured target.
14101
14102 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
14103 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
14104 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
14105
14106 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
14107 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
14108 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
14109
14110 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
14111 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
14112 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
14113
14114 @node D
14115 @subsection D
14116
14117 @cindex D
14118 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
14119 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
14120 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
14121
14122 @node Go
14123 @subsection Go
14124
14125 @cindex Go (programming language)
14126 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
14127 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
14128
14129 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
14130
14131 @table @code
14132 @cindex current Go package
14133 @item The current Go package
14134 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
14135 specifying global variables and functions.
14136
14137 For example, given the program:
14138
14139 @example
14140 package main
14141 var myglob = "Shall we?"
14142 func main () @{
14143 // ...
14144 @}
14145 @end example
14146
14147 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
14148
14149 @example
14150 (gdb) p myglob
14151 (gdb) p main.myglob
14152 @end example
14153
14154 @cindex builtin Go types
14155 @item Builtin Go types
14156 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
14157 as a string.
14158
14159 @cindex builtin Go functions
14160 @item Builtin Go functions
14161 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
14162 function and handles it internally.
14163
14164 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
14165 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
14166 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
14167 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
14168 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
14169 @end table
14170
14171 @node Objective-C
14172 @subsection Objective-C
14173
14174 @cindex Objective-C
14175 This section provides information about some commands and command
14176 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
14177 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
14178 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
14179
14180 @menu
14181 * Method Names in Commands::
14182 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
14183 @end menu
14184
14185 @node Method Names in Commands
14186 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
14187
14188 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
14189 names as line specifications:
14190
14191 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
14192 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
14193 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
14194 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
14195 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
14196 @itemize
14197 @item @code{clear}
14198 @item @code{break}
14199 @item @code{info line}
14200 @item @code{jump}
14201 @item @code{list}
14202 @end itemize
14203
14204 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
14205
14206 @smallexample
14207 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
14208 @end smallexample
14209
14210 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
14211 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
14212 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
14213 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
14214 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
14215 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
14216 debugged, enter:
14217
14218 @smallexample
14219 break -[Fruit create]
14220 @end smallexample
14221
14222 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
14223 enter:
14224
14225 @smallexample
14226 list +[NSText initialize]
14227 @end smallexample
14228
14229 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
14230 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
14231 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
14232 is also possible to specify just a method name:
14233
14234 @smallexample
14235 break create
14236 @end smallexample
14237
14238 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
14239 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
14240 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
14241 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
14242 none apply.
14243
14244 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
14245 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
14246
14247 @smallexample
14248 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
14249 @end smallexample
14250
14251 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
14252 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
14253 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
14254 @kindex print-object
14255 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
14256
14257 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
14258
14259 @smallexample
14260 print -[@var{object} hash]
14261 @end smallexample
14262
14263 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
14264 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
14265 @noindent
14266 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
14267 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
14268 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
14269 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
14270 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
14271 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
14272
14273 @node OpenCL C
14274 @subsection OpenCL C
14275
14276 @cindex OpenCL C
14277 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
14278
14279 @menu
14280 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
14281 * OpenCL C Expressions::
14282 * OpenCL C Operators::
14283 @end menu
14284
14285 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
14286 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
14287
14288 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
14289 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
14290 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
14291 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
14292 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
14293
14294 @node OpenCL C Expressions
14295 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
14296
14297 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
14298 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
14299 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
14300 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
14301
14302 @node OpenCL C Operators
14303 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
14304
14305 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
14306 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
14307 vector data types.
14308
14309 @node Fortran
14310 @subsection Fortran
14311 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
14312
14313 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
14314 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
14315
14316 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
14317 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
14318 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
14319 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
14320 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
14321 underscore.
14322
14323 @menu
14324 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
14325 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
14326 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
14327 @end menu
14328
14329 @node Fortran Operators
14330 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
14331
14332 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
14333
14334 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14335 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
14336 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
14337
14338 @table @code
14339 @item **
14340 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
14341 of the second one.
14342
14343 @item :
14344 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
14345 represent a section of array.
14346
14347 @item %
14348 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
14349 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
14350 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
14351 union type.
14352 @end table
14353
14354 @node Fortran Defaults
14355 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
14356
14357 @cindex Fortran Defaults
14358
14359 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
14360 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
14361 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
14362 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
14363
14364 @node Special Fortran Commands
14365 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
14366
14367 @cindex Special Fortran commands
14368
14369 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
14370 such as displaying common blocks.
14371
14372 @table @code
14373 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
14374 @kindex info common
14375 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
14376 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
14377 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
14378 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
14379 printed.
14380 @end table
14381
14382 @node Pascal
14383 @subsection Pascal
14384
14385 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
14386 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
14387 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
14388 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
14389 syntax.
14390
14391 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
14392 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
14393 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
14394
14395 @node Modula-2
14396 @subsection Modula-2
14397
14398 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
14399
14400 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
14401 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
14402 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
14403 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
14404 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
14405 table.
14406
14407 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
14408 @menu
14409 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
14410 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
14411 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
14412 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
14413 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
14414 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
14415 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
14416 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
14417 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
14418 @end menu
14419
14420 @node M2 Operators
14421 @subsubsection Operators
14422 @cindex Modula-2 operators
14423
14424 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14425 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14426 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
14427 following definitions hold:
14428
14429 @itemize @bullet
14430
14431 @item
14432 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
14433 their subranges.
14434
14435 @item
14436 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
14437
14438 @item
14439 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
14440
14441 @item
14442 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
14443 @var{type}}.
14444
14445 @item
14446 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
14447
14448 @item
14449 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
14450
14451 @item
14452 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
14453 @end itemize
14454
14455 @noindent
14456 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
14457 increasing precedence:
14458
14459 @table @code
14460 @item ,
14461 Function argument or array index separator.
14462
14463 @item :=
14464 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
14465 @var{value}.
14466
14467 @item <@r{, }>
14468 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
14469 types.
14470
14471 @item <=@r{, }>=
14472 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
14473 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
14474 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
14475
14476 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
14477 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
14478 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
14479 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
14480 comment character.
14481
14482 @item IN
14483 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
14484 Same precedence as @code{<}.
14485
14486 @item OR
14487 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14488
14489 @item AND@r{, }&
14490 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14491
14492 @item @@
14493 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14494
14495 @item +@r{, }-
14496 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
14497 and difference on set types.
14498
14499 @item *
14500 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
14501 on set types.
14502
14503 @item /
14504 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
14505 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
14506
14507 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
14508 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
14509 precedence as @code{*}.
14510
14511 @item -
14512 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
14513
14514 @item ^
14515 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
14516
14517 @item NOT
14518 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
14519 @code{^}.
14520
14521 @item .
14522 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
14523 precedence as @code{^}.
14524
14525 @item []
14526 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
14527
14528 @item ()
14529 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
14530 as @code{^}.
14531
14532 @item ::@r{, }.
14533 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
14534 @end table
14535
14536 @quotation
14537 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
14538 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
14539 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
14540 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
14541 @end quotation
14542
14543
14544 @node Built-In Func/Proc
14545 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
14546 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
14547
14548 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
14549 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
14550
14551 @table @var
14552
14553 @item a
14554 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
14555
14556 @item c
14557 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
14558
14559 @item i
14560 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
14561
14562 @item m
14563 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
14564 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
14565 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
14566
14567 @item n
14568 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
14569
14570 @item r
14571 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
14572
14573 @item t
14574 represents a type.
14575
14576 @item v
14577 represents a variable.
14578
14579 @item x
14580 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
14581 explanation of the function for details.
14582 @end table
14583
14584 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
14585
14586 @table @code
14587 @item ABS(@var{n})
14588 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
14589
14590 @item CAP(@var{c})
14591 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
14592 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
14593
14594 @item CHR(@var{i})
14595 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
14596
14597 @item DEC(@var{v})
14598 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
14599
14600 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
14601 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
14602 new value.
14603
14604 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
14605 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
14606 set.
14607
14608 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
14609 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
14610
14611 @item HIGH(@var{a})
14612 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
14613
14614 @item INC(@var{v})
14615 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
14616
14617 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
14618 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
14619 new value.
14620
14621 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
14622 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
14623 there. Returns the new set.
14624
14625 @item MAX(@var{t})
14626 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
14627
14628 @item MIN(@var{t})
14629 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
14630
14631 @item ODD(@var{i})
14632 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
14633
14634 @item ORD(@var{x})
14635 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
14636 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
14637 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
14638 integral, character and enumerated types.
14639
14640 @item SIZE(@var{x})
14641 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
14642
14643 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
14644 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
14645
14646 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
14647 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
14648
14649 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
14650 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
14651 @end table
14652
14653 @quotation
14654 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
14655 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
14656 an error.
14657 @end quotation
14658
14659 @cindex Modula-2 constants
14660 @node M2 Constants
14661 @subsubsection Constants
14662
14663 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
14664 ways:
14665
14666 @itemize @bullet
14667
14668 @item
14669 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
14670 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
14671 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
14672 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
14673
14674 @item
14675 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
14676 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
14677 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
14678 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
14679 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
14680 digits.
14681
14682 @item
14683 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
14684 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
14685 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
14686 followed by a @samp{C}.
14687
14688 @item
14689 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
14690 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
14691 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
14692 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
14693 sequences.
14694
14695 @item
14696 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
14697
14698 @item
14699 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
14700 @code{FALSE}.
14701
14702 @item
14703 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
14704
14705 @item
14706 Set constants are not yet supported.
14707 @end itemize
14708
14709 @node M2 Types
14710 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
14711 @cindex Modula-2 types
14712
14713 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
14714 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
14715 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
14716 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
14717 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
14718 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
14719
14720 The first example contains the following section of code:
14721
14722 @smallexample
14723 VAR
14724 s: SET OF CHAR ;
14725 r: [20..40] ;
14726 @end smallexample
14727
14728 @noindent
14729 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
14730 @code{r} and @code{s}.
14731
14732 @smallexample
14733 (@value{GDBP}) print s
14734 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
14735 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14736 SET OF CHAR
14737 (@value{GDBP}) print r
14738 21
14739 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
14740 [20..40]
14741 @end smallexample
14742
14743 @noindent
14744 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
14745
14746 @smallexample
14747 VAR
14748 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
14749 @end smallexample
14750
14751 @noindent
14752 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
14753
14754 @smallexample
14755 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14756 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
14757 @end smallexample
14758
14759 @noindent
14760 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
14761 expressions using the debugger.
14762
14763 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
14764 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
14765
14766 @smallexample
14767 VAR
14768 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
14769 @end smallexample
14770
14771 @smallexample
14772 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14773 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
14774 @end smallexample
14775
14776 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
14777 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
14778 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
14779 above.
14780
14781 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
14782
14783 @smallexample
14784 TYPE
14785 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
14786 t = [blue..yellow] ;
14787 VAR
14788 s: t ;
14789 BEGIN
14790 s := blue ;
14791 @end smallexample
14792
14793 @noindent
14794 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
14795 and value of a variable.
14796
14797 @smallexample
14798 (@value{GDBP}) print s
14799 $1 = blue
14800 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
14801 type = [blue..yellow]
14802 @end smallexample
14803
14804 @noindent
14805 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
14806 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
14807 their @code{C} counterparts.
14808
14809 @smallexample
14810 VAR
14811 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
14812 BEGIN
14813 s[1] := 1 ;
14814 @end smallexample
14815
14816 @smallexample
14817 (@value{GDBP}) print s
14818 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
14819 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14820 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
14821 @end smallexample
14822
14823 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
14824 pointer types as shown in this example:
14825
14826 @smallexample
14827 VAR
14828 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
14829 BEGIN
14830 NEW(s) ;
14831 s^[1] := 1 ;
14832 @end smallexample
14833
14834 @noindent
14835 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
14836
14837 @smallexample
14838 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14839 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
14840 @end smallexample
14841
14842 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
14843 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
14844 types:
14845
14846 @smallexample
14847 TYPE
14848 foo = RECORD
14849 f1: CARDINAL ;
14850 f2: CHAR ;
14851 f3: myarray ;
14852 END ;
14853
14854 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
14855 myrange = [-2..2] ;
14856 VAR
14857 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
14858 @end smallexample
14859
14860 @noindent
14861 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
14862 below.
14863
14864 @smallexample
14865 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14866 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
14867 f1 : CARDINAL;
14868 f2 : CHAR;
14869 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
14870 END
14871 @end smallexample
14872
14873 @node M2 Defaults
14874 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
14875 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
14876
14877 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
14878 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
14879 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14880 selected the working language.
14881
14882 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
14883 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
14884 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
14885 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
14886
14887 @node Deviations
14888 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
14889 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
14890
14891 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
14892 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
14893
14894 @itemize @bullet
14895 @item
14896 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
14897 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
14898 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
14899 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
14900 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
14901 returned a pointer.)
14902
14903 @item
14904 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
14905 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
14906 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
14907 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
14908
14909 @item
14910 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
14911 argument.
14912
14913 @item
14914 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
14915 @end itemize
14916
14917 @node M2 Checks
14918 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
14919 @cindex Modula-2 checks
14920
14921 @quotation
14922 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
14923 range checking.
14924 @end quotation
14925 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
14926
14927 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
14928
14929 @itemize @bullet
14930 @item
14931 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
14932 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
14933
14934 @item
14935 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
14936 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
14937 @end itemize
14938
14939 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
14940 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
14941
14942 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
14943 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
14944
14945 @node M2 Scope
14946 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
14947 @cindex scope
14948 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
14949 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
14950 @ifinfo
14951 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
14952 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
14953 @end ifinfo
14954 @ifnotinfo
14955 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
14956 @end ifnotinfo
14957
14958 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
14959 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
14960 similar syntax:
14961
14962 @smallexample
14963
14964 @var{module} . @var{id}
14965 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
14966 @end smallexample
14967
14968 @noindent
14969 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
14970 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
14971 identifier within your program, except another module.
14972
14973 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
14974 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
14975 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
14976 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
14977
14978 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
14979 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
14980 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
14981 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
14982 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
14983 @var{module}.
14984
14985 @node GDB/M2
14986 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
14987
14988 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
14989 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
14990 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
14991 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
14992 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
14993 analogue in Modula-2.
14994
14995 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
14996 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
14997 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
14998 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
14999 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
15000 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
15001
15002 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
15003 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
15004 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
15005
15006 @node Ada
15007 @subsection Ada
15008 @cindex Ada
15009
15010 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
15011 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
15012 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
15013 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15014 to be difficult.
15015
15016
15017 @cindex expressions in Ada
15018 @menu
15019 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
15020 and semantics supported by Ada mode
15021 in @value{GDBN}.
15022 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
15023 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
15024 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
15025 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
15026 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
15027 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15028 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
15029 Profile
15030 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
15031 @end menu
15032
15033 @node Ada Mode Intro
15034 @subsubsection Introduction
15035 @cindex Ada mode, general
15036
15037 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
15038 syntax, with some extensions.
15039 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
15040
15041 @itemize @bullet
15042 @item
15043 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
15044 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
15045 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
15046 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
15047
15048 @item
15049 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
15050 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15051
15052 @item
15053 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15054 @end itemize
15055
15056 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
15057 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
15058 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
15059 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
15060 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
15061
15062 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
15063 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
15064 was translated from an Ada source file.
15065
15066 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
15067 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
15068 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
15069 middle (to allow based literals).
15070
15071 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
15072 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
15073 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
15074 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
15075 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
15076 functions to procedures elsewhere.
15077
15078 @node Omissions from Ada
15079 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
15080 @cindex Ada, omissions from
15081
15082 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
15083
15084 @itemize @bullet
15085 @item
15086 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
15087
15088 @itemize @minus
15089 @item
15090 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
15091 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
15092
15093 @item
15094 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
15095
15096 @item
15097 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
15098
15099 @item
15100 @t{'Tag}.
15101
15102 @item
15103 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
15104 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
15105
15106 @item
15107 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
15108 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
15109
15110 @item
15111 @t{'Address}.
15112 @end itemize
15113
15114 @item
15115 The names in
15116 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
15117 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
15118 not currently available.
15119
15120 @item
15121 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
15122 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
15123 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
15124 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
15125 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
15126 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
15127 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
15128 indeterminate values.
15129
15130 @item
15131 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
15132 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
15133 are not implemented.
15134
15135 @item
15136 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
15137 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
15138 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
15139 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
15140 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
15141
15142 @smallexample
15143 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
15144 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
15145 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
15146 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
15147 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
15148 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
15149 @end smallexample
15150
15151 Changing a
15152 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
15153 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
15154 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
15155 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
15156 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
15157 declared to have a type such as:
15158
15159 @smallexample
15160 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
15161 Id : Integer;
15162 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
15163 end record;
15164 @end smallexample
15165
15166 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
15167 assignments:
15168
15169 @smallexample
15170 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
15171 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
15172 @end smallexample
15173
15174 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
15175 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
15176 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
15177 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
15178 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
15179 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
15180 redundant component associations, although which component values are
15181 assigned in such cases is not defined.
15182
15183 @item
15184 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
15185
15186 @item
15187 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
15188 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
15189 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
15190 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
15191 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
15192 the proper resolution.
15193
15194 @item
15195 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
15196
15197 @item
15198 Entry calls are not implemented.
15199
15200 @item
15201 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
15202 formats are not supported.
15203
15204 @item
15205 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
15206
15207 @item
15208 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
15209 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
15210 context.
15211 Should your program
15212 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
15213 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
15214 @end itemize
15215
15216 @node Additions to Ada
15217 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
15218 @cindex Ada, deviations from
15219
15220 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
15221 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
15222
15223 @itemize @bullet
15224 @item
15225 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
15226 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
15227 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
15228 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
15229 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
15230 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
15231 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
15232 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
15233
15234 @item
15235 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
15236 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
15237 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
15238
15239 @item
15240 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
15241 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
15242
15243 @item
15244 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
15245 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
15246 @end itemize
15247
15248 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
15249 additions specific to Ada:
15250
15251 @itemize @bullet
15252 @item
15253 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
15254 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
15255
15256 @smallexample
15257 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
15258 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
15259 @end smallexample
15260
15261 @item
15262 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
15263 the value of its right-hand operand.
15264 This allows, for example,
15265 complex conditional breaks:
15266
15267 @smallexample
15268 (@value{GDBP}) break f
15269 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
15270 @end smallexample
15271
15272 @item
15273 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
15274 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
15275 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
15276 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
15277 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
15278 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
15279 in strings. For example,
15280 @smallexample
15281 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
15282 @end smallexample
15283 @noindent
15284 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
15285 after each period.
15286
15287 @item
15288 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
15289 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
15290 to write
15291
15292 @smallexample
15293 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
15294 @end smallexample
15295
15296 @item
15297 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
15298 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
15299 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
15300 of 3 might print as
15301
15302 @smallexample
15303 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
15304 @end smallexample
15305
15306 @noindent
15307 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
15308 clause.
15309
15310 @item
15311 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
15312 multi-character subsequence of
15313 their names (an exact match gets preference).
15314 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
15315 in place of @t{a'length}.
15316
15317 @item
15318 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
15319 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
15320 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
15321 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
15322 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
15323 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
15324 For example,
15325 @smallexample
15326 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
15327 @end smallexample
15328
15329 @item
15330 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
15331 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
15332 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
15333 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
15334 object.
15335
15336 @end itemize
15337
15338 @node Stopping Before Main Program
15339 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
15340
15341 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
15342 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
15343 before reaching the main procedure.
15344 As defined in the Ada Reference
15345 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
15346 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
15347 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
15348 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
15349
15350 @node Ada Exceptions
15351 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
15352
15353 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
15354
15355 @table @code
15356 @kindex info exceptions
15357 @item info exceptions
15358 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
15359 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
15360 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
15361 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
15362 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
15363 @end table
15364
15365 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
15366 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
15367 argument.
15368
15369 @smallexample
15370 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
15371 All defined Ada exceptions:
15372 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15373 program_error: 0x613d20
15374 storage_error: 0x613ce0
15375 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
15376 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15377 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
15378 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
15379 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15380 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15381 @end smallexample
15382
15383 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
15384 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
15385
15386 @node Ada Tasks
15387 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
15388 @cindex Ada, tasking
15389
15390 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
15391 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
15392
15393 @table @code
15394 @kindex info tasks
15395 @item info tasks
15396 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
15397
15398
15399 @smallexample
15400 @iftex
15401 @leftskip=0.5cm
15402 @end iftex
15403 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15404 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15405 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15406 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
15407 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
15408 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
15409
15410 @end smallexample
15411
15412 @noindent
15413 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
15414 task currently being inspected.
15415
15416 @table @asis
15417 @item ID
15418 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
15419
15420 @item TID
15421 The Ada task ID.
15422
15423 @item P-ID
15424 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
15425
15426 @item Pri
15427 The base priority of the task.
15428
15429 @item State
15430 Current state of the task.
15431
15432 @table @code
15433 @item Unactivated
15434 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
15435 executing.
15436
15437 @item Runnable
15438 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
15439 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
15440
15441 @item Terminated
15442 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
15443 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
15444 terminated themselves.
15445
15446 @item Child Activation Wait
15447 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
15448
15449 @item Accept Statement
15450 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
15451
15452 @item Waiting on entry call
15453 The task is waiting on an entry call.
15454
15455 @item Async Select Wait
15456 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
15457 select statement.
15458
15459 @item Delay Sleep
15460 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
15461 alternative open.
15462
15463 @item Child Termination Wait
15464 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
15465 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
15466 waiting on a terminate Phase.
15467
15468 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
15469 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
15470 finish terminating.
15471
15472 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
15473 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
15474 @end table
15475
15476 @item Name
15477 Name of the task in the program.
15478
15479 @end table
15480
15481 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
15482 @item info task @var{taskno}
15483 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
15484 the following example:
15485 @smallexample
15486 @iftex
15487 @leftskip=0.5cm
15488 @end iftex
15489 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15490 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15491 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15492 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
15493 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
15494 Ada Task: 0x807c468
15495 Name: task_1
15496 Thread: 0x807f378
15497 Parent: 1 (main_task)
15498 Base Priority: 15
15499 State: Runnable
15500 @end smallexample
15501
15502 @item task
15503 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
15504 @cindex current Ada task ID
15505 This command prints the ID of the current task.
15506
15507 @smallexample
15508 @iftex
15509 @leftskip=0.5cm
15510 @end iftex
15511 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15512 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15513 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15514 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15515 (@value{GDBP}) task
15516 [Current task is 2]
15517 @end smallexample
15518
15519 @item task @var{taskno}
15520 @cindex Ada task switching
15521 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
15522 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
15523 from the current task to the given task.
15524
15525 @smallexample
15526 @iftex
15527 @leftskip=0.5cm
15528 @end iftex
15529 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15530 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15531 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15532 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15533 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
15534 [Switching to task 1]
15535 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15536 (@value{GDBP}) bt
15537 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15538 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
15539 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
15540 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
15541 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
15542 @end smallexample
15543
15544 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
15545 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
15546 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
15547 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
15548 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
15549 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
15550 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}).
15551 @var{linespec} specifies source lines, as described
15552 in @ref{Specify Location}.
15553
15554 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
15555 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
15556 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. @var{taskno} is one of the
15557 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
15558 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
15559
15560 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
15561 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
15562 program.
15563
15564 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
15565 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
15566 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
15567
15568 For example,
15569
15570 @smallexample
15571 @iftex
15572 @leftskip=0.5cm
15573 @end iftex
15574 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15575 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15576 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15577 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
15578 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
15579 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
15580 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
15581 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
15582 (@value{GDBP}) cont
15583 Continuing.
15584 task # 1 running
15585 task # 2 running
15586
15587 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
15588 15 flush;
15589 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15590 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15591 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15592 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
15593 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
15594 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
15595 @end smallexample
15596 @end table
15597
15598 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
15599 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15600 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
15601
15602 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
15603 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
15604 the platform being used.
15605 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
15606 switching is not supported. On Tru64, however, task switching will work
15607 as usual.
15608
15609 On certain platforms, including Tru64, the debugger needs to perform some
15610 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
15611 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
15612 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
15613 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
15614 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
15615
15616 @node Ravenscar Profile
15617 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
15618 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
15619
15620 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
15621 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
15622 requirements.
15623
15624 @table @code
15625 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
15626 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
15627 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
15628 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
15629 Profile. This is the default.
15630
15631 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
15632 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
15633 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
15634 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
15635 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
15636 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
15637 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
15638
15639 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
15640 @item show ravenscar task-switching
15641 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
15642 using the Ravenscar Profile.
15643
15644 @end table
15645
15646 @node Ada Glitches
15647 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
15648 @cindex Ada, problems
15649
15650 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
15651 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
15652 @value{GDBN},
15653 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
15654 and the GNU Ada compiler.
15655
15656 @itemize @bullet
15657 @item
15658 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
15659 storage are invisible to the debugger.
15660
15661 @item
15662 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
15663 argument lists are treated as positional).
15664
15665 @item
15666 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
15667
15668 @item
15669 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
15670 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
15671 the host machine.
15672
15673 @item
15674 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
15675 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
15676 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
15677 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
15678 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
15679 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
15680 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
15681 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
15682 you can usually resolve the confusion
15683 by qualifying the problematic names with package
15684 @code{Standard} explicitly.
15685 @end itemize
15686
15687 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
15688 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
15689 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
15690 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
15691 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
15692 enabled.
15693
15694 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
15695 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
15696 @table @code
15697
15698 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
15699 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
15700 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
15701 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
15702 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
15703 This is the default.
15704
15705 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
15706 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
15707 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
15708 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
15709 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
15710 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
15711 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
15712
15713 @end table
15714
15715 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
15716 @cindex GNAT encoding
15717 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
15718 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
15719 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
15720 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
15721 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
15722 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
15723
15724 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
15725 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
15726 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
15727 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
15728 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
15729 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
15730 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
15731 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
15732
15733 @table @code
15734
15735 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
15736 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
15737 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
15738 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
15739
15740 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
15741 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
15742 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
15743
15744 @end table
15745
15746 @node Unsupported Languages
15747 @section Unsupported Languages
15748
15749 @cindex unsupported languages
15750 @cindex minimal language
15751 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
15752 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
15753 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
15754 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
15755 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
15756 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
15757
15758 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
15759 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
15760 language.
15761
15762 @node Symbols
15763 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
15764
15765 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
15766 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
15767 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
15768 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
15769 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
15770 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
15771 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
15772
15773 @cindex symbol names
15774 @cindex names of symbols
15775 @cindex quoting names
15776 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
15777 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
15778 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
15779 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
15780 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
15781 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
15782 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
15783 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
15784
15785 @smallexample
15786 p 'foo.c'::x
15787 @end smallexample
15788
15789 @noindent
15790 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
15791
15792 @table @code
15793 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
15794 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
15795 @kindex set case-sensitive
15796 @item set case-sensitive on
15797 @itemx set case-sensitive off
15798 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
15799 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
15800 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
15801 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
15802 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
15803 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
15804 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
15805 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
15806 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
15807 case-insensitive matches.
15808
15809 @kindex show case-sensitive
15810 @item show case-sensitive
15811 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
15812 lookups.
15813
15814 @kindex set print type methods
15815 @item set print type methods
15816 @itemx set print type methods on
15817 @itemx set print type methods off
15818 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
15819 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
15820 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
15821 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
15822 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
15823 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
15824
15825 @kindex show print type methods
15826 @item show print type methods
15827 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
15828 classes.
15829
15830 @kindex set print type typedefs
15831 @item set print type typedefs
15832 @itemx set print type typedefs on
15833 @itemx set print type typedefs off
15834
15835 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
15836 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
15837 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
15838 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
15839 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
15840 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
15841 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
15842 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
15843 types.
15844
15845 @kindex show print type typedefs
15846 @item show print type typedefs
15847 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
15848 printing classes.
15849
15850 @kindex info address
15851 @cindex address of a symbol
15852 @item info address @var{symbol}
15853 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
15854 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
15855 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
15856 is always stored.
15857
15858 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
15859 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
15860 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
15861
15862 @kindex info symbol
15863 @cindex symbol from address
15864 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
15865 @item info symbol @var{addr}
15866 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
15867 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
15868 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
15869
15870 @smallexample
15871 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
15872 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
15873 @end smallexample
15874
15875 @noindent
15876 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
15877 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
15878
15879 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
15880 library containing the symbol is also printed:
15881
15882 @smallexample
15883 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
15884 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
15885 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
15886 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
15887 @end smallexample
15888
15889 @kindex whatis
15890 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
15891 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
15892 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
15893 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
15894
15895 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
15896 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
15897 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
15898
15899 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
15900 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
15901 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
15902 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
15903 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
15904 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
15905 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
15906 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
15907 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
15908
15909 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
15910 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
15911 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
15912 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
15913 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
15914 unroll it.
15915
15916 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
15917 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
15918 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
15919
15920 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
15921 Available flags are:
15922
15923 @table @code
15924 @item r
15925 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
15926 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
15927 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
15928
15929 @item m
15930 Do not print methods defined in the class.
15931
15932 @item M
15933 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
15934 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
15935
15936 @item t
15937 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
15938 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
15939 names are substituted when printing other types.
15940
15941 @item T
15942 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
15943 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
15944 @end table
15945
15946 @kindex ptype
15947 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
15948 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
15949 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
15950 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
15951
15952 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
15953 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
15954 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
15955 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
15956 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
15957 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
15958 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
15959 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
15960
15961 For example, for this variable declaration:
15962
15963 @smallexample
15964 typedef double real_t;
15965 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
15966 typedef struct complex complex_t;
15967 complex_t var;
15968 real_t *real_pointer_var;
15969 @end smallexample
15970
15971 @noindent
15972 the two commands give this output:
15973
15974 @smallexample
15975 @group
15976 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
15977 type = complex_t
15978 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
15979 type = struct complex @{
15980 real_t real;
15981 double imag;
15982 @}
15983 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
15984 type = struct complex
15985 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
15986 type = struct complex
15987 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
15988 type = struct complex @{
15989 real_t real;
15990 double imag;
15991 @}
15992 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
15993 type = real_t *
15994 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
15995 type = double *
15996 @end group
15997 @end smallexample
15998
15999 @noindent
16000 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
16001 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16002
16003 @cindex incomplete type
16004 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
16005 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
16006 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
16007 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
16008 given these declarations:
16009
16010 @smallexample
16011 struct foo;
16012 struct foo *fooptr;
16013 @end smallexample
16014
16015 @noindent
16016 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
16017
16018 @smallexample
16019 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
16020 $1 = <incomplete type>
16021 @end smallexample
16022
16023 @noindent
16024 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
16025 completely specified.
16026
16027 @kindex info types
16028 @item info types @var{regexp}
16029 @itemx info types
16030 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
16031 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
16032 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
16033 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
16034 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
16035 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
16036 name is @code{value}.
16037
16038 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
16039 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
16040 lists all source files where a type is defined.
16041
16042 @kindex info type-printers
16043 @item info type-printers
16044 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
16045 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
16046 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
16047 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
16048 type printers.
16049
16050 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
16051
16052 @kindex enable type-printer
16053 @kindex disable type-printer
16054 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16055 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16056 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
16057
16058 @kindex info scope
16059 @cindex local variables
16060 @item info scope @var{location}
16061 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
16062 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
16063 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
16064 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
16065 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
16066
16067 @smallexample
16068 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
16069 Scope for command_line_handler:
16070 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
16071 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
16072 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
16073 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
16074 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
16075 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
16076 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
16077 @end smallexample
16078
16079 @noindent
16080 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
16081 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
16082 collect}.
16083
16084 @kindex info source
16085 @item info source
16086 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
16087 the function containing the current point of execution:
16088 @itemize @bullet
16089 @item
16090 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
16091 @item
16092 the directory it was compiled in,
16093 @item
16094 its length, in lines,
16095 @item
16096 which programming language it is written in,
16097 @item
16098 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
16099 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
16100 @item
16101 whether the debugging information includes information about
16102 preprocessor macros.
16103 @end itemize
16104
16105
16106 @kindex info sources
16107 @item info sources
16108 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
16109 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
16110 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
16111
16112 @kindex info functions
16113 @item info functions
16114 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
16115
16116 @item info functions @var{regexp}
16117 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
16118 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
16119 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
16120 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
16121 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
16122 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
16123 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
16124
16125 @kindex info variables
16126 @item info variables
16127 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
16128 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
16129
16130 @item info variables @var{regexp}
16131 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
16132 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
16133 @var{regexp}.
16134
16135 @kindex info classes
16136 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
16137 @item info classes
16138 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
16139 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
16140 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16141 expression.
16142
16143 @kindex info selectors
16144 @item info selectors
16145 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
16146 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
16147 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16148 expression.
16149
16150 @ignore
16151 This was never implemented.
16152 @kindex info methods
16153 @item info methods
16154 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
16155 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
16156 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
16157 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
16158 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
16159 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
16160 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
16161 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
16162 @end ignore
16163
16164 @cindex opaque data types
16165 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
16166 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
16167 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
16168 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
16169 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
16170 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
16171 another source file. The default is on.
16172
16173 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
16174 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
16175
16176 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
16177 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
16178 is printed as follows:
16179 @smallexample
16180 @{<no data fields>@}
16181 @end smallexample
16182
16183 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
16184 @item show opaque-type-resolution
16185 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
16186
16187 @kindex set print symbol-loading
16188 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
16189 @item set print symbol-loading
16190 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
16191 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
16192 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
16193 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
16194 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
16195 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
16196 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
16197 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
16198 can be annoying.
16199 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
16200 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
16201 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
16202 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
16203
16204 @kindex show print symbol-loading
16205 @item show print symbol-loading
16206 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
16207 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
16208
16209 @kindex maint print symbols
16210 @cindex symbol dump
16211 @kindex maint print psymbols
16212 @cindex partial symbol dump
16213 @kindex maint print msymbols
16214 @cindex minimal symbol dump
16215 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
16216 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
16217 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
16218 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
16219 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
16220 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
16221 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
16222 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
16223 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
16224 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
16225 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
16226 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
16227 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
16228 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
16229 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
16230 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
16231 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
16232
16233 @kindex maint info symtabs
16234 @kindex maint info psymtabs
16235 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
16236 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16237 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16238 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16239 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16240 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16241
16242 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
16243 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
16244 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
16245 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
16246 structure in more detail. For example:
16247
16248 @smallexample
16249 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
16250 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16251 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16252 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16253 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
16254 readin no
16255 fullname (null)
16256 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
16257 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
16258 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
16259 dependencies (none)
16260 @}
16261 @}
16262 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16263 (@value{GDBP})
16264 @end smallexample
16265 @noindent
16266 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
16267 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
16268 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
16269 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
16270 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
16271
16272 @smallexample
16273 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
16274 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
16275 line 1574.
16276 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16277 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16278 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16279 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16280 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
16281 dirname (null)
16282 fullname (null)
16283 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
16284 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
16285 debugformat DWARF 2
16286 @}
16287 @}
16288 (@value{GDBP})
16289 @end smallexample
16290 @end table
16291
16292
16293 @node Altering
16294 @chapter Altering Execution
16295
16296 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
16297 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
16298 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
16299 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
16300 program.
16301
16302 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
16303 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
16304 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
16305
16306 @menu
16307 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
16308 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
16309 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
16310 * Returning:: Returning from a function
16311 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
16312 * Patching:: Patching your program
16313 @end menu
16314
16315 @node Assignment
16316 @section Assignment to Variables
16317
16318 @cindex assignment
16319 @cindex setting variables
16320 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
16321 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
16322
16323 @smallexample
16324 print x=4
16325 @end smallexample
16326
16327 @noindent
16328 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
16329 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
16330 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
16331 information on operators in supported languages.
16332
16333 @kindex set variable
16334 @cindex variables, setting
16335 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
16336 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
16337 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
16338 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
16339 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
16340
16341 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
16342 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
16343 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
16344 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
16345 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
16346 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
16347 command @code{set width}:
16348
16349 @smallexample
16350 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
16351 type = double
16352 (@value{GDBP}) p width
16353 $4 = 13
16354 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
16355 Invalid syntax in expression.
16356 @end smallexample
16357
16358 @noindent
16359 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
16360 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
16361
16362 @smallexample
16363 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
16364 @end smallexample
16365
16366 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
16367 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
16368 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
16369 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
16370 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
16371 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
16372
16373 @smallexample
16374 @group
16375 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
16376 type = double
16377 (@value{GDBP}) p g
16378 $1 = 1
16379 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
16380 (@value{GDBP}) p g
16381 $2 = 1
16382 (@value{GDBP}) r
16383 The program being debugged has been started already.
16384 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
16385 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
16386 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
16387 Invalid bfd target.
16388 (@value{GDBP}) show g
16389 The current BFD target is "=4".
16390 @end group
16391 @end smallexample
16392
16393 @noindent
16394 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
16395 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
16396 @code{g}, use
16397
16398 @smallexample
16399 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
16400 @end smallexample
16401
16402 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
16403 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
16404 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
16405 same length or shorter.
16406 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
16407 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
16408
16409 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
16410 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
16411 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
16412 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
16413 and representation in memory), and
16414
16415 @smallexample
16416 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
16417 @end smallexample
16418
16419 @noindent
16420 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
16421
16422 @node Jumping
16423 @section Continuing at a Different Address
16424
16425 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
16426 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
16427 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
16428
16429 @table @code
16430 @kindex jump
16431 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
16432 @item jump @var{linespec}
16433 @itemx j @var{linespec}
16434 @itemx jump @var{location}
16435 @itemx j @var{location}
16436 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
16437 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
16438 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
16439 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
16440 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
16441 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
16442
16443 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
16444 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
16445 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
16446 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
16447 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
16448 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
16449 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
16450 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
16451 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
16452 @end table
16453
16454 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
16455 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
16456 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
16457 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
16458 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
16459 example,
16460
16461 @smallexample
16462 set $pc = 0x485
16463 @end smallexample
16464
16465 @noindent
16466 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
16467 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
16468 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
16469
16470 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
16471 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
16472 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
16473 detail.
16474
16475 @c @group
16476 @node Signaling
16477 @section Giving your Program a Signal
16478 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
16479
16480 @table @code
16481 @kindex signal
16482 @item signal @var{signal}
16483 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
16484 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
16485 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
16486 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
16487
16488 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
16489 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
16490 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
16491 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
16492 signal.
16493
16494 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
16495 after executing the command.
16496 @end table
16497 @c @end group
16498
16499 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
16500 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
16501 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
16502 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
16503 passes the signal directly to your program.
16504
16505
16506 @node Returning
16507 @section Returning from a Function
16508
16509 @table @code
16510 @cindex returning from a function
16511 @kindex return
16512 @item return
16513 @itemx return @var{expression}
16514 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
16515 command. If you give an
16516 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
16517 value.
16518 @end table
16519
16520 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
16521 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
16522 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
16523 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
16524
16525 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
16526 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
16527 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
16528 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
16529 of functions.
16530
16531 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
16532 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
16533 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
16534 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
16535 selected stack frame returns naturally.
16536
16537 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
16538 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
16539 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
16540 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
16541 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
16542 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
16543 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
16544 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
16545 assignment into the right register(s).
16546
16547 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
16548 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
16549 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
16550 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
16551 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
16552 into a @code{long long int}:
16553
16554 @smallexample
16555 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
16556 29 return 31;
16557 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
16558 Make func return now? (y or n) y
16559 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
16560 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
16561 (@value{GDBP})
16562 @end smallexample
16563
16564 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
16565 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
16566 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
16567 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
16568 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
16569 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
16570 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
16571 an appropriate cast explicitly:
16572
16573 @smallexample
16574 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
16575 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
16576 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
16577 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
16578 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
16579 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
16580 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
16581 (@value{GDBP})
16582 @end smallexample
16583
16584 @node Calling
16585 @section Calling Program Functions
16586
16587 @table @code
16588 @cindex calling functions
16589 @cindex inferior functions, calling
16590 @item print @var{expr}
16591 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
16592 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
16593 debugged.
16594
16595 @kindex call
16596 @item call @var{expr}
16597 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
16598 returned values.
16599
16600 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
16601 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
16602 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
16603 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
16604 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
16605 value history.
16606 @end table
16607
16608 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
16609 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
16610 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
16611 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
16612
16613 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
16614 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
16615 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
16616 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
16617 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
16618 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
16619 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
16620 in that case is controlled by the
16621 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
16622
16623 @table @code
16624 @item set unwindonsignal
16625 @kindex set unwindonsignal
16626 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
16627 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
16628 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
16629 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
16630 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
16631 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
16632 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
16633 received.
16634
16635 @item show unwindonsignal
16636 @kindex show unwindonsignal
16637 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
16638 @value{GDBN}.
16639
16640 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
16641 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
16642 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
16643 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
16644 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
16645 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
16646 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
16647 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
16648 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
16649 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
16650
16651 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
16652 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
16653 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
16654 @value{GDBN}.
16655
16656 @end table
16657
16658 @cindex weak alias functions
16659 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
16660 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
16661 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
16662 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
16663 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
16664 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
16665 function instead.
16666
16667 @node Patching
16668 @section Patching Programs
16669
16670 @cindex patching binaries
16671 @cindex writing into executables
16672 @cindex writing into corefiles
16673
16674 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
16675 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
16676 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
16677 patching your program's binary.
16678
16679 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
16680 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
16681 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
16682 repairs.
16683
16684 @table @code
16685 @kindex set write
16686 @item set write on
16687 @itemx set write off
16688 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
16689 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
16690 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
16691
16692 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
16693 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
16694 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
16695
16696 @item show write
16697 @kindex show write
16698 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
16699 as well as reading.
16700 @end table
16701
16702 @node GDB Files
16703 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
16704
16705 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
16706 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
16707 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
16708 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
16709
16710 @menu
16711 * Files:: Commands to specify files
16712 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
16713 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
16714 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
16715 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
16716 * Data Files:: GDB data files
16717 @end menu
16718
16719 @node Files
16720 @section Commands to Specify Files
16721
16722 @cindex symbol table
16723 @cindex core dump file
16724
16725 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
16726 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
16727 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
16728 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
16729
16730 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
16731 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
16732 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
16733 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
16734 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
16735 new files are useful.
16736
16737 @table @code
16738 @cindex executable file
16739 @kindex file
16740 @item file @var{filename}
16741 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
16742 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
16743 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
16744 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
16745 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
16746 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
16747 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
16748 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
16749
16750 @cindex unlinked object files
16751 @cindex patching object files
16752 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
16753 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
16754 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
16755 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
16756 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
16757 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
16758 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
16759 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
16760
16761 @item file
16762 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
16763 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
16764
16765 @kindex exec-file
16766 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
16767 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
16768 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
16769 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
16770 discard information on the executable file.
16771
16772 @kindex symbol-file
16773 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
16774 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
16775 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
16776 table and program to run from the same file.
16777
16778 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
16779 program's symbol table.
16780
16781 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
16782 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
16783 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
16784 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
16785 @value{GDBN}.
16786
16787 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
16788 executing it once.
16789
16790 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
16791 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
16792 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
16793 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
16794 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
16795 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
16796 optimized code.
16797
16798 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
16799 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
16800 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
16801 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
16802 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
16803
16804 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
16805 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
16806 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
16807 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
16808 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
16809 Warnings and Messages}.)
16810
16811 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
16812 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
16813 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
16814 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
16815 in stabs format.
16816
16817 @kindex readnow
16818 @cindex reading symbols immediately
16819 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
16820 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
16821 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
16822 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
16823 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
16824 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
16825 entire symbol table available.
16826
16827 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
16828 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
16829 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
16830 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
16831 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
16832 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
16833 @c files.
16834
16835 @kindex core-file
16836 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
16837 @itemx core
16838 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
16839 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
16840 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
16841 executable file itself for other parts.
16842
16843 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
16844 to be used.
16845
16846 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
16847 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
16848 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
16849 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
16850 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
16851
16852 @kindex add-symbol-file
16853 @cindex dynamic linking
16854 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
16855 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
16856 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
16857 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
16858 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
16859 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
16860 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
16861 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
16862 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
16863 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
16864 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
16865 @var{address} as an expression.
16866
16867 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
16868 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
16869 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
16870 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
16871
16872 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
16873
16874 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
16875 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
16876 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
16877 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
16878 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
16879 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
16880 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
16881 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
16882 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
16883
16884 @itemize @bullet
16885 @item
16886 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
16887 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
16888 @item
16889 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
16890 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
16891 @item
16892 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
16893 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
16894 @end itemize
16895
16896 @noindent
16897 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
16898 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
16899 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
16900 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
16901 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
16902 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
16903 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
16904 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
16905 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
16906 way.
16907
16908 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
16909
16910 @kindex remove-symbol-file
16911 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
16912 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
16913 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
16914 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
16915 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
16916
16917 @smallexample
16918 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
16919 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
16920 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
16921 (y or n) y
16922 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
16923 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
16924 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
16925 (gdb)
16926 @end smallexample
16927
16928
16929 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
16930
16931 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
16932 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
16933 @cindex load symbols from memory
16934 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
16935 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
16936 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
16937 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
16938 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
16939 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
16940 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
16941 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
16942 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
16943
16944 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
16945 @kindex assf
16946 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
16947 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
16948 This command is deprecated and will be removed in future versions
16949 of @value{GDBN}. Use the @code{sharedlibrary} command instead.
16950
16951 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
16952 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
16953 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
16954 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
16955 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
16956 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
16957 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
16958 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
16959
16960 @kindex section
16961 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
16962 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
16963 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
16964 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
16965 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
16966 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
16967 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
16968 their addresses.
16969
16970 @kindex info files
16971 @kindex info target
16972 @item info files
16973 @itemx info target
16974 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
16975 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
16976 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
16977 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
16978 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
16979 current ones.
16980
16981 @kindex maint info sections
16982 @item maint info sections
16983 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
16984 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
16985 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
16986 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
16987 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
16988 may be arbitrarily combined):
16989
16990 @table @code
16991 @item ALLOBJ
16992 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
16993 @item @var{sections}
16994 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
16995 @item @var{section-flags}
16996 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
16997 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
16998 @table @code
16999 @item ALLOC
17000 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
17001 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
17002 @item LOAD
17003 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
17004 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
17005 @item RELOC
17006 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
17007 @item READONLY
17008 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
17009 @item CODE
17010 Section contains executable code only.
17011 @item DATA
17012 Section contains data only (no executable code).
17013 @item ROM
17014 Section will reside in ROM.
17015 @item CONSTRUCTOR
17016 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
17017 @item HAS_CONTENTS
17018 Section is not empty.
17019 @item NEVER_LOAD
17020 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
17021 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
17022 A notification to the linker that the section contains
17023 COFF shared library information.
17024 @item IS_COMMON
17025 Section contains common symbols.
17026 @end table
17027 @end table
17028 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
17029 @cindex read-only sections
17030 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
17031 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
17032 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
17033 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
17034 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
17035 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
17036 enhancement to debugging performance.
17037
17038 The default is off.
17039
17040 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
17041 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
17042 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
17043 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
17044
17045 @item show trust-readonly-sections
17046 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
17047 @end table
17048
17049 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
17050 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
17051 name and remembers it that way.
17052
17053 @cindex shared libraries
17054 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
17055 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
17056 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
17057
17058 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
17059 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
17060
17061 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
17062 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
17063 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
17064 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
17065 debugging a core file).
17066
17067 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
17068 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
17069
17070 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
17071 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
17072 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
17073
17074 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
17075 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
17076 particularly large or there are many of them.
17077
17078 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
17079 commands:
17080
17081 @table @code
17082 @kindex set auto-solib-add
17083 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
17084 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
17085 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
17086 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
17087 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
17088 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
17089 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
17090
17091 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
17092 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
17093 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
17094 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
17095 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
17096 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
17097 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
17098 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
17099 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
17100
17101 @kindex show auto-solib-add
17102 @item show auto-solib-add
17103 Display the current autoloading mode.
17104 @end table
17105
17106 @cindex load shared library
17107 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
17108 command:
17109
17110 @table @code
17111 @kindex info sharedlibrary
17112 @kindex info share
17113 @item info share @var{regex}
17114 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
17115 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
17116 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
17117 all shared libraries that are loaded.
17118
17119 @kindex sharedlibrary
17120 @kindex share
17121 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
17122 @itemx share @var{regex}
17123 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
17124 Unix regular expression.
17125 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
17126 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
17127 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
17128 loaded.
17129
17130 @item nosharedlibrary
17131 @kindex nosharedlibrary
17132 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
17133 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
17134 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
17135 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
17136 discarded.
17137 @end table
17138
17139 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
17140 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
17141 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
17142 Catchpoints}).
17143
17144 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
17145 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
17146 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
17147 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
17148
17149 @table @code
17150 @item set stop-on-solib-events
17151 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
17152 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
17153 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
17154 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
17155 shared library.
17156
17157 @item show stop-on-solib-events
17158 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
17159 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
17160 library events happen.
17161 @end table
17162
17163 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
17164 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
17165 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
17166 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
17167 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
17168 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
17169 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
17170 not.
17171
17172 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
17173 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
17174 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
17175 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
17176 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
17177
17178 @table @code
17179 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
17180 @cindex system root, alternate
17181 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
17182 @kindex set sysroot
17183 @item set sysroot @var{path}
17184 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
17185 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
17186 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
17187 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
17188 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
17189 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
17190 under @var{path}.
17191
17192 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will
17193 retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only
17194 supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get}
17195 command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).
17196 The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:}
17197 (if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system.
17198 @footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory
17199 that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent
17200 variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.}
17201
17202 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
17203 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
17204 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
17205 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
17206 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
17207
17208 @smallexample
17209 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
17210 @end smallexample
17211
17212 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
17213 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
17214 system:
17215
17216 @smallexample
17217 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
17218 @end smallexample
17219
17220 If that does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries removing
17221 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
17222 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
17223 colons:
17224
17225 @smallexample
17226 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
17227 @end smallexample
17228
17229 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
17230 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
17231 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
17232 @samp{z}):
17233
17234 @smallexample
17235 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
17236 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
17237 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
17238 @end smallexample
17239
17240 @noindent
17241 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
17242 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
17243 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
17244
17245 If that still does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries
17246 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
17247
17248 @smallexample
17249 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
17250 @end smallexample
17251
17252 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
17253 if you don't want or need to.
17254
17255 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
17256 sysroot}.
17257
17258 @cindex default system root
17259 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
17260 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
17261 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
17262 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
17263 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
17264 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
17265 location.
17266
17267 @kindex show sysroot
17268 @item show sysroot
17269 Display the current shared library prefix.
17270
17271 @kindex set solib-search-path
17272 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
17273 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
17274 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
17275 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
17276 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
17277 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
17278 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
17279 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
17280 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
17281 of shared library symbols.
17282
17283 @kindex show solib-search-path
17284 @item show solib-search-path
17285 Display the current shared library search path.
17286
17287 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
17288 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
17289 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
17290 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
17291 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
17292
17293 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
17294 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
17295 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
17296 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
17297 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
17298 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
17299 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
17300 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
17301 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
17302 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
17303 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
17304 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
17305 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
17306 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
17307 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
17308 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
17309 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
17310 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
17311 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
17312 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
17313 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
17314 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
17315
17316 @table @code
17317 @item unix
17318 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
17319 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
17320 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
17321 the forward slash.
17322
17323 @item dos-based
17324 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
17325 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
17326 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
17327 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
17328 considered directory separators.
17329
17330 @item auto
17331 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
17332 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
17333 This is the default.
17334 @end table
17335 @end table
17336
17337 @cindex file name canonicalization
17338 @cindex base name differences
17339 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
17340 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
17341 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
17342 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
17343 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
17344 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
17345 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
17346 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
17347 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
17348 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
17349 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
17350 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
17351 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
17352 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
17353 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
17354
17355 @table @code
17356 @item set basenames-may-differ
17357 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
17358 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
17359
17360 @item show basenames-may-differ
17361 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
17362 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
17363 @end table
17364
17365 @node Separate Debug Files
17366 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
17367 @cindex separate debugging information files
17368 @cindex debugging information in separate files
17369 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
17370 @cindex debugging information directory, global
17371 @cindex global debugging information directories
17372 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
17373 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
17374
17375 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
17376 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
17377 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
17378 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
17379 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
17380 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
17381 install only when they need to debug a problem.
17382
17383 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
17384 file:
17385
17386 @itemize @bullet
17387 @item
17388 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
17389 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
17390 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
17391 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
17392 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
17393 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
17394 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
17395 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
17396
17397 @item
17398 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
17399 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
17400 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
17401 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
17402 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
17403 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
17404 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
17405 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
17406 below.
17407 @end itemize
17408
17409 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
17410 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
17411
17412 @itemize @bullet
17413 @item
17414 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
17415 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
17416 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
17417 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
17418 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
17419
17420 @item
17421 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
17422 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
17423 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
17424 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
17425 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
17426 hex characters, not 10.)
17427 @end itemize
17428
17429 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
17430 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
17431 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
17432 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
17433 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
17434 debug information files, in the indicated order:
17435
17436 @itemize @minus
17437 @item
17438 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
17439 @item
17440 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
17441 @item
17442 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
17443 @item
17444 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
17445 @end itemize
17446
17447 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
17448 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
17449 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
17450 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
17451 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
17452
17453 @table @code
17454
17455 @kindex set debug-file-directory
17456 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
17457 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
17458 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
17459 concatenating them by a path separator.
17460
17461 @kindex show debug-file-directory
17462 @item show debug-file-directory
17463 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
17464 information files.
17465
17466 @end table
17467
17468 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
17469 @cindex debug link sections
17470 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
17471 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
17472
17473 @itemize
17474 @item
17475 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
17476 a zero byte,
17477 @item
17478 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
17479 boundary within the section, and
17480 @item
17481 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
17482 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
17483 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
17484 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
17485 @end itemize
17486
17487 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
17488 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
17489 described above.
17490
17491 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
17492 @cindex build ID sections
17493 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
17494 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
17495 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
17496 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
17497 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
17498 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
17499 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
17500 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
17501 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
17502
17503 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
17504 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
17505 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
17506 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
17507 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
17508 in an ordinary executable.
17509
17510 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
17511 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
17512 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
17513 following commands:
17514
17515 @smallexample
17516 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
17517 @kbd{strip -g foo}
17518 @end smallexample
17519
17520 @noindent
17521 These commands remove the debugging
17522 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
17523 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
17524 two files:
17525
17526 @itemize @bullet
17527 @item
17528 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
17529 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
17530
17531 @smallexample
17532 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
17533 @end smallexample
17534
17535 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
17536 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
17537 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
17538 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
17539
17540 @item
17541 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
17542 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
17543 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
17544 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
17545 @end itemize
17546
17547 @noindent
17548
17549 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
17550 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
17551 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
17552
17553 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
17554 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
17555 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
17556 @c different ways!
17557 @ifhtml
17558 @display
17559 @html
17560 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
17561 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
17562 @end html
17563 @end display
17564 @end ifhtml
17565 @ifnothtml
17566 @display
17567 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
17568 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
17569 @end display
17570 @end ifnothtml
17571
17572 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
17573 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
17574 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
17575 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
17576 CRC.
17577
17578 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
17579 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{Remote Protocol,
17580 , @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol}). However in the
17581 case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed @emph{most}
17582 significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so trailing
17583 zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
17584
17585 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
17586 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
17587 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
17588 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
17589 @code{0xffffffff}.
17590
17591 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
17592 @smallexample
17593 unsigned long
17594 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
17595 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
17596 @{
17597 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
17598 @{
17599 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
17600 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
17601 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
17602 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
17603 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
17604 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
17605 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
17606 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
17607 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
17608 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
17609 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
17610 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
17611 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
17612 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
17613 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
17614 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
17615 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
17616 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
17617 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
17618 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
17619 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
17620 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
17621 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
17622 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
17623 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
17624 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
17625 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
17626 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
17627 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
17628 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
17629 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
17630 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
17631 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
17632 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
17633 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
17634 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
17635 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
17636 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
17637 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
17638 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
17639 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
17640 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
17641 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
17642 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
17643 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
17644 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
17645 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
17646 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
17647 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
17648 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
17649 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
17650 0x2d02ef8d
17651 @};
17652 unsigned char *end;
17653
17654 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
17655 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
17656 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
17657 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
17658 @}
17659 @end smallexample
17660
17661 @noindent
17662 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
17663
17664 @node MiniDebugInfo
17665 @section Debugging information in a special section
17666 @cindex separate debug sections
17667 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
17668
17669 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
17670 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
17671 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
17672 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
17673
17674 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
17675 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
17676 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
17677 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
17678 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
17679 debugging information might be included in the section.
17680
17681 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
17682 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
17683 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
17684
17685 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
17686 standard utilities:
17687
17688 @smallexample
17689 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
17690 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
17691 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
17692 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
17693
17694 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
17695 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
17696 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
17697 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
17698 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
17699 | sort > funcsyms
17700
17701 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
17702 # table.
17703 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
17704
17705 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
17706 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
17707
17708 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
17709 # removing some unnecessary sections.
17710 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
17711 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
17712
17713 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
17714 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
17715
17716 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
17717 # original binary.
17718 xz mini_debuginfo
17719 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
17720 @end smallexample
17721
17722 @node Index Files
17723 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
17724 @cindex index files
17725 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
17726
17727 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
17728 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
17729 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
17730 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
17731 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
17732 startup.
17733
17734 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
17735 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
17736 using @command{objcopy}.
17737
17738 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
17739
17740 @table @code
17741 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
17742 @kindex save gdb-index
17743 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
17744 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
17745 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
17746 @var{directory}.
17747 @end table
17748
17749 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
17750 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
17751
17752 @smallexample
17753 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
17754 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
17755 @end smallexample
17756
17757 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
17758 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
17759 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
17760 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
17761 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
17762 The default is @code{off}.
17763 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
17764 @xref{Index Section Format}.
17765
17766 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
17767 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
17768
17769 @smallexample
17770 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
17771 @end smallexample
17772
17773 Instead you must do, for example,
17774
17775 @smallexample
17776 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
17777 @end smallexample
17778
17779 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
17780 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
17781 currently work for programs using Ada.
17782
17783 @node Symbol Errors
17784 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
17785
17786 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
17787 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
17788 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
17789 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
17790 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
17791 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
17792 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
17793 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
17794 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
17795 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
17796 Messages}).
17797
17798 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
17799
17800 @table @code
17801 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
17802
17803 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
17804 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
17805 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
17806 in its outer scope blocks.
17807
17808 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
17809 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
17810 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
17811 function.
17812
17813 @item block at @var{address} out of order
17814
17815 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
17816 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
17817 do so.
17818
17819 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
17820 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
17821 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
17822 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
17823 Messages}.)
17824
17825 @item bad block start address patched
17826
17827 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
17828 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
17829 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
17830
17831 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
17832 starting on the previous source line.
17833
17834 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
17835
17836 @cindex foo
17837 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
17838 larger than the size of the string table.
17839
17840 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
17841 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
17842 with this name.
17843
17844 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
17845
17846 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
17847 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
17848 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
17849
17850 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
17851 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
17852 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
17853 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
17854 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
17855 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
17856
17857 @item stub type has NULL name
17858
17859 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
17860
17861 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
17862 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
17863 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
17864 it.
17865
17866 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
17867
17868 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
17869
17870 @end table
17871
17872 @node Data Files
17873 @section GDB Data Files
17874
17875 @cindex prefix for data files
17876 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
17877 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
17878
17879 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
17880 is currently using.
17881
17882 @table @code
17883 @kindex set data-directory
17884 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
17885 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
17886 to @var{directory}.
17887
17888 @kindex show data-directory
17889 @item show data-directory
17890 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
17891 @end table
17892
17893 @cindex default data directory
17894 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
17895 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
17896 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
17897 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
17898 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
17899 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
17900 location.
17901
17902 The data directory may also be specified with the
17903 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
17904 @xref{Mode Options}.
17905
17906 @node Targets
17907 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
17908
17909 @cindex debugging target
17910 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
17911
17912 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
17913 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
17914 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
17915 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
17916 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
17917 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
17918 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
17919 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
17920
17921 @cindex target architecture
17922 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
17923 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
17924 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
17925 command.
17926
17927 @table @code
17928 @kindex set architecture
17929 @kindex show architecture
17930 @item set architecture @var{arch}
17931 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
17932 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
17933 supported architectures.
17934
17935 @item show architecture
17936 Show the current target architecture.
17937
17938 @item set processor
17939 @itemx processor
17940 @kindex set processor
17941 @kindex show processor
17942 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
17943 and @code{show architecture}.
17944 @end table
17945
17946 @menu
17947 * Active Targets:: Active targets
17948 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
17949 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
17950 @end menu
17951
17952 @node Active Targets
17953 @section Active Targets
17954
17955 @cindex stacking targets
17956 @cindex active targets
17957 @cindex multiple targets
17958
17959 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
17960 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
17961 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
17962 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
17963 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
17964 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
17965 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
17966 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
17967 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
17968
17969 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
17970 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
17971 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
17972 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
17973
17974 @node Target Commands
17975 @section Commands for Managing Targets
17976
17977 @table @code
17978 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
17979 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
17980 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
17981 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
17982 protocol of the target machine.
17983
17984 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
17985 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
17986 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
17987
17988 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
17989 after executing the command.
17990
17991 @kindex help target
17992 @item help target
17993 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
17994 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
17995 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
17996
17997 @item help target @var{name}
17998 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
17999 select it.
18000
18001 @kindex set gnutarget
18002 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
18003 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
18004 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
18005 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
18006 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
18007 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
18008
18009 @quotation
18010 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
18011 you must know the actual BFD name.
18012 @end quotation
18013
18014 @noindent
18015 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
18016
18017 @kindex show gnutarget
18018 @item show gnutarget
18019 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
18020 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
18021 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
18022 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
18023 @end table
18024
18025 @cindex common targets
18026 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
18027 configuration):
18028
18029 @table @code
18030 @kindex target
18031 @item target exec @var{program}
18032 @cindex executable file target
18033 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
18034 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
18035
18036 @item target core @var{filename}
18037 @cindex core dump file target
18038 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
18039 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
18040
18041 @item target remote @var{medium}
18042 @cindex remote target
18043 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
18044 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
18045 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
18046
18047 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
18048 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
18049
18050 @smallexample
18051 target remote /dev/ttya
18052 @end smallexample
18053
18054 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
18055 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
18056 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
18057 clobbered by the download.
18058
18059 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
18060 @cindex built-in simulator target
18061 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
18062 In general,
18063 @smallexample
18064 target sim
18065 load
18066 run
18067 @end smallexample
18068 @noindent
18069 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
18070 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
18071 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
18072 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
18073 Processors}.
18074
18075 @end table
18076
18077 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
18078 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
18079
18080 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
18081 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
18082 various aspects of this process.
18083
18084 @table @code
18085
18086 @item set hash
18087 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
18088 @cindex hash mark while downloading
18089 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
18090 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
18091 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
18092 monitor.
18093
18094 @item show hash
18095 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
18096 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
18097
18098 @item set debug monitor
18099 @kindex set debug monitor
18100 @cindex display remote monitor communications
18101 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
18102 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
18103
18104 @item show debug monitor
18105 @kindex show debug monitor
18106 Show the current status of displaying communications between
18107 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
18108 @end table
18109
18110 @table @code
18111
18112 @kindex load @var{filename}
18113 @item load @var{filename}
18114 @anchor{load}
18115 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
18116 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
18117 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
18118 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
18119 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
18120 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18121
18122 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
18123 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
18124 target is @dots{}}''
18125
18126 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
18127 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
18128 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
18129 specifies a fixed address.
18130 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
18131
18132 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
18133 load programs into flash memory.
18134
18135 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
18136 @end table
18137
18138 @node Byte Order
18139 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
18140
18141 @cindex choosing target byte order
18142 @cindex target byte order
18143
18144 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
18145 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
18146 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
18147 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
18148 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
18149 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
18150
18151 @table @code
18152 @kindex set endian
18153 @item set endian big
18154 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
18155
18156 @item set endian little
18157 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
18158
18159 @item set endian auto
18160 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
18161 executable.
18162
18163 @item show endian
18164 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
18165
18166 @end table
18167
18168 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
18169 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
18170 target system.
18171
18172
18173 @node Remote Debugging
18174 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
18175 @cindex remote debugging
18176
18177 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
18178 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
18179 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
18180 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
18181 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
18182
18183 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
18184 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
18185 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
18186 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
18187 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
18188 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
18189
18190 Other remote targets may be available in your
18191 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
18192
18193 @menu
18194 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
18195 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
18196 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
18197 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
18198 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
18199 @end menu
18200
18201 @node Connecting
18202 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
18203
18204 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
18205 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
18206 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
18207 program as the first argument.
18208
18209 @cindex @code{target remote}
18210 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
18211 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
18212 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
18213 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
18214 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
18215 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
18216
18217 @table @code
18218
18219 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
18220 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
18221 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
18222 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
18223
18224 @smallexample
18225 target remote /dev/ttyb
18226 @end smallexample
18227
18228 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
18229 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
18230 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
18231 @code{target} command.
18232
18233 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
18234 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
18235 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
18236 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
18237 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
18238 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
18239 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
18240 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
18241 target.
18242
18243 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
18244 @code{manyfarms}:
18245
18246 @smallexample
18247 target remote manyfarms:2828
18248 @end smallexample
18249
18250 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
18251 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
18252 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
18253 port 1234 on your local machine:
18254
18255 @smallexample
18256 target remote :1234
18257 @end smallexample
18258 @noindent
18259
18260 Note that the colon is still required here.
18261
18262 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
18263 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
18264 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
18265 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
18266
18267 @smallexample
18268 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
18269 @end smallexample
18270
18271 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
18272 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
18273 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
18274 cause havoc with your debugging session.
18275
18276 @item target remote | @var{command}
18277 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
18278 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
18279 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
18280 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
18281 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
18282 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
18283 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
18284 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
18285
18286 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
18287 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
18288 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
18289
18290 @end table
18291
18292 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
18293 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
18294 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
18295 need to use @kbd{run}.
18296
18297 @cindex interrupting remote programs
18298 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
18299 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
18300 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
18301 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
18302 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
18303 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
18304
18305 @smallexample
18306 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
18307 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
18308 @end smallexample
18309
18310 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
18311 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
18312 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
18313 goes back to waiting.
18314
18315 @table @code
18316 @kindex detach (remote)
18317 @item detach
18318 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
18319 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
18320 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
18321 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
18322 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
18323
18324 @kindex disconnect
18325 @item disconnect
18326 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
18327 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
18328 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
18329 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
18330 another target.
18331
18332 @cindex send command to remote monitor
18333 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
18334 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
18335 @kindex monitor
18336 @item monitor @var{cmd}
18337 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
18338 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
18339 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
18340 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
18341 and implement.
18342 @end table
18343
18344 @node File Transfer
18345 @section Sending files to a remote system
18346 @cindex remote target, file transfer
18347 @cindex file transfer
18348 @cindex sending files to remote systems
18349
18350 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
18351 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
18352 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
18353 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
18354 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
18355 the only way to upload or download files.
18356
18357 Not all remote targets support these commands.
18358
18359 @table @code
18360 @kindex remote put
18361 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
18362 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
18363 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
18364
18365 @kindex remote get
18366 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
18367 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
18368 on the host system.
18369
18370 @kindex remote delete
18371 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
18372 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
18373
18374 @end table
18375
18376 @node Server
18377 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
18378
18379 @kindex gdbserver
18380 @cindex remote connection without stubs
18381 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
18382 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
18383 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
18384
18385 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
18386 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
18387 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
18388 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
18389 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
18390 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
18391 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
18392 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
18393 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
18394 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
18395 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
18396 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
18397 choice for debugging.
18398
18399 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
18400 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
18401 protocol.
18402
18403 @quotation
18404 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
18405 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
18406 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
18407 target system with the same privileges as the user running
18408 @code{gdbserver}.
18409 @end quotation
18410
18411 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
18412 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
18413 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
18414
18415 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
18416 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
18417 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
18418 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
18419 system does all the symbol handling.
18420
18421 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
18422 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
18423 syntax is:
18424
18425 @smallexample
18426 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
18427 @end smallexample
18428
18429 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
18430 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
18431 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
18432 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
18433 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
18434 @file{/dev/com1}:
18435
18436 @smallexample
18437 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
18438 @end smallexample
18439
18440 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
18441 with it.
18442
18443 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
18444
18445 @smallexample
18446 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
18447 @end smallexample
18448
18449 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
18450 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
18451 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
18452 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
18453 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
18454 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
18455 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
18456 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
18457 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
18458 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
18459 @code{target remote} command.
18460
18461 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
18462 with ssh:
18463
18464 @smallexample
18465 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
18466 @end smallexample
18467
18468 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
18469 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
18470 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
18471 You could elide it if you want to.
18472
18473 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
18474 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
18475 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
18476 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
18477
18478 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
18479 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
18480 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
18481
18482 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
18483 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
18484
18485 @smallexample
18486 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
18487 @end smallexample
18488
18489 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
18490 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
18491
18492 @pindex pidof
18493 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
18494 @code{pidof} utility:
18495
18496 @smallexample
18497 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
18498 @end smallexample
18499
18500 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
18501 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
18502 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
18503
18504 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
18505 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, multiple processes
18506 @cindex multiple processes with @code{gdbserver}
18507
18508 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
18509 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
18510 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
18511 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
18512
18513 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
18514 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
18515 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
18516 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
18517 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
18518 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
18519 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
18520 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
18521 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
18522
18523 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
18524 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
18525 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
18526 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
18527 the program you want to debug.
18528
18529 In multi-process mode @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit unless you
18530 use the option @option{--once}. You can terminate it by using
18531 @code{monitor exit} (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}). Note that the
18532 conditions under which @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN}
18533 connects to it (@kbd{target remote} or @kbd{target extended-remote}). The
18534 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
18535
18536 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
18537
18538 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP port.
18539
18540 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
18541 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
18542 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
18543 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
18544 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
18545 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
18546 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
18547 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
18548
18549 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
18550 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
18551 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
18552
18553 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
18554 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
18555 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
18556 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
18557 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
18558 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
18559 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
18560 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
18561 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
18562 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
18563 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
18564 instance closes its port after the first connection.
18565
18566 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
18567 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
18568
18569 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
18570 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
18571 status information about the debugging process.
18572 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
18573 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
18574 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
18575 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
18576
18577 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
18578 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
18579 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
18580 Possible options are:
18581
18582 @table @code
18583 @item none
18584 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
18585 @item all
18586 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
18587 @item timestamps
18588 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
18589 @end table
18590
18591 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
18592 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
18593
18594 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
18595 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
18596 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
18597 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
18598 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
18599
18600 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
18601 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
18602 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
18603 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
18604
18605 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
18606 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
18607 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
18608 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
18609
18610 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
18611 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
18612 environment:
18613
18614 @smallexample
18615 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
18616 @end smallexample
18617
18618 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
18619
18620 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
18621
18622 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
18623 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
18624 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
18625 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
18626
18627 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
18628 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
18629 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
18630 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
18631 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
18632 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
18633 programs.
18634
18635 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
18636 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
18637 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
18638 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
18639 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
18640 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
18641 already on the target.
18642
18643 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
18644 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
18645 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
18646
18647 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
18648 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
18649 Here are the available commands.
18650
18651 @table @code
18652 @item monitor help
18653 List the available monitor commands.
18654
18655 @item monitor set debug 0
18656 @itemx monitor set debug 1
18657 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
18658
18659 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
18660 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
18661 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
18662 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
18663
18664 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
18665 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
18666 Possible options are:
18667
18668 @table @code
18669 @item none
18670 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
18671 @item all
18672 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
18673 @item timestamps
18674 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
18675 @end table
18676
18677 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
18678 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
18679
18680 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
18681 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
18682 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18683 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
18684 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
18685 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
18686
18687 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
18688 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
18689
18690 @item monitor exit
18691 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
18692 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
18693 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
18694 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
18695 of a multi-process mode debug session.
18696
18697 @end table
18698
18699 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
18700 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
18701
18702 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
18703 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
18704
18705 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
18706 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
18707 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
18708 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
18709 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
18710 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
18711 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
18712 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
18713 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
18714 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
18715 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
18716 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
18717
18718 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
18719
18720 @table @code
18721 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
18722
18723 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
18724 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
18725 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
18726
18727 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
18728
18729 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
18730 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
18731 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
18732 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
18733 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
18734 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
18735
18736 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
18737
18738 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
18739 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
18740 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
18741 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
18742 command for that. For example:
18743
18744 @smallexample
18745 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
18746 @end smallexample
18747
18748 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
18749 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
18750 @end table
18751
18752 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
18753 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
18754 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
18755 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
18756 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
18757 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
18758 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
18759 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
18760 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
18761 @code{gdbserver} like so:
18762
18763 @smallexample
18764 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
18765 @end smallexample
18766
18767 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
18768
18769 @smallexample
18770 $ gdb myprogram
18771 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
18772 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
18773 (@value{GDBP}) b main
18774 (@value{GDBP}) continue
18775 @end smallexample
18776
18777 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
18778 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
18779 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
18780 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
18781 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
18782 tracing.
18783
18784 @node Remote Configuration
18785 @section Remote Configuration
18786
18787 @kindex set remote
18788 @kindex show remote
18789 This section documents the configuration options available when
18790 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
18791 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
18792 system-call-allowed}.
18793
18794 @table @code
18795 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
18796 @cindex address size for remote targets
18797 @cindex bits in remote address
18798 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
18799 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
18800 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
18801 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
18802
18803 @item show remoteaddresssize
18804 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
18805
18806 @item set serial baud @var{n}
18807 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
18808 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
18809 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
18810 remote targets.
18811
18812 @item show serial baud
18813 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
18814
18815 @item set remotebreak
18816 @cindex interrupt remote programs
18817 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
18818 @anchor{set remotebreak}
18819 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
18820 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
18821 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
18822 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
18823 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
18824
18825 @item show remotebreak
18826 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
18827 interrupt the remote program.
18828
18829 @item set remoteflow on
18830 @itemx set remoteflow off
18831 @kindex set remoteflow
18832 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
18833 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
18834
18835 @item show remoteflow
18836 @kindex show remoteflow
18837 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
18838
18839 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
18840 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
18841 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
18842 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
18843 @code{ascii}.
18844
18845 @item show remotelogbase
18846 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
18847 protocol.
18848
18849 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
18850 @cindex record serial communications on file
18851 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
18852 default is not to record at all.
18853
18854 @item show remotelogfile.
18855 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
18856 serial communications.
18857
18858 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
18859 @cindex timeout for serial communications
18860 @cindex remote timeout
18861 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
18862 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
18863
18864 @item show remotetimeout
18865 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
18866 responses.
18867
18868 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
18869 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
18870 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
18871 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
18872 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
18873 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
18874 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
18875 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
18876
18877 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
18878 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
18879 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
18880 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
18881 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
18882 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
18883 as unlimited.
18884
18885 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
18886 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
18887 a remote hardware watchpoint.
18888
18889 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
18890 @itemx show remote exec-file
18891 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
18892 @cindex executable file, for remote target
18893 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
18894 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
18895 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
18896 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
18897
18898 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
18899 @cindex interrupt remote programs
18900 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
18901 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
18902 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
18903 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
18904 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
18905 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
18906 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
18907 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
18908
18909 @item show interrupt-sequence
18910 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
18911 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
18912 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
18913 also known as Magic SysRq g.
18914
18915 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
18916 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
18917 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
18918 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
18919 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
18920 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
18921
18922 @item show interrupt-on-connect
18923 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
18924 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
18925
18926 @kindex set tcp
18927 @kindex show tcp
18928 @item set tcp auto-retry on
18929 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
18930 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
18931 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
18932 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
18933 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
18934 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
18935 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
18936 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
18937
18938 @item set tcp auto-retry off
18939 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
18940
18941 @item show tcp auto-retry
18942 Show the current auto-retry setting.
18943
18944 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
18945 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
18946 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
18947 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
18948 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
18949 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
18950 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
18951 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
18952 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
18953 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
18954 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
18955
18956 @item show tcp connect-timeout
18957 Show the current connection timeout setting.
18958 @end table
18959
18960 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
18961 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
18962 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
18963 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
18964 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
18965 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
18966 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
18967 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
18968 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
18969
18970 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
18971 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
18972 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
18973 @value{GDBN} developers.
18974
18975 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
18976 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
18977 are:
18978
18979 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
18980 @item Command Name
18981 @tab Remote Packet
18982 @tab Related Features
18983
18984 @item @code{fetch-register}
18985 @tab @code{p}
18986 @tab @code{info registers}
18987
18988 @item @code{set-register}
18989 @tab @code{P}
18990 @tab @code{set}
18991
18992 @item @code{binary-download}
18993 @tab @code{X}
18994 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
18995
18996 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
18997 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
18998 @tab @code{info auxv}
18999
19000 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
19001 @tab @code{qSymbol}
19002 @tab Detecting multiple threads
19003
19004 @item @code{attach}
19005 @tab @code{vAttach}
19006 @tab @code{attach}
19007
19008 @item @code{verbose-resume}
19009 @tab @code{vCont}
19010 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
19011
19012 @item @code{run}
19013 @tab @code{vRun}
19014 @tab @code{run}
19015
19016 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
19017 @tab @code{Z0}
19018 @tab @code{break}
19019
19020 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
19021 @tab @code{Z1}
19022 @tab @code{hbreak}
19023
19024 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
19025 @tab @code{Z2}
19026 @tab @code{watch}
19027
19028 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
19029 @tab @code{Z3}
19030 @tab @code{rwatch}
19031
19032 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
19033 @tab @code{Z4}
19034 @tab @code{awatch}
19035
19036 @item @code{target-features}
19037 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
19038 @tab @code{set architecture}
19039
19040 @item @code{library-info}
19041 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
19042 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
19043
19044 @item @code{memory-map}
19045 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
19046 @tab @code{info mem}
19047
19048 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
19049 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
19050 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
19051
19052 @item @code{read-spu-object}
19053 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
19054 @tab @code{info spu}
19055
19056 @item @code{write-spu-object}
19057 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
19058 @tab @code{info spu}
19059
19060 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
19061 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
19062 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
19063
19064 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
19065 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
19066 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
19067
19068 @item @code{threads}
19069 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
19070 @tab @code{info threads}
19071
19072 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
19073 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
19074 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
19075
19076 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
19077 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
19078 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
19079
19080 @item @code{search-memory}
19081 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
19082 @tab @code{find}
19083
19084 @item @code{supported-packets}
19085 @tab @code{qSupported}
19086 @tab Remote communications parameters
19087
19088 @item @code{pass-signals}
19089 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
19090 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
19091
19092 @item @code{program-signals}
19093 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
19094 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
19095
19096 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
19097 @tab @code{vFile:close}
19098 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19099
19100 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
19101 @tab @code{vFile:open}
19102 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19103
19104 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
19105 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
19106 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19107
19108 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
19109 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
19110 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19111
19112 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
19113 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
19114 @tab @code{remote delete}
19115
19116 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
19117 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
19118 @tab Host I/O
19119
19120 @item @code{noack-packet}
19121 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
19122 @tab Packet acknowledgment
19123
19124 @item @code{osdata}
19125 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
19126 @tab @code{info os}
19127
19128 @item @code{query-attached}
19129 @tab @code{qAttached}
19130 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
19131
19132 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
19133 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
19134 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
19135
19136 @item @code{trace-status}
19137 @tab @code{qTStatus}
19138 @tab @code{tstatus}
19139
19140 @item @code{traceframe-info}
19141 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
19142 @tab Traceframe info
19143
19144 @item @code{install-in-trace}
19145 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
19146 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
19147
19148 @item @code{disable-randomization}
19149 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
19150 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
19151
19152 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
19153 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
19154 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
19155 @end multitable
19156
19157 @node Remote Stub
19158 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
19159
19160 @cindex debugging stub, example
19161 @cindex remote stub, example
19162 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
19163 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
19164 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
19165 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
19166 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
19167 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
19168 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
19169 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
19170
19171 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
19172 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
19173 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
19174 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
19175 program, you need:
19176
19177 @enumerate
19178 @item
19179 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
19180 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
19181 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
19182
19183 @item
19184 A C subroutine library to support your program's
19185 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
19186
19187 @item
19188 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
19189 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
19190 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
19191 documentation.
19192 @end enumerate
19193
19194 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
19195 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
19196 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
19197
19198 @table @emph
19199 @item On the host,
19200 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
19201 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
19202 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
19203
19204 @item On the target,
19205 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
19206 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
19207 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
19208
19209 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
19210 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
19211 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
19212 @end table
19213
19214 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
19215 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
19216 @sc{sparc} boards.
19217
19218 @cindex remote serial stub list
19219 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
19220
19221 @table @code
19222
19223 @item i386-stub.c
19224 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
19225 @cindex Intel
19226 @cindex i386
19227 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
19228
19229 @item m68k-stub.c
19230 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
19231 @cindex Motorola 680x0
19232 @cindex m680x0
19233 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
19234
19235 @item sh-stub.c
19236 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
19237 @cindex Renesas
19238 @cindex SH
19239 For Renesas SH architectures.
19240
19241 @item sparc-stub.c
19242 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
19243 @cindex Sparc
19244 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
19245
19246 @item sparcl-stub.c
19247 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
19248 @cindex Fujitsu
19249 @cindex SparcLite
19250 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
19251
19252 @end table
19253
19254 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
19255 recently added stubs.
19256
19257 @menu
19258 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
19259 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
19260 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
19261 @end menu
19262
19263 @node Stub Contents
19264 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
19265
19266 @cindex remote serial stub
19267 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
19268 subroutines:
19269
19270 @table @code
19271 @item set_debug_traps
19272 @findex set_debug_traps
19273 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
19274 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
19275 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
19276 program's startup code.
19277
19278 @item handle_exception
19279 @findex handle_exception
19280 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
19281 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
19282 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
19283 run when a trap is triggered.
19284
19285 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
19286 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
19287 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
19288 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
19289 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
19290 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
19291 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
19292 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
19293 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
19294 machine.
19295
19296 @item breakpoint
19297 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
19298 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
19299 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
19300 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
19301 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
19302 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
19303 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
19304 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
19305 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
19306 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
19307 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
19308
19309 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
19310 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
19311 start of your debugging session.
19312 @end table
19313
19314 @node Bootstrapping
19315 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
19316
19317 @cindex remote stub, support routines
19318 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
19319 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
19320 debugging target machine.
19321
19322 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
19323 serial port.
19324
19325 @table @code
19326 @item int getDebugChar()
19327 @findex getDebugChar
19328 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
19329 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
19330 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
19331
19332 @item void putDebugChar(int)
19333 @findex putDebugChar
19334 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
19335 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
19336 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
19337 @end table
19338
19339 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
19340 @cindex interrupting remote targets
19341 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
19342 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
19343 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
19344 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
19345 remote system to stop.
19346
19347 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
19348 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
19349 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
19350 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
19351
19352 Other routines you need to supply are:
19353
19354 @table @code
19355 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
19356 @findex exceptionHandler
19357 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
19358 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
19359 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
19360 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
19361 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
19362 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
19363 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
19364 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
19365 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
19366 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
19367 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
19368 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
19369 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
19370
19371 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
19372 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
19373 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
19374 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
19375 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
19376
19377 @item void flush_i_cache()
19378 @findex flush_i_cache
19379 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
19380 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
19381 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
19382
19383 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
19384 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
19385 @end table
19386
19387 @noindent
19388 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
19389
19390 @table @code
19391 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
19392 @findex memset
19393 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
19394 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
19395 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
19396 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
19397 @end table
19398
19399 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
19400 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
19401 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
19402 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
19403
19404
19405 @node Debug Session
19406 @subsection Putting it All Together
19407
19408 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
19409 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
19410 steps.
19411
19412 @enumerate
19413 @item
19414 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
19415 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
19416 @display
19417 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
19418 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
19419 @end display
19420
19421 @item
19422 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
19423 procedure is called:
19424
19425 @smallexample
19426 set_debug_traps();
19427 breakpoint();
19428 @end smallexample
19429
19430 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
19431 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
19432 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
19433 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
19434 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
19435 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
19436 progress.
19437
19438 @item
19439 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
19440 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
19441
19442 @smallexample
19443 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
19444 @end smallexample
19445
19446 @noindent
19447 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
19448 function in your program, that function is called when
19449 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
19450 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
19451 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
19452
19453 @item
19454 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
19455 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
19456
19457 @item
19458 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
19459 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
19460
19461 @item
19462 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
19463 @c document that. FIXME.
19464 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
19465 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
19466
19467 @item
19468 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
19469 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
19470
19471 @end enumerate
19472
19473 @node Configurations
19474 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
19475
19476 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
19477 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
19478 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
19479
19480 There are three major categories of configurations: native
19481 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
19482 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
19483 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
19484 are quite different from each other.
19485
19486 @menu
19487 * Native::
19488 * Embedded OS::
19489 * Embedded Processors::
19490 * Architectures::
19491 @end menu
19492
19493 @node Native
19494 @section Native
19495
19496 This section describes details specific to particular native
19497 configurations.
19498
19499 @menu
19500 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
19501 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
19502 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
19503 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
19504 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
19505 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
19506 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
19507 @end menu
19508
19509 @node HP-UX
19510 @subsection HP-UX
19511
19512 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
19513 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
19514 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
19515
19516
19517 @node BSD libkvm Interface
19518 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
19519
19520 @cindex libkvm
19521 @cindex kernel memory image
19522 @cindex kernel crash dump
19523
19524 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
19525 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
19526 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
19527 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
19528 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
19529 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
19530 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
19531 @code{kvm} target:
19532
19533 @smallexample
19534 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
19535 @end smallexample
19536
19537 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
19538 argument:
19539
19540 @smallexample
19541 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
19542 @end smallexample
19543
19544 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
19545 available:
19546
19547 @table @code
19548 @kindex kvm
19549 @item kvm pcb
19550 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
19551
19552 @item kvm proc
19553 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
19554 modern FreeBSD systems.
19555 @end table
19556
19557 @node SVR4 Process Information
19558 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
19559 @cindex /proc
19560 @cindex examine process image
19561 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
19562
19563 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
19564 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
19565 process using file-system subroutines.
19566
19567 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
19568 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
19569 information about the process running your program, or about any
19570 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
19571 @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, and Irix, but
19572 not HP-UX, for example.
19573
19574 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
19575 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
19576
19577 @table @code
19578 @kindex info proc
19579 @cindex process ID
19580 @item info proc
19581 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
19582 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
19583 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
19584 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
19585 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
19586 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
19587 executable file's absolute file name.
19588
19589 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
19590 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
19591 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
19592 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
19593 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
19594 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
19595
19596 @item info proc cmdline
19597 @cindex info proc cmdline
19598 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
19599 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
19600
19601 @item info proc cwd
19602 @cindex info proc cwd
19603 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
19604 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
19605
19606 @item info proc exe
19607 @cindex info proc exe
19608 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
19609 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
19610
19611 @item info proc mappings
19612 @cindex memory address space mappings
19613 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
19614 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
19615 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
19616 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
19617 memory access rights to that range.
19618
19619 @item info proc stat
19620 @itemx info proc status
19621 @cindex process detailed status information
19622 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
19623 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
19624 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
19625 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
19626 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
19627 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
19628 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
19629
19630 @item info proc all
19631 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
19632 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
19633
19634 @ignore
19635 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
19636 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
19637 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
19638 @kindex info proc times
19639 @item info proc times
19640 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
19641 its children.
19642
19643 @kindex info proc id
19644 @item info proc id
19645 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
19646 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
19647 @end ignore
19648
19649 @item set procfs-trace
19650 @kindex set procfs-trace
19651 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
19652 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
19653
19654 @item show procfs-trace
19655 @kindex show procfs-trace
19656 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
19657
19658 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
19659 @kindex set procfs-file
19660 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
19661 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
19662 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
19663 standard output.
19664
19665 @item show procfs-file
19666 @kindex show procfs-file
19667 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
19668
19669 @item proc-trace-entry
19670 @itemx proc-trace-exit
19671 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
19672 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
19673 @kindex proc-trace-entry
19674 @kindex proc-trace-exit
19675 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
19676 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
19677 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
19678 from the @code{syscall} interface.
19679
19680 @item info pidlist
19681 @kindex info pidlist
19682 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
19683 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
19684 processes and all the threads within each process.
19685
19686 @item info meminfo
19687 @kindex info meminfo
19688 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
19689 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
19690 @end table
19691
19692 @node DJGPP Native
19693 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
19694 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
19695 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
19696 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
19697
19698 @cindex DPMI
19699 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
19700 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
19701 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
19702 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
19703
19704 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
19705 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
19706 subsection describes those commands.
19707
19708 @table @code
19709 @kindex info dos
19710 @item info dos
19711 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
19712 information about the target system and important OS structures.
19713
19714 @kindex sysinfo
19715 @cindex MS-DOS system info
19716 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
19717 @item info dos sysinfo
19718 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
19719 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
19720 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
19721
19722 @cindex GDT
19723 @cindex LDT
19724 @cindex IDT
19725 @cindex segment descriptor tables
19726 @cindex descriptor tables display
19727 @item info dos gdt
19728 @itemx info dos ldt
19729 @itemx info dos idt
19730 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
19731 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
19732 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
19733 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
19734 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
19735 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
19736 rights.
19737
19738 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
19739 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
19740 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
19741 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
19742 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
19743
19744 @cindex garbled pointers
19745 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
19746 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
19747 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
19748 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
19749 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
19750 debugged program's data segment:
19751
19752 @smallexample
19753 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
19754 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
19755 @end smallexample
19756
19757 @noindent
19758 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
19759 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
19760
19761 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
19762 @item info dos pde
19763 @itemx info dos pte
19764 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
19765 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
19766 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
19767 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
19768 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
19769 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
19770 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
19771 that is currently in use.
19772
19773 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
19774 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
19775 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
19776 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
19777 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
19778 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
19779 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
19780
19781 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
19782 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
19783 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
19784 controller.
19785
19786 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
19787
19788 @cindex physical address from linear address
19789 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
19790 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
19791 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
19792 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
19793 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
19794 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
19795 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
19796
19797 @smallexample
19798 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
19799 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
19800 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
19801 @end smallexample
19802
19803 @noindent
19804 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
19805 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
19806 attributes of that page.
19807
19808 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
19809 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
19810 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
19811 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
19812 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
19813 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
19814
19815 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
19816 transfer buffer:
19817
19818 @smallexample
19819 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
19820 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
19821 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
19822 @end smallexample
19823
19824 @noindent
19825 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
19826 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
19827 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
19828 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
19829 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
19830
19831 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
19832 @end table
19833
19834 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
19835 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
19836 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
19837 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
19838
19839 @table @code
19840 @kindex set com1base
19841 @kindex set com1irq
19842 @kindex set com2base
19843 @kindex set com2irq
19844 @kindex set com3base
19845 @kindex set com3irq
19846 @kindex set com4base
19847 @kindex set com4irq
19848 @item set com1base @var{addr}
19849 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
19850 port.
19851
19852 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
19853 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
19854 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
19855
19856 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
19857 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
19858 other 3 COM ports.
19859
19860 @kindex show com1base
19861 @kindex show com1irq
19862 @kindex show com2base
19863 @kindex show com2irq
19864 @kindex show com3base
19865 @kindex show com3irq
19866 @kindex show com4base
19867 @kindex show com4irq
19868 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
19869 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
19870 lines used by the COM ports.
19871
19872 @item info serial
19873 @kindex info serial
19874 @cindex DOS serial port status
19875 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
19876 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
19877 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
19878 counts of various errors encountered so far.
19879 @end table
19880
19881
19882 @node Cygwin Native
19883 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
19884 @cindex MS Windows debugging
19885 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
19886 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
19887
19888 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
19889 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
19890
19891 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
19892 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
19893 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
19894 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
19895 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
19896 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
19897 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
19898 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
19899
19900 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
19901 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
19902 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
19903
19904 @table @code
19905 @kindex info w32
19906 @item info w32
19907 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
19908 information about the target system and important OS structures.
19909
19910 @item info w32 selector
19911 This command displays information returned by
19912 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
19913 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
19914 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
19915 Without argument, this command displays information
19916 about the six segment registers.
19917
19918 @item info w32 thread-information-block
19919 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
19920 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
19921 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
19922
19923 @kindex info dll
19924 @item info dll
19925 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
19926
19927 @kindex dll-symbols
19928 @item dll-symbols
19929 This command is deprecated and will be removed in future versions
19930 of @value{GDBN}. Use the @code{sharedlibrary} command instead.
19931
19932 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
19933 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
19934
19935 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
19936 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
19937 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
19938 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
19939 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
19940 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
19941 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
19942 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
19943 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
19944 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
19945 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
19946
19947 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
19948 @item show cygwin-exceptions
19949 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
19950 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
19951
19952 @kindex set new-console
19953 @item set new-console @var{mode}
19954 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
19955 be started in a new console on next start.
19956 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
19957 be started in the same console as the debugger.
19958
19959 @kindex show new-console
19960 @item show new-console
19961 Displays whether a new console is used
19962 when the debuggee is started.
19963
19964 @kindex set new-group
19965 @item set new-group @var{mode}
19966 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
19967 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
19968 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
19969 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
19970
19971 @kindex show new-group
19972 @item show new-group
19973 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
19974
19975 @kindex set debugevents
19976 @item set debugevents
19977 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
19978 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
19979 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
19980 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
19981 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
19982
19983 @kindex set debugexec
19984 @item set debugexec
19985 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
19986 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
19987
19988 @kindex set debugexceptions
19989 @item set debugexceptions
19990 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
19991 debuggee seen by the debugger.
19992
19993 @kindex set debugmemory
19994 @item set debugmemory
19995 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
19996 and writes by the debugger.
19997
19998 @kindex set shell
19999 @item set shell
20000 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
20001 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
20002
20003 @kindex show shell
20004 @item show shell
20005 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
20006
20007 @end table
20008
20009 @menu
20010 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
20011 @end menu
20012
20013 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
20014 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
20015 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
20016 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
20017
20018 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
20019 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
20020 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
20021 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
20022 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
20023 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
20024 ``minimal symbols''.
20025
20026 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
20027 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
20028 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
20029 program run once to completion.
20030
20031 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
20032
20033 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
20034 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
20035 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
20036 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
20037 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
20038 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
20039 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
20040 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
20041 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
20042
20043 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
20044 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
20045 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
20046 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
20047 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
20048 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
20049
20050 @smallexample
20051 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
20052 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
20053
20054 Non-debugging symbols:
20055 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
20056 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
20057 @end smallexample
20058
20059 @smallexample
20060 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
20061 All functions matching regular expression "!":
20062
20063 Non-debugging symbols:
20064 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
20065 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
20066 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
20067 [etc...]
20068 @end smallexample
20069
20070 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
20071
20072 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
20073 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
20074 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
20075 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
20076 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
20077 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
20078 a function within a DLL without a running program.
20079
20080 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
20081 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
20082 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
20083 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
20084 problem:
20085
20086 @smallexample
20087 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
20088 $1 = 268572168
20089 @end smallexample
20090
20091 @smallexample
20092 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
20093 0x10021610: "\230y\""
20094 @end smallexample
20095
20096 And two possible solutions:
20097
20098 @smallexample
20099 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
20100 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
20101 @end smallexample
20102
20103 @smallexample
20104 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
20105 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
20106 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
20107 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
20108 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
20109 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
20110 @end smallexample
20111
20112 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
20113 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
20114 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
20115 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
20116 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
20117
20118 @smallexample
20119 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
20120 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
20121 @end smallexample
20122
20123 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
20124 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
20125 safe.
20126
20127 @node Hurd Native
20128 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
20129 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
20130
20131 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
20132 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
20133
20134 @table @code
20135 @item set signals
20136 @itemx set sigs
20137 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
20138 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
20139 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
20140 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
20141 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
20142 @code{signals}.
20143
20144 @item show signals
20145 @itemx show sigs
20146 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
20147 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
20148 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
20149
20150 @item set signal-thread
20151 @itemx set sigthread
20152 @kindex set signal-thread
20153 @kindex set sigthread
20154 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
20155 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
20156 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
20157 signal-thread}.
20158
20159 @item show signal-thread
20160 @itemx show sigthread
20161 @kindex show signal-thread
20162 @kindex show sigthread
20163 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
20164 delivered a signal.
20165
20166 @item set stopped
20167 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
20168 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
20169 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
20170 continued by delivering a signal to it.
20171
20172 @item show stopped
20173 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
20174 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
20175 stopped.
20176
20177 @item set exceptions
20178 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
20179 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
20180 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
20181 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
20182 trapping on.
20183
20184 @item show exceptions
20185 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
20186 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
20187
20188 @item set task pause
20189 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
20190 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20191 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20192 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
20193 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
20194 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
20195 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
20196 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
20197 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
20198
20199 @item show task pause
20200 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
20201 Show the current state of task suspension.
20202
20203 @item set task detach-suspend-count
20204 @cindex task suspend count
20205 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20206 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
20207 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
20208
20209 @item show task detach-suspend-count
20210 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
20211
20212 @item set task exception-port
20213 @itemx set task excp
20214 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20215 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
20216 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
20217 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
20218
20219 @item set noninvasive
20220 @cindex noninvasive task options
20221 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
20222 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
20223 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
20224 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
20225
20226 @item info send-rights
20227 @itemx info receive-rights
20228 @itemx info port-rights
20229 @itemx info port-sets
20230 @itemx info dead-names
20231 @itemx info ports
20232 @itemx info psets
20233 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20234 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20235 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20236 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20237 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20238 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
20239 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
20240 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
20241 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
20242
20243 @item set thread pause
20244 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
20245 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20246 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20247 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
20248 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
20249 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
20250 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
20251 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
20252 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
20253 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
20254 only the current thread.
20255
20256 @item show thread pause
20257 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
20258 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
20259
20260 @item set thread run
20261 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
20262
20263 @item show thread run
20264 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
20265
20266 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
20267 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20268 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20269 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
20270 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
20271 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
20272 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
20273
20274 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
20275 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
20276 detaching.
20277
20278 @item set thread exception-port
20279 @itemx set thread excp
20280 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
20281 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
20282 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
20283
20284 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
20285 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
20286 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
20287 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
20288
20289 @item set thread default
20290 @itemx show thread default
20291 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20292 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
20293 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
20294 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
20295 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
20296 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
20297 the non-default commands.
20298 @end table
20299
20300 @node Darwin
20301 @subsection Darwin
20302 @cindex Darwin
20303
20304 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
20305
20306 @table @code
20307 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
20308 @kindex set debug darwin
20309 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
20310 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
20311
20312 @item show debug darwin
20313 @kindex show debug darwin
20314 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
20315
20316 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
20317 @kindex set debug mach-o
20318 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
20319 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
20320 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
20321 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
20322 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
20323 usage.
20324
20325 @item show debug mach-o
20326 @kindex show debug mach-o
20327 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
20328
20329 @item set mach-exceptions on
20330 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
20331 @kindex set mach-exceptions
20332 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
20333 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
20334 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
20335 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
20336
20337 @item show mach-exceptions
20338 @kindex show mach-exceptions
20339 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
20340 @end table
20341
20342
20343 @node Embedded OS
20344 @section Embedded Operating Systems
20345
20346 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
20347 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
20348 architectures.
20349
20350 @menu
20351 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
20352 @end menu
20353
20354 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
20355 various real-time operating systems.
20356
20357 @node VxWorks
20358 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
20359
20360 @cindex VxWorks
20361
20362 @table @code
20363
20364 @kindex target vxworks
20365 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
20366 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
20367 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
20368
20369 @end table
20370
20371 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
20372 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
20373
20374 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
20375 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
20376 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
20377 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
20378 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
20379 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
20380 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
20381
20382 @table @code
20383 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
20384 @kindex vxworks-timeout
20385 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
20386 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
20387 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
20388 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
20389 of a thin network line.
20390 @end table
20391
20392 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
20393 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
20394 procedures.
20395
20396 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
20397 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
20398 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
20399 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
20400 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
20401 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
20402 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
20403 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
20404 manual.
20405 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
20406
20407 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
20408 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
20409 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
20410 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
20411
20412 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
20413
20414 @smallexample
20415 (vxgdb)
20416 @end smallexample
20417
20418 @menu
20419 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
20420 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
20421 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
20422 @end menu
20423
20424 @node VxWorks Connection
20425 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
20426
20427 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
20428 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
20429
20430 @smallexample
20431 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
20432 @end smallexample
20433
20434 @need 750
20435 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
20436
20437 @smallexample
20438 Attaching remote machine across net...
20439 Connected to tt.
20440 @end smallexample
20441
20442 @need 1000
20443 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
20444 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
20445 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
20446 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
20447 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
20448
20449 @smallexample
20450 prog.o: No such file or directory.
20451 @end smallexample
20452
20453 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
20454 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
20455 command again.
20456
20457 @node VxWorks Download
20458 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
20459
20460 @cindex download to VxWorks
20461 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
20462 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
20463 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
20464 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
20465 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
20466 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
20467 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
20468 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
20469 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
20470 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
20471 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
20472 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
20473 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
20474 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
20475 program, type this on VxWorks:
20476
20477 @smallexample
20478 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
20479 @end smallexample
20480
20481 @noindent
20482 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
20483
20484 @smallexample
20485 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
20486 (vxgdb) load prog.o
20487 @end smallexample
20488
20489 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
20490
20491 @smallexample
20492 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
20493 @end smallexample
20494
20495 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
20496 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
20497 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
20498 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
20499 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
20500 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
20501 table.)
20502
20503 @node VxWorks Attach
20504 @subsubsection Running Tasks
20505
20506 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
20507 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
20508 follows:
20509
20510 @smallexample
20511 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
20512 @end smallexample
20513
20514 @noindent
20515 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
20516 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
20517 the time of attachment.
20518
20519 @node Embedded Processors
20520 @section Embedded Processors
20521
20522 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
20523 configurations.
20524
20525 @cindex send command to simulator
20526 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
20527 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
20528
20529 @table @code
20530 @item sim @var{command}
20531 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
20532 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
20533 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
20534 acceptable commands.
20535 @end table
20536
20537
20538 @menu
20539 * ARM:: ARM RDI
20540 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
20541 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
20542 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
20543 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
20544 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
20545 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
20546 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
20547 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
20548 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
20549 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
20550 * CRIS:: CRIS
20551 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
20552 @end menu
20553
20554 @node ARM
20555 @subsection ARM
20556 @cindex ARM RDI
20557
20558 @table @code
20559 @kindex target rdi
20560 @item target rdi @var{dev}
20561 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
20562 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
20563 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
20564
20565 @kindex target rdp
20566 @item target rdp @var{dev}
20567 ARM Demon monitor.
20568
20569 @end table
20570
20571 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
20572
20573 @table @code
20574 @item set arm disassembler
20575 @kindex set arm
20576 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
20577 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
20578
20579 @item show arm disassembler
20580 @kindex show arm
20581 Show the current disassembly style.
20582
20583 @item set arm apcs32
20584 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
20585 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
20586
20587 @item show arm apcs32
20588 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
20589
20590 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
20591 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
20592 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
20593
20594 @table @code
20595 @item auto
20596 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
20597 @item softfpa
20598 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
20599 processors.
20600 @item fpa
20601 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
20602 @item softvfp
20603 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
20604 @item vfp
20605 VFP co-processor.
20606 @end table
20607
20608 @item show arm fpu
20609 Show the current type of the FPU.
20610
20611 @item set arm abi
20612 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
20613
20614 @item show arm abi
20615 Show the currently used ABI.
20616
20617 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
20618 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
20619 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
20620 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
20621 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
20622 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
20623 register).
20624
20625 @item show arm fallback-mode
20626 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
20627
20628 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
20629 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
20630 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
20631 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
20632 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
20633
20634 @item show arm force-mode
20635 Show the current forced instruction mode.
20636
20637 @item set debug arm
20638 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
20639 target support subsystem.
20640
20641 @item show debug arm
20642 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
20643 @end table
20644
20645 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
20646 using the RDI interface:
20647
20648 @table @code
20649 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
20650 @kindex rdilogfile
20651 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
20652 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
20653 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
20654 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
20655 @file{rdi.log}.
20656
20657 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
20658 @kindex rdilogenable
20659 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
20660 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
20661 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
20662 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
20663 are logged to a file.
20664
20665 @item set rdiromatzero
20666 @kindex set rdiromatzero
20667 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
20668 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
20669 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
20670 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
20671 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
20672
20673 @item show rdiromatzero
20674 @kindex show rdiromatzero
20675 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
20676
20677 @item set rdiheartbeat
20678 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
20679 @cindex RDI heartbeat
20680 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
20681 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
20682 well as the Angel monitor.
20683
20684 @item show rdiheartbeat
20685 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
20686 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
20687 @end table
20688
20689 @table @code
20690 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
20691 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
20692
20693 @table @code
20694 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
20695 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support.
20696 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
20697 The default value is @code{all}.
20698
20699 @table @code
20700 @item none
20701 @item demon
20702 @item angel
20703 @item redboot
20704 @item all
20705 @end table
20706 @end table
20707 @end table
20708
20709 @node M32R/D
20710 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
20711
20712 @table @code
20713 @kindex target m32r
20714 @item target m32r @var{dev}
20715 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
20716
20717 @kindex target m32rsdi
20718 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
20719 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
20720 @end table
20721
20722 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
20723
20724 @table @code
20725 @item set download-path @var{path}
20726 @kindex set download-path
20727 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
20728 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
20729
20730 @item show download-path
20731 @kindex show download-path
20732 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
20733
20734 @item set board-address @var{addr}
20735 @kindex set board-address
20736 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
20737 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
20738
20739 @item show board-address
20740 @kindex show board-address
20741 Show the current IP address of the target board.
20742
20743 @item set server-address @var{addr}
20744 @kindex set server-address
20745 @cindex download server address (M32R)
20746 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
20747 host machine.
20748
20749 @item show server-address
20750 @kindex show server-address
20751 Display the IP address of the download server.
20752
20753 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
20754 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
20755 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
20756 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
20757 executable file is uploaded.
20758
20759 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
20760 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
20761 Test the @code{upload} command.
20762 @end table
20763
20764 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
20765
20766 @table @code
20767 @item sdireset
20768 @kindex sdireset
20769 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
20770 This command resets the SDI connection.
20771
20772 @item sdistatus
20773 @kindex sdistatus
20774 This command shows the SDI connection status.
20775
20776 @item debug_chaos
20777 @kindex debug_chaos
20778 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
20779 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
20780
20781 @item use_debug_dma
20782 @kindex use_debug_dma
20783 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
20784
20785 @item use_mon_code
20786 @kindex use_mon_code
20787 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
20788
20789 @item use_ib_break
20790 @kindex use_ib_break
20791 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
20792
20793 @item use_dbt_break
20794 @kindex use_dbt_break
20795 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
20796 @end table
20797
20798 @node M68K
20799 @subsection M68k
20800
20801 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
20802 target command for the following ROM monitor.
20803
20804 @table @code
20805
20806 @kindex target dbug
20807 @item target dbug @var{dev}
20808 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
20809
20810 @end table
20811
20812 @node MicroBlaze
20813 @subsection MicroBlaze
20814 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
20815 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
20816
20817 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
20818 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
20819 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
20820 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
20821 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
20822 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
20823 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
20824 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
20825 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
20826 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
20827 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
20828
20829 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
20830
20831 @table @code
20832 @item target remote :1234
20833 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
20834 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
20835
20836 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
20837 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
20838 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
20839
20840 @item load
20841 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
20842
20843 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
20844 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
20845
20846 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
20847 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
20848 @end table
20849
20850 @node MIPS Embedded
20851 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
20852
20853 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} boards
20854 @value{GDBN} can use the @acronym{MIPS} remote debugging protocol to talk to a
20855 @acronym{MIPS} board attached to a serial line. This is available when
20856 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-elf}.
20857
20858 @need 1000
20859 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
20860
20861 @table @code
20862 @item target mips @var{port}
20863 @kindex target mips @var{port}
20864 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
20865 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
20866 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
20867 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
20868 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
20869 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
20870
20871 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
20872 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
20873 debugger:
20874
20875 @smallexample
20876 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
20877 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
20878 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
20879 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
20880 (@value{GDBP}) run
20881 @end smallexample
20882
20883 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
20884 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
20885 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
20886 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
20887 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
20888
20889 @item target pmon @var{port}
20890 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
20891 PMON ROM monitor.
20892
20893 @item target ddb @var{port}
20894 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
20895 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
20896
20897 @item target lsi @var{port}
20898 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
20899 LSI variant of PMON.
20900
20901 @kindex target r3900
20902 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
20903 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
20904
20905 @kindex target array
20906 @item target array @var{dev}
20907 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
20908
20909 @end table
20910
20911
20912 @noindent
20913 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
20914
20915 @table @code
20916 @item set mipsfpu double
20917 @itemx set mipsfpu single
20918 @itemx set mipsfpu none
20919 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
20920 @itemx show mipsfpu
20921 @kindex set mipsfpu
20922 @kindex show mipsfpu
20923 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
20924 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
20925 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
20926 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
20927 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
20928 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
20929 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
20930 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
20931 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
20932 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
20933 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
20934 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
20935 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
20936
20937 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
20938 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
20939 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
20940
20941 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
20942 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
20943
20944 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
20945 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
20946 @itemx show timeout
20947 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
20948 @cindex @code{timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
20949 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
20950 @kindex set timeout
20951 @kindex show timeout
20952 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
20953 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
20954 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the @acronym{MIPS}
20955 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
20956 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
20957 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
20958 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
20959 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
20960 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
20961 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-elf}.)
20962
20963 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
20964 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
20965 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
20966 to run before stopping.
20967
20968 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
20969 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20970 @cindex synchronize with remote @acronym{MIPS} target
20971 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
20972 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
20973 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
20974
20975 @item show syn-garbage-limit
20976 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20977 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
20978 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
20979
20980 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
20981 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20982 @cindex remote monitor prompt
20983 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
20984 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
20985 @table @asis
20986 @item pmon target
20987 @samp{PMON}
20988 @item ddb target
20989 @samp{NEC010}
20990 @item lsi target
20991 @samp{PMON>}
20992 @end table
20993
20994 @item show monitor-prompt
20995 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20996 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
20997 remote monitor.
20998
20999 @item set monitor-warnings
21000 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21001 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
21002 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
21003 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
21004 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
21005
21006 @item show monitor-warnings
21007 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21008 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
21009
21010 @item pmon @var{command}
21011 @kindex pmon@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21012 @cindex send PMON command
21013 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
21014 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
21015 @end table
21016
21017 @node PowerPC Embedded
21018 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
21019
21020 @cindex DVC register
21021 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
21022 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
21023
21024 @smallexample
21025 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
21026 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
21027 @end smallexample
21028
21029 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
21030 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
21031 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
21032 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
21033 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
21034 or newer.
21035
21036 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
21037 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
21038 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
21039 watching variables of scalar types.
21040
21041 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
21042 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
21043
21044 @smallexample
21045 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
21046 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
21047 @end smallexample
21048
21049 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
21050 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
21051
21052 @cindex ranged breakpoint
21053 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
21054 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
21055 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
21056 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
21057 use the @code{break-range} command.
21058
21059 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
21060
21061 @table @code
21062 @kindex break-range
21063 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
21064 Set a breakpoint for an address range.
21065 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location} can specify a function name,
21066 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
21067 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
21068 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
21069 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
21070 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
21071 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
21072
21073 @kindex set powerpc
21074 @item set powerpc soft-float
21075 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
21076 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
21077 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
21078 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21079
21080 @item set powerpc vector-abi
21081 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
21082 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
21083 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
21084 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
21085 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
21086 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
21087 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21088
21089 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
21090 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
21091 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
21092 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
21093 address of its first byte.
21094
21095 @kindex target dink32
21096 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
21097 DINK32 ROM monitor.
21098
21099 @kindex target ppcbug
21100 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
21101 @kindex target ppcbug1
21102 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
21103 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
21104
21105 @kindex target sds
21106 @item target sds @var{dev}
21107 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
21108 @end table
21109
21110 @cindex SDS protocol
21111 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
21112 by @value{GDBN}:
21113
21114 @table @code
21115 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
21116 @kindex set sdstimeout
21117 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
21118 default is 2 seconds.
21119
21120 @item show sdstimeout
21121 @kindex show sdstimeout
21122 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
21123
21124 @item sds @var{command}
21125 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
21126 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
21127 @end table
21128
21129
21130 @node PA
21131 @subsection HP PA Embedded
21132
21133 @table @code
21134
21135 @kindex target op50n
21136 @item target op50n @var{dev}
21137 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
21138
21139 @kindex target w89k
21140 @item target w89k @var{dev}
21141 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
21142
21143 @end table
21144
21145 @node Sparclet
21146 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
21147
21148 @cindex Sparclet
21149
21150 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
21151 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
21152 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
21153 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
21154 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
21155
21156 @table @code
21157 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
21158 @kindex remotetimeout
21159 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
21160 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
21161 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
21162 @end table
21163
21164 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
21165 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
21166 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
21167 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
21168 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
21169
21170 @smallexample
21171 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
21172 @end smallexample
21173
21174 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
21175
21176 @smallexample
21177 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
21178 @end smallexample
21179
21180 @cindex running, on Sparclet
21181 Once you have set
21182 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
21183 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
21184 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
21185
21186 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
21187
21188 @smallexample
21189 (gdbslet)
21190 @end smallexample
21191
21192 @menu
21193 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
21194 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
21195 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
21196 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
21197 @end menu
21198
21199 @node Sparclet File
21200 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
21201
21202 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
21203
21204 @smallexample
21205 (gdbslet) file prog
21206 @end smallexample
21207
21208 @need 1000
21209 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
21210 @value{GDBN} locates
21211 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
21212 path.
21213 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
21214 files will be searched as well.
21215 @value{GDBN} locates
21216 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
21217 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
21218 If it fails
21219 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
21220
21221 @smallexample
21222 prog: No such file or directory.
21223 @end smallexample
21224
21225 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
21226 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
21227 @code{target} command again.
21228
21229 @node Sparclet Connection
21230 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
21231
21232 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
21233 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
21234
21235 @smallexample
21236 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
21237 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
21238 main () at ../prog.c:3
21239 @end smallexample
21240
21241 @need 750
21242 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
21243
21244 @smallexample
21245 Connected to ttya.
21246 @end smallexample
21247
21248 @node Sparclet Download
21249 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
21250
21251 @cindex download to Sparclet
21252 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
21253 you can use the @value{GDBN}
21254 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
21255 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
21256 command.
21257 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
21258 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
21259 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
21260 of each of the file's sections.
21261 For instance, if the program
21262 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
21263 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
21264
21265 @smallexample
21266 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
21267 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
21268 @end smallexample
21269
21270 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
21271 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
21272 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
21273
21274 @node Sparclet Execution
21275 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
21276
21277 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
21278 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
21279 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
21280 manual for the list of commands.
21281
21282 @smallexample
21283 (gdbslet) b main
21284 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
21285 (gdbslet) run
21286 Starting program: prog
21287 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
21288 3 char *symarg = 0;
21289 (gdbslet) step
21290 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
21291 (gdbslet)
21292 @end smallexample
21293
21294 @node Sparclite
21295 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
21296
21297 @table @code
21298
21299 @kindex target sparclite
21300 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
21301 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
21302 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
21303 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
21304 remote protocol.
21305
21306 @end table
21307
21308 @node Z8000
21309 @subsection Zilog Z8000
21310
21311 @cindex Z8000
21312 @cindex simulator, Z8000
21313 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
21314
21315 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
21316 a Z8000 simulator.
21317
21318 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
21319 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
21320 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
21321 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
21322
21323 @table @code
21324 @item target sim @var{args}
21325 @kindex sim
21326 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
21327 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
21328 options, specify them via @var{args}.
21329 @end table
21330
21331 @noindent
21332 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
21333 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
21334 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
21335 to run your program, and so on.
21336
21337 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
21338 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
21339 additional items of information as specially named registers:
21340
21341 @table @code
21342
21343 @item cycles
21344 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
21345
21346 @item insts
21347 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
21348
21349 @item time
21350 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
21351
21352 @end table
21353
21354 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
21355 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
21356 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
21357 simulated clock ticks.
21358
21359 @node AVR
21360 @subsection Atmel AVR
21361 @cindex AVR
21362
21363 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
21364 following AVR-specific commands:
21365
21366 @table @code
21367 @item info io_registers
21368 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
21369 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
21370 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
21371 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
21372 @end table
21373
21374 @node CRIS
21375 @subsection CRIS
21376 @cindex CRIS
21377
21378 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
21379 following CRIS-specific commands:
21380
21381 @table @code
21382 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
21383 @cindex CRIS version
21384 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
21385 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
21386 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
21387
21388 @item show cris-version
21389 Show the current CRIS version.
21390
21391 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
21392 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
21393 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
21394 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
21395 @code{R59}.
21396
21397 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
21398 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
21399
21400 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
21401 @cindex CRIS mode
21402 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
21403 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
21404 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
21405
21406 @item show cris-mode
21407 Show the current CRIS mode.
21408 @end table
21409
21410 @node Super-H
21411 @subsection Renesas Super-H
21412 @cindex Super-H
21413
21414 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
21415 commands:
21416
21417 @table @code
21418 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
21419 @kindex set sh calling-convention
21420 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
21421 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
21422 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
21423 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
21424 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
21425 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
21426 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
21427 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
21428 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
21429 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
21430
21431 @item show sh calling-convention
21432 @kindex show sh calling-convention
21433 Show the current calling convention setting.
21434
21435 @end table
21436
21437
21438 @node Architectures
21439 @section Architectures
21440
21441 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
21442 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
21443
21444 @menu
21445 * AArch64::
21446 * i386::
21447 * Alpha::
21448 * MIPS::
21449 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
21450 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
21451 * PowerPC::
21452 * Nios II::
21453 @end menu
21454
21455 @node AArch64
21456 @subsection AArch64
21457 @cindex AArch64 support
21458
21459 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
21460 following special commands:
21461
21462 @table @code
21463 @item set debug aarch64
21464 @kindex set debug aarch64
21465 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
21466 messages are to be displayed.
21467
21468 @item show debug aarch64
21469 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
21470
21471 @end table
21472
21473 @node i386
21474 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
21475
21476 @table @code
21477 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
21478 @kindex set struct-convention
21479 @cindex struct return convention
21480 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
21481 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
21482 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
21483 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
21484 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
21485 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
21486 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
21487 be returned in a register.
21488
21489 @item show struct-convention
21490 @kindex show struct-convention
21491 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
21492 from functions.
21493 @end table
21494
21495 @subsubsection Intel(R) @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
21496 @cindex Intel(R) Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
21497
21498 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
21499 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
21500 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
21501 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
21502 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
21503 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
21504 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
21505
21506 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
21507 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
21508 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
21509 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
21510 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
21511 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
21512
21513 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
21514 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
21515 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
21516
21517 @smallexample
21518 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
21519 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
21520 @end smallexample
21521
21522 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
21523 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
21524 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
21525 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
21526 the pointer.
21527
21528 @node Alpha
21529 @subsection Alpha
21530
21531 See the following section.
21532
21533 @node MIPS
21534 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
21535
21536 @cindex stack on Alpha
21537 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
21538 @cindex Alpha stack
21539 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
21540 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
21541 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
21542 find the beginning of a function.
21543
21544 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
21545 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
21546 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
21547 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
21548 commands:
21549
21550 @table @code
21551 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
21552 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
21553 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
21554 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
21555 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
21556 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
21557 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
21558 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
21559
21560 @item show heuristic-fence-post
21561 Display the current limit.
21562 @end table
21563
21564 @noindent
21565 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
21566 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
21567
21568 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
21569 programs:
21570
21571 @table @code
21572 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
21573 @kindex set mips abi
21574 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
21575 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
21576 values of @var{arg} are:
21577
21578 @table @samp
21579 @item auto
21580 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
21581 default).
21582 @item o32
21583 @item o64
21584 @item n32
21585 @item n64
21586 @item eabi32
21587 @item eabi64
21588 @end table
21589
21590 @item show mips abi
21591 @kindex show mips abi
21592 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
21593
21594 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
21595 @kindex set mips compression
21596 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
21597 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
21598 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
21599 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
21600 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
21601 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
21602 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
21603 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
21604 provided by the executable.
21605
21606 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
21607 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
21608 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
21609 identified as such.
21610
21611 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
21612 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
21613 implicitly from an executable.
21614
21615 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
21616 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
21617 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
21618 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
21619 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
21620
21621 @item show mips compression
21622 @kindex show mips compression
21623 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
21624 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
21625
21626 @item set mipsfpu
21627 @itemx show mipsfpu
21628 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
21629
21630 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
21631 @kindex set mips mask-address
21632 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
21633 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
21634 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
21635 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
21636 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
21637
21638 @item show mips mask-address
21639 @kindex show mips mask-address
21640 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
21641 not.
21642
21643 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21644 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21645 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
21646 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
21647 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
21648 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
21649
21650 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21651 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21652 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
21653
21654 @item set debug mips
21655 @kindex set debug mips
21656 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
21657 target code in @value{GDBN}.
21658
21659 @item show debug mips
21660 @kindex show debug mips
21661 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
21662 @end table
21663
21664
21665 @node HPPA
21666 @subsection HPPA
21667 @cindex HPPA support
21668
21669 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
21670 following special commands:
21671
21672 @table @code
21673 @item set debug hppa
21674 @kindex set debug hppa
21675 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
21676 messages are to be displayed.
21677
21678 @item show debug hppa
21679 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
21680
21681 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
21682 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
21683 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
21684 given @var{address}.
21685
21686 @end table
21687
21688
21689 @node SPU
21690 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
21691 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
21692 @cindex SPU
21693
21694 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
21695 it provides the following special commands:
21696
21697 @table @code
21698 @item info spu event
21699 @kindex info spu
21700 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
21701 and pending event status.
21702
21703 @item info spu signal
21704 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
21705 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
21706 notification channels.
21707
21708 @item info spu mailbox
21709 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
21710 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
21711 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
21712
21713 @item info spu dma
21714 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
21715 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
21716 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
21717
21718 @item info spu proxydma
21719 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
21720 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
21721 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
21722
21723 @end table
21724
21725 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
21726 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
21727 special commands:
21728
21729 @table @code
21730 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
21731 @kindex set spu
21732 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
21733 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
21734 function. The default is @code{off}.
21735
21736 @item show spu stop-on-load
21737 @kindex show spu
21738 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
21739
21740 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
21741 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
21742 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
21743 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
21744 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
21745 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
21746
21747 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
21748 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
21749
21750 @end table
21751
21752 @node PowerPC
21753 @subsection PowerPC
21754 @cindex PowerPC architecture
21755
21756 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
21757 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
21758 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
21759 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
21760 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
21761
21762 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
21763 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
21764 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
21765
21766 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
21767 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
21768
21769 @node Nios II
21770 @subsection Nios II
21771 @cindex Nios II architecture
21772
21773 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
21774 it provides the following special commands:
21775
21776 @table @code
21777
21778 @item set debug nios2
21779 @kindex set debug nios2
21780 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
21781 target code in @value{GDBN}.
21782
21783 @item show debug nios2
21784 @kindex show debug nios2
21785 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
21786 @end table
21787
21788 @node Controlling GDB
21789 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
21790
21791 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
21792 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
21793 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
21794 described here.
21795
21796 @menu
21797 * Prompt:: Prompt
21798 * Editing:: Command editing
21799 * Command History:: Command history
21800 * Screen Size:: Screen size
21801 * Numbers:: Numbers
21802 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
21803 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
21804 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
21805 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
21806 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
21807 @end menu
21808
21809 @node Prompt
21810 @section Prompt
21811
21812 @cindex prompt
21813
21814 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
21815 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
21816 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
21817 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
21818 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
21819 which one you are talking to.
21820
21821 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
21822 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
21823 or a prompt that does not.
21824
21825 @table @code
21826 @kindex set prompt
21827 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
21828 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
21829
21830 @kindex show prompt
21831 @item show prompt
21832 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
21833 @end table
21834
21835 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
21836 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
21837 are:
21838
21839 @table @code
21840 @kindex set extended-prompt
21841 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
21842 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
21843 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
21844 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
21845 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
21846 is displayed.
21847
21848 For example:
21849
21850 @smallexample
21851 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
21852 @end smallexample
21853
21854 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
21855 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
21856
21857 @kindex show extended-prompt
21858 @item show extended-prompt
21859 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
21860 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
21861 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
21862 @end table
21863
21864 @node Editing
21865 @section Command Editing
21866 @cindex readline
21867 @cindex command line editing
21868
21869 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
21870 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
21871 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
21872 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
21873 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
21874 debugging sessions.
21875
21876 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
21877 command @code{set}.
21878
21879 @table @code
21880 @kindex set editing
21881 @cindex editing
21882 @item set editing
21883 @itemx set editing on
21884 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
21885
21886 @item set editing off
21887 Disable command line editing.
21888
21889 @kindex show editing
21890 @item show editing
21891 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
21892 @end table
21893
21894 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
21895 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
21896 @end ifset
21897 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
21898 @xref{Command Line Editing},
21899 @end ifclear
21900 for more details about the Readline
21901 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
21902 encouraged to read that chapter.
21903
21904 @node Command History
21905 @section Command History
21906 @cindex command history
21907
21908 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
21909 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
21910 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
21911 history facility.
21912
21913 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
21914 package, to provide the history facility.
21915 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
21916 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
21917 @end ifset
21918 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
21919 @xref{Using History Interactively},
21920 @end ifclear
21921 for the detailed description of the History library.
21922
21923 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
21924 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
21925 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
21926 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
21927 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
21928 pressed on a line by itself.
21929
21930 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
21931 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
21932 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
21933 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
21934
21935 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
21936 history.
21937
21938 @table @code
21939 @cindex history substitution
21940 @cindex history file
21941 @kindex set history filename
21942 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
21943 @item set history filename @var{fname}
21944 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
21945 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
21946 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
21947 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
21948 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
21949 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
21950 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
21951 is not set.
21952
21953 @cindex save command history
21954 @kindex set history save
21955 @item set history save
21956 @itemx set history save on
21957 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
21958 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
21959
21960 @item set history save off
21961 Stop recording command history in a file.
21962
21963 @cindex history size
21964 @kindex set history size
21965 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
21966 @item set history size @var{size}
21967 @itemx set history size unlimited
21968 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
21969 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
21970 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set. If @var{size}
21971 is @code{unlimited}, the number of commands @value{GDBN} keeps in the
21972 history list is unlimited.
21973 @end table
21974
21975 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
21976 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
21977 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
21978 @end ifset
21979 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
21980 @xref{Event Designators},
21981 @end ifclear
21982 for more details.
21983
21984 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
21985 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
21986 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
21987 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
21988 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
21989 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
21990 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
21991 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
21992
21993 The commands to control history expansion are:
21994
21995 @table @code
21996 @item set history expansion on
21997 @itemx set history expansion
21998 @kindex set history expansion
21999 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
22000
22001 @item set history expansion off
22002 Disable history expansion.
22003
22004 @c @group
22005 @kindex show history
22006 @item show history
22007 @itemx show history filename
22008 @itemx show history save
22009 @itemx show history size
22010 @itemx show history expansion
22011 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
22012 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
22013 @c @end group
22014 @end table
22015
22016 @table @code
22017 @kindex show commands
22018 @cindex show last commands
22019 @cindex display command history
22020 @item show commands
22021 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
22022
22023 @item show commands @var{n}
22024 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
22025
22026 @item show commands +
22027 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
22028 @end table
22029
22030 @node Screen Size
22031 @section Screen Size
22032 @cindex size of screen
22033 @cindex pauses in output
22034
22035 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
22036 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
22037 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
22038 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
22039 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
22040 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
22041 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
22042 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
22043
22044 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
22045 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
22046 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
22047 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
22048 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
22049 width} commands:
22050
22051 @table @code
22052 @kindex set height
22053 @kindex set width
22054 @kindex show width
22055 @kindex show height
22056 @item set height @var{lpp}
22057 @itemx set height unlimited
22058 @itemx show height
22059 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
22060 @itemx set width unlimited
22061 @itemx show width
22062 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
22063 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
22064 commands display the current settings.
22065
22066 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
22067 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
22068 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
22069 buffer.
22070
22071 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
22072 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
22073
22074 @item set pagination on
22075 @itemx set pagination off
22076 @kindex set pagination
22077 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
22078 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
22079 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
22080 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
22081
22082 @item show pagination
22083 @kindex show pagination
22084 Show the current pagination mode.
22085 @end table
22086
22087 @node Numbers
22088 @section Numbers
22089 @cindex number representation
22090 @cindex entering numbers
22091
22092 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
22093 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
22094 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
22095 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
22096 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
22097 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
22098 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
22099 both input and output with the commands described below.
22100
22101 @table @code
22102 @kindex set input-radix
22103 @item set input-radix @var{base}
22104 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
22105 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
22106 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
22107 example, any of
22108
22109 @smallexample
22110 set input-radix 012
22111 set input-radix 10.
22112 set input-radix 0xa
22113 @end smallexample
22114
22115 @noindent
22116 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
22117 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
22118 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
22119 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
22120 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
22121 change the radix.
22122
22123 @kindex set output-radix
22124 @item set output-radix @var{base}
22125 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
22126 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
22127 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
22128
22129 @kindex show input-radix
22130 @item show input-radix
22131 Display the current default base for numeric input.
22132
22133 @kindex show output-radix
22134 @item show output-radix
22135 Display the current default base for numeric display.
22136
22137 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
22138 @itemx show radix
22139 @kindex set radix
22140 @kindex show radix
22141 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
22142 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
22143 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
22144 default value of 10.
22145
22146 @end table
22147
22148 @node ABI
22149 @section Configuring the Current ABI
22150
22151 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
22152 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
22153 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
22154 current ABI.
22155
22156 @cindex OS ABI
22157 @kindex set osabi
22158 @kindex show osabi
22159 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
22160
22161 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
22162 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
22163 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
22164 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
22165 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
22166 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
22167 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
22168 platform provides.
22169
22170 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
22171 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
22172 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
22173 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
22174
22175 @table @code
22176 @item show osabi
22177 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
22178
22179 @item set osabi
22180 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
22181
22182 @item set osabi @var{abi}
22183 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
22184 @end table
22185
22186 @cindex float promotion
22187
22188 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
22189 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
22190 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
22191 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
22192 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
22193 @code{double} and then passed.
22194
22195 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
22196 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
22197 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
22198
22199 @table @code
22200 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
22201 @item set coerce-float-to-double
22202 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
22203 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
22204 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
22205
22206 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
22207 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
22208 functions.
22209
22210 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
22211 @item show coerce-float-to-double
22212 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
22213 @end table
22214
22215 @kindex set cp-abi
22216 @kindex show cp-abi
22217 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
22218 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
22219 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
22220 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
22221 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
22222 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
22223 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
22224 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
22225 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
22226 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
22227 ``auto''.
22228
22229 @table @code
22230 @item show cp-abi
22231 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
22232
22233 @item set cp-abi
22234 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
22235
22236 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
22237 @itemx set cp-abi auto
22238 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
22239 @end table
22240
22241 @node Auto-loading
22242 @section Automatically loading associated files
22243 @cindex auto-loading
22244
22245 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
22246 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
22247 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
22248 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
22249 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
22250 sources).
22251
22252 @menu
22253 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
22254 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
22255
22256 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
22257 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
22258 @end menu
22259
22260 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
22261 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
22262 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
22263
22264 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
22265 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
22266 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22267
22268 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
22269 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
22270
22271 @table @code
22272 @anchor{set auto-load off}
22273 @kindex set auto-load off
22274 @item set auto-load off
22275 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
22276 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
22277 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
22278 @smallexample
22279 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
22280 @end smallexample
22281
22282 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
22283 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
22284 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
22285 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
22286 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
22287 @code{set auto-load no}.
22288
22289 @anchor{show auto-load}
22290 @kindex show auto-load
22291 @item show auto-load
22292 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
22293 or disabled.
22294
22295 @smallexample
22296 (gdb) show auto-load
22297 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
22298 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
22299 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
22300 is on.
22301 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
22302 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
22303 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22304 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
22305 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22306 @end smallexample
22307
22308 @anchor{info auto-load}
22309 @kindex info auto-load
22310 @item info auto-load
22311 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
22312 not.
22313
22314 @smallexample
22315 (gdb) info auto-load
22316 gdb-scripts:
22317 Loaded Script
22318 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
22319 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
22320 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
22321 loaded.
22322 python-scripts:
22323 Loaded Script
22324 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
22325 @end smallexample
22326 @end table
22327
22328 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
22329
22330 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
22331 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
22332 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
22333 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
22334 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
22335 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
22336 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
22337 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22338 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22339 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22340 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22341 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22342 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22343 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
22344 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22345 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
22346 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22347 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
22348 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22349 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
22350 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22351 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
22352 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22353 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
22354 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22355 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
22356 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
22357 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
22358 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
22359 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22360 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
22361 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22362 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
22363 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22364 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
22365 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
22366 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
22367 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
22368 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
22369 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
22370 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
22371 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
22372 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
22373 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
22374 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
22375 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
22376 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
22377 @end multitable
22378
22379 @node Init File in the Current Directory
22380 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
22381 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
22382
22383 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
22384 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
22385 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
22386
22387 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
22388 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22389
22390 @table @code
22391 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
22392 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
22393 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
22394 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
22395 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
22396
22397 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
22398 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
22399 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
22400 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
22401 current directory is enabled or disabled.
22402
22403 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
22404 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
22405 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
22406 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
22407 current directory have been auto-loaded.
22408 @end table
22409
22410 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
22411 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
22412 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
22413
22414 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
22415
22416 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
22417 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
22418
22419 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
22420 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
22421 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
22422 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
22423 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
22424 library.
22425
22426 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
22427 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22428
22429 @table @code
22430 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
22431 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
22432 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
22433 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
22434
22435 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
22436 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
22437 @item show auto-load libthread-db
22438 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
22439 enabled or disabled.
22440
22441 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
22442 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
22443 @item info auto-load libthread-db
22444 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
22445 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
22446 @end table
22447
22448 @node Auto-loading safe path
22449 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
22450 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
22451
22452 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
22453 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
22454 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
22455 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
22456 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
22457
22458 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
22459 get loaded:
22460
22461 @smallexample
22462 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
22463 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
22464 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
22465 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
22466 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
22467 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
22468 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
22469 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
22470 @end smallexample
22471
22472 @noindent
22473 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
22474 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
22475
22476 @smallexample
22477 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
22478 @end smallexample
22479
22480 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
22481
22482 @table @code
22483 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
22484 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
22485 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
22486 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
22487 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
22488 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
22489 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
22490 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
22491 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
22492 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
22493
22494 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
22495 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
22496 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
22497
22498 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
22499 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
22500 @item show auto-load safe-path
22501 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
22502 scripts.
22503
22504 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
22505 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
22506 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
22507 Add an entry (or list of entries) the list of directories trusted for automatic
22508 loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited by the
22509 host platform path separator in use.
22510 @end table
22511
22512 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
22513 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
22514 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
22515 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
22516 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
22517
22518 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
22519 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
22520 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
22521 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
22522 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
22523 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
22524 init file in the current directory
22525 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
22526
22527 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
22528 example, you could use one of the following ways:
22529
22530 @table @asis
22531 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
22532 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
22533 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
22534 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
22535
22536 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
22537 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
22538 @value{GDBN} session.
22539
22540 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
22541 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
22542 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
22543 from trusted sources.
22544
22545 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
22546 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
22547 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
22548 trusted sources.
22549 @end table
22550
22551 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
22552 also suppresses any such warning messages:
22553
22554 @table @asis
22555 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
22556 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
22557
22558 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
22559 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
22560 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
22561 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
22562 @end table
22563
22564 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
22565 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
22566 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
22567 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
22568 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
22569 recommended to be entered.
22570
22571 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
22572 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
22573 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
22574
22575 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
22576 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
22577 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
22578 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
22579 be printed.
22580
22581 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
22582 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
22583 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
22584
22585 @smallexample
22586 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
22587 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
22588 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
22589 for objfile "/tmp/true".
22590 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
22591 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
22592 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
22593 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
22594 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
22595 @end smallexample
22596
22597 @table @code
22598 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
22599 @kindex set debug auto-load
22600 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
22601 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
22602
22603 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
22604 @kindex show debug auto-load
22605 @item show debug auto-load
22606 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
22607 on or off.
22608 @end table
22609
22610 @node Messages/Warnings
22611 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
22612
22613 @cindex verbose operation
22614 @cindex optional warnings
22615 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
22616 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
22617 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
22618 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
22619
22620 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
22621 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
22622 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
22623
22624 @table @code
22625 @kindex set verbose
22626 @item set verbose on
22627 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
22628
22629 @item set verbose off
22630 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
22631
22632 @kindex show verbose
22633 @item show verbose
22634 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
22635 @end table
22636
22637 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
22638 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
22639 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
22640 Symbol Files}).
22641
22642 @table @code
22643
22644 @kindex set complaints
22645 @item set complaints @var{limit}
22646 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
22647 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
22648 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
22649 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
22650
22651 @kindex show complaints
22652 @item show complaints
22653 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
22654
22655 @end table
22656
22657 @anchor{confirmation requests}
22658 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
22659 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
22660 you try to run a program which is already running:
22661
22662 @smallexample
22663 (@value{GDBP}) run
22664 The program being debugged has been started already.
22665 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
22666 @end smallexample
22667
22668 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
22669 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
22670
22671 @table @code
22672
22673 @kindex set confirm
22674 @cindex flinching
22675 @cindex confirmation
22676 @cindex stupid questions
22677 @item set confirm off
22678 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
22679 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
22680 automatically disables confirmation requests.
22681
22682 @item set confirm on
22683 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
22684
22685 @kindex show confirm
22686 @item show confirm
22687 Displays state of confirmation requests.
22688
22689 @end table
22690
22691 @cindex command tracing
22692 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
22693 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
22694 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
22695 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
22696
22697 @table @code
22698 @kindex set trace-commands
22699 @cindex command scripts, debugging
22700 @item set trace-commands on
22701 Enable command tracing.
22702 @item set trace-commands off
22703 Disable command tracing.
22704 @item show trace-commands
22705 Display the current state of command tracing.
22706 @end table
22707
22708 @node Debugging Output
22709 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
22710 @cindex optional debugging messages
22711
22712 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
22713 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
22714 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
22715 section documents those commands.
22716
22717 @table @code
22718 @kindex set exec-done-display
22719 @item set exec-done-display
22720 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
22721 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
22722 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
22723 @kindex show exec-done-display
22724 @item show exec-done-display
22725 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
22726 notification.
22727 @kindex set debug
22728 @cindex ARM AArch64
22729 @item set debug aarch64
22730 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
22731 The default is off.
22732 @kindex show debug
22733 @item show debug aarch64
22734 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
22735 ARM AArch64.
22736 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
22737 @cindex architecture debugging info
22738 @item set debug arch
22739 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
22740 @item show debug arch
22741 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
22742 @item set debug aix-solib
22743 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
22744 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
22745 support module. The default is off.
22746 @item show debug aix-thread
22747 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
22748 @item set debug aix-thread
22749 @cindex AIX threads
22750 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
22751 module.
22752 @item show debug aix-thread
22753 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
22754 @item set debug check-physname
22755 @cindex physname
22756 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
22757 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
22758 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
22759 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
22760 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
22761 both ways and display any discrepancies.
22762 @item show debug check-physname
22763 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
22764 @item set debug coff-pe-read
22765 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
22766 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
22767 exported symbols. The default is off.
22768 @item show debug coff-pe-read
22769 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
22770 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
22771 @item set debug dwarf2-die
22772 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
22773 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
22774 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
22775 A value of zero turns off the display.
22776 @item show debug dwarf2-die
22777 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
22778 @item set debug dwarf2-read
22779 @cindex DWARF2 Reading
22780 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
22781 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
22782 A value of 1 provides basic information.
22783 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
22784 @item show debug dwarf2-read
22785 Show the current state of DWARF2 reader debugging.
22786 @item set debug displaced
22787 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
22788 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
22789 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
22790 @item show debug displaced
22791 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
22792 related to displaced stepping.
22793 @item set debug event
22794 @cindex event debugging info
22795 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
22796 default is off.
22797 @item show debug event
22798 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
22799 info.
22800 @item set debug expression
22801 @cindex expression debugging info
22802 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
22803 expression parsing. The default is off.
22804 @item show debug expression
22805 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
22806 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
22807 @item set debug frame
22808 @cindex frame debugging info
22809 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
22810 default is off.
22811 @item show debug frame
22812 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
22813 info.
22814 @item set debug gnu-nat
22815 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
22816 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
22817 @item show debug gnu-nat
22818 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
22819 @item set debug infrun
22820 @cindex inferior debugging info
22821 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
22822 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
22823 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
22824 @item show debug infrun
22825 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
22826 @item set debug jit
22827 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
22828 Turns on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
22829 @item show debug jit
22830 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
22831 @item set debug lin-lwp
22832 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
22833 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
22834 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
22835 @item show debug lin-lwp
22836 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
22837 @item set debug mach-o
22838 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
22839 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
22840 processing. The default is off.
22841 @item show debug mach-o
22842 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
22843 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
22844 @item set debug notification
22845 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
22846 Turns on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
22847 The default is off.
22848 @item show debug notification
22849 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
22850 @item set debug observer
22851 @cindex observer debugging info
22852 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
22853 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
22854 @item show debug observer
22855 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
22856 @item set debug overload
22857 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
22858 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
22859 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
22860 is off.
22861 @item show debug overload
22862 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
22863 debugging info.
22864 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
22865 @cindex debug expression parser
22866 @item set debug parser
22867 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
22868 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
22869 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
22870 details. The default is off.
22871 @item show debug parser
22872 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
22873 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
22874 @cindex serial connections, debugging
22875 @cindex debug remote protocol
22876 @cindex remote protocol debugging
22877 @cindex display remote packets
22878 @item set debug remote
22879 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
22880 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
22881 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
22882 @item show debug remote
22883 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
22884 @item set debug serial
22885 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
22886 default is off.
22887 @item show debug serial
22888 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
22889 info.
22890 @item set debug solib-frv
22891 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
22892 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
22893 @item show debug solib-frv
22894 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
22895 messages.
22896 @item set debug symfile
22897 @cindex symbol file functions
22898 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
22899 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
22900 @item show debug symfile
22901 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
22902 @item set debug symtab-create
22903 @cindex symbol table creation
22904 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
22905 The default is 0 (off).
22906 A value of 1 provides basic information.
22907 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
22908 @item show debug symtab-create
22909 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
22910 @item set debug target
22911 @cindex target debugging info
22912 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
22913 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
22914 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
22915 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
22916 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
22917 @item show debug target
22918 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
22919 info.
22920 @item set debug timestamp
22921 @cindex timestampping debugging info
22922 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
22923 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
22924 message.
22925 @item show debug timestamp
22926 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
22927 debugging info.
22928 @item set debugvarobj
22929 @cindex variable object debugging info
22930 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
22931 info. The default is off.
22932 @item show debugvarobj
22933 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
22934 debugging info.
22935 @item set debug xml
22936 @cindex XML parser debugging
22937 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
22938 @item show debug xml
22939 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
22940 @end table
22941
22942 @node Other Misc Settings
22943 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
22944 @cindex miscellaneous settings
22945
22946 @table @code
22947 @kindex set interactive-mode
22948 @item set interactive-mode
22949 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
22950 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
22951 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
22952 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
22953 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
22954 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
22955 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
22956 is, non-interactively otherwise.
22957
22958 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
22959 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
22960 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
22961 inside a cygwin window.
22962
22963 @kindex show interactive-mode
22964 @item show interactive-mode
22965 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
22966 @end table
22967
22968 @node Extending GDB
22969 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
22970 @cindex extending GDB
22971
22972 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
22973 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
22974 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
22975 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
22976 being debugged.
22977
22978 @menu
22979 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
22980 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
22981 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
22982 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
22983 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
22984 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
22985 @end menu
22986
22987 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
22988 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
22989 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
22990 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
22991 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
22992 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
22993
22994 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
22995 setting:
22996
22997 @table @code
22998 @kindex set script-extension
22999 @kindex show script-extension
23000 @item set script-extension off
23001 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23002
23003 @item set script-extension soft
23004 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23005 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
23006 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
23007 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
23008
23009 @item set script-extension strict
23010 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23011 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
23012 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
23013
23014 @item show script-extension
23015 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
23016
23017 @end table
23018
23019 @node Sequences
23020 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
23021
23022 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
23023 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
23024 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
23025 files.
23026
23027 @menu
23028 * Define:: How to define your own commands
23029 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
23030 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
23031 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
23032 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
23033 @end menu
23034
23035 @node Define
23036 @subsection User-defined Commands
23037
23038 @cindex user-defined command
23039 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
23040 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
23041 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
23042 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
23043 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
23044 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
23045
23046 @smallexample
23047 define adder
23048 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23049 end
23050 @end smallexample
23051
23052 @noindent
23053 To execute the command use:
23054
23055 @smallexample
23056 adder 1 2 3
23057 @end smallexample
23058
23059 @noindent
23060 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
23061 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
23062 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
23063 functions calls.
23064
23065 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
23066 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
23067 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
23068 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
23069
23070 @smallexample
23071 define adder
23072 if $argc == 2
23073 print $arg0 + $arg1
23074 end
23075 if $argc == 3
23076 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23077 end
23078 end
23079 @end smallexample
23080
23081 @table @code
23082
23083 @kindex define
23084 @item define @var{commandname}
23085 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
23086 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
23087 @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
23088 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
23089 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
23090 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
23091
23092 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
23093 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
23094 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23095
23096 @kindex document
23097 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
23098 @item document @var{commandname}
23099 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
23100 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
23101 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
23102 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
23103 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
23104 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
23105
23106 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
23107 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
23108 does not change the documentation.
23109
23110 @kindex dont-repeat
23111 @cindex don't repeat command
23112 @item dont-repeat
23113 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
23114 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
23115 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
23116
23117 @kindex help user-defined
23118 @item help user-defined
23119 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
23120 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
23121 included (if any).
23122
23123 @kindex show user
23124 @item show user
23125 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
23126 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
23127 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
23128 definitions for all user-defined commands.
23129 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
23130
23131 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
23132 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
23133 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
23134 @item show max-user-call-depth
23135 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
23136 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
23137 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
23138 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
23139 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
23140 @end table
23141
23142 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
23143 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
23144
23145 When user-defined commands are executed, the
23146 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
23147 stops execution of the user-defined command.
23148
23149 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
23150 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
23151 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
23152 messages when used in a user-defined command.
23153
23154 @node Hooks
23155 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
23156 @cindex command hooks
23157 @cindex hooks, for commands
23158 @cindex hooks, pre-command
23159
23160 @kindex hook
23161 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
23162 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
23163 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
23164 before that command.
23165
23166 @cindex hooks, post-command
23167 @kindex hookpost
23168 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
23169 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
23170 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
23171 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
23172 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
23173
23174 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
23175 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
23176
23177 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
23178 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
23179
23180 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
23181 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
23182 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
23183 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
23184 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
23185
23186 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
23187 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
23188 you could define:
23189
23190 @smallexample
23191 define hook-stop
23192 handle SIGALRM nopass
23193 end
23194
23195 define hook-run
23196 handle SIGALRM pass
23197 end
23198
23199 define hook-continue
23200 handle SIGALRM pass
23201 end
23202 @end smallexample
23203
23204 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
23205 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
23206 you could define:
23207
23208 @smallexample
23209 define hook-echo
23210 echo <<<---
23211 end
23212
23213 define hookpost-echo
23214 echo --->>>\n
23215 end
23216
23217 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
23218 <<<---Hello World--->>>
23219 (@value{GDBP})
23220
23221 @end smallexample
23222
23223 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
23224 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
23225 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
23226 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
23227 @c or not?
23228 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
23229 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
23230 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
23231
23232 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
23233 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
23234 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
23235
23236 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
23237 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
23238
23239 @node Command Files
23240 @subsection Command Files
23241
23242 @cindex command files
23243 @cindex scripting commands
23244 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
23245 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
23246 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
23247 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
23248 terminal.
23249
23250 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
23251 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
23252 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
23253 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
23254 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
23255
23256 @table @code
23257 @kindex source
23258 @cindex execute commands from a file
23259 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
23260 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
23261 @end table
23262
23263 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
23264 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
23265 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
23266 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
23267 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
23268
23269 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
23270 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
23271 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
23272 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
23273 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
23274 is not relevant to scripts.
23275
23276 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
23277 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
23278 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
23279 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
23280 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23281 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
23282 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
23283 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
23284 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23285 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
23286 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
23287 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
23288 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
23289 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
23290
23291 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
23292 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
23293 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
23294
23295 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
23296 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
23297 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
23298 when called from command files.
23299
23300 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
23301 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
23302 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
23303 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
23304 the next command.
23305
23306 @smallexample
23307 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
23308 @end smallexample
23309
23310 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
23311 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
23312 would be directed to @file{log}.
23313
23314 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
23315 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
23316 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
23317 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
23318 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
23319 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
23320 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
23321 conditionally, etc.
23322
23323 @table @code
23324 @kindex if
23325 @kindex else
23326 @item if
23327 @itemx else
23328 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
23329 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
23330 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
23331 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
23332 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
23333 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
23334 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23335
23336 @kindex while
23337 @item while
23338 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
23339 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
23340 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
23341 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
23342 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
23343 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
23344
23345 @kindex loop_break
23346 @item loop_break
23347 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
23348 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
23349 line.
23350
23351 @kindex loop_continue
23352 @item loop_continue
23353 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
23354 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
23355 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
23356 the controlling expression.
23357
23358 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
23359 @item end
23360 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
23361 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
23362 @end table
23363
23364
23365 @node Output
23366 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
23367
23368 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
23369 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
23370 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
23371 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
23372 want.
23373
23374 @table @code
23375 @kindex echo
23376 @item echo @var{text}
23377 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
23378 @c because it is not in ANSI.
23379 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
23380 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
23381 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
23382 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
23383 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
23384 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
23385 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
23386 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
23387 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
23388
23389 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
23390 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
23391
23392 @smallexample
23393 echo This is some text\n\
23394 which is continued\n\
23395 onto several lines.\n
23396 @end smallexample
23397
23398 produces the same output as
23399
23400 @smallexample
23401 echo This is some text\n
23402 echo which is continued\n
23403 echo onto several lines.\n
23404 @end smallexample
23405
23406 @kindex output
23407 @item output @var{expression}
23408 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
23409 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
23410 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
23411 on expressions.
23412
23413 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
23414 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
23415 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
23416 Formats}, for more information.
23417
23418 @kindex printf
23419 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
23420 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
23421 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
23422 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
23423 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
23424 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
23425 executing the code below:
23426
23427 @smallexample
23428 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
23429 @end smallexample
23430
23431 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
23432 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
23433 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
23434 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
23435 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
23436 printed.
23437
23438 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
23439
23440 @smallexample
23441 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
23442 @end smallexample
23443
23444 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
23445 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
23446 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
23447
23448 @itemize @bullet
23449 @item
23450 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
23451
23452 @item
23453 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
23454 width.
23455
23456 @item
23457 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
23458 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
23459
23460 @item
23461 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
23462 supported.
23463
23464 @item
23465 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
23466
23467 @item
23468 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
23469 @end itemize
23470
23471 @noindent
23472 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
23473 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
23474 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
23475 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
23476
23477 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
23478 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
23479 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
23480 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
23481 supported.
23482
23483 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
23484 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
23485 together with a floating point specifier.
23486 letters:
23487
23488 @itemize @bullet
23489 @item
23490 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
23491
23492 @item
23493 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
23494
23495 @item
23496 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
23497 @end itemize
23498
23499 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
23500 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
23501 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
23502
23503 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
23504 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
23505
23506 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
23507 @smallexample
23508 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
23509 @end smallexample
23510
23511 @kindex eval
23512 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
23513 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
23514 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
23515
23516 @end table
23517
23518 @node Auto-loading sequences
23519 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
23520 @cindex native script auto-loading
23521
23522 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
23523 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
23524 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
23525 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23526
23527 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
23528 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
23529
23530 @table @code
23531 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
23532 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
23533 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
23534 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
23535
23536 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
23537 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
23538 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
23539 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
23540 disabled.
23541
23542 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
23543 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
23544 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
23545 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
23546 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
23547 auto-loaded.
23548 @end table
23549
23550 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
23551 matching names are printed.
23552
23553 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
23554 @include python.texi
23555
23556 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
23557 @include guile.texi
23558
23559 @node Auto-loading extensions
23560 @section Auto-loading extensions
23561 @cindex auto-loading extensions
23562
23563 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
23564 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
23565 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
23566 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
23567 section of modern file formats like ELF.
23568
23569 @menu
23570 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
23571 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23572 * Which flavor to choose?::
23573 @end menu
23574
23575 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
23576 debugging commands and features.
23577
23578 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
23579 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
23580 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
23581 for more information.
23582 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
23583 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
23584
23585 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
23586 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23587
23588 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
23589 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
23590 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
23591 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
23592 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
23593
23594 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
23595 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
23596 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
23597 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
23598
23599 @table @code
23600 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
23601 GDB's own command language
23602 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
23603 Python
23604 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
23605 Guile
23606 @end table
23607
23608 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
23609 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
23610 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
23611 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
23612 script in the specified extension language.
23613
23614 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
23615 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
23616
23617 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
23618 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23619
23620 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
23621 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
23622 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
23623 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
23624 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
23625 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
23626
23627 @table @code
23628 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
23629 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
23630 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23631 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
23632 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
23633 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
23634
23635 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
23636 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
23637
23638 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
23639 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
23640 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
23641 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
23642
23643 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
23644 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
23645 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
23646 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
23647 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
23648 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
23649 platform.
23650
23651 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23652 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23653 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23654
23655 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
23656 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
23657 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
23658 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23659 @end table
23660
23661 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
23662 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
23663 @var{objfile} is opened.
23664 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
23665 is evaluated more than once.
23666
23667 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
23668 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23669 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23670
23671 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
23672 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
23673 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
23674 If this section exists, its contents is a list of NUL-terminated names
23675 of scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-NULL prefix byte that
23676 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language.
23677
23678 @value{GDBN} will look for each specified script file first in the
23679 current directory and then along the source search path
23680 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
23681 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
23682 directory is not relevant to scripts.
23683
23684 Entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
23685 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
23686
23687 @example
23688 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
23689 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
23690 asm("\
23691 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
23692 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
23693 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
23694 .popsection \n\
23695 ");
23696 @end example
23697
23698 @noindent
23699 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
23700 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
23701
23702 @example
23703 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
23704 @end example
23705
23706 The script name may include directories if desired.
23707
23708 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
23709 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23710
23711 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
23712 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
23713 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
23714 will remove duplicates.
23715
23716 @node Which flavor to choose?
23717 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
23718
23719 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
23720 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
23721
23722 @noindent
23723 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
23724
23725 @itemize @bullet
23726 @item
23727 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
23728
23729 @item
23730 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
23731
23732 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
23733 in the source search path.
23734 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
23735 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
23736
23737 @item
23738 Doesn't require source code additions.
23739 @end itemize
23740
23741 @noindent
23742 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
23743
23744 @itemize @bullet
23745 @item
23746 Works with static linking.
23747
23748 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
23749 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
23750 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
23751 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
23752 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
23753
23754 @item
23755 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
23756
23757 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
23758 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
23759
23760 @item
23761 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
23762
23763 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
23764 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
23765 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
23766 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
23767 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
23768 top of the source tree to the source search path.
23769 @end itemize
23770
23771 @node Multiple Extension Languages
23772 @section Multiple Extension Languages
23773
23774 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
23775 and generally do not interfere with each other.
23776 There are some things to be aware of, however.
23777
23778 @subsection Python comes first
23779
23780 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
23781 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
23782 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
23783 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
23784 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
23785 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
23786 pretty-printed form of a value).
23787 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
23788 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
23789 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
23790
23791 @node Aliases
23792 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
23793 @cindex aliases for commands
23794
23795 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
23796 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
23797 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
23798 that involves less typing.
23799
23800 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
23801 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
23802 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
23803
23804 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
23805 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
23806 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
23807
23808 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
23809
23810 @table @code
23811
23812 @kindex alias
23813 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
23814
23815 @end table
23816
23817 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
23818 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
23819 underscores.
23820
23821 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
23822 that is being aliased.
23823
23824 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
23825 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
23826 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
23827
23828 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
23829 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
23830
23831 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
23832 of a command so that there is less to type.
23833 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
23834 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
23835 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
23836 The following will accomplish this.
23837
23838 @smallexample
23839 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
23840 @end smallexample
23841
23842 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
23843 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
23844 for it with the @samp{document} command.
23845 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
23846
23847 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
23848 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
23849 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
23850 of a command.
23851
23852 @smallexample
23853 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
23854 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
23855 (gdb) set p elms 20
23856 (gdb) show p elms
23857 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
23858 @end smallexample
23859
23860 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
23861 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
23862 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
23863
23864 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
23865 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
23866
23867 @smallexample
23868 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
23869 @end smallexample
23870
23871 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
23872 alias for a more complex command.
23873 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
23874
23875 @smallexample
23876 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
23877 (gdb) spe 20
23878 @end smallexample
23879
23880 @node Interpreters
23881 @chapter Command Interpreters
23882 @cindex command interpreters
23883
23884 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
23885 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
23886 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
23887
23888 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
23889 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
23890 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
23891 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
23892
23893 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
23894 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
23895 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
23896 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
23897
23898 @table @code
23899 @item console
23900 @cindex console interpreter
23901 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
23902 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
23903 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
23904
23905 @item mi
23906 @cindex mi interpreter
23907 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
23908 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
23909 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
23910 Interface}.
23911
23912 @item mi2
23913 @cindex mi2 interpreter
23914 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
23915
23916 @item mi1
23917 @cindex mi1 interpreter
23918 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
23919
23920 @end table
23921
23922 @cindex invoke another interpreter
23923 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
23924 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
23925 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
23926 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
23927 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
23928 the IDE inoperable!
23929
23930 @kindex interpreter-exec
23931 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
23932 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
23933 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
23934 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
23935
23936 @smallexample
23937 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
23938 @end smallexample
23939
23940 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
23941 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
23942
23943 @node TUI
23944 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
23945 @cindex TUI
23946 @cindex Text User Interface
23947
23948 @menu
23949 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
23950 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
23951 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
23952 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
23953 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
23954 @end menu
23955
23956 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
23957 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
23958 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
23959 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
23960 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
23961 is available.
23962
23963 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
23964 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
23965 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
23966 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
23967 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
23968
23969 @node TUI Overview
23970 @section TUI Overview
23971
23972 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
23973
23974 @table @emph
23975 @item command
23976 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
23977 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
23978 managed using readline.
23979
23980 @item source
23981 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
23982 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
23983
23984 @item assembly
23985 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
23986
23987 @item register
23988 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
23989 when their values change.
23990 @end table
23991
23992 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
23993 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
23994 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
23995 indicates the breakpoint type:
23996
23997 @table @code
23998 @item B
23999 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24000
24001 @item b
24002 Breakpoint which was never hit.
24003
24004 @item H
24005 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24006
24007 @item h
24008 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
24009 @end table
24010
24011 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
24012
24013 @table @code
24014 @item +
24015 Breakpoint is enabled.
24016
24017 @item -
24018 Breakpoint is disabled.
24019 @end table
24020
24021 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
24022 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
24023 changes.
24024
24025 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
24026 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
24027 layouts:
24028
24029 @itemize @bullet
24030 @item
24031 source only,
24032
24033 @item
24034 assembly only,
24035
24036 @item
24037 source and assembly,
24038
24039 @item
24040 source and registers, or
24041
24042 @item
24043 assembly and registers.
24044 @end itemize
24045
24046 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
24047
24048 @table @emph
24049 @item target
24050 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
24051 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
24052
24053 @item process
24054 Gives the current process or thread number.
24055 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
24056
24057 @item function
24058 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
24059 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
24060 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
24061 the string @code{??} is displayed.
24062
24063 @item line
24064 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
24065 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
24066
24067 @item pc
24068 Indicates the current program counter address.
24069 @end table
24070
24071 @node TUI Keys
24072 @section TUI Key Bindings
24073 @cindex TUI key bindings
24074
24075 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
24076 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24077 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
24078 @end ifset
24079 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24080 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
24081 @end ifclear
24082 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
24083 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
24084
24085 @table @kbd
24086 @kindex C-x C-a
24087 @item C-x C-a
24088 @kindex C-x a
24089 @itemx C-x a
24090 @kindex C-x A
24091 @itemx C-x A
24092 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
24093 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
24094 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
24095 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
24096 The screen is then refreshed.
24097
24098 @kindex C-x 1
24099 @item C-x 1
24100 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
24101 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
24102 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
24103
24104 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
24105
24106 @kindex C-x 2
24107 @item C-x 2
24108 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
24109 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
24110 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
24111 previous layout and the new one.
24112
24113 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
24114
24115 @kindex C-x o
24116 @item C-x o
24117 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
24118 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
24119 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
24120
24121 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
24122
24123 @kindex C-x s
24124 @item C-x s
24125 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
24126 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
24127 @end table
24128
24129 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
24130
24131 @table @asis
24132 @kindex PgUp
24133 @item @key{PgUp}
24134 Scroll the active window one page up.
24135
24136 @kindex PgDn
24137 @item @key{PgDn}
24138 Scroll the active window one page down.
24139
24140 @kindex Up
24141 @item @key{Up}
24142 Scroll the active window one line up.
24143
24144 @kindex Down
24145 @item @key{Down}
24146 Scroll the active window one line down.
24147
24148 @kindex Left
24149 @item @key{Left}
24150 Scroll the active window one column left.
24151
24152 @kindex Right
24153 @item @key{Right}
24154 Scroll the active window one column right.
24155
24156 @kindex C-L
24157 @item @kbd{C-L}
24158 Refresh the screen.
24159 @end table
24160
24161 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
24162 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
24163 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
24164 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
24165 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
24166
24167 @node TUI Single Key Mode
24168 @section TUI Single Key Mode
24169 @cindex TUI single key mode
24170
24171 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
24172 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
24173 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
24174
24175 @table @kbd
24176 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24177 @item c
24178 continue
24179
24180 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24181 @item d
24182 down
24183
24184 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24185 @item f
24186 finish
24187
24188 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24189 @item n
24190 next
24191
24192 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24193 @item q
24194 exit the SingleKey mode.
24195
24196 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24197 @item r
24198 run
24199
24200 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24201 @item s
24202 step
24203
24204 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24205 @item u
24206 up
24207
24208 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24209 @item v
24210 info locals
24211
24212 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24213 @item w
24214 where
24215 @end table
24216
24217 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
24218 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
24219 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
24220 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
24221 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
24222 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
24223
24224
24225 @node TUI Commands
24226 @section TUI-specific Commands
24227 @cindex TUI commands
24228
24229 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
24230 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
24231 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
24232 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
24233
24234 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
24235 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
24236 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
24237 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
24238 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
24239
24240 @table @code
24241 @item info win
24242 @kindex info win
24243 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
24244
24245 @item layout next
24246 @kindex layout
24247 Display the next layout.
24248
24249 @item layout prev
24250 Display the previous layout.
24251
24252 @item layout src
24253 Display the source window only.
24254
24255 @item layout asm
24256 Display the assembly window only.
24257
24258 @item layout split
24259 Display the source and assembly window.
24260
24261 @item layout regs
24262 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
24263
24264 @item focus next
24265 @kindex focus
24266 Make the next window active for scrolling.
24267
24268 @item focus prev
24269 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
24270
24271 @item focus src
24272 Make the source window active for scrolling.
24273
24274 @item focus asm
24275 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
24276
24277 @item focus regs
24278 Make the register window active for scrolling.
24279
24280 @item focus cmd
24281 Make the command window active for scrolling.
24282
24283 @item refresh
24284 @kindex refresh
24285 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
24286
24287 @item tui reg float
24288 @kindex tui reg
24289 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
24290
24291 @item tui reg general
24292 Show the general registers in the register window.
24293
24294 @item tui reg next
24295 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
24296 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
24297 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
24298 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
24299
24300 @item tui reg system
24301 Show the system registers in the register window.
24302
24303 @item update
24304 @kindex update
24305 Update the source window and the current execution point.
24306
24307 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
24308 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
24309 @kindex winheight
24310 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
24311 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
24312 decrease it.
24313
24314 @item tabset @var{nchars}
24315 @kindex tabset
24316 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
24317 @end table
24318
24319 @node TUI Configuration
24320 @section TUI Configuration Variables
24321 @cindex TUI configuration variables
24322
24323 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
24324
24325 @table @code
24326 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
24327 @kindex set tui border-kind
24328 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
24329 The possible values are the following:
24330 @table @code
24331 @item space
24332 Use a space character to draw the border.
24333
24334 @item ascii
24335 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
24336
24337 @item acs
24338 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
24339 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
24340 @end table
24341
24342 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
24343 @kindex set tui border-mode
24344 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
24345 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
24346 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
24347 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
24348 @table @code
24349 @item normal
24350 Use normal attributes to display the border.
24351
24352 @item standout
24353 Use standout mode.
24354
24355 @item reverse
24356 Use reverse video mode.
24357
24358 @item half
24359 Use half bright mode.
24360
24361 @item half-standout
24362 Use half bright and standout mode.
24363
24364 @item bold
24365 Use extra bright or bold mode.
24366
24367 @item bold-standout
24368 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
24369 @end table
24370 @end table
24371
24372 @node Emacs
24373 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
24374
24375 @cindex Emacs
24376 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
24377 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
24378 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
24379 @value{GDBN}.
24380
24381 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
24382 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
24383 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
24384 created Emacs buffer.
24385 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
24386
24387 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
24388 things:
24389
24390 @itemize @bullet
24391 @item
24392 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
24393 the GUD buffer.
24394
24395 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
24396 and output done by the program you are debugging.
24397
24398 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
24399 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
24400 in this way.
24401
24402 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
24403 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
24404 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
24405 stop.
24406
24407 @item
24408 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
24409
24410 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
24411 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
24412 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
24413 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
24414 and the source.
24415
24416 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
24417 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
24418 @end itemize
24419
24420 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
24421 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
24422 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
24423 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
24424
24425 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
24426 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
24427 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
24428 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
24429 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
24430 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
24431 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
24432 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
24433 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
24434
24435 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
24436 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
24437 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
24438 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
24439
24440 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
24441 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
24442 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
24443 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
24444 one you want.
24445
24446 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
24447 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
24448
24449 @table @kbd
24450 @item C-h m
24451 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
24452
24453 @item C-c C-s
24454 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
24455 update the display window to show the current file and location.
24456
24457 @item C-c C-n
24458 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
24459 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
24460 to show the current file and location.
24461
24462 @item C-c C-i
24463 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
24464 display window accordingly.
24465
24466 @item C-c C-f
24467 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
24468 @code{finish} command.
24469
24470 @item C-c C-r
24471 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
24472 command.
24473
24474 @item C-c <
24475 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
24476 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
24477 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
24478
24479 @item C-c >
24480 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
24481 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
24482 @end table
24483
24484 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
24485 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
24486
24487 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
24488 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
24489 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
24490 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
24491 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
24492 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
24493 speedbar displays watch expressions.
24494
24495 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
24496 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
24497 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
24498 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
24499 frame.
24500
24501 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
24502 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
24503 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
24504 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
24505 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
24506 to correspond properly with the code.
24507
24508 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
24509 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
24510 Emacs Manual}).
24511
24512 @node GDB/MI
24513 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
24514
24515 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
24516
24517 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
24518 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
24519 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
24520 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
24521 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
24522 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
24523
24524 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
24525 in the form of a reference manual.
24526
24527 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
24528 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
24529 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
24530
24531 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
24532
24533 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
24534 This chapter uses the following notation:
24535
24536 @itemize @bullet
24537 @item
24538 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
24539
24540 @item
24541 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
24542 it may or may not be given.
24543
24544 @item
24545 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
24546 may repeat zero or more times.
24547
24548 @item
24549 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
24550 may repeat one or more times.
24551
24552 @item
24553 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
24554 @end itemize
24555
24556 @ignore
24557 @heading Dependencies
24558 @end ignore
24559
24560 @menu
24561 * GDB/MI General Design::
24562 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
24563 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
24564 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
24565 * GDB/MI Output Records::
24566 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
24567 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
24568 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
24569 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
24570 * GDB/MI Program Context::
24571 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
24572 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
24573 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
24574 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
24575 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
24576 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
24577 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
24578 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
24579 * GDB/MI File Commands::
24580 @ignore
24581 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
24582 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
24583 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
24584 @end ignore
24585 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
24586 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
24587 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
24588 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
24589 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
24590 @end menu
24591
24592 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24593 @node GDB/MI General Design
24594 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
24595 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
24596
24597 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
24598 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
24599 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
24600 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
24601 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
24602 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
24603 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
24604 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
24605 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
24606 a command and reported as part of that command response.
24607
24608 The important examples of notifications are:
24609 @itemize @bullet
24610
24611 @item
24612 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
24613 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
24614 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
24615 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
24616 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
24617 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
24618 command itself was successfully executed.
24619
24620 @item
24621 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
24622 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
24623 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
24624 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
24625 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
24626 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
24627
24628 @item
24629 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
24630 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
24631 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
24632 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
24633 orthogonal frontend design.
24634
24635 @end itemize
24636
24637 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
24638 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
24639 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
24640 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
24641 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
24642 the user interface.
24643
24644
24645 @menu
24646 * Context management::
24647 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
24648 * Thread groups::
24649 @end menu
24650
24651 @node Context management
24652 @subsection Context management
24653
24654 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
24655
24656 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
24657 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
24658 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
24659 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
24660 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
24661 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
24662 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
24663 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
24664 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
24665
24666 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
24667 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
24668 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
24669 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
24670 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
24671 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
24672 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
24673 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
24674 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
24675 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
24676 for thread and frame to operate on.
24677
24678 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
24679 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
24680 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
24681 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
24682 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
24683 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
24684 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
24685 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
24686 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
24687 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
24688
24689 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
24690 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
24691 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
24692 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
24693 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
24694 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
24695 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
24696 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
24697 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
24698 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
24699 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
24700 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
24701 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
24702 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
24703 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
24704 @samp{--frame} options.
24705
24706 @subsubsection Language
24707
24708 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
24709 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
24710 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
24711 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
24712 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
24713 For instance:
24714
24715 @smallexample
24716 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
24717 ^done,value="4"
24718 (gdb)
24719 @end smallexample
24720
24721 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
24722 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
24723 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
24724
24725 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
24726 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
24727
24728 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
24729 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
24730 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
24731 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
24732 @code{-gdb-set target-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
24733 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
24734 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
24735 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
24736 @code{-list-target-features} command.
24737
24738 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
24739 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
24740 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
24741 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
24742 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
24743 are running.
24744
24745 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
24746 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
24747 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
24748 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
24749 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
24750 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
24751 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
24752 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
24753 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
24754 @samp{--thread} option).
24755
24756 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
24757 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
24758 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
24759 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
24760
24761 @node Thread groups
24762 @subsection Thread groups
24763 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
24764 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
24765 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
24766 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
24767 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
24768
24769 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
24770 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
24771 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
24772 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
24773 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
24774 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
24775 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
24776 into processes.
24777
24778 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
24779 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
24780 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
24781 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
24782 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
24783 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
24784 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
24785 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
24786 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
24787 the members of specific thread group.
24788
24789 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
24790 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
24791 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
24792 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
24793 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
24794 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
24795 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
24796 after attaching to that thread group.
24797
24798 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
24799 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
24800 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
24801 such thread groups.
24802
24803 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24804 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
24805 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
24806
24807 @menu
24808 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
24809 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
24810 @end menu
24811
24812 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
24813 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
24814
24815 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
24816 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
24817 @table @code
24818 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
24819 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
24820
24821 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
24822 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
24823 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
24824
24825 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
24826 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
24827 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
24828
24829 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
24830 "any sequence of digits"
24831
24832 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
24833 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
24834
24835 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
24836 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
24837
24838 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
24839 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
24840
24841 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
24842 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
24843 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
24844
24845 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
24846 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
24847
24848 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
24849 @code{CR | CR-LF}
24850 @end table
24851
24852 @noindent
24853 Notes:
24854
24855 @itemize @bullet
24856 @item
24857 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
24858 output is described below.
24859
24860 @item
24861 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
24862 finishes.
24863
24864 @item
24865 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
24866 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
24867 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
24868 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
24869 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
24870 @end itemize
24871
24872 Pragmatics:
24873
24874 @itemize @bullet
24875 @item
24876 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
24877
24878 @item
24879 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
24880 @end itemize
24881
24882 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
24883 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
24884
24885 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
24886 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
24887 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
24888 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
24889 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
24890 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
24891
24892 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
24893 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
24894 @var{token}.
24895
24896 @table @code
24897 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
24898 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
24899
24900 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
24901 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
24902
24903 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
24904 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
24905
24906 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
24907 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
24908
24909 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
24910 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
24911
24912 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
24913 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
24914
24915 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
24916 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
24917
24918 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
24919 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
24920
24921 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
24922 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
24923
24924 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
24925 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
24926 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
24927
24928 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
24929 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
24930
24931 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
24932 @code{ @var{string} }
24933
24934 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
24935 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
24936
24937 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
24938 @code{@var{c-string}}
24939
24940 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
24941 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
24942
24943 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
24944 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
24945 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
24946
24947 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
24948 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
24949
24950 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
24951 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
24952
24953 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
24954 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
24955
24956 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
24957 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
24958
24959 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
24960 @code{CR | CR-LF}
24961
24962 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
24963 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
24964 @end table
24965
24966 @noindent
24967 Notes:
24968
24969 @itemize @bullet
24970 @item
24971 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
24972
24973 @item
24974 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
24975 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
24976 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
24977 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
24978 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
24979 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
24980 prior command.
24981
24982 @item
24983 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24984 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
24985 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
24986 prefixed by @samp{+}.
24987
24988 @item
24989 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24990 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
24991 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
24992 @samp{*}.
24993
24994 @item
24995 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24996 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
24997 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
24998 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
24999
25000 @item
25001 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25002 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
25003 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
25004 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
25005
25006 @item
25007 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25008 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
25009 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
25010
25011 @item
25012 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25013 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
25014 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
25015 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
25016
25017 @item
25018 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25019 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
25020 @var{values}.
25021
25022
25023 @end itemize
25024
25025 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
25026 details about the various output records.
25027
25028 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25029 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
25030 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
25031
25032 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
25033 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
25034
25035 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
25036 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
25037 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
25038 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
25039 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
25040 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
25041
25042 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
25043 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
25044 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
25045
25046 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25047 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
25048 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
25049 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
25050
25051 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
25052 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
25053
25054 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
25055 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
25056 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
25057 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
25058 might change.
25059
25060 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
25061 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
25062 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
25063 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
25064
25065 @itemize @bullet
25066 @item
25067 New MI commands may be added.
25068
25069 @item
25070 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
25071
25072 @item
25073 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
25074 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
25075
25076 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
25077 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
25078
25079 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
25080 @c resolve inconsistencies.
25081 @end itemize
25082
25083 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
25084 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
25085 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
25086 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
25087 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
25088
25089 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
25090 @c version?
25091
25092 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
25093 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
25094 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
25095 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
25096 @cindex mailing lists
25097
25098 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25099 @node GDB/MI Output Records
25100 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
25101
25102 @menu
25103 * GDB/MI Result Records::
25104 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
25105 * GDB/MI Async Records::
25106 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
25107 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
25108 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
25109 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
25110 @end menu
25111
25112 @node GDB/MI Result Records
25113 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
25114
25115 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25116 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
25117 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
25118 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
25119
25120 @table @code
25121 @findex ^done
25122 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
25123 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
25124 values.
25125
25126 @item "^running"
25127 @findex ^running
25128 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
25129 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
25130 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
25131 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
25132 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
25133 which threads are resumed.
25134
25135 @item "^connected"
25136 @findex ^connected
25137 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
25138
25139 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
25140 @findex ^error
25141 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
25142 the corresponding error message.
25143
25144 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
25145 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
25146 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
25147
25148 @table @samp
25149 @item "undefined-command"
25150 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
25151 @end table
25152
25153 @item "^exit"
25154 @findex ^exit
25155 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
25156
25157 @end table
25158
25159 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
25160 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
25161
25162 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
25163 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25164 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
25165 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
25166 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
25167
25168 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
25169 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
25170 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
25171 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
25172 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
25173
25174 @table @code
25175 @item "~" @var{string-output}
25176 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
25177 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
25178
25179 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
25180 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
25181 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
25182 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
25183
25184 @item "&" @var{string-output}
25185 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
25186 internals.
25187 @end table
25188
25189 @node GDB/MI Async Records
25190 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
25191
25192 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25193 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
25194 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
25195 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
25196 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
25197 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
25198
25199 The following is the list of possible async records:
25200
25201 @table @code
25202
25203 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
25204 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
25205 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
25206 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
25207 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
25208 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
25209 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
25210 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
25211 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
25212 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
25213
25214 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
25215 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
25216 following values:
25217
25218 @table @code
25219 @item breakpoint-hit
25220 A breakpoint was reached.
25221 @item watchpoint-trigger
25222 A watchpoint was triggered.
25223 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
25224 A read watchpoint was triggered.
25225 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
25226 An access watchpoint was triggered.
25227 @item function-finished
25228 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
25229 @item location-reached
25230 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
25231 @item watchpoint-scope
25232 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
25233 @item end-stepping-range
25234 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
25235 similar CLI command was accomplished.
25236 @item exited-signalled
25237 The inferior exited because of a signal.
25238 @item exited
25239 The inferior exited.
25240 @item exited-normally
25241 The inferior exited normally.
25242 @item signal-received
25243 A signal was received by the inferior.
25244 @item solib-event
25245 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
25246 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
25247 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
25248 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
25249 @item fork
25250 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
25251 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25252 @item vfork
25253 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
25254 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25255 @item syscall-entry
25256 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
25257 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25258 @item syscall-entry
25259 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
25260 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25261 @item exec
25262 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
25263 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25264 @end table
25265
25266 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
25267 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
25268 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
25269 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
25270 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
25271 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
25272 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
25273 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
25274 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
25275 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
25276 if such information is not available.
25277
25278 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
25279 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
25280 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
25281 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
25282 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
25283 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
25284 cannot be used in any way.
25285
25286 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
25287 A thread group became associated with a running program,
25288 either because the program was just started or the thread group
25289 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
25290 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
25291 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
25292
25293 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
25294 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
25295 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
25296 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
25297 thread group. @var{code} is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
25298 only when the inferior exited with some code.
25299
25300 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
25301 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
25302 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
25303 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
25304 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
25305
25306 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
25307 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
25308 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
25309 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
25310 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
25311 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
25312 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
25313
25314 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
25315 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
25316 that thread.
25317
25318 @item =library-loaded,...
25319 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
25320 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
25321 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
25322 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
25323 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
25324 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
25325 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
25326 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
25327 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
25328 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
25329 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
25330 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
25331 thread groups.
25332
25333 @item =library-unloaded,...
25334 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
25335 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
25336 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
25337 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
25338 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
25339 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
25340 thread groups.
25341
25342 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
25343 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
25344 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
25345 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
25346 frame is @var{tpnum}.
25347
25348 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
25349 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
25350 initial value @var{initial}.
25351
25352 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
25353 @itemx =tsv-deleted
25354 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
25355 trace state variables are deleted.
25356
25357 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
25358 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
25359 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
25360 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
25361 value of trace state variable is known.
25362
25363 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
25364 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
25365 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
25366 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
25367 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
25368 user.
25369
25370 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
25371 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
25372 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
25373
25374 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
25375 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
25376
25377 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}"
25378 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
25379 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
25380 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
25381 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
25382
25383 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
25384 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
25385 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
25386 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
25387 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
25388 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
25389
25390 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
25391 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
25392 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
25393 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
25394 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
25395 executable code.
25396 @end table
25397
25398 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
25399 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
25400
25401 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
25402 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
25403 following fields:
25404
25405 @table @code
25406 @item number
25407 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
25408 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
25409 @samp{1.2}.
25410
25411 @item type
25412 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
25413 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
25414
25415 @item catch-type
25416 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
25417 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
25418
25419 @item disp
25420 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
25421 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
25422 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
25423
25424 @item enabled
25425 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
25426 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
25427 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
25428
25429 @item addr
25430 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
25431 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
25432 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
25433 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
25434 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
25435
25436 @item func
25437 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
25438 If not known, this field is not present.
25439
25440 @item filename
25441 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
25442 If not known, this field is not present.
25443
25444 @item fullname
25445 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
25446 known. If not known, this field is not present.
25447
25448 @item line
25449 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
25450 If not known, this field is not present.
25451
25452 @item at
25453 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
25454 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
25455 by a symbol name.
25456
25457 @item pending
25458 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
25459 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
25460
25461 @item evaluated-by
25462 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
25463 @samp{target}.
25464
25465 @item thread
25466 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
25467 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
25468
25469 @item task
25470 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
25471 field will hold the task identifier.
25472
25473 @item cond
25474 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
25475
25476 @item ignore
25477 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
25478
25479 @item enable
25480 The enable count of the breakpoint.
25481
25482 @item traceframe-usage
25483 FIXME.
25484
25485 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
25486 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
25487
25488 @item mask
25489 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
25490
25491 @item pass
25492 A tracepoint's pass count.
25493
25494 @item original-location
25495 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
25496 This field is optional.
25497
25498 @item times
25499 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
25500
25501 @item installed
25502 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
25503 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
25504 is not.
25505
25506 @item what
25507 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
25508
25509 @end table
25510
25511 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
25512 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
25513
25514 @smallexample
25515 -> -break-insert main
25516 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25517 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
25518 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
25519 times="0"@}
25520 <- (gdb)
25521 @end smallexample
25522
25523 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
25524 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
25525
25526 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
25527 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
25528 fields:
25529
25530 @table @code
25531 @item level
25532 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
25533 zero. This field is always present.
25534
25535 @item func
25536 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
25537 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
25538
25539 @item addr
25540 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
25541
25542 @item file
25543 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
25544 address. This field may be absent.
25545
25546 @item line
25547 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
25548 may be absent.
25549
25550 @item from
25551 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
25552 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
25553
25554 @end table
25555
25556 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
25557 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
25558
25559 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
25560 uses a tuple with the following fields:
25561
25562 @table @code
25563 @item id
25564 The numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
25565 always present.
25566
25567 @item target-id
25568 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
25569
25570 @item details
25571 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
25572 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
25573 frontend. This field is optional.
25574
25575 @item state
25576 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
25577 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
25578
25579 @item core
25580 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
25581 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
25582 @end table
25583
25584 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
25585 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
25586
25587 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
25588 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
25589 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
25590 the @code{exception-name} field.
25591
25592 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25593 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
25594 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
25595 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
25596
25597 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
25598 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
25599 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
25600 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
25601
25602 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
25603 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
25604
25605 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
25606
25607 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
25608 information of the breakpoint.
25609
25610 @smallexample
25611 -> -break-insert main
25612 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25613 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
25614 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
25615 times="0"@}
25616 <- (gdb)
25617 @end smallexample
25618
25619 @subheading Program Execution
25620
25621 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
25622 reason that execution stopped.
25623
25624 @smallexample
25625 -> -exec-run
25626 <- ^running
25627 <- (gdb)
25628 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
25629 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
25630 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
25631 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
25632 <- (gdb)
25633 -> -exec-continue
25634 <- ^running
25635 <- (gdb)
25636 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
25637 <- (gdb)
25638 @end smallexample
25639
25640 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
25641
25642 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
25643
25644 @smallexample
25645 -> (gdb)
25646 <- -gdb-exit
25647 <- ^exit
25648 @end smallexample
25649
25650 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
25651 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
25652 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
25653 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
25654 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
25655 fails to exit in reasonable time.
25656
25657 @subheading A Bad Command
25658
25659 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
25660
25661 @smallexample
25662 -> -rubbish
25663 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
25664 <- (gdb)
25665 @end smallexample
25666
25667
25668 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25669 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
25670 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
25671
25672 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
25673 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
25674
25675 @subheading Motivation
25676
25677 The motivation for this collection of commands.
25678
25679 @subheading Introduction
25680
25681 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
25682
25683 @subheading Commands
25684
25685 For each command in the block, the following is described:
25686
25687 @subsubheading Synopsis
25688
25689 @smallexample
25690 -command @var{args}@dots{}
25691 @end smallexample
25692
25693 @subsubheading Result
25694
25695 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25696
25697 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
25698
25699 @subsubheading Example
25700
25701 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
25702 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
25703
25704
25705 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25706 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
25707 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
25708
25709 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
25710 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
25711 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
25712 breakpoints.
25713
25714 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
25715 @findex -break-after
25716
25717 @subsubheading Synopsis
25718
25719 @smallexample
25720 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
25721 @end smallexample
25722
25723 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
25724 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
25725 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
25726 @samp{-break-list} command below.
25727
25728 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25729
25730 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
25731
25732 @subsubheading Example
25733
25734 @smallexample
25735 (gdb)
25736 -break-insert main
25737 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25738 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
25739 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
25740 times="0"@}
25741 (gdb)
25742 -break-after 1 3
25743 ~
25744 ^done
25745 (gdb)
25746 -break-list
25747 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25748 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25749 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25750 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25751 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25752 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25753 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25754 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25755 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25756 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
25757 (gdb)
25758 @end smallexample
25759
25760 @ignore
25761 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
25762 @findex -break-catch
25763 @end ignore
25764
25765 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
25766 @findex -break-commands
25767
25768 @subsubheading Synopsis
25769
25770 @smallexample
25771 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
25772 @end smallexample
25773
25774 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
25775 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
25776 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
25777 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
25778 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
25779 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
25780
25781 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25782
25783 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
25784
25785 @subsubheading Example
25786
25787 @smallexample
25788 (gdb)
25789 -break-insert main
25790 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25791 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
25792 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
25793 times="0"@}
25794 (gdb)
25795 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
25796 ^done
25797 (gdb)
25798 @end smallexample
25799
25800 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
25801 @findex -break-condition
25802
25803 @subsubheading Synopsis
25804
25805 @smallexample
25806 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
25807 @end smallexample
25808
25809 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
25810 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
25811 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
25812 command below).
25813
25814 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25815
25816 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
25817
25818 @subsubheading Example
25819
25820 @smallexample
25821 (gdb)
25822 -break-condition 1 1
25823 ^done
25824 (gdb)
25825 -break-list
25826 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25827 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25828 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25829 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25830 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25831 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25832 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25833 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25834 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25835 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
25836 (gdb)
25837 @end smallexample
25838
25839 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
25840 @findex -break-delete
25841
25842 @subsubheading Synopsis
25843
25844 @smallexample
25845 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25846 @end smallexample
25847
25848 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
25849 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
25850
25851 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25852
25853 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
25854
25855 @subsubheading Example
25856
25857 @smallexample
25858 (gdb)
25859 -break-delete 1
25860 ^done
25861 (gdb)
25862 -break-list
25863 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
25864 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25865 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25866 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25867 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25868 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25869 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25870 body=[]@}
25871 (gdb)
25872 @end smallexample
25873
25874 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
25875 @findex -break-disable
25876
25877 @subsubheading Synopsis
25878
25879 @smallexample
25880 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25881 @end smallexample
25882
25883 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
25884 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
25885
25886 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25887
25888 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
25889
25890 @subsubheading Example
25891
25892 @smallexample
25893 (gdb)
25894 -break-disable 2
25895 ^done
25896 (gdb)
25897 -break-list
25898 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25899 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25900 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25901 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25902 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25903 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25904 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25905 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
25906 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25907 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
25908 (gdb)
25909 @end smallexample
25910
25911 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
25912 @findex -break-enable
25913
25914 @subsubheading Synopsis
25915
25916 @smallexample
25917 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25918 @end smallexample
25919
25920 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
25921
25922 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25923
25924 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
25925
25926 @subsubheading Example
25927
25928 @smallexample
25929 (gdb)
25930 -break-enable 2
25931 ^done
25932 (gdb)
25933 -break-list
25934 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25935 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25936 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25937 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25938 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25939 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25940 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25941 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25942 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25943 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
25944 (gdb)
25945 @end smallexample
25946
25947 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
25948 @findex -break-info
25949
25950 @subsubheading Synopsis
25951
25952 @smallexample
25953 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
25954 @end smallexample
25955
25956 @c REDUNDANT???
25957 Get information about a single breakpoint.
25958
25959 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
25960 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
25961 table.
25962
25963 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25964
25965 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
25966
25967 @subsubheading Example
25968 N.A.
25969
25970 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
25971 @findex -break-insert
25972
25973 @subsubheading Synopsis
25974
25975 @smallexample
25976 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
25977 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
25978 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
25979 @end smallexample
25980
25981 @noindent
25982 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
25983
25984 @itemize @bullet
25985 @item function
25986 @c @item +offset
25987 @c @item -offset
25988 @c @item linenum
25989 @item filename:linenum
25990 @item filename:function
25991 @item *address
25992 @end itemize
25993
25994 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
25995
25996 @table @samp
25997 @item -t
25998 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
25999 @item -h
26000 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
26001 @item -f
26002 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
26003 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26004 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26005 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26006 cannot be parsed.
26007 @item -d
26008 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26009 @item -a
26010 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
26011 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
26012 @item -c @var{condition}
26013 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26014 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26015 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
26016 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26017 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26018 @end table
26019
26020 @subsubheading Result
26021
26022 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26023 resulting breakpoint.
26024
26025 Note: this format is open to change.
26026 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26027
26028 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26029
26030 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
26031 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
26032
26033 @subsubheading Example
26034
26035 @smallexample
26036 (gdb)
26037 -break-insert main
26038 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
26039 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26040 times="0"@}
26041 (gdb)
26042 -break-insert -t foo
26043 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
26044 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26045 times="0"@}
26046 (gdb)
26047 -break-list
26048 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26049 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26050 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26051 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26052 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26053 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26054 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26055 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26056 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
26057 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26058 times="0"@},
26059 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
26060 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
26061 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26062 times="0"@}]@}
26063 (gdb)
26064 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
26065 @c ~int foo(int, int);
26066 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
26067 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26068 @c times="0"@}
26069 @c (gdb)
26070 @end smallexample
26071
26072 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
26073 @findex -dprintf-insert
26074
26075 @subsubheading Synopsis
26076
26077 @smallexample
26078 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
26079 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26080 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
26081 [ @var{argument} ]
26082 @end smallexample
26083
26084 @noindent
26085 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26086
26087 @itemize @bullet
26088 @item @var{function}
26089 @c @item +offset
26090 @c @item -offset
26091 @c @item @var{linenum}
26092 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
26093 @item @var{filename}:function
26094 @item *@var{address}
26095 @end itemize
26096
26097 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26098
26099 @table @samp
26100 @item -t
26101 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26102 @item -f
26103 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
26104 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26105 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26106 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26107 cannot be parsed.
26108 @item -d
26109 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26110 @item -c @var{condition}
26111 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26112 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26113 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
26114 to @var{ignore-count}.
26115 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26116 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26117 @end table
26118
26119 @subsubheading Result
26120
26121 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26122 resulting breakpoint.
26123
26124 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26125
26126 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26127
26128 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
26129
26130 @subsubheading Example
26131
26132 @smallexample
26133 (gdb)
26134 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
26135 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26136 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
26137 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
26138 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
26139 original-location="foo"@}
26140 (gdb)
26141 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
26142 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26143 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
26144 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
26145 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
26146 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
26147 (gdb)
26148 @end smallexample
26149
26150 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
26151 @findex -break-list
26152
26153 @subsubheading Synopsis
26154
26155 @smallexample
26156 -break-list
26157 @end smallexample
26158
26159 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
26160
26161 @table @samp
26162 @item Number
26163 number of the breakpoint
26164 @item Type
26165 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
26166 @item Disposition
26167 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
26168 or @samp{nokeep}
26169 @item Enabled
26170 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
26171 @item Address
26172 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
26173 @item What
26174 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
26175 name, line number
26176 @item Thread-groups
26177 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
26178 @item Times
26179 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
26180 @end table
26181
26182 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
26183 @code{body} field is an empty list.
26184
26185 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26186
26187 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
26188
26189 @subsubheading Example
26190
26191 @smallexample
26192 (gdb)
26193 -break-list
26194 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26195 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26196 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26197 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26198 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26199 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26200 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26201 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26202 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26203 times="0"@},
26204 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26205 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26206 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26207 (gdb)
26208 @end smallexample
26209
26210 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
26211
26212 @smallexample
26213 (gdb)
26214 -break-list
26215 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26216 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26217 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26218 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26219 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26220 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26221 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26222 body=[]@}
26223 (gdb)
26224 @end smallexample
26225
26226 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
26227 @findex -break-passcount
26228
26229 @subsubheading Synopsis
26230
26231 @smallexample
26232 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
26233 @end smallexample
26234
26235 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
26236 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
26237 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
26238 command @samp{passcount}.
26239
26240 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
26241 @findex -break-watch
26242
26243 @subsubheading Synopsis
26244
26245 @smallexample
26246 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
26247 @end smallexample
26248
26249 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
26250 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
26251 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
26252 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
26253 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
26254 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
26255 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
26256 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
26257
26258 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
26259 breakpoints inserted.
26260
26261 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26262
26263 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
26264 @samp{rwatch}.
26265
26266 @subsubheading Example
26267
26268 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
26269
26270 @smallexample
26271 (gdb)
26272 -break-watch x
26273 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
26274 (gdb)
26275 -exec-continue
26276 ^running
26277 (gdb)
26278 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
26279 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
26280 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
26281 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
26282 (gdb)
26283 @end smallexample
26284
26285 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
26286 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
26287 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
26288
26289 @smallexample
26290 (gdb)
26291 -break-watch C
26292 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
26293 (gdb)
26294 -exec-continue
26295 ^running
26296 (gdb)
26297 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
26298 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
26299 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
26300 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26301 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
26302 (gdb)
26303 -exec-continue
26304 ^running
26305 (gdb)
26306 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
26307 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
26308 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
26309 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26310 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
26311 (gdb)
26312 @end smallexample
26313
26314 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
26315 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
26316 deleted.
26317
26318 @smallexample
26319 (gdb)
26320 -break-watch C
26321 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
26322 (gdb)
26323 -break-list
26324 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26325 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26326 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26327 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26328 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26329 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26330 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26331 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26332 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26333 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26334 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
26335 times="1"@},
26336 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
26337 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26338 (gdb)
26339 -exec-continue
26340 ^running
26341 (gdb)
26342 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
26343 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
26344 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
26345 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26346 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
26347 (gdb)
26348 -break-list
26349 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26350 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26351 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26352 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26353 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26354 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26355 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26356 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26357 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26358 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26359 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
26360 times="1"@},
26361 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
26362 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
26363 (gdb)
26364 -exec-continue
26365 ^running
26366 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
26367 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
26368 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
26369 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26370 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
26371 (gdb)
26372 -break-list
26373 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26374 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26375 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26376 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26377 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26378 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26379 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26380 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26381 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26382 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26383 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
26384 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
26385 (gdb)
26386 @end smallexample
26387
26388
26389 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26390 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
26391 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
26392
26393 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
26394 catchpoints.
26395
26396 @menu
26397 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26398 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26399 @end menu
26400
26401 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
26402 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
26403
26404 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
26405 @findex -catch-load
26406
26407 @subsubheading Synopsis
26408
26409 @smallexample
26410 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
26411 @end smallexample
26412
26413 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
26414 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
26415 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
26416 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
26417 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
26418
26419
26420 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26421
26422 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
26423
26424 @subsubheading Example
26425
26426 @smallexample
26427 -catch-load -t foo.so
26428 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
26429 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
26430 (gdb)
26431 @end smallexample
26432
26433
26434 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
26435 @findex -catch-unload
26436
26437 @subsubheading Synopsis
26438
26439 @smallexample
26440 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
26441 @end smallexample
26442
26443 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
26444 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
26445 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
26446 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
26447 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
26448
26449 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26450
26451 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
26452
26453 @subsubheading Example
26454
26455 @smallexample
26456 -catch-unload -d bar.so
26457 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
26458 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
26459 (gdb)
26460 @end smallexample
26461
26462 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
26463 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
26464
26465 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
26466 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
26467
26468 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
26469 @findex -catch-assert
26470
26471 @subsubheading Synopsis
26472
26473 @smallexample
26474 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
26475 @end smallexample
26476
26477 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
26478
26479 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
26480
26481 @table @samp
26482 @item -c @var{condition}
26483 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26484 @item -d
26485 Create a disabled catchpoint.
26486 @item -t
26487 Create a temporary catchpoint.
26488 @end table
26489
26490 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26491
26492 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
26493
26494 @subsubheading Example
26495
26496 @smallexample
26497 -catch-assert
26498 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26499 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
26500 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
26501 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
26502 (gdb)
26503 @end smallexample
26504
26505 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
26506 @findex -catch-exception
26507
26508 @subsubheading Synopsis
26509
26510 @smallexample
26511 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
26512 [ -t ] [ -u ]
26513 @end smallexample
26514
26515 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
26516 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
26517 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
26518 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
26519 catchpoints.
26520
26521 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
26522
26523 @table @samp
26524 @item -c @var{condition}
26525 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26526 @item -d
26527 Create a disabled catchpoint.
26528 @item -e @var{exception-name}
26529 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
26530 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
26531 @item -t
26532 Create a temporary catchpoint.
26533 @item -u
26534 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
26535 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
26536 @end table
26537
26538 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26539
26540 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
26541 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
26542
26543 @subsubheading Example
26544
26545 @smallexample
26546 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
26547 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26548 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
26549 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
26550 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
26551 (gdb)
26552 @end smallexample
26553
26554 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26555 @node GDB/MI Program Context
26556 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
26557
26558 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
26559 @findex -exec-arguments
26560
26561
26562 @subsubheading Synopsis
26563
26564 @smallexample
26565 -exec-arguments @var{args}
26566 @end smallexample
26567
26568 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
26569 @samp{-exec-run}.
26570
26571 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26572
26573 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
26574
26575 @subsubheading Example
26576
26577 @smallexample
26578 (gdb)
26579 -exec-arguments -v word
26580 ^done
26581 (gdb)
26582 @end smallexample
26583
26584
26585 @ignore
26586 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
26587 @findex -exec-show-arguments
26588
26589 @subsubheading Synopsis
26590
26591 @smallexample
26592 -exec-show-arguments
26593 @end smallexample
26594
26595 Print the arguments of the program.
26596
26597 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26598
26599 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
26600
26601 @subsubheading Example
26602 N.A.
26603 @end ignore
26604
26605
26606 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
26607 @findex -environment-cd
26608
26609 @subsubheading Synopsis
26610
26611 @smallexample
26612 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
26613 @end smallexample
26614
26615 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
26616
26617 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26618
26619 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
26620
26621 @subsubheading Example
26622
26623 @smallexample
26624 (gdb)
26625 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
26626 ^done
26627 (gdb)
26628 @end smallexample
26629
26630
26631 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
26632 @findex -environment-directory
26633
26634 @subsubheading Synopsis
26635
26636 @smallexample
26637 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
26638 @end smallexample
26639
26640 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
26641 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
26642 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
26643 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
26644 occurs as normal.
26645 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
26646 multiple directories in a single command
26647 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
26648 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
26649 If blanks are needed as
26650 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
26651 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
26652 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
26653 character must not be used
26654 in any directory name.
26655 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
26656
26657 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26658
26659 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
26660
26661 @subsubheading Example
26662
26663 @smallexample
26664 (gdb)
26665 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
26666 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
26667 (gdb)
26668 -environment-directory ""
26669 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
26670 (gdb)
26671 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
26672 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
26673 (gdb)
26674 -environment-directory -r
26675 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
26676 (gdb)
26677 @end smallexample
26678
26679
26680 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
26681 @findex -environment-path
26682
26683 @subsubheading Synopsis
26684
26685 @smallexample
26686 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
26687 @end smallexample
26688
26689 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
26690 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
26691 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
26692 supplied in addition to the
26693 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
26694 occurs as normal.
26695 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
26696 multiple directories in a single command
26697 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
26698 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
26699 If blanks are needed as
26700 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
26701 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
26702 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
26703 character must not be used
26704 in any directory name.
26705 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
26706
26707
26708 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26709
26710 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
26711
26712 @subsubheading Example
26713
26714 @smallexample
26715 (gdb)
26716 -environment-path
26717 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
26718 (gdb)
26719 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
26720 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
26721 (gdb)
26722 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
26723 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
26724 (gdb)
26725 @end smallexample
26726
26727
26728 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
26729 @findex -environment-pwd
26730
26731 @subsubheading Synopsis
26732
26733 @smallexample
26734 -environment-pwd
26735 @end smallexample
26736
26737 Show the current working directory.
26738
26739 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26740
26741 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
26742
26743 @subsubheading Example
26744
26745 @smallexample
26746 (gdb)
26747 -environment-pwd
26748 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
26749 (gdb)
26750 @end smallexample
26751
26752 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26753 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
26754 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
26755
26756
26757 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
26758 @findex -thread-info
26759
26760 @subsubheading Synopsis
26761
26762 @smallexample
26763 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
26764 @end smallexample
26765
26766 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
26767 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
26768 threads. When printing information about all threads,
26769 also reports the current thread.
26770
26771 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26772
26773 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
26774 about all threads.
26775
26776 @subsubheading Result
26777
26778 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
26779 defined for a given thread:
26780
26781 @table @samp
26782 @item current
26783 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
26784
26785 @item id
26786 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
26787
26788 @item target-id
26789 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
26790
26791 @item details
26792 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
26793 field is optional.
26794
26795 @item name
26796 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
26797 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
26798 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
26799 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
26800 field is omitted.
26801
26802 @item frame
26803 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
26804
26805 @item state
26806 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
26807 values:
26808
26809 @table @code
26810 @item stopped
26811 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
26812 threads.
26813
26814 @item running
26815 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
26816 threads.
26817
26818 @end table
26819
26820 @item core
26821 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
26822 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
26823
26824 @end table
26825
26826 @subsubheading Example
26827
26828 @smallexample
26829 -thread-info
26830 ^done,threads=[
26831 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
26832 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
26833 args=[]@},state="running"@},
26834 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
26835 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
26836 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
26837 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
26838 state="running"@}],
26839 current-thread-id="1"
26840 (gdb)
26841 @end smallexample
26842
26843 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
26844 @findex -thread-list-ids
26845
26846 @subsubheading Synopsis
26847
26848 @smallexample
26849 -thread-list-ids
26850 @end smallexample
26851
26852 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
26853 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
26854
26855 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
26856 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
26857
26858 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26859
26860 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
26861
26862 @subsubheading Example
26863
26864 @smallexample
26865 (gdb)
26866 -thread-list-ids
26867 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
26868 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
26869 (gdb)
26870 @end smallexample
26871
26872
26873 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
26874 @findex -thread-select
26875
26876 @subsubheading Synopsis
26877
26878 @smallexample
26879 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
26880 @end smallexample
26881
26882 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
26883 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
26884
26885 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
26886 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
26887
26888 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26889
26890 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
26891
26892 @subsubheading Example
26893
26894 @smallexample
26895 (gdb)
26896 -exec-next
26897 ^running
26898 (gdb)
26899 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
26900 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
26901 (gdb)
26902 -thread-list-ids
26903 ^done,
26904 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
26905 number-of-threads="3"
26906 (gdb)
26907 -thread-select 3
26908 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
26909 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
26910 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
26911 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
26912 (gdb)
26913 @end smallexample
26914
26915 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26916 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
26917 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
26918
26919 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
26920 @findex -ada-task-info
26921
26922 @subsubheading Synopsis
26923
26924 @smallexample
26925 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
26926 @end smallexample
26927
26928 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
26929 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
26930
26931 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26932
26933 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
26934 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
26935
26936 @subsubheading Result
26937
26938 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
26939 defined for each Ada task:
26940
26941 @table @samp
26942 @item current
26943 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
26944
26945 @item id
26946 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
26947
26948 @item task-id
26949 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
26950
26951 @item thread-id
26952 The identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada task.
26953
26954 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
26955 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
26956 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
26957
26958 @item parent-id
26959 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
26960 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
26961
26962 @item priority
26963 The base priority of the task.
26964
26965 @item state
26966 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
26967 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
26968
26969 @item name
26970 The name of the task.
26971
26972 @end table
26973
26974 @subsubheading Example
26975
26976 @smallexample
26977 -ada-task-info
26978 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
26979 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
26980 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
26981 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
26982 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
26983 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
26984 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
26985 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
26986 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
26987 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
26988 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
26989 (gdb)
26990 @end smallexample
26991
26992 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26993 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
26994 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
26995
26996 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
26997 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
26998 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
26999 other cases.
27000
27001 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
27002 @findex -exec-continue
27003
27004 @subsubheading Synopsis
27005
27006 @smallexample
27007 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
27008 @end smallexample
27009
27010 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
27011 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
27012 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
27013 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
27014 @itemize @bullet
27015 @item
27016 breakpoints or watchpoints
27017 @item
27018 signals or exceptions
27019 @item
27020 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
27021 @item
27022 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
27023 @end itemize
27024 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
27025 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
27026 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
27027 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
27028 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
27029 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
27030
27031 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27032
27033 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
27034
27035 @subsubheading Example
27036
27037 @smallexample
27038 -exec-continue
27039 ^running
27040 (gdb)
27041 @@Hello world
27042 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
27043 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
27044 line="13"@}
27045 (gdb)
27046 @end smallexample
27047
27048
27049 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
27050 @findex -exec-finish
27051
27052 @subsubheading Synopsis
27053
27054 @smallexample
27055 -exec-finish [--reverse]
27056 @end smallexample
27057
27058 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
27059 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
27060 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
27061 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
27062 function was called.
27063
27064 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27065
27066 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
27067
27068 @subsubheading Example
27069
27070 Function returning @code{void}.
27071
27072 @smallexample
27073 -exec-finish
27074 ^running
27075 (gdb)
27076 @@hello from foo
27077 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
27078 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
27079 (gdb)
27080 @end smallexample
27081
27082 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
27083 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
27084 value itself.
27085
27086 @smallexample
27087 -exec-finish
27088 ^running
27089 (gdb)
27090 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
27091 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
27092 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27093 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
27094 (gdb)
27095 @end smallexample
27096
27097
27098 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
27099 @findex -exec-interrupt
27100
27101 @subsubheading Synopsis
27102
27103 @smallexample
27104 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
27105 @end smallexample
27106
27107 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
27108 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
27109 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
27110 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
27111 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
27112
27113 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
27114 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
27115 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
27116 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
27117
27118 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
27119 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
27120 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
27121 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
27122
27123 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27124
27125 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
27126
27127 @subsubheading Example
27128
27129 @smallexample
27130 (gdb)
27131 111-exec-continue
27132 111^running
27133
27134 (gdb)
27135 222-exec-interrupt
27136 222^done
27137 (gdb)
27138 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
27139 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27140 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
27141 (gdb)
27142
27143 (gdb)
27144 -exec-interrupt
27145 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
27146 (gdb)
27147 @end smallexample
27148
27149 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
27150 @findex -exec-jump
27151
27152 @subsubheading Synopsis
27153
27154 @smallexample
27155 -exec-jump @var{location}
27156 @end smallexample
27157
27158 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
27159 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
27160 different forms of @var{location}.
27161
27162 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27163
27164 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
27165
27166 @subsubheading Example
27167
27168 @smallexample
27169 -exec-jump foo.c:10
27170 *running,thread-id="all"
27171 ^running
27172 @end smallexample
27173
27174
27175 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
27176 @findex -exec-next
27177
27178 @subsubheading Synopsis
27179
27180 @smallexample
27181 -exec-next [--reverse]
27182 @end smallexample
27183
27184 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
27185 of the next source line is reached.
27186
27187 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27188 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
27189 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
27190 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
27191 source line where the function was called.
27192
27193
27194 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27195
27196 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
27197
27198 @subsubheading Example
27199
27200 @smallexample
27201 -exec-next
27202 ^running
27203 (gdb)
27204 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
27205 (gdb)
27206 @end smallexample
27207
27208
27209 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
27210 @findex -exec-next-instruction
27211
27212 @subsubheading Synopsis
27213
27214 @smallexample
27215 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
27216 @end smallexample
27217
27218 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
27219 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
27220 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
27221 printed as well.
27222
27223 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27224 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
27225 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
27226 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
27227 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
27228
27229 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27230
27231 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
27232
27233 @subsubheading Example
27234
27235 @smallexample
27236 (gdb)
27237 -exec-next-instruction
27238 ^running
27239
27240 (gdb)
27241 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27242 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
27243 (gdb)
27244 @end smallexample
27245
27246
27247 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
27248 @findex -exec-return
27249
27250 @subsubheading Synopsis
27251
27252 @smallexample
27253 -exec-return
27254 @end smallexample
27255
27256 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
27257 Displays the new current frame.
27258
27259 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27260
27261 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
27262
27263 @subsubheading Example
27264
27265 @smallexample
27266 (gdb)
27267 200-break-insert callee4
27268 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
27269 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
27270 (gdb)
27271 000-exec-run
27272 000^running
27273 (gdb)
27274 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
27275 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27276 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27277 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
27278 (gdb)
27279 205-break-delete
27280 205^done
27281 (gdb)
27282 111-exec-return
27283 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
27284 args=[@{name="strarg",
27285 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27286 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27287 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27288 (gdb)
27289 @end smallexample
27290
27291
27292 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
27293 @findex -exec-run
27294
27295 @subsubheading Synopsis
27296
27297 @smallexample
27298 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
27299 @end smallexample
27300
27301 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
27302 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
27303 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
27304 the program has exited exceptionally.
27305
27306 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
27307 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
27308 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
27309 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
27310 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
27311
27312 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
27313 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
27314 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
27315 (@pxref{Starting}).
27316
27317 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27318
27319 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
27320
27321 @subsubheading Examples
27322
27323 @smallexample
27324 (gdb)
27325 -break-insert main
27326 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
27327 (gdb)
27328 -exec-run
27329 ^running
27330 (gdb)
27331 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
27332 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27333 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
27334 (gdb)
27335 @end smallexample
27336
27337 @noindent
27338 Program exited normally:
27339
27340 @smallexample
27341 (gdb)
27342 -exec-run
27343 ^running
27344 (gdb)
27345 x = 55
27346 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
27347 (gdb)
27348 @end smallexample
27349
27350 @noindent
27351 Program exited exceptionally:
27352
27353 @smallexample
27354 (gdb)
27355 -exec-run
27356 ^running
27357 (gdb)
27358 x = 55
27359 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
27360 (gdb)
27361 @end smallexample
27362
27363 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
27364 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
27365
27366 @smallexample
27367 (gdb)
27368 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
27369 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
27370 @end smallexample
27371
27372
27373 @c @subheading -exec-signal
27374
27375
27376 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
27377 @findex -exec-step
27378
27379 @subsubheading Synopsis
27380
27381 @smallexample
27382 -exec-step [--reverse]
27383 @end smallexample
27384
27385 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
27386 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
27387 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
27388 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
27389 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
27390 previously executed source line.
27391
27392 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27393
27394 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
27395
27396 @subsubheading Example
27397
27398 Stepping into a function:
27399
27400 @smallexample
27401 -exec-step
27402 ^running
27403 (gdb)
27404 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27405 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
27406 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
27407 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
27408 (gdb)
27409 @end smallexample
27410
27411 Regular stepping:
27412
27413 @smallexample
27414 -exec-step
27415 ^running
27416 (gdb)
27417 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
27418 (gdb)
27419 @end smallexample
27420
27421
27422 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
27423 @findex -exec-step-instruction
27424
27425 @subsubheading Synopsis
27426
27427 @smallexample
27428 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
27429 @end smallexample
27430
27431 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
27432 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
27433 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
27434 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
27435 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
27436 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
27437 as well.
27438
27439 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27440
27441 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
27442
27443 @subsubheading Example
27444
27445 @smallexample
27446 (gdb)
27447 -exec-step-instruction
27448 ^running
27449
27450 (gdb)
27451 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27452 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27453 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
27454 (gdb)
27455 -exec-step-instruction
27456 ^running
27457
27458 (gdb)
27459 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27460 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27461 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
27462 (gdb)
27463 @end smallexample
27464
27465
27466 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
27467 @findex -exec-until
27468
27469 @subsubheading Synopsis
27470
27471 @smallexample
27472 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
27473 @end smallexample
27474
27475 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
27476 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
27477 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
27478 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
27479
27480 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27481
27482 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
27483
27484 @subsubheading Example
27485
27486 @smallexample
27487 (gdb)
27488 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
27489 ^running
27490 (gdb)
27491 x = 55
27492 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
27493 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
27494 (gdb)
27495 @end smallexample
27496
27497 @ignore
27498 @subheading -file-clear
27499 Is this going away????
27500 @end ignore
27501
27502 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27503 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
27504 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
27505
27506 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
27507 @findex -enable-frame-filters
27508
27509 @smallexample
27510 -enable-frame-filters
27511 @end smallexample
27512
27513 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
27514 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
27515 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
27516 request that this functionality be enabled.
27517
27518 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
27519
27520 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
27521 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
27522
27523 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
27524 @findex -stack-info-frame
27525
27526 @subsubheading Synopsis
27527
27528 @smallexample
27529 -stack-info-frame
27530 @end smallexample
27531
27532 Get info on the selected frame.
27533
27534 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27535
27536 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
27537 (without arguments).
27538
27539 @subsubheading Example
27540
27541 @smallexample
27542 (gdb)
27543 -stack-info-frame
27544 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
27545 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27546 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
27547 (gdb)
27548 @end smallexample
27549
27550 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
27551 @findex -stack-info-depth
27552
27553 @subsubheading Synopsis
27554
27555 @smallexample
27556 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
27557 @end smallexample
27558
27559 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
27560 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
27561
27562 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27563
27564 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
27565
27566 @subsubheading Example
27567
27568 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
27569
27570 @smallexample
27571 (gdb)
27572 -stack-info-depth
27573 ^done,depth="12"
27574 (gdb)
27575 -stack-info-depth 4
27576 ^done,depth="4"
27577 (gdb)
27578 -stack-info-depth 12
27579 ^done,depth="12"
27580 (gdb)
27581 -stack-info-depth 11
27582 ^done,depth="11"
27583 (gdb)
27584 -stack-info-depth 13
27585 ^done,depth="12"
27586 (gdb)
27587 @end smallexample
27588
27589 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
27590 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
27591 @findex -stack-list-arguments
27592
27593 @subsubheading Synopsis
27594
27595 @smallexample
27596 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
27597 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
27598 @end smallexample
27599
27600 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
27601 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
27602 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
27603 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
27604 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
27605 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
27606 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
27607 which case only existing frames will be returned.
27608
27609 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
27610 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
27611 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
27612 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
27613 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
27614 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
27615
27616 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
27617 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
27618 are still displayed, however.
27619
27620 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
27621 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
27622
27623 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27624
27625 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
27626 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
27627 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
27628
27629 @subsubheading Example
27630
27631 @smallexample
27632 (gdb)
27633 -stack-list-frames
27634 ^done,
27635 stack=[
27636 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27637 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27638 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
27639 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
27640 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27641 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
27642 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
27643 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27644 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
27645 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
27646 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27647 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
27648 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
27649 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27650 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
27651 (gdb)
27652 -stack-list-arguments 0
27653 ^done,
27654 stack-args=[
27655 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
27656 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
27657 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
27658 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
27659 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
27660 (gdb)
27661 -stack-list-arguments 1
27662 ^done,
27663 stack-args=[
27664 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
27665 frame=@{level="1",
27666 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
27667 frame=@{level="2",args=[
27668 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
27669 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
27670 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
27671 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
27672 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
27673 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
27674 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
27675 (gdb)
27676 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
27677 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
27678 (gdb)
27679 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
27680 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
27681 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
27682 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
27683 (gdb)
27684 @end smallexample
27685
27686 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
27687
27688
27689 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
27690 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
27691 @findex -stack-list-frames
27692
27693 @subsubheading Synopsis
27694
27695 @smallexample
27696 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
27697 @end smallexample
27698
27699 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
27700 following info:
27701
27702 @table @samp
27703 @item @var{level}
27704 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
27705 @item @var{addr}
27706 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
27707 @item @var{func}
27708 Function name.
27709 @item @var{file}
27710 File name of the source file where the function lives.
27711 @item @var{fullname}
27712 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
27713 @item @var{line}
27714 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
27715 @item @var{from}
27716 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
27717 if the frame's function is not known.
27718 @end table
27719
27720 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
27721 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
27722 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
27723 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
27724 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
27725 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
27726 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
27727 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
27728 Python frame filters will not be executed.
27729
27730 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27731
27732 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
27733
27734 @subsubheading Example
27735
27736 Full stack backtrace:
27737
27738 @smallexample
27739 (gdb)
27740 -stack-list-frames
27741 ^done,stack=
27742 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
27743 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
27744 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27745 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27746 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27747 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27748 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27749 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27750 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27751 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27752 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27753 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27754 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27755 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27756 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27757 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27758 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27759 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27760 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27761 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27762 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27763 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27764 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
27765 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
27766 (gdb)
27767 @end smallexample
27768
27769 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
27770
27771 @smallexample
27772 (gdb)
27773 -stack-list-frames 3 5
27774 ^done,stack=
27775 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27776 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27777 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27778 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27779 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27780 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
27781 (gdb)
27782 @end smallexample
27783
27784 Show a single frame:
27785
27786 @smallexample
27787 (gdb)
27788 -stack-list-frames 3 3
27789 ^done,stack=
27790 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27791 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
27792 (gdb)
27793 @end smallexample
27794
27795
27796 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
27797 @findex -stack-list-locals
27798 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
27799
27800 @subsubheading Synopsis
27801
27802 @smallexample
27803 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
27804 @end smallexample
27805
27806 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
27807 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
27808 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
27809 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
27810 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
27811 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
27812 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
27813 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
27814 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
27815 Python frame filters will not be executed.
27816
27817 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
27818 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
27819 variables are still displayed, however.
27820
27821 This command is deprecated in favor of the
27822 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
27823
27824 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27825
27826 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
27827
27828 @subsubheading Example
27829
27830 @smallexample
27831 (gdb)
27832 -stack-list-locals 0
27833 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
27834 (gdb)
27835 -stack-list-locals --all-values
27836 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
27837 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
27838 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
27839 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
27840 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
27841 (gdb)
27842 @end smallexample
27843
27844 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
27845 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
27846 @findex -stack-list-variables
27847
27848 @subsubheading Synopsis
27849
27850 @smallexample
27851 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
27852 @end smallexample
27853
27854 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
27855 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
27856 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
27857 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
27858 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
27859 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
27860 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
27861
27862 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
27863 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
27864 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
27865
27866 @subsubheading Example
27867
27868 @smallexample
27869 (gdb)
27870 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
27871 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
27872 (gdb)
27873 @end smallexample
27874
27875
27876 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
27877 @findex -stack-select-frame
27878
27879 @subsubheading Synopsis
27880
27881 @smallexample
27882 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
27883 @end smallexample
27884
27885 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
27886 the stack.
27887
27888 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
27889 option to every command.
27890
27891 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27892
27893 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
27894 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
27895
27896 @subsubheading Example
27897
27898 @smallexample
27899 (gdb)
27900 -stack-select-frame 2
27901 ^done
27902 (gdb)
27903 @end smallexample
27904
27905 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27906 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
27907 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
27908
27909 @ignore
27910
27911 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
27912
27913 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
27914 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
27915 used by @code{Insight}.
27916
27917 The two main reasons for that are:
27918
27919 @enumerate 1
27920 @item
27921 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
27922
27923 @item
27924 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
27925 now).
27926 @end enumerate
27927
27928 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
27929 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
27930 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
27931 hints about their use.
27932
27933 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
27934 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
27935 least, the following operations:
27936
27937 @itemize @bullet
27938 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
27939 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
27940 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
27941 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
27942 @end itemize
27943
27944 @end ignore
27945
27946 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
27947
27948 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
27949
27950 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
27951 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
27952 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
27953 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
27954 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
27955 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
27956 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
27957 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
27958 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
27959 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
27960 object, or to change display format.
27961
27962 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
27963 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
27964 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
27965 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
27966 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
27967 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
27968 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
27969 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
27970 child will be created.
27971
27972 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
27973 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
27974 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
27975 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
27976 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
27977
27978 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
27979 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
27980 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
27981 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
27982 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
27983 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
27984 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
27985 variables that frontend has created.
27986
27987 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
27988 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
27989 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
27990 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
27991 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
27992 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
27993 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
27994 implicitly updated.
27995
27996 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
27997 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
27998 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
27999 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
28000 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
28001 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
28002 frame. Consider this example:
28003
28004 @smallexample
28005 void do_work(...)
28006 @{
28007 struct work_state state;
28008
28009 if (...)
28010 do_work(...);
28011 @}
28012 @end smallexample
28013
28014 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
28015 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
28016 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
28017 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
28018 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
28019
28020 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
28021 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
28022 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
28023 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
28024 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
28025 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
28026
28027 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
28028 access this functionality:
28029
28030 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
28031 @item @strong{Operation}
28032 @tab @strong{Description}
28033
28034 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
28035 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
28036 @item @code{-var-create}
28037 @tab create a variable object
28038 @item @code{-var-delete}
28039 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
28040 @item @code{-var-set-format}
28041 @tab set the display format of this variable
28042 @item @code{-var-show-format}
28043 @tab show the display format of this variable
28044 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
28045 @tab tells how many children this object has
28046 @item @code{-var-list-children}
28047 @tab return a list of the object's children
28048 @item @code{-var-info-type}
28049 @tab show the type of this variable object
28050 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
28051 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
28052 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
28053 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
28054 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
28055 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
28056 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
28057 @tab get the value of this variable
28058 @item @code{-var-assign}
28059 @tab set the value of this variable
28060 @item @code{-var-update}
28061 @tab update the variable and its children
28062 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
28063 @tab set frozeness attribute
28064 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
28065 @tab set range of children to display on update
28066 @end multitable
28067
28068 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
28069 how it can be used.
28070
28071 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
28072
28073 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
28074 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
28075
28076 @smallexample
28077 -enable-pretty-printing
28078 @end smallexample
28079
28080 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
28081 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
28082 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28083 request that this functionality be enabled.
28084
28085 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28086
28087 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28088 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28089
28090 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
28091 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
28092
28093 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
28094 @findex -var-create
28095
28096 @subsubheading Synopsis
28097
28098 @smallexample
28099 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
28100 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
28101 @end smallexample
28102
28103 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
28104 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
28105 register.
28106
28107 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
28108 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
28109 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
28110 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
28111 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
28112
28113 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
28114 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
28115 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
28116 object must be created.
28117
28118 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
28119 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
28120
28121 @itemize @bullet
28122 @item
28123 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
28124
28125 @item
28126 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
28127
28128 @item
28129 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
28130 @end itemize
28131
28132 @cindex dynamic varobj
28133 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
28134 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
28135 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
28136 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
28137 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
28138 compatibility for existing clients.
28139
28140 @subsubheading Result
28141
28142 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
28143 are:
28144
28145 @table @samp
28146 @item name
28147 The name of the varobj.
28148
28149 @item numchild
28150 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
28151 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
28152 @samp{has_more} attribute.
28153
28154 @item value
28155 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
28156 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
28157 will not be interesting.
28158
28159 @item type
28160 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
28161 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
28162 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
28163 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
28164 @emph{declared} one.
28165
28166 @item thread-id
28167 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
28168 thread's identifier.
28169
28170 @item has_more
28171 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
28172 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
28173
28174 @item dynamic
28175 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28176 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28177 then this attribute will not be present.
28178
28179 @item displayhint
28180 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28181 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28182 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28183 @end table
28184
28185 Typical output will look like this:
28186
28187 @smallexample
28188 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
28189 has_more="@var{has_more}"
28190 @end smallexample
28191
28192
28193 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
28194 @findex -var-delete
28195
28196 @subsubheading Synopsis
28197
28198 @smallexample
28199 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
28200 @end smallexample
28201
28202 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
28203 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
28204
28205 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
28206
28207
28208 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
28209 @findex -var-set-format
28210
28211 @subsubheading Synopsis
28212
28213 @smallexample
28214 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
28215 @end smallexample
28216
28217 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
28218 @var{format-spec}.
28219
28220 @anchor{-var-set-format}
28221 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
28222
28223 @smallexample
28224 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
28225 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
28226 @end smallexample
28227
28228 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
28229 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
28230 for pointers, etc.).
28231
28232 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
28233 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
28234
28235 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
28236 @findex -var-show-format
28237
28238 @subsubheading Synopsis
28239
28240 @smallexample
28241 -var-show-format @var{name}
28242 @end smallexample
28243
28244 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
28245
28246 @smallexample
28247 @var{format} @expansion{}
28248 @var{format-spec}
28249 @end smallexample
28250
28251
28252 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
28253 @findex -var-info-num-children
28254
28255 @subsubheading Synopsis
28256
28257 @smallexample
28258 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
28259 @end smallexample
28260
28261 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
28262
28263 @smallexample
28264 numchild=@var{n}
28265 @end smallexample
28266
28267 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
28268 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
28269 be available.
28270
28271
28272 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
28273 @findex -var-list-children
28274
28275 @subsubheading Synopsis
28276
28277 @smallexample
28278 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
28279 @end smallexample
28280 @anchor{-var-list-children}
28281
28282 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
28283 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
28284 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
28285 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
28286 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
28287 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
28288 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
28289 and unions.
28290
28291 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
28292 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
28293 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
28294 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
28295 reported.
28296
28297 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
28298 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
28299 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
28300 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
28301 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
28302 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
28303 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
28304 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
28305 the visible items.
28306
28307 For each child the following results are returned:
28308
28309 @table @var
28310
28311 @item name
28312 Name of the variable object created for this child.
28313
28314 @item exp
28315 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
28316 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
28317
28318 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
28319 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
28320
28321 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
28322 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
28323 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
28324 type and value are not present.
28325
28326 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
28327 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
28328 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
28329
28330 @item numchild
28331 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
28332 0.
28333
28334 @item type
28335 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
28336 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
28337 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
28338 @emph{declared} one.
28339
28340 @item value
28341 If values were requested, this is the value.
28342
28343 @item thread-id
28344 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
28345 Otherwise this result is not present.
28346
28347 @item frozen
28348 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
28349
28350 @item displayhint
28351 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28352 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28353 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28354
28355 @item dynamic
28356 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28357 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28358 then this attribute will not be present.
28359
28360 @end table
28361
28362 The result may have its own attributes:
28363
28364 @table @samp
28365 @item displayhint
28366 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28367 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28368 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28369
28370 @item has_more
28371 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
28372 remaining after the end of the selected range.
28373 @end table
28374
28375 @subsubheading Example
28376
28377 @smallexample
28378 (gdb)
28379 -var-list-children n
28380 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
28381 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
28382 (gdb)
28383 -var-list-children --all-values n
28384 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
28385 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
28386 @end smallexample
28387
28388
28389 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
28390 @findex -var-info-type
28391
28392 @subsubheading Synopsis
28393
28394 @smallexample
28395 -var-info-type @var{name}
28396 @end smallexample
28397
28398 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
28399 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
28400 @value{GDBN} CLI:
28401
28402 @smallexample
28403 type=@var{typename}
28404 @end smallexample
28405
28406
28407 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
28408 @findex -var-info-expression
28409
28410 @subsubheading Synopsis
28411
28412 @smallexample
28413 -var-info-expression @var{name}
28414 @end smallexample
28415
28416 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
28417 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
28418 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
28419
28420 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
28421 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
28422
28423 @smallexample
28424 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
28425 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
28426 @end smallexample
28427
28428 @noindent
28429 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
28430 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
28431
28432 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
28433 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
28434 is of limited use.
28435
28436 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
28437 @findex -var-info-path-expression
28438
28439 @subsubheading Synopsis
28440
28441 @smallexample
28442 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
28443 @end smallexample
28444
28445 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
28446 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
28447 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
28448 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
28449 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
28450 watchpoint from a variable object.
28451
28452 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
28453 and will give an error when invoked on one.
28454
28455 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
28456 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
28457 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
28458 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
28459 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
28460 @smallexample
28461 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
28462 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
28463 @end smallexample
28464
28465 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
28466 @findex -var-show-attributes
28467
28468 @subsubheading Synopsis
28469
28470 @smallexample
28471 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
28472 @end smallexample
28473
28474 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
28475
28476 @smallexample
28477 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
28478 @end smallexample
28479
28480 @noindent
28481 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
28482
28483 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
28484 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
28485
28486 @subsubheading Synopsis
28487
28488 @smallexample
28489 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
28490 @end smallexample
28491
28492 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
28493 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
28494 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
28495 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
28496 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
28497 the current display format will be used. The current display format
28498 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
28499
28500 @smallexample
28501 value=@var{value}
28502 @end smallexample
28503
28504 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
28505 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
28506
28507 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
28508 @findex -var-assign
28509
28510 @subsubheading Synopsis
28511
28512 @smallexample
28513 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
28514 @end smallexample
28515
28516 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
28517 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
28518 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
28519 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
28520
28521 @subsubheading Example
28522
28523 @smallexample
28524 (gdb)
28525 -var-assign var1 3
28526 ^done,value="3"
28527 (gdb)
28528 -var-update *
28529 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
28530 (gdb)
28531 @end smallexample
28532
28533 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
28534 @findex -var-update
28535
28536 @subsubheading Synopsis
28537
28538 @smallexample
28539 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
28540 @end smallexample
28541
28542 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
28543 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
28544 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
28545 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
28546 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
28547 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
28548 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
28549 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
28550 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
28551 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
28552 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
28553 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
28554 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
28555
28556 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
28557 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
28558 diagnostic.
28559
28560 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
28561 only the selected range of children will be reported.
28562
28563 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
28564 @samp{changelist}.
28565
28566 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
28567
28568 @table @samp
28569 @item name
28570 The name of the varobj.
28571
28572 @item value
28573 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
28574 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
28575
28576 @item in_scope
28577 @anchor{-var-update}
28578 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
28579
28580 @table @code
28581 @item "true"
28582 The variable object's current value is valid.
28583
28584 @item "false"
28585 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
28586 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
28587 scope.
28588
28589 @item "invalid"
28590 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
28591 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
28592 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
28593 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
28594 objects.
28595 @end table
28596
28597 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
28598 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
28599
28600 @item type_changed
28601 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
28602 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
28603 be @samp{false}.
28604
28605 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
28606 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
28607 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
28608 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
28609 unset.
28610
28611 @item new_type
28612 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
28613 hold the new type.
28614
28615 @item new_num_children
28616 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
28617 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
28618
28619 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
28620 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
28621 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
28622 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
28623 children which may be available.
28624
28625 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
28626 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
28627 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
28628 only happen at the end of the update range).
28629
28630 @item displayhint
28631 The display hint, if any.
28632
28633 @item has_more
28634 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
28635 available outside the varobj's update range.
28636
28637 @item dynamic
28638 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28639 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28640 then this attribute will not be present.
28641
28642 @item new_children
28643 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
28644 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
28645 be listed in this attribute.
28646 @end table
28647
28648 @subsubheading Example
28649
28650 @smallexample
28651 (gdb)
28652 -var-assign var1 3
28653 ^done,value="3"
28654 (gdb)
28655 -var-update --all-values var1
28656 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
28657 type_changed="false"@}]
28658 (gdb)
28659 @end smallexample
28660
28661 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
28662 @findex -var-set-frozen
28663 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
28664
28665 @subsubheading Synopsis
28666
28667 @smallexample
28668 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
28669 @end smallexample
28670
28671 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
28672 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
28673 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
28674 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
28675 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
28676 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
28677 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
28678 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
28679 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
28680 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
28681 @code{-var-update} does.
28682
28683 @subsubheading Example
28684
28685 @smallexample
28686 (gdb)
28687 -var-set-frozen V 1
28688 ^done
28689 (gdb)
28690 @end smallexample
28691
28692 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
28693 @findex -var-set-update-range
28694 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
28695
28696 @subsubheading Synopsis
28697
28698 @smallexample
28699 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
28700 @end smallexample
28701
28702 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
28703 @code{-var-update}.
28704
28705 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
28706 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
28707 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
28708 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
28709
28710 @subsubheading Example
28711
28712 @smallexample
28713 (gdb)
28714 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
28715 ^done
28716 @end smallexample
28717
28718 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
28719 @findex -var-set-visualizer
28720 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
28721
28722 @subsubheading Synopsis
28723
28724 @smallexample
28725 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
28726 @end smallexample
28727
28728 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
28729
28730 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
28731 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
28732
28733 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
28734 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
28735 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
28736 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
28737 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
28738 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
28739 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
28740
28741 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
28742 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
28743 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
28744 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
28745
28746 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
28747 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
28748 can be used to check this.
28749
28750 @subsubheading Example
28751
28752 Resetting the visualizer:
28753
28754 @smallexample
28755 (gdb)
28756 -var-set-visualizer V None
28757 ^done
28758 @end smallexample
28759
28760 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
28761
28762 @smallexample
28763 (gdb)
28764 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
28765 ^done
28766 @end smallexample
28767
28768 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
28769 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
28770
28771 @smallexample
28772 (gdb)
28773 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
28774 ^done
28775 @end smallexample
28776
28777 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28778 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
28779 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
28780
28781 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
28782 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
28783 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
28784 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
28785
28786 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
28787 @c @subheading -data-assign
28788 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
28789 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
28790 @c set variable
28791 @c @subsubheading Example
28792 @c N.A.
28793
28794 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
28795 @findex -data-disassemble
28796
28797 @subsubheading Synopsis
28798
28799 @smallexample
28800 -data-disassemble
28801 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
28802 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
28803 -- @var{mode}
28804 @end smallexample
28805
28806 @noindent
28807 Where:
28808
28809 @table @samp
28810 @item @var{start-addr}
28811 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
28812 @item @var{end-addr}
28813 is the end address
28814 @item @var{filename}
28815 is the name of the file to disassemble
28816 @item @var{linenum}
28817 is the line number to disassemble around
28818 @item @var{lines}
28819 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
28820 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
28821 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
28822 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
28823 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
28824 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
28825 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
28826 are displayed.
28827 @item @var{mode}
28828 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly), 1 (meaning mixed source and
28829 disassembly), 2 (meaning disassembly with raw opcodes), or 3 (meaning
28830 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes).
28831 @end table
28832
28833 @subsubheading Result
28834
28835 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
28836 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
28837 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
28838
28839 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
28840 following fields:
28841
28842 @table @code
28843 @item address
28844 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
28845
28846 @item func-name
28847 The name of the function this instruction is within.
28848
28849 @item offset
28850 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
28851
28852 @item inst
28853 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
28854
28855 @item opcodes
28856 This field is only present for mode 2. This contains the raw opcode
28857 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
28858
28859 @end table
28860
28861 For modes 1 and 3 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
28862 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
28863
28864 @table @code
28865 @item line
28866 The line number within @samp{file}.
28867
28868 @item file
28869 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
28870 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
28871 used.
28872
28873 @item fullname
28874 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
28875 using the source file search path
28876 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
28877 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
28878
28879 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
28880 present in the debug information.
28881
28882 @item line_asm_insn
28883 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
28884 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
28885 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
28886 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
28887 @samp{opcodes}.
28888
28889 @end table
28890
28891 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
28892 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
28893 adjust its format.
28894
28895 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28896
28897 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
28898
28899 @subsubheading Example
28900
28901 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
28902
28903 @smallexample
28904 (gdb)
28905 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
28906 ^done,
28907 asm_insns=[
28908 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
28909 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
28910 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
28911 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
28912 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
28913 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
28914 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
28915 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
28916 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
28917 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
28918 (gdb)
28919 @end smallexample
28920
28921 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
28922 @code{main}.
28923
28924 @smallexample
28925 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
28926 ^done,asm_insns=[
28927 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
28928 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
28929 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
28930 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
28931 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
28932 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
28933 [@dots{}]
28934 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
28935 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
28936 (gdb)
28937 @end smallexample
28938
28939 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
28940
28941 @smallexample
28942 (gdb)
28943 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
28944 ^done,asm_insns=[
28945 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
28946 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
28947 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
28948 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
28949 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
28950 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
28951 (gdb)
28952 @end smallexample
28953
28954 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
28955
28956 @smallexample
28957 (gdb)
28958 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
28959 ^done,asm_insns=[
28960 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
28961 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28962 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28963 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
28964 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
28965 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
28966 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28967 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28968 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
28969 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
28970 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
28971 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
28972 (gdb)
28973 @end smallexample
28974
28975
28976 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
28977 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
28978
28979 @subsubheading Synopsis
28980
28981 @smallexample
28982 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
28983 @end smallexample
28984
28985 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
28986 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
28987 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
28988
28989 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28990
28991 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
28992 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
28993 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
28994
28995 @subsubheading Example
28996
28997 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
28998 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
28999 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
29000 output.
29001
29002 @smallexample
29003 211-data-evaluate-expression A
29004 211^done,value="1"
29005 (gdb)
29006 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
29007 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
29008 (gdb)
29009 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
29010 411^done,value="4"
29011 (gdb)
29012 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
29013 511^done,value="4"
29014 (gdb)
29015 @end smallexample
29016
29017
29018 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
29019 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
29020
29021 @subsubheading Synopsis
29022
29023 @smallexample
29024 -data-list-changed-registers
29025 @end smallexample
29026
29027 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
29028
29029 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29030
29031 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
29032 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
29033
29034 @subsubheading Example
29035
29036 On a PPC MBX board:
29037
29038 @smallexample
29039 (gdb)
29040 -exec-continue
29041 ^running
29042
29043 (gdb)
29044 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
29045 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
29046 line="5"@}
29047 (gdb)
29048 -data-list-changed-registers
29049 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
29050 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
29051 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
29052 (gdb)
29053 @end smallexample
29054
29055
29056 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
29057 @findex -data-list-register-names
29058
29059 @subsubheading Synopsis
29060
29061 @smallexample
29062 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
29063 @end smallexample
29064
29065 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
29066 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
29067 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
29068 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
29069 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
29070 include empty register names.
29071
29072 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29073
29074 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
29075 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
29076 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
29077
29078 @subsubheading Example
29079
29080 For the PPC MBX board:
29081 @smallexample
29082 (gdb)
29083 -data-list-register-names
29084 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
29085 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
29086 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
29087 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
29088 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
29089 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
29090 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
29091 (gdb)
29092 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
29093 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
29094 (gdb)
29095 @end smallexample
29096
29097 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
29098 @findex -data-list-register-values
29099
29100 @subsubheading Synopsis
29101
29102 @smallexample
29103 -data-list-register-values
29104 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
29105 @end smallexample
29106
29107 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
29108 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
29109 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
29110 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be
29111 returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option indicates that only
29112 the available registers are to be returned.
29113
29114 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
29115
29116 @table @code
29117 @item x
29118 Hexadecimal
29119 @item o
29120 Octal
29121 @item t
29122 Binary
29123 @item d
29124 Decimal
29125 @item r
29126 Raw
29127 @item N
29128 Natural
29129 @end table
29130
29131 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29132
29133 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
29134 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
29135
29136 @subsubheading Example
29137
29138 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
29139 don't appear in the actual output):
29140
29141 @smallexample
29142 (gdb)
29143 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
29144 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29145 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
29146 (gdb)
29147 -data-list-register-values x
29148 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
29149 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29150 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
29151 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
29152 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
29153 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
29154 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
29155 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
29156 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
29157 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29158 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
29159 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
29160 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
29161 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
29162 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
29163 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
29164 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
29165 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
29166 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
29167 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
29168 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
29169 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
29170 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
29171 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
29172 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
29173 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
29174 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
29175 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
29176 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
29177 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
29178 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
29179 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
29180 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29181 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
29182 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
29183 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
29184 (gdb)
29185 @end smallexample
29186
29187
29188 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
29189 @findex -data-read-memory
29190
29191 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
29192
29193 @subsubheading Synopsis
29194
29195 @smallexample
29196 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
29197 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
29198 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
29199 @end smallexample
29200
29201 @noindent
29202 where:
29203
29204 @table @samp
29205 @item @var{address}
29206 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29207 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29208 quoted using the C convention.
29209
29210 @item @var{word-format}
29211 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
29212 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
29213 ,Output Formats}).
29214
29215 @item @var{word-size}
29216 The size of each memory word in bytes.
29217
29218 @item @var{nr-rows}
29219 The number of rows in the output table.
29220
29221 @item @var{nr-cols}
29222 The number of columns in the output table.
29223
29224 @item @var{aschar}
29225 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
29226 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
29227 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
29228 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
29229
29230 @item @var{byte-offset}
29231 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
29232 @end table
29233
29234 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
29235 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
29236 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
29237 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
29238 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
29239 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
29240 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
29241 @samp{addr}.
29242
29243 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
29244 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
29245 @samp{prev-page}.
29246
29247 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29248
29249 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
29250 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
29251
29252 @subsubheading Example
29253
29254 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
29255 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
29256 word. Display each word in hex.
29257
29258 @smallexample
29259 (gdb)
29260 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
29261 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
29262 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
29263 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
29264 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
29265 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
29266 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
29267 (gdb)
29268 @end smallexample
29269
29270 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
29271 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
29272
29273 @smallexample
29274 (gdb)
29275 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
29276 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
29277 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
29278 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
29279 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
29280 (gdb)
29281 @end smallexample
29282
29283 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
29284 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
29285 used as the non-printable character.
29286
29287 @smallexample
29288 (gdb)
29289 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
29290 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
29291 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
29292 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
29293 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29294 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29295 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29296 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29297 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
29298 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
29299 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
29300 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
29301 (gdb)
29302 @end smallexample
29303
29304 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
29305 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
29306
29307 @subsubheading Synopsis
29308
29309 @smallexample
29310 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
29311 @var{address} @var{count}
29312 @end smallexample
29313
29314 @noindent
29315 where:
29316
29317 @table @samp
29318 @item @var{address}
29319 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29320 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29321 quoted using the C convention.
29322
29323 @item @var{count}
29324 The number of bytes to read. This should be an integer literal.
29325
29326 @item @var{byte-offset}
29327 The offsets in bytes relative to @var{address} at which to start
29328 reading. This should be an integer literal. This option is provided
29329 so that a frontend is not required to first evaluate address and then
29330 perform address arithmetics itself.
29331
29332 @end table
29333
29334 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
29335 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
29336 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
29337 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
29338 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
29339 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
29340
29341 In general, every single byte in the region may be readable or not,
29342 and the only way to read every readable byte is to try a read at
29343 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
29344 attempt to read all accessible bytes at either beginning or the end
29345 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
29346 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
29347 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
29348 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
29349
29350 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
29351 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
29352 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
29353 and has the following fields:
29354
29355 @table @code
29356 @item begin
29357 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
29358
29359 @item end
29360 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
29361
29362 @item offset
29363 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
29364 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
29365
29366 @item contents
29367 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
29368
29369 @end table
29370
29371
29372
29373 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29374
29375 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
29376
29377 @subsubheading Example
29378
29379 @smallexample
29380 (gdb)
29381 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
29382 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
29383 end="0xbffff15e",
29384 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
29385 (gdb)
29386 @end smallexample
29387
29388
29389 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
29390 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
29391
29392 @subsubheading Synopsis
29393
29394 @smallexample
29395 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
29396 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
29397 @end smallexample
29398
29399 @noindent
29400 where:
29401
29402 @table @samp
29403 @item @var{address}
29404 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29405 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29406 quoted using the C convention.
29407
29408 @item @var{contents}
29409 The hex-encoded bytes to write.
29410
29411 @item @var{count}
29412 Optional argument indicating the number of bytes to be written. If @var{count}
29413 is greater than @var{contents}' length, @value{GDBN} will repeatedly
29414 write @var{contents} until it fills @var{count} bytes.
29415
29416 @end table
29417
29418 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29419
29420 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
29421
29422 @subsubheading Example
29423
29424 @smallexample
29425 (gdb)
29426 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
29427 ^done
29428 (gdb)
29429 @end smallexample
29430
29431 @smallexample
29432 (gdb)
29433 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
29434 ^done
29435 (gdb)
29436 @end smallexample
29437
29438 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29439 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
29440 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
29441
29442 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
29443 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
29444
29445 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
29446 @findex -trace-find
29447
29448 @subsubheading Synopsis
29449
29450 @smallexample
29451 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
29452 @end smallexample
29453
29454 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
29455 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
29456 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
29457
29458 @table @samp
29459
29460 @item none
29461 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
29462
29463 @item frame-number
29464 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
29465 that index.
29466
29467 @item tracepoint-number
29468 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
29469 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
29470
29471 @item pc
29472 An address is required as parameter. Finds
29473 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
29474 address.
29475
29476 @item pc-inside-range
29477 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
29478 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
29479 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
29480
29481 @item pc-outside-range
29482 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
29483 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
29484 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
29485
29486 @item line
29487 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
29488 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
29489 the specified location.
29490
29491 @end table
29492
29493 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
29494 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
29495
29496 @table @samp
29497 @item found
29498 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
29499 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
29500
29501 @item traceframe
29502 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
29503 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
29504
29505 @item tracepoint
29506 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
29507 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
29508
29509 @item frame
29510 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
29511 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
29512 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
29513
29514 @end table
29515
29516 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29517
29518 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
29519
29520 @subheading -trace-define-variable
29521 @findex -trace-define-variable
29522
29523 @subsubheading Synopsis
29524
29525 @smallexample
29526 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
29527 @end smallexample
29528
29529 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
29530 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
29531 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
29532 with the @samp{$} character.
29533
29534 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29535
29536 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
29537
29538 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
29539 @findex -trace-frame-collected
29540
29541 @subsubheading Synopsis
29542
29543 @smallexample
29544 -trace-frame-collected
29545 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
29546 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
29547 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
29548 [--memory-contents]
29549 @end smallexample
29550
29551 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
29552 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
29553 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
29554 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
29555 See the output description table below for more details.
29556
29557 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
29558 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
29559 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
29560 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
29561 memory range and which is a computed expression.
29562
29563 For instance, if the actions were
29564 @smallexample
29565 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
29566 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
29567 @end smallexample
29568
29569 @noindent
29570 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
29571 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
29572 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
29573 objects would be computed expressions.
29574
29575 An example output would be:
29576
29577 @smallexample
29578 (gdb)
29579 -trace-frame-collected
29580 ^done,
29581 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
29582 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
29583 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
29584 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
29585 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
29586 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
29587 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
29588 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
29589 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
29590 ...
29591 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
29592 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
29593 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
29594 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
29595 (gdb)
29596 @end smallexample
29597
29598 Where:
29599
29600 @table @code
29601 @item explicit-variables
29602 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
29603 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
29604 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
29605 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
29606 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
29607 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
29608 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
29609 arrays, structures and unions.
29610
29611 @item computed-expressions
29612 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
29613 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
29614 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
29615 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
29616
29617 @item registers
29618 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
29619 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
29620 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
29621 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
29622 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
29623
29624 @item tvars
29625 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
29626 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
29627 current value are returned.
29628
29629 @item memory
29630 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
29631 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
29632 collected memory range and has the following fields:
29633
29634 @table @code
29635 @item address
29636 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
29637
29638 @item length
29639 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
29640
29641 @item contents
29642 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
29643 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
29644
29645 @end table
29646
29647 @end table
29648
29649 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29650
29651 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
29652
29653 @subsubheading Example
29654
29655 @subheading -trace-list-variables
29656 @findex -trace-list-variables
29657
29658 @subsubheading Synopsis
29659
29660 @smallexample
29661 -trace-list-variables
29662 @end smallexample
29663
29664 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
29665 table has the following fields:
29666
29667 @table @samp
29668 @item name
29669 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
29670
29671 @item initial
29672 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
29673 field is always present.
29674
29675 @item current
29676 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
29677 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
29678 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
29679 presently running.
29680
29681 @end table
29682
29683 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29684
29685 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
29686
29687 @subsubheading Example
29688
29689 @smallexample
29690 (gdb)
29691 -trace-list-variables
29692 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
29693 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
29694 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
29695 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
29696 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
29697 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
29698 (gdb)
29699 @end smallexample
29700
29701 @subheading -trace-save
29702 @findex -trace-save
29703
29704 @subsubheading Synopsis
29705
29706 @smallexample
29707 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
29708 @end smallexample
29709
29710 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
29711 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
29712 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
29713 to perform the save.
29714
29715 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29716
29717 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
29718
29719
29720 @subheading -trace-start
29721 @findex -trace-start
29722
29723 @subsubheading Synopsis
29724
29725 @smallexample
29726 -trace-start
29727 @end smallexample
29728
29729 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
29730 have any fields.
29731
29732 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29733
29734 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
29735
29736 @subheading -trace-status
29737 @findex -trace-status
29738
29739 @subsubheading Synopsis
29740
29741 @smallexample
29742 -trace-status
29743 @end smallexample
29744
29745 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
29746 the following fields:
29747
29748 @table @samp
29749
29750 @item supported
29751 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
29752 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
29753 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
29754 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
29755 started. This field is always present.
29756
29757 @item running
29758 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
29759 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
29760 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
29761
29762 @item stop-reason
29763 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
29764 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
29765 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
29766 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
29767 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
29768 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
29769 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
29770 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
29771 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
29772
29773 @item stopping-tracepoint
29774 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
29775 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
29776 @samp{passcount}.
29777
29778 @item frames
29779 @itemx frames-created
29780 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
29781 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
29782 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
29783 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
29784
29785 @item buffer-size
29786 @itemx buffer-free
29787 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
29788 remaining space. These fields are optional.
29789
29790 @item circular
29791 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
29792 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
29793 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
29794 and may fill up.
29795
29796 @item disconnected
29797 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
29798 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
29799 that the trace run will stop.
29800
29801 @item trace-file
29802 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
29803 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
29804
29805 @end table
29806
29807 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29808
29809 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
29810
29811 @subheading -trace-stop
29812 @findex -trace-stop
29813
29814 @subsubheading Synopsis
29815
29816 @smallexample
29817 -trace-stop
29818 @end smallexample
29819
29820 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
29821 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
29822 @samp{running} fields are not output.
29823
29824 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29825
29826 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
29827
29828
29829 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29830 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
29831 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
29832
29833
29834 @ignore
29835 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
29836 @findex -symbol-info-address
29837
29838 @subsubheading Synopsis
29839
29840 @smallexample
29841 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
29842 @end smallexample
29843
29844 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
29845
29846 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29847
29848 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
29849
29850 @subsubheading Example
29851 N.A.
29852
29853
29854 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
29855 @findex -symbol-info-file
29856
29857 @subsubheading Synopsis
29858
29859 @smallexample
29860 -symbol-info-file
29861 @end smallexample
29862
29863 Show the file for the symbol.
29864
29865 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29866
29867 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
29868 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
29869
29870 @subsubheading Example
29871 N.A.
29872
29873
29874 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
29875 @findex -symbol-info-function
29876
29877 @subsubheading Synopsis
29878
29879 @smallexample
29880 -symbol-info-function
29881 @end smallexample
29882
29883 Show which function the symbol lives in.
29884
29885 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29886
29887 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
29888
29889 @subsubheading Example
29890 N.A.
29891
29892
29893 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
29894 @findex -symbol-info-line
29895
29896 @subsubheading Synopsis
29897
29898 @smallexample
29899 -symbol-info-line
29900 @end smallexample
29901
29902 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
29903
29904 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29905
29906 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
29907 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
29908
29909 @subsubheading Example
29910 N.A.
29911
29912
29913 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
29914 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
29915
29916 @subsubheading Synopsis
29917
29918 @smallexample
29919 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
29920 @end smallexample
29921
29922 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
29923
29924 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29925
29926 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
29927
29928 @subsubheading Example
29929 N.A.
29930
29931
29932 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
29933 @findex -symbol-list-functions
29934
29935 @subsubheading Synopsis
29936
29937 @smallexample
29938 -symbol-list-functions
29939 @end smallexample
29940
29941 List the functions in the executable.
29942
29943 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29944
29945 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
29946 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
29947
29948 @subsubheading Example
29949 N.A.
29950 @end ignore
29951
29952
29953 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
29954 @findex -symbol-list-lines
29955
29956 @subsubheading Synopsis
29957
29958 @smallexample
29959 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
29960 @end smallexample
29961
29962 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
29963 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
29964 ascending PC order.
29965
29966 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29967
29968 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
29969
29970 @subsubheading Example
29971 @smallexample
29972 (gdb)
29973 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
29974 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
29975 (gdb)
29976 @end smallexample
29977
29978
29979 @ignore
29980 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
29981 @findex -symbol-list-types
29982
29983 @subsubheading Synopsis
29984
29985 @smallexample
29986 -symbol-list-types
29987 @end smallexample
29988
29989 List all the type names.
29990
29991 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29992
29993 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
29994 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
29995
29996 @subsubheading Example
29997 N.A.
29998
29999
30000 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
30001 @findex -symbol-list-variables
30002
30003 @subsubheading Synopsis
30004
30005 @smallexample
30006 -symbol-list-variables
30007 @end smallexample
30008
30009 List all the global and static variable names.
30010
30011 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30012
30013 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30014
30015 @subsubheading Example
30016 N.A.
30017
30018
30019 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
30020 @findex -symbol-locate
30021
30022 @subsubheading Synopsis
30023
30024 @smallexample
30025 -symbol-locate
30026 @end smallexample
30027
30028 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30029
30030 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
30031
30032 @subsubheading Example
30033 N.A.
30034
30035
30036 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
30037 @findex -symbol-type
30038
30039 @subsubheading Synopsis
30040
30041 @smallexample
30042 -symbol-type @var{variable}
30043 @end smallexample
30044
30045 Show type of @var{variable}.
30046
30047 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30048
30049 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
30050 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
30051
30052 @subsubheading Example
30053 N.A.
30054 @end ignore
30055
30056
30057 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30058 @node GDB/MI File Commands
30059 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
30060
30061 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
30062 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
30063
30064 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
30065 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
30066
30067 @subsubheading Synopsis
30068
30069 @smallexample
30070 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
30071 @end smallexample
30072
30073 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
30074 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
30075 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
30076 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
30077 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
30078 notification.
30079
30080 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30081
30082 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
30083
30084 @subsubheading Example
30085
30086 @smallexample
30087 (gdb)
30088 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30089 ^done
30090 (gdb)
30091 @end smallexample
30092
30093
30094 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
30095 @findex -file-exec-file
30096
30097 @subsubheading Synopsis
30098
30099 @smallexample
30100 -file-exec-file @var{file}
30101 @end smallexample
30102
30103 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
30104 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
30105 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
30106 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
30107 notification.
30108
30109 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30110
30111 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
30112
30113 @subsubheading Example
30114
30115 @smallexample
30116 (gdb)
30117 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30118 ^done
30119 (gdb)
30120 @end smallexample
30121
30122
30123 @ignore
30124 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
30125 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
30126
30127 @subsubheading Synopsis
30128
30129 @smallexample
30130 -file-list-exec-sections
30131 @end smallexample
30132
30133 List the sections of the current executable file.
30134
30135 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30136
30137 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
30138 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
30139 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
30140
30141 @subsubheading Example
30142 N.A.
30143 @end ignore
30144
30145
30146 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
30147 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
30148
30149 @subsubheading Synopsis
30150
30151 @smallexample
30152 -file-list-exec-source-file
30153 @end smallexample
30154
30155 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
30156 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
30157 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
30158 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
30159
30160 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30161
30162 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
30163
30164 @subsubheading Example
30165
30166 @smallexample
30167 (gdb)
30168 123-file-list-exec-source-file
30169 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
30170 (gdb)
30171 @end smallexample
30172
30173
30174 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
30175 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
30176
30177 @subsubheading Synopsis
30178
30179 @smallexample
30180 -file-list-exec-source-files
30181 @end smallexample
30182
30183 List the source files for the current executable.
30184
30185 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
30186 name) of a source file.
30187
30188 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30189
30190 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
30191 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
30192
30193 @subsubheading Example
30194 @smallexample
30195 (gdb)
30196 -file-list-exec-source-files
30197 ^done,files=[
30198 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
30199 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
30200 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
30201 (gdb)
30202 @end smallexample
30203
30204 @ignore
30205 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
30206 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
30207
30208 @subsubheading Synopsis
30209
30210 @smallexample
30211 -file-list-shared-libraries
30212 @end smallexample
30213
30214 List the shared libraries in the program.
30215
30216 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30217
30218 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
30219
30220 @subsubheading Example
30221 N.A.
30222
30223
30224 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
30225 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
30226
30227 @subsubheading Synopsis
30228
30229 @smallexample
30230 -file-list-symbol-files
30231 @end smallexample
30232
30233 List symbol files.
30234
30235 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30236
30237 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
30238
30239 @subsubheading Example
30240 N.A.
30241 @end ignore
30242
30243
30244 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
30245 @findex -file-symbol-file
30246
30247 @subsubheading Synopsis
30248
30249 @smallexample
30250 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
30251 @end smallexample
30252
30253 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
30254 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
30255 produced, except for a completion notification.
30256
30257 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30258
30259 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
30260
30261 @subsubheading Example
30262
30263 @smallexample
30264 (gdb)
30265 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30266 ^done
30267 (gdb)
30268 @end smallexample
30269
30270 @ignore
30271 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30272 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
30273 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
30274
30275 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
30276
30277 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
30278
30279 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
30280
30281 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
30282
30283 @c @subheading -overlay-map
30284
30285 @c @subheading -overlay-off
30286
30287 @c @subheading -overlay-on
30288
30289 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
30290
30291 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30292 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
30293 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
30294
30295 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
30296
30297 @c @subheading -signal-handle
30298
30299 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
30300
30301 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
30302 @end ignore
30303
30304
30305 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30306 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
30307 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
30308
30309
30310 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
30311 @findex -target-attach
30312
30313 @subsubheading Synopsis
30314
30315 @smallexample
30316 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
30317 @end smallexample
30318
30319 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
30320 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
30321 group, the id previously returned by
30322 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
30323
30324 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30325
30326 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
30327
30328 @subsubheading Example
30329 @smallexample
30330 (gdb)
30331 -target-attach 34
30332 =thread-created,id="1"
30333 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
30334 ^done
30335 (gdb)
30336 @end smallexample
30337
30338 @ignore
30339 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
30340 @findex -target-compare-sections
30341
30342 @subsubheading Synopsis
30343
30344 @smallexample
30345 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
30346 @end smallexample
30347
30348 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
30349 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
30350
30351 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30352
30353 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
30354
30355 @subsubheading Example
30356 N.A.
30357 @end ignore
30358
30359
30360 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
30361 @findex -target-detach
30362
30363 @subsubheading Synopsis
30364
30365 @smallexample
30366 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
30367 @end smallexample
30368
30369 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
30370 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
30371 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
30372
30373 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30374
30375 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
30376
30377 @subsubheading Example
30378
30379 @smallexample
30380 (gdb)
30381 -target-detach
30382 ^done
30383 (gdb)
30384 @end smallexample
30385
30386
30387 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
30388 @findex -target-disconnect
30389
30390 @subsubheading Synopsis
30391
30392 @smallexample
30393 -target-disconnect
30394 @end smallexample
30395
30396 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
30397 generally not resumed.
30398
30399 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30400
30401 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
30402
30403 @subsubheading Example
30404
30405 @smallexample
30406 (gdb)
30407 -target-disconnect
30408 ^done
30409 (gdb)
30410 @end smallexample
30411
30412
30413 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
30414 @findex -target-download
30415
30416 @subsubheading Synopsis
30417
30418 @smallexample
30419 -target-download
30420 @end smallexample
30421
30422 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
30423 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
30424
30425 @table @samp
30426 @item section
30427 The name of the section.
30428 @item section-sent
30429 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
30430 @item section-size
30431 The size of the section.
30432 @item total-sent
30433 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
30434 @item total-size
30435 The size of the overall executable to download.
30436 @end table
30437
30438 @noindent
30439 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
30440 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
30441
30442 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
30443 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
30444
30445 @table @samp
30446 @item section
30447 The name of the section.
30448 @item section-size
30449 The size of the section.
30450 @item total-size
30451 The size of the overall executable to download.
30452 @end table
30453
30454 @noindent
30455 At the end, a summary is printed.
30456
30457 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30458
30459 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
30460
30461 @subsubheading Example
30462
30463 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
30464 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
30465
30466 @smallexample
30467 (gdb)
30468 -target-download
30469 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
30470 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
30471 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
30472 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
30473 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
30474 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
30475 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
30476 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
30477 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
30478 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
30479 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
30480 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
30481 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
30482 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
30483 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
30484 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
30485 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
30486 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
30487 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
30488 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
30489 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
30490 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
30491 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
30492 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
30493 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
30494 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
30495 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
30496 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
30497 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
30498 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
30499 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
30500 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
30501 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
30502 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
30503 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
30504 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
30505 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
30506 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
30507 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
30508 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
30509 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
30510 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
30511 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
30512 write-rate="429"
30513 (gdb)
30514 @end smallexample
30515
30516
30517 @ignore
30518 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
30519 @findex -target-exec-status
30520
30521 @subsubheading Synopsis
30522
30523 @smallexample
30524 -target-exec-status
30525 @end smallexample
30526
30527 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
30528 not, for instance).
30529
30530 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30531
30532 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
30533
30534 @subsubheading Example
30535 N.A.
30536
30537
30538 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
30539 @findex -target-list-available-targets
30540
30541 @subsubheading Synopsis
30542
30543 @smallexample
30544 -target-list-available-targets
30545 @end smallexample
30546
30547 List the possible targets to connect to.
30548
30549 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30550
30551 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
30552
30553 @subsubheading Example
30554 N.A.
30555
30556
30557 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
30558 @findex -target-list-current-targets
30559
30560 @subsubheading Synopsis
30561
30562 @smallexample
30563 -target-list-current-targets
30564 @end smallexample
30565
30566 Describe the current target.
30567
30568 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30569
30570 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
30571 other things).
30572
30573 @subsubheading Example
30574 N.A.
30575
30576
30577 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
30578 @findex -target-list-parameters
30579
30580 @subsubheading Synopsis
30581
30582 @smallexample
30583 -target-list-parameters
30584 @end smallexample
30585
30586 @c ????
30587 @end ignore
30588
30589 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30590
30591 No equivalent.
30592
30593 @subsubheading Example
30594 N.A.
30595
30596
30597 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
30598 @findex -target-select
30599
30600 @subsubheading Synopsis
30601
30602 @smallexample
30603 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
30604 @end smallexample
30605
30606 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
30607
30608 @table @samp
30609 @item @var{type}
30610 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
30611 @item @var{parameters}
30612 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
30613 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
30614 @end table
30615
30616 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
30617 which the target program is, in the following form:
30618
30619 @smallexample
30620 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
30621 args=[@var{arg list}]
30622 @end smallexample
30623
30624 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30625
30626 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
30627
30628 @subsubheading Example
30629
30630 @smallexample
30631 (gdb)
30632 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
30633 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
30634 (gdb)
30635 @end smallexample
30636
30637 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30638 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
30639 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
30640
30641
30642 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
30643 @findex -target-file-put
30644
30645 @subsubheading Synopsis
30646
30647 @smallexample
30648 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
30649 @end smallexample
30650
30651 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
30652 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
30653
30654 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30655
30656 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
30657
30658 @subsubheading Example
30659
30660 @smallexample
30661 (gdb)
30662 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
30663 ^done
30664 (gdb)
30665 @end smallexample
30666
30667
30668 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
30669 @findex -target-file-get
30670
30671 @subsubheading Synopsis
30672
30673 @smallexample
30674 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
30675 @end smallexample
30676
30677 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
30678 on the host system.
30679
30680 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30681
30682 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
30683
30684 @subsubheading Example
30685
30686 @smallexample
30687 (gdb)
30688 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
30689 ^done
30690 (gdb)
30691 @end smallexample
30692
30693
30694 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
30695 @findex -target-file-delete
30696
30697 @subsubheading Synopsis
30698
30699 @smallexample
30700 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
30701 @end smallexample
30702
30703 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
30704
30705 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30706
30707 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
30708
30709 @subsubheading Example
30710
30711 @smallexample
30712 (gdb)
30713 -target-file-delete remotefile
30714 ^done
30715 (gdb)
30716 @end smallexample
30717
30718
30719 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30720 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
30721 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
30722
30723 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
30724 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
30725
30726 @subsubheading Synopsis
30727
30728 @smallexample
30729 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
30730 @end smallexample
30731
30732 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
30733 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
30734 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
30735
30736 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30737
30738 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
30739
30740 @subsubheading Result
30741
30742 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
30743 defined for each exception:
30744
30745 @table @samp
30746 @item name
30747 The name of the exception.
30748
30749 @item address
30750 The address of the exception.
30751
30752 @end table
30753
30754 @subsubheading Example
30755
30756 @smallexample
30757 -info-ada-exceptions aint
30758 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
30759 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
30760 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
30761 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
30762 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
30763 @end smallexample
30764
30765 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
30766
30767 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
30768 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
30769 Catchpoint Commands}.
30770
30771
30772 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30773 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
30774 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
30775
30776 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
30777 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
30778 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
30779 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
30780
30781 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
30782 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
30783 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
30784
30785 @subsubheading Synopsis
30786
30787 @smallexample
30788 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
30789 @end smallexample
30790
30791 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
30792
30793 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
30794 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
30795 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
30796 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
30797 dash.
30798
30799 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30800
30801 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30802
30803 @subsubheading Result
30804
30805 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
30806
30807 @table @samp
30808 @item exists
30809 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
30810 @code{"false"} otherwise.
30811
30812 @end table
30813
30814 @subsubheading Example
30815
30816 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
30817
30818 @smallexample
30819 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
30820 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
30821 @end smallexample
30822
30823 @noindent
30824 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
30825 to the debugger:
30826
30827 @smallexample
30828 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
30829 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
30830 @end smallexample
30831
30832 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
30833 @findex -list-features
30834 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
30835
30836 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
30837 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
30838 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
30839 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
30840 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
30841 startup.
30842
30843 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
30844 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
30845 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
30846 is given below.
30847
30848 Example output:
30849
30850 @smallexample
30851 (gdb) -list-features
30852 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
30853 @end smallexample
30854
30855 The current list of features is:
30856
30857 @ftable @samp
30858 @item frozen-varobjs
30859 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
30860 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
30861 of @code{-varobj-create}.
30862 @item pending-breakpoints
30863 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
30864 command.
30865 @item python
30866 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
30867 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
30868 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
30869 @item thread-info
30870 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
30871 @item data-read-memory-bytes
30872 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
30873 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
30874 @item breakpoint-notifications
30875 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
30876 CLI will be announced via async records.
30877 @item ada-task-info
30878 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
30879 @item language-option
30880 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
30881 option (@pxref{Context management}).
30882 @item info-gdb-mi-command
30883 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
30884 @item undefined-command-error-code
30885 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
30886 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
30887 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
30888 @item exec-run-start-option
30889 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
30890 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
30891 @end ftable
30892
30893 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
30894 @findex -list-target-features
30895
30896 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
30897 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
30898 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
30899 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
30900 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
30901 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
30902 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
30903 Example output:
30904
30905 @smallexample
30906 (gdb) -list-target-features
30907 ^done,result=["async"]
30908 @end smallexample
30909
30910 The current list of features is:
30911
30912 @table @samp
30913 @item async
30914 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
30915 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
30916 while the target is running.
30917
30918 @item reverse
30919 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
30920 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
30921
30922 @end table
30923
30924 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30925 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
30926 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
30927
30928 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
30929
30930 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
30931 @findex -gdb-exit
30932
30933 @subsubheading Synopsis
30934
30935 @smallexample
30936 -gdb-exit
30937 @end smallexample
30938
30939 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
30940
30941 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30942
30943 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
30944
30945 @subsubheading Example
30946
30947 @smallexample
30948 (gdb)
30949 -gdb-exit
30950 ^exit
30951 @end smallexample
30952
30953
30954 @ignore
30955 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
30956 @findex -exec-abort
30957
30958 @subsubheading Synopsis
30959
30960 @smallexample
30961 -exec-abort
30962 @end smallexample
30963
30964 Kill the inferior running program.
30965
30966 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30967
30968 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
30969
30970 @subsubheading Example
30971 N.A.
30972 @end ignore
30973
30974
30975 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
30976 @findex -gdb-set
30977
30978 @subsubheading Synopsis
30979
30980 @smallexample
30981 -gdb-set
30982 @end smallexample
30983
30984 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
30985 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
30986
30987 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30988
30989 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
30990
30991 @subsubheading Example
30992
30993 @smallexample
30994 (gdb)
30995 -gdb-set $foo=3
30996 ^done
30997 (gdb)
30998 @end smallexample
30999
31000
31001 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
31002 @findex -gdb-show
31003
31004 @subsubheading Synopsis
31005
31006 @smallexample
31007 -gdb-show
31008 @end smallexample
31009
31010 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
31011
31012 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31013
31014 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
31015
31016 @subsubheading Example
31017
31018 @smallexample
31019 (gdb)
31020 -gdb-show annotate
31021 ^done,value="0"
31022 (gdb)
31023 @end smallexample
31024
31025 @c @subheading -gdb-source
31026
31027
31028 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
31029 @findex -gdb-version
31030
31031 @subsubheading Synopsis
31032
31033 @smallexample
31034 -gdb-version
31035 @end smallexample
31036
31037 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
31038
31039 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31040
31041 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
31042 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
31043
31044 @subsubheading Example
31045
31046 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
31047 @c box in TeX.
31048 @smallexample
31049 (gdb)
31050 -gdb-version
31051 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
31052 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
31053 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
31054 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
31055 ~ certain conditions.
31056 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
31057 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
31058 ~ details.
31059 ~This GDB was configured as
31060 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
31061 ^done
31062 (gdb)
31063 @end smallexample
31064
31065 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
31066 @findex -list-thread-groups
31067
31068 @subheading Synopsis
31069
31070 @smallexample
31071 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
31072 @end smallexample
31073
31074 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
31075 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
31076 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
31077 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
31078 top-level thread groups.
31079
31080 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
31081 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
31082 available on the target.
31083
31084 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
31085 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
31086 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
31087 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
31088 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
31089 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
31090 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
31091 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
31092
31093 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
31094 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
31095 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
31096 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
31097 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
31098 @samp{threads} field.
31099
31100 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
31101 the following caveats:
31102
31103 @itemize @bullet
31104 @item
31105 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
31106 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
31107 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
31108
31109 @item
31110 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
31111 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
31112 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
31113 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
31114 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
31115 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
31116
31117 @end itemize
31118
31119 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
31120 have the following fields:
31121
31122 @table @code
31123 @item id
31124 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
31125 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
31126 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
31127
31128 @item type
31129 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
31130 valid type.
31131
31132 @item pid
31133 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
31134 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
31135
31136 @item num_children
31137 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
31138 absent for an available thread group.
31139
31140 @item threads
31141 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
31142 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
31143 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
31144
31145 @item cores
31146 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
31147 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
31148 such information is not available.
31149
31150 @item executable
31151 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
31152 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
31153 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
31154
31155 @end table
31156
31157 @subheading Example
31158
31159 @smallexample
31160 @value{GDBP}
31161 -list-thread-groups
31162 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
31163 -list-thread-groups 17
31164 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
31165 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
31166 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
31167 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
31168 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
31169 -list-thread-groups --available
31170 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
31171 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
31172 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31173 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31174 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
31175 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
31176 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31177 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31178 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
31179 @end smallexample
31180
31181 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
31182 @findex -info-os
31183
31184 @subsubheading Synopsis
31185
31186 @smallexample
31187 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
31188 @end smallexample
31189
31190 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
31191 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
31192 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
31193 of data of that type.
31194
31195 The types of information available depend on the target operating
31196 system.
31197
31198 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31199
31200 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
31201
31202 @subsubheading Example
31203
31204 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
31205 like this:
31206
31207 @smallexample
31208 @value{GDBP}
31209 -info-os
31210 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="9",nr_cols="3",
31211 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
31212 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
31213 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
31214 body=[item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
31215 col2="Processes"@},
31216 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
31217 col2="Process groups"@},
31218 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
31219 col2="Threads"@},
31220 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
31221 col2="File descriptors"@},
31222 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
31223 col2="Sockets"@},
31224 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
31225 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
31226 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
31227 col2="Semaphores"@},
31228 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
31229 col2="Message queues"@},
31230 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
31231 col2="Kernel modules"@}]@}
31232 @value{GDBP}
31233 -info-os processes
31234 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
31235 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
31236 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
31237 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
31238 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
31239 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
31240 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
31241 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
31242 ...
31243 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
31244 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
31245 (gdb)
31246 @end smallexample
31247
31248 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
31249 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
31250 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
31251 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
31252 @code{info os} omits it.)
31253
31254 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
31255 @findex -add-inferior
31256
31257 @subheading Synopsis
31258
31259 @smallexample
31260 -add-inferior
31261 @end smallexample
31262
31263 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
31264 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
31265 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
31266 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
31267 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
31268 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
31269
31270 @subheading Example
31271
31272 @smallexample
31273 @value{GDBP}
31274 -add-inferior
31275 ^done,inferior="i3"
31276 @end smallexample
31277
31278 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
31279 @findex -interpreter-exec
31280
31281 @subheading Synopsis
31282
31283 @smallexample
31284 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
31285 @end smallexample
31286 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
31287
31288 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
31289
31290 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31291
31292 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
31293
31294 @subheading Example
31295
31296 @smallexample
31297 (gdb)
31298 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
31299 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
31300 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
31301 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
31302 ^done
31303 (gdb)
31304 @end smallexample
31305
31306 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
31307 @findex -inferior-tty-set
31308
31309 @subheading Synopsis
31310
31311 @smallexample
31312 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31313 @end smallexample
31314
31315 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
31316
31317 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31318
31319 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
31320
31321 @subheading Example
31322
31323 @smallexample
31324 (gdb)
31325 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31326 ^done
31327 (gdb)
31328 @end smallexample
31329
31330 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
31331 @findex -inferior-tty-show
31332
31333 @subheading Synopsis
31334
31335 @smallexample
31336 -inferior-tty-show
31337 @end smallexample
31338
31339 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
31340
31341 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31342
31343 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
31344
31345 @subheading Example
31346
31347 @smallexample
31348 (gdb)
31349 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31350 ^done
31351 (gdb)
31352 -inferior-tty-show
31353 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
31354 (gdb)
31355 @end smallexample
31356
31357 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
31358 @findex -enable-timings
31359
31360 @subheading Synopsis
31361
31362 @smallexample
31363 -enable-timings [yes | no]
31364 @end smallexample
31365
31366 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
31367 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
31368 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
31369 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
31370
31371 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31372
31373 No equivalent.
31374
31375 @subheading Example
31376
31377 @smallexample
31378 (gdb)
31379 -enable-timings
31380 ^done
31381 (gdb)
31382 -break-insert main
31383 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
31384 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
31385 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
31386 times="0"@},
31387 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
31388 (gdb)
31389 -enable-timings no
31390 ^done
31391 (gdb)
31392 -exec-run
31393 ^running
31394 (gdb)
31395 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
31396 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
31397 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
31398 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
31399 (gdb)
31400 @end smallexample
31401
31402 @node Annotations
31403 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
31404
31405 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
31406 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
31407 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
31408 relatively high level.
31409
31410 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
31411 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
31412
31413 @ignore
31414 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
31415 @end ignore
31416
31417 @menu
31418 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
31419 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
31420 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
31421 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
31422 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
31423 * Annotations for Running::
31424 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
31425 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
31426 @end menu
31427
31428 @node Annotations Overview
31429 @section What is an Annotation?
31430 @cindex annotations
31431
31432 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
31433 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
31434 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
31435 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
31436 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
31437 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
31438 cannot contain newline characters.
31439
31440 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
31441 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
31442 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
31443 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
31444 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
31445 means those three characters as output.
31446
31447 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
31448 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
31449 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
31450 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
31451 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
31452 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
31453 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
31454 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
31455 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
31456
31457 @table @code
31458 @kindex set annotate
31459 @item set annotate @var{level}
31460 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
31461 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
31462
31463 @item show annotate
31464 @kindex show annotate
31465 Show the current annotation level.
31466 @end table
31467
31468 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
31469
31470 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
31471
31472 @smallexample
31473 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
31474 GNU gdb 6.0
31475 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
31476 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
31477 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
31478 under certain conditions.
31479 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
31480 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
31481 for details.
31482 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
31483
31484 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
31485 (@value{GDBP})
31486 ^Z^Zprompt
31487 @kbd{quit}
31488
31489 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
31490 $
31491 @end smallexample
31492
31493 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
31494 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
31495 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
31496 output from @value{GDBN}.
31497
31498 @node Server Prefix
31499 @section The Server Prefix
31500 @cindex server prefix
31501
31502 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
31503 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
31504 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
31505 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
31506 a transparent manner.
31507
31508 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
31509 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
31510 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
31511 @code{print} command.
31512
31513 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
31514 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
31515
31516 @node Prompting
31517 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
31518
31519 @cindex annotations for prompts
31520 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
31521 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
31522 over, etc.
31523
31524 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
31525 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
31526 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
31527 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
31528 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
31529 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
31530 features the following annotations:
31531
31532 @smallexample
31533 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
31534 ^Z^Zprompt
31535 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
31536 @end smallexample
31537
31538 The input types are
31539
31540 @table @code
31541 @findex pre-prompt annotation
31542 @findex prompt annotation
31543 @findex post-prompt annotation
31544 @item prompt
31545 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
31546
31547 @findex pre-commands annotation
31548 @findex commands annotation
31549 @findex post-commands annotation
31550 @item commands
31551 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
31552 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
31553
31554 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
31555 @findex overload-choice annotation
31556 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
31557 @item overload-choice
31558 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
31559
31560 @findex pre-query annotation
31561 @findex query annotation
31562 @findex post-query annotation
31563 @item query
31564 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
31565
31566 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
31567 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
31568 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
31569 @item prompt-for-continue
31570 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
31571 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
31572 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
31573 presence of annotations.
31574 @end table
31575
31576 @node Errors
31577 @section Errors
31578 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
31579
31580 @findex quit annotation
31581 @smallexample
31582 ^Z^Zquit
31583 @end smallexample
31584
31585 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
31586
31587 @findex error annotation
31588 @smallexample
31589 ^Z^Zerror
31590 @end smallexample
31591
31592 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
31593
31594 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
31595 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
31596 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
31597 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
31598 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
31599 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
31600 to the top level.
31601
31602 @findex error-begin annotation
31603 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
31604
31605 @smallexample
31606 ^Z^Zerror-begin
31607 @end smallexample
31608
31609 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
31610 message.
31611
31612 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
31613 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
31614 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
31615
31616 @node Invalidation
31617 @section Invalidation Notices
31618
31619 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
31620 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
31621 changed.
31622
31623 @table @code
31624 @findex frames-invalid annotation
31625 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
31626
31627 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
31628 have changed.
31629
31630 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
31631 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
31632
31633 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
31634 deleted a breakpoint.
31635 @end table
31636
31637 @node Annotations for Running
31638 @section Running the Program
31639 @cindex annotations for running programs
31640
31641 @findex starting annotation
31642 @findex stopping annotation
31643 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
31644 @code{step} or @code{continue},
31645
31646 @smallexample
31647 ^Z^Zstarting
31648 @end smallexample
31649
31650 is output. When the program stops,
31651
31652 @smallexample
31653 ^Z^Zstopped
31654 @end smallexample
31655
31656 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
31657 annotations describe how the program stopped.
31658
31659 @table @code
31660 @findex exited annotation
31661 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
31662 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
31663 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
31664
31665 @findex signalled annotation
31666 @findex signal-name annotation
31667 @findex signal-name-end annotation
31668 @findex signal-string annotation
31669 @findex signal-string-end annotation
31670 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
31671 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
31672 annotation continues:
31673
31674 @smallexample
31675 @var{intro-text}
31676 ^Z^Zsignal-name
31677 @var{name}
31678 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
31679 @var{middle-text}
31680 ^Z^Zsignal-string
31681 @var{string}
31682 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
31683 @var{end-text}
31684 @end smallexample
31685
31686 @noindent
31687 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
31688 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
31689 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
31690 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
31691 user's benefit and have no particular format.
31692
31693 @findex signal annotation
31694 @item ^Z^Zsignal
31695 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
31696 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
31697 terminated with it.
31698
31699 @findex breakpoint annotation
31700 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
31701 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
31702
31703 @findex watchpoint annotation
31704 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
31705 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
31706 @end table
31707
31708 @node Source Annotations
31709 @section Displaying Source
31710 @cindex annotations for source display
31711
31712 @findex source annotation
31713 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
31714
31715 @smallexample
31716 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
31717 @end smallexample
31718
31719 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
31720 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
31721 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
31722 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
31723 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
31724 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
31725 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
31726 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
31727 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
31728 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
31729 depend on the language).
31730
31731 @node JIT Interface
31732 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
31733 @cindex just-in-time compilation
31734 @cindex JIT compilation interface
31735
31736 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
31737 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
31738 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
31739 performance while maintaining platform independence.
31740
31741 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
31742 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
31743 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
31744 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
31745 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
31746 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
31747
31748 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
31749 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
31750 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
31751 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
31752 LLVM JIT.
31753
31754 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
31755 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
31756 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
31757 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
31758 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
31759 out about additional code.
31760
31761 @menu
31762 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
31763 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
31764 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
31765 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
31766 @end menu
31767
31768 @node Declarations
31769 @section JIT Declarations
31770
31771 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
31772 implement the interface:
31773
31774 @smallexample
31775 typedef enum
31776 @{
31777 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
31778 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
31779 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
31780 @} jit_actions_t;
31781
31782 struct jit_code_entry
31783 @{
31784 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
31785 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
31786 const char *symfile_addr;
31787 uint64_t symfile_size;
31788 @};
31789
31790 struct jit_descriptor
31791 @{
31792 uint32_t version;
31793 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
31794 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
31795 uint32_t action_flag;
31796 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
31797 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
31798 @};
31799
31800 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
31801 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
31802
31803 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
31804 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
31805 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
31806 @end smallexample
31807
31808 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
31809 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
31810 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
31811
31812 @node Registering Code
31813 @section Registering Code
31814
31815 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
31816
31817 @itemize @bullet
31818 @item
31819 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
31820 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
31821
31822 @item
31823 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
31824 file.
31825
31826 @item
31827 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
31828
31829 @item
31830 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
31831
31832 @item
31833 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
31834 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
31835 @end itemize
31836
31837 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
31838 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
31839 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
31840 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
31841
31842 @node Unregistering Code
31843 @section Unregistering Code
31844
31845 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
31846
31847 @itemize @bullet
31848 @item
31849 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
31850
31851 @item
31852 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
31853
31854 @item
31855 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
31856 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
31857 @end itemize
31858
31859 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
31860 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
31861
31862 @node Custom Debug Info
31863 @section Custom Debug Info
31864 @cindex custom JIT debug info
31865 @cindex JIT debug info reader
31866
31867 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
31868 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
31869 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
31870 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
31871 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
31872 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
31873 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
31874 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
31875 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
31876
31877 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
31878 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
31879 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
31880 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
31881 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
31882 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
31883 compiler.
31884
31885 @menu
31886 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
31887 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
31888 @end menu
31889
31890 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
31891 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
31892 @kindex jit-reader-load
31893 @kindex jit-reader-unload
31894
31895 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
31896 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
31897
31898 @table @code
31899 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
31900 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}. @var{reader} is a shared
31901 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
31902 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
31903 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
31904 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
31905 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
31906
31907 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
31908 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
31909 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
31910 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
31911 @code{jit-reader-load}.
31912
31913 @item jit-reader-unload
31914 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
31915
31916 @end table
31917
31918 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
31919 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
31920 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
31921
31922 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
31923 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
31924
31925 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
31926 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
31927 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
31928 the system include directory.
31929
31930 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
31931 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
31932 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
31933
31934 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
31935 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
31936
31937 @findex gdb_init_reader
31938 @smallexample
31939 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
31940 @end smallexample
31941
31942 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
31943
31944 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
31945 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
31946 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
31947 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
31948 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
31949 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
31950
31951 @smallexample
31952 struct gdb_reader_funcs
31953 @{
31954 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
31955 int reader_version;
31956
31957 /* For use by the reader. */
31958 void *priv_data;
31959
31960 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
31961 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
31962 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
31963 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
31964 @};
31965 @end smallexample
31966
31967 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
31968 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
31969
31970 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
31971 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
31972 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
31973 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
31974 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
31975 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
31976 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
31977 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
31978 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
31979 target's address space.
31980
31981 @node In-Process Agent
31982 @chapter In-Process Agent
31983 @cindex debugging agent
31984 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
31985 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
31986 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
31987 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
31988 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
31989 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
31990 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
31991 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
31992 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
31993 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
31994 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
31995 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
31996 behavior without interrupting it.
31997
31998 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
31999 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
32000 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
32001 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
32002 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
32003 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
32004 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
32005 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
32006 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
32007
32008 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
32009 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
32010 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
32011 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
32012
32013 @anchor{Control Agent}
32014 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
32015 debugging with the following commands:
32016
32017 @table @code
32018 @kindex set agent on
32019 @item set agent on
32020 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
32021 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
32022 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
32023 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
32024 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
32025 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
32026
32027 @kindex set agent off
32028 @item set agent off
32029 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
32030 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
32031
32032 @kindex show agent
32033 @item show agent
32034 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
32035 the in-process agent.
32036 @end table
32037
32038 @menu
32039 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
32040 @end menu
32041
32042 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
32043 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
32044 @cindex in-process agent protocol
32045
32046 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
32047 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
32048 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
32049 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
32050 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
32051 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
32052 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
32053 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
32054 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
32055
32056 @menu
32057 * IPA Protocol Objects::
32058 * IPA Protocol Commands::
32059 @end menu
32060
32061 @node IPA Protocol Objects
32062 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
32063 @cindex ipa protocol objects
32064
32065 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
32066 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
32067
32068 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
32069 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
32070 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
32071 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
32072
32073 @enumerate
32074 @item
32075 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
32076 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
32077 @item
32078 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
32079 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
32080 the other one.
32081 @end enumerate
32082
32083 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
32084
32085 @enumerate
32086 @item
32087 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
32088 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
32089 @anchor{agent expression object}
32090 @item
32091 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
32092 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
32093 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
32094 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
32095 @item
32096 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
32097 @anchor{tracepoint object}
32098
32099 @end enumerate
32100
32101 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
32102 object:
32103
32104 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
32105 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
32106 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
32107 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
32108 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
32109 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
32110 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32111 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
32112 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
32113 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
32114 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
32115 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
32116 memory address for collecting.
32117 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
32118 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32119 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
32120 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32121 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
32122 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32123 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
32124 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
32125 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
32126 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
32127 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
32128 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
32129 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
32130 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
32131 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
32132 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
32133 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
32134 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
32135 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
32136 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
32137 @ref{agent expression object}
32138 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
32139 @ref{agent expression object}
32140 @item actions @tab variable
32141 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
32142 @end multitable
32143
32144 @node IPA Protocol Commands
32145 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
32146 @cindex ipa protocol commands
32147
32148 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
32149 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
32150
32151 @table @samp
32152
32153 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
32154 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
32155 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
32156 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
32157 in IPA finally.
32158
32159 Replies:
32160 @table @samp
32161 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
32162 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
32163 @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
32164 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
32165 @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
32166 @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
32167 @item E @var{NN}
32168 for an error
32169
32170 @end table
32171
32172 @item close
32173 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
32174 is about to kill inferiors.
32175
32176 @item qTfSTM
32177 @xref{qTfSTM}.
32178 @item qTsSTM
32179 @xref{qTsSTM}.
32180 @item qTSTMat
32181 @xref{qTSTMat}.
32182 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
32183 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
32184
32185 Replies:
32186 @table @samp
32187 @item E @var{NN}
32188 for an error
32189 @end table
32190 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
32191 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
32192 @end table
32193
32194 @node GDB Bugs
32195 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
32196 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
32197 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
32198
32199 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
32200
32201 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
32202 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
32203 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
32204 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
32205
32206 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
32207 information that enables us to fix the bug.
32208
32209 @menu
32210 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
32211 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
32212 @end menu
32213
32214 @node Bug Criteria
32215 @section Have You Found a Bug?
32216 @cindex bug criteria
32217
32218 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
32219
32220 @itemize @bullet
32221 @cindex fatal signal
32222 @cindex debugger crash
32223 @cindex crash of debugger
32224 @item
32225 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
32226 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
32227
32228 @cindex error on valid input
32229 @item
32230 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
32231 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
32232 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
32233
32234 @cindex invalid input
32235 @item
32236 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
32237 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
32238 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
32239 for traditional practice''.
32240
32241 @item
32242 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
32243 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
32244 @end itemize
32245
32246 @node Bug Reporting
32247 @section How to Report Bugs
32248 @cindex bug reports
32249 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
32250
32251 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
32252 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
32253 contact that organization first.
32254
32255 You can find contact information for many support companies and
32256 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
32257 distribution.
32258 @c should add a web page ref...
32259
32260 @ifset BUGURL
32261 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
32262 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
32263 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
32264 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
32265 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
32266 be used.
32267
32268 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
32269 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
32270 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
32271 @samp{bug-gdb}.
32272
32273 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
32274 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
32275 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
32276 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
32277 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
32278 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
32279 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
32280 bug reports to the mailing list.
32281 @end ifset
32282 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
32283 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
32284 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
32285 @end ifclear
32286 @end ifset
32287
32288 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
32289 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
32290 fact or leave it out, state it!
32291
32292 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
32293 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
32294 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
32295 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
32296 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
32297 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
32298 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
32299 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
32300 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
32301
32302 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
32303 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
32304 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
32305 self-contained.
32306
32307 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
32308 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
32309 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
32310 bugs properly.
32311
32312 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
32313
32314 @itemize @bullet
32315 @item
32316 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
32317 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
32318 version}.
32319
32320 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
32321 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
32322
32323 @item
32324 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
32325 version number.
32326
32327 @item
32328 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
32329 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
32330 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
32331 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
32332
32333 @item
32334 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
32335 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
32336
32337 @item
32338 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
32339 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
32340 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
32341 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
32342 those compilers.
32343
32344 @item
32345 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
32346 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
32347 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
32348 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
32349
32350 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
32351 and then we might not encounter the bug.
32352
32353 @item
32354 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
32355 reproduce the bug.
32356
32357 @item
32358 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
32359 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
32360
32361 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
32362 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
32363 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
32364 a chance to make a mistake.
32365
32366 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
32367 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
32368 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
32369 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
32370 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
32371 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
32372 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
32373 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
32374
32375 @pindex script
32376 @cindex recording a session script
32377 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
32378 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
32379 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
32380 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
32381
32382 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
32383 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
32384
32385 @item
32386 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
32387 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
32388 it by context, not by line number.
32389
32390 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
32391 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
32392
32393 @end itemize
32394
32395 Here are some things that are not necessary:
32396
32397 @itemize @bullet
32398 @item
32399 A description of the envelope of the bug.
32400
32401 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
32402 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
32403 changes will not affect it.
32404
32405 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
32406 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
32407 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
32408 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
32409
32410 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
32411 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
32412 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
32413 less time, and so on.
32414
32415 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
32416 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
32417
32418 @item
32419 A patch for the bug.
32420
32421 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
32422 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
32423 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
32424 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
32425
32426 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
32427 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
32428 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
32429 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
32430
32431 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
32432 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
32433 help us to understand.
32434
32435 @item
32436 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
32437
32438 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
32439 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
32440 @end itemize
32441
32442 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
32443 @c and consists of the two following files:
32444 @c rluser.texi
32445 @c hsuser.texi
32446 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
32447 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
32448 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
32449 @include rluser.texi
32450 @include hsuser.texi
32451 @end ifclear
32452
32453 @node In Memoriam
32454 @appendix In Memoriam
32455
32456 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
32457 contributors:
32458
32459 @table @code
32460 @item Fred Fish
32461 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
32462 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
32463 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
32464
32465 @item Michael Snyder
32466 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
32467 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
32468 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
32469 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
32470 @end table
32471
32472 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
32473 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
32474
32475 @node Formatting Documentation
32476 @appendix Formatting Documentation
32477
32478 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
32479 @cindex reference card
32480 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
32481 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
32482 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
32483 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
32484 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
32485 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
32486
32487 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
32488 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
32489
32490 @smallexample
32491 make refcard.dvi
32492 @end smallexample
32493
32494 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
32495 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
32496 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
32497 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
32498 your @sc{dvi} output program.
32499
32500 @cindex documentation
32501
32502 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
32503 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
32504 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
32505 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
32506 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
32507 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
32508
32509 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
32510 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
32511 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
32512 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
32513 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
32514 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
32515 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
32516 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
32517
32518 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
32519 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
32520 @code{makeinfo}.
32521
32522 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
32523 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
32524 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
32525
32526 @smallexample
32527 cd gdb
32528 make gdb.info
32529 @end smallexample
32530
32531 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
32532 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
32533 Texinfo definitions file.
32534
32535 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
32536 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
32537 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
32538 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
32539 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
32540 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
32541 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
32542
32543 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
32544 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
32545 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
32546 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
32547 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
32548 directory.
32549
32550 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
32551 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
32552 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
32553 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
32554
32555 @smallexample
32556 make gdb.dvi
32557 @end smallexample
32558
32559 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
32560
32561 @node Installing GDB
32562 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
32563 @cindex installation
32564
32565 @menu
32566 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
32567 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
32568 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
32569 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
32570 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
32571 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
32572 @end menu
32573
32574 @node Requirements
32575 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
32576 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
32577
32578 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
32579 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
32580
32581 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
32582 @table @asis
32583 @item ISO C90 compiler
32584 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
32585 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
32586
32587 @end table
32588
32589 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
32590 @table @asis
32591 @item Expat
32592 @anchor{Expat}
32593 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
32594 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
32595 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
32596 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
32597 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
32598 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
32599
32600 Expat is used for:
32601
32602 @itemize @bullet
32603 @item
32604 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
32605 @item
32606 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
32607 @item
32608 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
32609 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
32610 @item
32611 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
32612 @item
32613 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
32614 @item
32615 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format})
32616 @end itemize
32617
32618 @item zlib
32619 @cindex compressed debug sections
32620 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
32621 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
32622 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
32623 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
32624 information in such binaries.
32625
32626 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
32627 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
32628 @url{http://zlib.net}.
32629
32630 @item iconv
32631 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
32632 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
32633 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
32634 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
32635
32636 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
32637 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
32638 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
32639 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
32640
32641 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
32642 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
32643 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
32644
32645 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
32646 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
32647 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
32648 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
32649 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
32650 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
32651 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
32652 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
32653 @end table
32654
32655 @node Running Configure
32656 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
32657 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
32658 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
32659 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
32660 build the @code{gdb} program.
32661 @iftex
32662 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
32663 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
32664 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
32665 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
32666 @end iftex
32667
32668 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
32669 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
32670 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
32671
32672 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
32673 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
32674
32675 @table @code
32676 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
32677 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
32678
32679 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
32680 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
32681
32682 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
32683 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
32684
32685 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
32686 @sc{gnu} include files
32687
32688 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
32689 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
32690
32691 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
32692 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
32693
32694 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
32695 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
32696
32697 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
32698 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
32699
32700 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
32701 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
32702 @end table
32703
32704 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
32705 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
32706 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
32707
32708 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
32709 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
32710 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
32711 argument.
32712
32713 For example:
32714
32715 @smallexample
32716 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
32717 ./configure @var{host}
32718 make
32719 @end smallexample
32720
32721 @noindent
32722 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
32723 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
32724 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
32725 correct value by examining your system.)
32726
32727 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
32728 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
32729 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
32730 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
32731
32732 @need 750
32733 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
32734 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
32735 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
32736
32737 @smallexample
32738 sh configure @var{host}
32739 @end smallexample
32740
32741 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
32742 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
32743 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
32744 @file{configure}
32745 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
32746 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
32747
32748 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
32749 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
32750 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
32751 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
32752 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
32753 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
32754 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
32755 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
32756 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
32757
32758 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
32759 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
32760 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
32761 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
32762 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
32763
32764 @node Separate Objdir
32765 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
32766
32767 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
32768 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
32769 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
32770 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
32771 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
32772 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
32773 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
32774 program specified there.
32775
32776 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
32777 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
32778 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
32779 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
32780 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
32781 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
32782
32783 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
32784 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
32785
32786 @smallexample
32787 @group
32788 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
32789 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
32790 cd ../gdb-sun4
32791 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
32792 make
32793 @end group
32794 @end smallexample
32795
32796 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
32797 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
32798 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
32799 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
32800 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
32801 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
32802
32803 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
32804 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
32805 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
32806 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
32807 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
32808
32809 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
32810 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
32811 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
32812 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
32813 You specify a cross-debugging target by
32814 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
32815
32816 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
32817 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
32818 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
32819
32820 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
32821 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
32822 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
32823 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
32824 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
32825
32826 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
32827 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
32828 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
32829 with each other.
32830
32831 @node Config Names
32832 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
32833
32834 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
32835 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
32836 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
32837 of information in the following pattern:
32838
32839 @smallexample
32840 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
32841 @end smallexample
32842
32843 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
32844 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
32845 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
32846
32847 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
32848 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
32849 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
32850 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
32851 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
32852 abbreviations---for example:
32853
32854 @smallexample
32855 % sh config.sub i386-linux
32856 i386-pc-linux-gnu
32857 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
32858 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
32859 % sh config.sub hp9k700
32860 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
32861 % sh config.sub sun4
32862 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
32863 % sh config.sub sun3
32864 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
32865 % sh config.sub i986v
32866 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
32867 @end smallexample
32868
32869 @noindent
32870 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
32871 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
32872
32873 @node Configure Options
32874 @section @file{configure} Options
32875
32876 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
32877 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
32878 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
32879 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
32880
32881 @smallexample
32882 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
32883 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
32884 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
32885 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
32886 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
32887 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
32888 @var{host}
32889 @end smallexample
32890
32891 @noindent
32892 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
32893 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
32894 @samp{--}.
32895
32896 @table @code
32897 @item --help
32898 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
32899
32900 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
32901 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
32902 @file{@var{dir}}.
32903
32904 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
32905 Configure the source to install programs under directory
32906 @file{@var{dir}}.
32907
32908 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
32909 @need 2000
32910 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
32911 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
32912 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
32913 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
32914 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
32915 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
32916 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
32917 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
32918 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
32919 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
32920 @var{dirname}.
32921
32922 @item --norecursion
32923 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
32924 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
32925
32926 @item --target=@var{target}
32927 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
32928 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
32929 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
32930
32931 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
32932
32933 @item @var{host} @dots{}
32934 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
32935
32936 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
32937 @end table
32938
32939 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
32940 needed for special purposes only.
32941
32942 @node System-wide configuration
32943 @section System-wide configuration and settings
32944 @cindex system-wide init file
32945
32946 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
32947 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
32948 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
32949
32950 Here is the corresponding configure option:
32951
32952 @table @code
32953 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
32954 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
32955 @var{file}.
32956 @end table
32957
32958 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
32959 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
32960
32961 @itemize @bullet
32962 @item
32963 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
32964 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
32965 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
32966 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
32967 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
32968 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
32969
32970 @item
32971 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
32972 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
32973 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
32974 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
32975 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
32976 @end itemize
32977
32978 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
32979 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
32980 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
32981 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
32982 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
32983 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
32984 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
32985 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
32986 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
32987 reread.
32988
32989 @menu
32990 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
32991 @end menu
32992
32993 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
32994 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
32995 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
32996
32997 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
32998 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
32999 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
33000 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
33001 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
33002 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
33003
33004 The following scripts are currently available:
33005 @itemize @bullet
33006
33007 @item @file{elinos.py}
33008 @pindex elinos.py
33009 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
33010 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
33011 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
33012 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
33013 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
33014 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
33015
33016 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
33017 @pindex wrs-linux.py
33018 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
33019 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
33020 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
33021 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
33022
33023 @end itemize
33024
33025 @node Maintenance Commands
33026 @appendix Maintenance Commands
33027 @cindex maintenance commands
33028 @cindex internal commands
33029
33030 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
33031 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
33032 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
33033 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
33034 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
33035
33036 @table @code
33037 @kindex maint agent
33038 @kindex maint agent-eval
33039 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33040 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33041 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
33042 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
33043 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
33044 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
33045 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
33046 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
33047 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
33048 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
33049 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
33050 addition and return the sum.
33051 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
33052 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
33053
33054 @kindex maint agent-printf
33055 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
33056 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
33057 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
33058 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
33059 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
33060
33061 @kindex maint info breakpoints
33062 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
33063 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
33064 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
33065 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
33066 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
33067 is shown:
33068
33069 @table @code
33070 @item breakpoint
33071 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
33072
33073 @item watchpoint
33074 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
33075
33076 @item longjmp
33077 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
33078 @code{longjmp} calls.
33079
33080 @item longjmp resume
33081 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
33082
33083 @item until
33084 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
33085
33086 @item finish
33087 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
33088
33089 @item shlib events
33090 Shared library events.
33091
33092 @end table
33093
33094 @kindex maint info bfds
33095 @item maint info bfds
33096 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
33097 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Top, , BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}.
33098
33099 @kindex set displaced-stepping
33100 @kindex show displaced-stepping
33101 @cindex displaced stepping support
33102 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
33103 @item set displaced-stepping
33104 @itemx show displaced-stepping
33105 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
33106 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
33107 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
33108 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
33109 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
33110
33111 @table @code
33112 @item set displaced-stepping on
33113 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
33114 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
33115
33116 @item set displaced-stepping off
33117 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
33118 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
33119
33120 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
33121 @item set displaced-stepping auto
33122 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
33123 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
33124 architecture supports displaced stepping.
33125 @end table
33126
33127 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
33128 @item maint check-psymtabs
33129 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
33130 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
33131
33132 @kindex maint check-symtabs
33133 @item maint check-symtabs
33134 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
33135
33136 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
33137 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
33138 Expand symbol tables.
33139 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
33140 names matching @var{regexp}.
33141
33142 @kindex maint cplus first_component
33143 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
33144 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
33145
33146 @kindex maint cplus namespace
33147 @item maint cplus namespace
33148 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
33149
33150 @kindex maint demangle
33151 @item maint demangle @var{name}
33152 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
33153
33154 @kindex maint deprecate
33155 @kindex maint undeprecate
33156 @cindex deprecated commands
33157 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
33158 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
33159 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
33160 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
33161 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
33162 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
33163 the replacement as part of the warning.
33164
33165 @kindex maint dump-me
33166 @item maint dump-me
33167 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
33168 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
33169 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
33170 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
33171
33172 @kindex maint internal-error
33173 @kindex maint internal-warning
33174 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33175 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33176 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
33177 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
33178 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
33179 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
33180 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
33181 @value{GDBN} session.
33182
33183 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
33184 used as the text of the error or warning message.
33185
33186 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
33187
33188 @smallexample
33189 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
33190 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
33191 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
33192 debugging may prove unreliable.
33193 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
33194 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
33195 (@value{GDBP})
33196 @end smallexample
33197
33198 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
33199 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
33200
33201 @kindex maint set internal-error
33202 @kindex maint show internal-error
33203 @kindex maint set internal-warning
33204 @kindex maint show internal-warning
33205 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33206 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
33207 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33208 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
33209 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
33210 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
33211 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
33212 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
33213 described in the table below.
33214
33215 @table @samp
33216 @item quit
33217 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
33218 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
33219
33220 @item corefile
33221 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
33222 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do.
33223 @end table
33224
33225 @kindex maint packet
33226 @item maint packet @var{text}
33227 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
33228 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
33229 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
33230 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
33231 checksum.
33232
33233 @kindex maint print architecture
33234 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33235 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
33236 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
33237
33238 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
33239 @item maint print c-tdesc
33240 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
33241 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
33242 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
33243
33244 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
33245 @item maint print dummy-frames
33246 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
33247
33248 @smallexample
33249 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
33250 @dots{}
33251 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
33252 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
33253 58 return (a + b);
33254 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
33255 @dots{}
33256 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
33257 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
33258 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
33259 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
33260 (@value{GDBP})
33261 @end smallexample
33262
33263 Takes an optional file parameter.
33264
33265 @kindex maint print registers
33266 @kindex maint print raw-registers
33267 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
33268 @kindex maint print register-groups
33269 @kindex maint print remote-registers
33270 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33271 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33272 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33273 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33274 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33275 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
33276
33277 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
33278 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
33279 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
33280 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
33281 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
33282 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
33283 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
33284 and offsets in the `G' packets.
33285
33286 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
33287 write the information.
33288
33289 @kindex maint print reggroups
33290 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33291 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
33292 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
33293 information.
33294
33295 The register groups info looks like this:
33296
33297 @smallexample
33298 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
33299 Group Type
33300 general user
33301 float user
33302 all user
33303 vector user
33304 system user
33305 save internal
33306 restore internal
33307 @end smallexample
33308
33309 @kindex flushregs
33310 @item flushregs
33311 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
33312
33313 @kindex maint print objfiles
33314 @cindex info for known object files
33315 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
33316 Print a dump of all known object files.
33317 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
33318 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
33319 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
33320
33321 @kindex maint print section-scripts
33322 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
33323 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
33324 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
33325 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
33326 matching @var{regexp}.
33327 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
33328 and the full path if known.
33329 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
33330
33331 @kindex maint print statistics
33332 @cindex bcache statistics
33333 @item maint print statistics
33334 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
33335 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
33336 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
33337 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
33338 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
33339 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
33340 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
33341 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
33342 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
33343 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
33344 lengths.
33345
33346 @kindex maint print target-stack
33347 @cindex target stack description
33348 @item maint print target-stack
33349 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
33350 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
33351 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
33352 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
33353 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
33354 address.
33355
33356 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
33357 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
33358
33359 @kindex maint print type
33360 @cindex type chain of a data type
33361 @item maint print type @var{expr}
33362 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
33363 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
33364 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
33365 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
33366 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
33367
33368 @kindex maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
33369 @kindex maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
33370 @item maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
33371 @item maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
33372 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
33373 information.
33374
33375 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
33376 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
33377 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
33378 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
33379 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
33380 always see the disassembly form.
33381
33382 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
33383
33384 @smallexample
33385 (gdb) info addr argc
33386 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
33387 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
33388 @end smallexample
33389
33390 For more information on these expressions, see
33391 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
33392
33393 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
33394 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
33395 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
33396 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
33397 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
33398
33399 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
33400 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
33401 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
33402 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
33403 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
33404 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
33405 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
33406 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
33407 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
33408
33409 @kindex maint set profile
33410 @kindex maint show profile
33411 @cindex profiling GDB
33412 @item maint set profile
33413 @itemx maint show profile
33414 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
33415
33416 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
33417 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
33418 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
33419 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
33420 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
33421 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
33422 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
33423
33424 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
33425 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
33426
33427 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
33428 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
33429 @cindex hardware debug registers
33430 @item maint set show-debug-regs
33431 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
33432 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
33433 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
33434 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
33435 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
33436 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
33437
33438 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
33439 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
33440 @item maint set show-all-tib
33441 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
33442 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
33443 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
33444 command.
33445
33446 @kindex maint set per-command
33447 @kindex maint show per-command
33448 @item maint set per-command
33449 @itemx maint show per-command
33450 @cindex resources used by commands
33451
33452 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
33453 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
33454
33455 @table @code
33456 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
33457 @itemx maint show per-command space
33458 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
33459 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
33460 took, following the command's own output.
33461 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
33462 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
33463
33464 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
33465 @itemx maint show per-command time
33466 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
33467 for each command.
33468 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
33469 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
33470 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
33471 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
33472 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
33473 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
33474 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
33475 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
33476 spent by the program been debugged.
33477 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
33478 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
33479
33480 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
33481 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
33482 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
33483 for each command.
33484 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
33485
33486 @enumerate a
33487 @item
33488 number of symbol tables
33489 @item
33490 number of primary symbol tables
33491 @item
33492 number of blocks in the blockvector
33493 @end enumerate
33494 @end table
33495
33496 @kindex maint space
33497 @cindex memory used by commands
33498 @item maint space @var{value}
33499 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
33500 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
33501
33502 @kindex maint time
33503 @cindex time of command execution
33504 @item maint time @var{value}
33505 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
33506 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
33507
33508 @kindex maint translate-address
33509 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
33510 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
33511 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
33512 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
33513 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
33514 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
33515 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
33516
33517 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
33518 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
33519 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
33520
33521 @end table
33522
33523 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
33524 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
33525
33526 @table @code
33527 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
33528 @kindex set watchdog
33529 @cindex watchdog timer
33530 @cindex timeout for commands
33531 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
33532 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
33533 reports and error and the command is aborted.
33534
33535 @item show watchdog
33536 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
33537 @end table
33538
33539 @node Remote Protocol
33540 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
33541
33542 @menu
33543 * Overview::
33544 * Packets::
33545 * Stop Reply Packets::
33546 * General Query Packets::
33547 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
33548 * Tracepoint Packets::
33549 * Host I/O Packets::
33550 * Interrupts::
33551 * Notification Packets::
33552 * Remote Non-Stop::
33553 * Packet Acknowledgment::
33554 * Examples::
33555 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
33556 * Library List Format::
33557 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
33558 * Memory Map Format::
33559 * Thread List Format::
33560 * Traceframe Info Format::
33561 * Branch Trace Format::
33562 @end menu
33563
33564 @node Overview
33565 @section Overview
33566
33567 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
33568 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
33569 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
33570 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
33571
33572 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
33573 transmitted and received data, respectively.
33574
33575 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
33576 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
33577 @cindex remote serial protocol
33578 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
33579 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
33580 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
33581 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
33582 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
33583
33584 @smallexample
33585 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
33586 @end smallexample
33587 @noindent
33588
33589 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
33590 @noindent
33591 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
33592 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
33593 eight bit unsigned checksum).
33594
33595 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
33596 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
33597
33598 @smallexample
33599 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
33600 @end smallexample
33601
33602 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
33603 @noindent
33604 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
33605 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
33606 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
33607
33608 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
33609 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
33610 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
33611 retransmission):
33612
33613 @smallexample
33614 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
33615 <- @code{+}
33616 @end smallexample
33617 @noindent
33618
33619 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
33620 once a connection is established.
33621 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
33622
33623 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
33624 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
33625 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
33626 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
33627 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
33628 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
33629 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
33630
33631 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
33632 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
33633 exceptions).
33634
33635 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
33636 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
33637 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
33638 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
33639
33640 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
33641 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
33642 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
33643
33644 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
33645 @anchor{Binary Data}
33646 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
33647 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
33648 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
33649 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
33650 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
33651 binary data.
33652
33653 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
33654 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
33655 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
33656 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
33657 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
33658 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
33659 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
33660 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
33661 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
33662 (described next).
33663
33664 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
33665 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
33666 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
33667 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
33668 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
33669 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
33670 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
33671 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
33672 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
33673 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
33674 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
33675 3}} more times.
33676
33677 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
33678 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
33679 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
33680 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
33681 @samp{0*"00}.
33682
33683 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
33684 error number. That number is not well defined.
33685
33686 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
33687 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
33688 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
33689 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
33690 on that response.
33691
33692 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
33693 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
33694 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
33695 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
33696 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
33697 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
33698
33699 @node Packets
33700 @section Packets
33701
33702 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
33703 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
33704 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
33705 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
33706
33707 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
33708 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
33709 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
33710 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
33711 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
33712 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
33713 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
33714 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
33715 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
33716 @var{baz}.
33717
33718 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
33719 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
33720 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
33721 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
33722 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
33723 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
33724 pick any thread.
33725
33726 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
33727 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
33728 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
33729 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
33730 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
33731 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
33732 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
33733 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
33734 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
33735 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
33736 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
33737 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
33738 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
33739
33740 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
33741 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
33742 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
33743 more information.
33744
33745 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
33746 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
33747
33748 Here are the packet descriptions.
33749
33750 @table @samp
33751
33752 @item !
33753 @cindex @samp{!} packet
33754 @anchor{extended mode}
33755 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
33756 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
33757 debugged.
33758
33759 Reply:
33760 @table @samp
33761 @item OK
33762 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
33763 @end table
33764
33765 @item ?
33766 @cindex @samp{?} packet
33767 @anchor{? packet}
33768 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
33769 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
33770 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
33771
33772 Reply:
33773 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33774
33775 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
33776 @cindex @samp{A} packet
33777 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
33778 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
33779 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
33780
33781 Reply:
33782 @table @samp
33783 @item OK
33784 The arguments were set.
33785 @item E @var{NN}
33786 An error occurred.
33787 @end table
33788
33789 @item b @var{baud}
33790 @cindex @samp{b} packet
33791 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
33792 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
33793
33794 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
33795 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
33796 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
33797
33798 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
33799 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
33800 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
33801 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
33802 of view, nothing actually happened.}
33803
33804 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
33805 @cindex @samp{B} packet
33806 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
33807 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
33808
33809 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
33810 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
33811
33812 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
33813 @anchor{bc}
33814 @item bc
33815 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
33816 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
33817
33818 Reply:
33819 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33820
33821 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
33822 @anchor{bs}
33823 @item bs
33824 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
33825 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
33826
33827 Reply:
33828 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33829
33830 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
33831 @cindex @samp{c} packet
33832 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
33833 resume at current address.
33834
33835 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
33836 packet}.
33837
33838 Reply:
33839 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33840
33841 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
33842 @cindex @samp{C} packet
33843 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
33844 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
33845
33846 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
33847 packet}.
33848
33849 Reply:
33850 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33851
33852 @item d
33853 @cindex @samp{d} packet
33854 Toggle debug flag.
33855
33856 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
33857 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
33858
33859 @item D
33860 @itemx D;@var{pid}
33861 @cindex @samp{D} packet
33862 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
33863 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
33864 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
33865
33866 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
33867 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
33868 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
33869 big-endian hex string.
33870
33871 Reply:
33872 @table @samp
33873 @item OK
33874 for success
33875 @item E @var{NN}
33876 for an error
33877 @end table
33878
33879 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
33880 @cindex @samp{F} packet
33881 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
33882 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
33883 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
33884
33885 @item g
33886 @anchor{read registers packet}
33887 @cindex @samp{g} packet
33888 Read general registers.
33889
33890 Reply:
33891 @table @samp
33892 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
33893 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
33894 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
33895 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
33896 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
33897 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
33898 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
33899
33900 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
33901 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
33902 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
33903 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
33904 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
33905 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
33906 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
33907 have been collected, and both have zero value:
33908
33909 @smallexample
33910 -> @code{g}
33911 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
33912 @end smallexample
33913
33914 @item E @var{NN}
33915 for an error.
33916 @end table
33917
33918 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
33919 @cindex @samp{G} packet
33920 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
33921 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
33922
33923 Reply:
33924 @table @samp
33925 @item OK
33926 for success
33927 @item E @var{NN}
33928 for an error
33929 @end table
33930
33931 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
33932 @cindex @samp{H} packet
33933 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
33934 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{op} depends on the operation to be performed:
33935 it should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
33936 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
33937 option), @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
33938 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
33939 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
33940
33941 Reply:
33942 @table @samp
33943 @item OK
33944 for success
33945 @item E @var{NN}
33946 for an error
33947 @end table
33948
33949 @c FIXME: JTC:
33950 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
33951 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
33952 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
33953 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
33954 @c described. For example:
33955 @c
33956 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
33957 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
33958 @c otherwise returns current registers.
33959 @c
33960 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
33961 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
33962 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
33963
33964 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
33965 @anchor{cycle step packet}
33966 @cindex @samp{i} packet
33967 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
33968 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
33969 step starting at that address.
33970
33971 @item I
33972 @cindex @samp{I} packet
33973 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
33974 step packet}.
33975
33976 @item k
33977 @cindex @samp{k} packet
33978 Kill request.
33979
33980 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
33981
33982 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
33983 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
33984
33985 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
33986
33987 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
33988 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
33989 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
33990
33991 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
33992 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
33993 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
33994
33995 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
33996 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
33997 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
33998 (@pxref{? packet}).
33999
34000 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
34001 @cindex @samp{m} packet
34002 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
34003 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
34004
34005 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
34006 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
34007 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
34008 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
34009 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
34010 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
34011 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
34012 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
34013
34014 Reply:
34015 @table @samp
34016 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34017 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
34018 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
34019 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
34020 @item E @var{NN}
34021 @var{NN} is errno
34022 @end table
34023
34024 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34025 @cindex @samp{M} packet
34026 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
34027 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
34028 hexadecimal number.
34029
34030 Reply:
34031 @table @samp
34032 @item OK
34033 for success
34034 @item E @var{NN}
34035 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
34036 written).
34037 @end table
34038
34039 @item p @var{n}
34040 @cindex @samp{p} packet
34041 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
34042 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
34043 register value is encoded.
34044
34045 Reply:
34046 @table @samp
34047 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34048 the register's value
34049 @item E @var{NN}
34050 for an error
34051 @item @w{}
34052 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
34053 @end table
34054
34055 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
34056 @anchor{write register packet}
34057 @cindex @samp{P} packet
34058 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
34059 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
34060 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
34061
34062 Reply:
34063 @table @samp
34064 @item OK
34065 for success
34066 @item E @var{NN}
34067 for an error
34068 @end table
34069
34070 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
34071 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
34072 @cindex @samp{q} packet
34073 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
34074 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
34075 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
34076
34077 @item r
34078 @cindex @samp{r} packet
34079 Reset the entire system.
34080
34081 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
34082
34083 @item R @var{XX}
34084 @cindex @samp{R} packet
34085 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
34086 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34087
34088 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
34089
34090 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
34091 @cindex @samp{s} packet
34092 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
34093 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
34094
34095 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34096 packet}.
34097
34098 Reply:
34099 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34100
34101 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
34102 @anchor{step with signal packet}
34103 @cindex @samp{S} packet
34104 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
34105 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
34106
34107 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34108 packet}.
34109
34110 Reply:
34111 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34112
34113 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
34114 @cindex @samp{t} packet
34115 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
34116 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
34117 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
34118
34119 @item T @var{thread-id}
34120 @cindex @samp{T} packet
34121 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
34122
34123 Reply:
34124 @table @samp
34125 @item OK
34126 thread is still alive
34127 @item E @var{NN}
34128 thread is dead
34129 @end table
34130
34131 @item v
34132 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
34133 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
34134
34135 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
34136 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
34137 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
34138 The process ID is a
34139 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
34140 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
34141 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
34142
34143 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
34144 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
34145 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
34146 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
34147 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
34148 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
34149 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
34150 @c stopping or restarting threads.
34151
34152 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34153
34154 Reply:
34155 @table @samp
34156 @item E @var{nn}
34157 for an error
34158 @item @r{Any stop packet}
34159 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
34160 @item OK
34161 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
34162 @end table
34163
34164 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
34165 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
34166 @anchor{vCont packet}
34167 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
34168 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
34169 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
34170 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
34171 in their current state in non-stop mode.
34172 Specifying multiple
34173 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
34174 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34175
34176 Currently supported actions are:
34177
34178 @table @samp
34179 @item c
34180 Continue.
34181 @item C @var{sig}
34182 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
34183 @item s
34184 Step.
34185 @item S @var{sig}
34186 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
34187 @item t
34188 Stop.
34189 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
34190 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
34191 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
34192 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
34193 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
34194 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
34195
34196 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
34197 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
34198 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
34199 jumps to @var{start}).
34200
34201 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
34202 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
34203 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
34204
34205 @end table
34206
34207 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
34208 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
34209 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
34210
34211 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
34212 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
34213 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
34214 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
34215 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
34216 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
34217 as an implementation detail.
34218
34219 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
34220 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
34221 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
34222 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
34223 @var{thread-id}.
34224
34225 Reply:
34226 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34227
34228 @item vCont?
34229 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
34230 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
34231
34232 Reply:
34233 @table @samp
34234 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
34235 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
34236 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
34237 @item @w{}
34238 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
34239 @end table
34240
34241 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
34242 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
34243 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
34244 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
34245
34246 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
34247 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
34248 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
34249 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
34250 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
34251 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
34252 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
34253 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
34254 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
34255 packet is received.
34256
34257 Reply:
34258 @table @samp
34259 @item OK
34260 for success
34261 @item E @var{NN}
34262 for an error
34263 @end table
34264
34265 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34266 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
34267 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
34268 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
34269 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
34270 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
34271 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
34272 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
34273 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
34274 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
34275 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
34276 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
34277
34278
34279 Reply:
34280 @table @samp
34281 @item OK
34282 for success
34283 @item E.memtype
34284 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
34285 @item E @var{NN}
34286 for an error
34287 @end table
34288
34289 @item vFlashDone
34290 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
34291 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
34292 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
34293 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
34294 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
34295 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
34296 request is completed.
34297
34298 @item vKill;@var{pid}
34299 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
34300 @anchor{vKill packet}
34301 Kill the process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
34302 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
34303 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
34304 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
34305
34306 Reply:
34307 @table @samp
34308 @item E @var{nn}
34309 for an error
34310 @item OK
34311 for success
34312 @end table
34313
34314 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
34315 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
34316 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
34317 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
34318 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
34319 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
34320 state.
34321
34322 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
34323
34324 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34325
34326 Reply:
34327 @table @samp
34328 @item E @var{nn}
34329 for an error
34330 @item @r{Any stop packet}
34331 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
34332 @end table
34333
34334 @item vStopped
34335 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
34336 @xref{Notification Packets}.
34337
34338 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34339 @anchor{X packet}
34340 @cindex @samp{X} packet
34341 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
34342 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
34343 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
34344
34345 Reply:
34346 @table @samp
34347 @item OK
34348 for success
34349 @item E @var{NN}
34350 for an error
34351 @end table
34352
34353 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
34354 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
34355 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
34356 @cindex @samp{z} packet
34357 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
34358 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
34359 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
34360
34361 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
34362 separately.
34363
34364 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
34365 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
34366 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
34367 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
34368 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
34369 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
34370
34371 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34372 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
34373 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
34374 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
34375 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
34376 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
34377
34378 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
34379 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
34380 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
34381 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
34382 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
34383 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
34384 @var{cond_list} is an optional list of conditional expressions in bytecode
34385 form that should be evaluated on the target's side. These are the
34386 conditions that should be taken into consideration when deciding if
34387 the breakpoint trigger should be reported back to @var{GDBN}.
34388
34389 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
34390 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
34391
34392 @table @samp
34393
34394 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
34395 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
34396 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
34397
34398 @end table
34399
34400 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
34401 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
34402 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
34403 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
34404 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
34405 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
34406 separators. Each expression has the following form:
34407
34408 @table @samp
34409
34410 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
34411 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
34412 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
34413
34414 @end table
34415
34416 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
34417
34418 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
34419 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
34420 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
34421 target, is not defined.}
34422
34423 Reply:
34424 @table @samp
34425 @item OK
34426 success
34427 @item @w{}
34428 not supported
34429 @item E @var{NN}
34430 for an error
34431 @end table
34432
34433 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34434 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}
34435 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
34436 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
34437 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
34438 address @var{addr}.
34439
34440 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
34441 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. @var{kind}
34442 and @var{cond_list} have the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
34443
34444 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
34445 movement.}
34446
34447 Reply:
34448 @table @samp
34449 @item OK
34450 success
34451 @item @w{}
34452 not supported
34453 @item E @var{NN}
34454 for an error
34455 @end table
34456
34457 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34458 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34459 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
34460 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
34461 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
34462 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
34463
34464 Reply:
34465 @table @samp
34466 @item OK
34467 success
34468 @item @w{}
34469 not supported
34470 @item E @var{NN}
34471 for an error
34472 @end table
34473
34474 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34475 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34476 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
34477 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
34478 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
34479 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
34480
34481 Reply:
34482 @table @samp
34483 @item OK
34484 success
34485 @item @w{}
34486 not supported
34487 @item E @var{NN}
34488 for an error
34489 @end table
34490
34491 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34492 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34493 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
34494 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
34495 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
34496 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
34497
34498 Reply:
34499 @table @samp
34500 @item OK
34501 success
34502 @item @w{}
34503 not supported
34504 @item E @var{NN}
34505 for an error
34506 @end table
34507
34508 @end table
34509
34510 @node Stop Reply Packets
34511 @section Stop Reply Packets
34512 @cindex stop reply packets
34513
34514 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
34515 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
34516 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
34517 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
34518 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
34519 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
34520 @value{GDBN} source code.
34521
34522 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
34523 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
34524 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
34525 components.
34526
34527 @table @samp
34528
34529 @item S @var{AA}
34530 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
34531 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
34532 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
34533
34534 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
34535 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
34536 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
34537 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
34538 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
34539 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
34540 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
34541 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
34542
34543 @itemize @bullet
34544 @item
34545 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
34546 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
34547 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
34548 two-digit hex number.
34549
34550 @item
34551 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
34552 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34553
34554 @item
34555 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
34556 the core on which the stop event was detected.
34557
34558 @item
34559 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
34560 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
34561 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
34562 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
34563
34564 @item
34565 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
34566 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
34567 future.
34568 @end itemize
34569
34570 The currently defined stop reasons are:
34571
34572 @table @samp
34573 @item watch
34574 @itemx rwatch
34575 @itemx awatch
34576 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
34577 hex.
34578
34579 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
34580 @item library
34581 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
34582 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
34583 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
34584
34585 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
34586 @item replaylog
34587 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
34588 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
34589 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
34590 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
34591 for more information.
34592 @end table
34593
34594 @item W @var{AA}
34595 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
34596 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
34597 applicable to certain targets.
34598
34599 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
34600 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
34601 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
34602 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
34603
34604 @item X @var{AA}
34605 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
34606 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
34607
34608 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
34609 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
34610 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
34611 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
34612
34613 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
34614 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
34615 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
34616 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
34617 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
34618
34619 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
34620 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
34621 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
34622 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
34623 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
34624 system calls.
34625
34626 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
34627 this very system call.
34628
34629 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
34630 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
34631 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
34632 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
34633 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
34634 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
34635
34636 @end table
34637
34638 @node General Query Packets
34639 @section General Query Packets
34640 @cindex remote query requests
34641
34642 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
34643 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
34644 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
34645 sending information to and from the stub.
34646
34647 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
34648 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
34649 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
34650 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
34651 conventions:
34652
34653 @itemize @bullet
34654 @item
34655 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
34656 @item
34657 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
34658 letter.
34659 @item
34660 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
34661 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
34662 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
34663 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
34664 @end itemize
34665
34666 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
34667 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
34668 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
34669 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
34670 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
34671 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
34672 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
34673 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
34674 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
34675 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
34676 packet.}.
34677
34678 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
34679 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
34680 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
34681 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
34682 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
34683
34684 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
34685
34686 @table @samp
34687
34688 @item QAgent:1
34689 @itemx QAgent:0
34690 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
34691 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
34692
34693 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
34694 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
34695 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
34696 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
34697 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
34698 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
34699 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
34700 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
34701 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
34702 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
34703 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
34704
34705 @item qC
34706 @cindex current thread, remote request
34707 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
34708 Return the current thread ID.
34709
34710 Reply:
34711 @table @samp
34712 @item QC @var{thread-id}
34713 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
34714 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34715 @item @r{(anything else)}
34716 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
34717 @end table
34718
34719 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
34720 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
34721 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
34722 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
34723 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
34724 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
34725 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
34726
34727 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
34728 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
34729 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
34730 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
34731 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
34732 detect trailing zeros.
34733
34734 Reply:
34735 @table @samp
34736 @item E @var{NN}
34737 An error (such as memory fault)
34738 @item C @var{crc32}
34739 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
34740 @end table
34741
34742 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
34743 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
34744 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
34745 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
34746 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
34747 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
34748 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
34749 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
34750 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
34751 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
34752 randomization.
34753
34754 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34755
34756 Reply:
34757 @table @samp
34758 @item OK
34759 The request succeeded.
34760
34761 @item E @var{nn}
34762 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
34763
34764 @item @w{}
34765 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
34766 by the stub.
34767 @end table
34768
34769 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
34770 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
34771 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
34772 address space randomization.
34773
34774 @item qfThreadInfo
34775 @itemx qsThreadInfo
34776 @cindex list active threads, remote request
34777 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
34778 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
34779 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
34780 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
34781 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
34782 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
34783 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
34784 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
34785
34786 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
34787
34788 Reply:
34789 @table @samp
34790 @item m @var{thread-id}
34791 A single thread ID
34792 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
34793 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
34794 @item l
34795 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
34796 @end table
34797
34798 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
34799 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
34800 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
34801 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
34802 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
34803 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
34804 fields.
34805
34806 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
34807 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
34808 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
34809 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
34810 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
34811
34812 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
34813 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
34814
34815 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
34816 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
34817 information associated with the variable.)
34818
34819 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
34820 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
34821 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
34822 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
34823 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
34824 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
34825
34826 Reply:
34827 @table @samp
34828 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
34829 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
34830 local storage requested.
34831
34832 @item E @var{nn}
34833 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
34834
34835 @item @w{}
34836 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
34837 @end table
34838
34839 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
34840 @cindex get thread information block address
34841 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
34842 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
34843
34844 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
34845
34846 Reply:
34847 @table @samp
34848 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
34849 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
34850 thread information block.
34851
34852 @item E @var{nn}
34853 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
34854 address could not be retrieved.
34855
34856 @item @w{}
34857 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
34858 @end table
34859
34860 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
34861 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
34862 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
34863 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
34864 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
34865 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
34866 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
34867
34868 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
34869
34870 Reply:
34871 @table @samp
34872 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
34873 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
34874 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
34875 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
34876 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
34877 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
34878 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
34879 @end table
34880
34881 @item qOffsets
34882 @cindex section offsets, remote request
34883 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
34884 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
34885 image.
34886
34887 Reply:
34888 @table @samp
34889 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
34890 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
34891 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
34892 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
34893 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
34894 segments by the supplied offsets.
34895
34896 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
34897 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
34898 to the @code{Bss} section.}
34899
34900 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
34901 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
34902 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
34903 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
34904 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
34905 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
34906 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
34907 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
34908 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
34909 @end table
34910
34911 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
34912 @cindex thread information, remote request
34913 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
34914 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
34915 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
34916 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
34917
34918 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
34919 (see below).
34920
34921 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
34922
34923 @item QNonStop:1
34924 @itemx QNonStop:0
34925 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
34926 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
34927 @anchor{QNonStop}
34928 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
34929 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
34930
34931 Reply:
34932 @table @samp
34933 @item OK
34934 The request succeeded.
34935
34936 @item E @var{nn}
34937 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
34938
34939 @item @w{}
34940 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
34941 the stub.
34942 @end table
34943
34944 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
34945 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
34946 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
34947 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
34948
34949 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
34950 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
34951 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
34952 @anchor{QPassSignals}
34953 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
34954 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
34955 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
34956 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
34957 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
34958 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
34959 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
34960 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
34961 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
34962
34963 Reply:
34964 @table @samp
34965 @item OK
34966 The request succeeded.
34967
34968 @item E @var{nn}
34969 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
34970
34971 @item @w{}
34972 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
34973 the stub.
34974 @end table
34975
34976 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
34977 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
34978 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
34979 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
34980
34981 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
34982 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
34983 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
34984 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
34985 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
34986 Others should be silently discarded.
34987
34988 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
34989 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
34990 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
34991 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
34992 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
34993 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
34994 signals.
34995
34996 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
34997 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
34998
34999 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
35000 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
35001 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
35002 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
35003 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
35004
35005 Reply:
35006 @table @samp
35007 @item OK
35008 The request succeeded.
35009
35010 @item E @var{nn}
35011 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
35012
35013 @item @w{}
35014 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
35015 by the stub.
35016 @end table
35017
35018 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
35019 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
35020 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35021 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35022
35023 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
35024 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
35025 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
35026 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
35027 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
35028 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
35029 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
35030 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
35031 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
35032
35033 Reply:
35034 @table @samp
35035 @item OK
35036 A command response with no output.
35037 @item @var{OUTPUT}
35038 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
35039 @item E @var{NN}
35040 Indicate a badly formed request.
35041 @item @w{}
35042 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
35043 @end table
35044
35045 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
35046 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
35047 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
35048 packets.)
35049
35050 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
35051 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
35052 @ifnotinfo
35053 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
35054 @end ifnotinfo
35055 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
35056 @anchor{qSearch memory}
35057 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
35058 @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex.
35059 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, hex encoded.
35060
35061 Reply:
35062 @table @samp
35063 @item 0
35064 The pattern was not found.
35065 @item 1,address
35066 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
35067 @item E @var{NN}
35068 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
35069 @item @w{}
35070 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
35071 @end table
35072
35073 @item QStartNoAckMode
35074 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
35075 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
35076 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
35077 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
35078
35079 Reply:
35080 @table @samp
35081 @item OK
35082 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
35083 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
35084 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
35085 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
35086 @item @w{}
35087 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
35088 @end table
35089
35090 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
35091 @cindex supported packets, remote query
35092 @cindex features of the remote protocol
35093 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
35094 @anchor{qSupported}
35095 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
35096 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
35097 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
35098 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
35099 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
35100 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
35101 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
35102 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
35103 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
35104 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
35105 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
35106 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
35107 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
35108 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
35109
35110 Reply:
35111 @table @samp
35112 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
35113 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
35114 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
35115 possible forms).
35116 @item @w{}
35117 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
35118 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
35119 @end table
35120
35121 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
35122 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
35123 are:
35124
35125 @table @samp
35126 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
35127 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
35128 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
35129 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
35130 @item @var{name}+
35131 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
35132 need an associated value.
35133 @item @var{name}-
35134 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
35135 @item @var{name}?
35136 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
35137 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
35138 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
35139 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
35140 @end table
35141
35142 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
35143 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
35144 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
35145 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
35146 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
35147
35148 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
35149 are defined:
35150
35151 @table @samp
35152 @item multiprocess
35153 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
35154 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
35155 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
35156 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
35157 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
35158
35159 @item xmlRegisters
35160 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
35161 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
35162 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
35163 description.
35164
35165 @item qRelocInsn
35166 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
35167 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
35168 instruction reply packet}).
35169 @end table
35170
35171 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
35172 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
35173 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
35174 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
35175 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
35176 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
35177 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
35178 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
35179 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
35180 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
35181 all the features it supports.
35182
35183 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
35184 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
35185
35186 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
35187 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
35188 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
35189 form response.
35190
35191 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
35192 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
35193 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
35194 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
35195
35196 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
35197 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
35198 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
35199 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
35200 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
35201
35202 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
35203
35204 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
35205 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
35206 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
35207 @item Feature Name
35208 @tab Value Required
35209 @tab Default
35210 @tab Probe Allowed
35211
35212 @item @samp{PacketSize}
35213 @tab Yes
35214 @tab @samp{-}
35215 @tab No
35216
35217 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
35218 @tab No
35219 @tab @samp{-}
35220 @tab Yes
35221
35222 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
35223 @tab No
35224 @tab @samp{-}
35225 @tab Yes
35226
35227 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
35228 @tab No
35229 @tab @samp{-}
35230 @tab Yes
35231
35232 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
35233 @tab No
35234 @tab @samp{-}
35235 @tab Yes
35236
35237 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
35238 @tab No
35239 @tab @samp{-}
35240 @tab Yes
35241
35242 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
35243 @tab No
35244 @tab @samp{-}
35245 @tab No
35246
35247 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
35248 @tab No
35249 @tab @samp{-}
35250 @tab Yes
35251
35252 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
35253 @tab No
35254 @tab @samp{-}
35255 @tab Yes
35256
35257 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
35258 @tab No
35259 @tab @samp{-}
35260 @tab Yes
35261
35262 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
35263 @tab No
35264 @tab @samp{-}
35265 @tab Yes
35266
35267 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
35268 @tab No
35269 @tab @samp{-}
35270 @tab Yes
35271
35272 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
35273 @tab No
35274 @tab @samp{-}
35275 @tab Yes
35276
35277 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
35278 @tab No
35279 @tab @samp{-}
35280 @tab Yes
35281
35282 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
35283 @tab No
35284 @tab @samp{-}
35285 @tab Yes
35286
35287 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
35288 @tab No
35289 @tab @samp{-}
35290 @tab Yes
35291
35292 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
35293 @tab No
35294 @tab @samp{-}
35295 @tab Yes
35296
35297 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
35298 @tab Yes
35299 @tab @samp{-}
35300 @tab Yes
35301
35302 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
35303 @tab Yes
35304 @tab @samp{-}
35305 @tab Yes
35306
35307 @item @samp{QNonStop}
35308 @tab No
35309 @tab @samp{-}
35310 @tab Yes
35311
35312 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
35313 @tab No
35314 @tab @samp{-}
35315 @tab Yes
35316
35317 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
35318 @tab No
35319 @tab @samp{-}
35320 @tab Yes
35321
35322 @item @samp{multiprocess}
35323 @tab No
35324 @tab @samp{-}
35325 @tab No
35326
35327 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
35328 @tab No
35329 @tab @samp{-}
35330 @tab No
35331
35332 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
35333 @tab No
35334 @tab @samp{-}
35335 @tab No
35336
35337 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
35338 @tab No
35339 @tab @samp{-}
35340 @tab No
35341
35342 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
35343 @tab No
35344 @tab @samp{-}
35345 @tab No
35346
35347 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
35348 @tab No
35349 @tab @samp{-}
35350 @tab No
35351
35352 @item @samp{QAgent}
35353 @tab No
35354 @tab @samp{-}
35355 @tab No
35356
35357 @item @samp{QAllow}
35358 @tab No
35359 @tab @samp{-}
35360 @tab No
35361
35362 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
35363 @tab No
35364 @tab @samp{-}
35365 @tab No
35366
35367 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
35368 @tab No
35369 @tab @samp{-}
35370 @tab No
35371
35372 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
35373 @tab No
35374 @tab @samp{-}
35375 @tab No
35376
35377 @item @samp{tracenz}
35378 @tab No
35379 @tab @samp{-}
35380 @tab No
35381
35382 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
35383 @tab No
35384 @tab @samp{-}
35385 @tab No
35386
35387 @end multitable
35388
35389 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
35390
35391 @table @samp
35392 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
35393 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
35394 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
35395 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
35396 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
35397 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
35398 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
35399 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
35400 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
35401 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
35402
35403 @item qXfer:auxv:read
35404 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
35405 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
35406
35407 @item qXfer:btrace:read
35408 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
35409 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
35410
35411 @item qXfer:features:read
35412 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
35413 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
35414
35415 @item qXfer:libraries:read
35416 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
35417 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
35418
35419 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
35420 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
35421 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
35422
35423 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
35424 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
35425 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
35426 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
35427
35428 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
35429 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
35430 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
35431
35432 @item qXfer:sdata:read
35433 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
35434 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
35435
35436 @item qXfer:spu:read
35437 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
35438 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
35439
35440 @item qXfer:spu:write
35441 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
35442 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
35443
35444 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
35445 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
35446 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
35447
35448 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
35449 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
35450 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
35451
35452 @item qXfer:threads:read
35453 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
35454 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
35455
35456 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
35457 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
35458 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
35459
35460 @item qXfer:uib:read
35461 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
35462 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
35463
35464 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
35465 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
35466 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
35467
35468 @item QNonStop
35469 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
35470 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
35471
35472 @item QPassSignals
35473 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
35474 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
35475
35476 @item QStartNoAckMode
35477 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
35478 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
35479
35480 @item multiprocess
35481 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
35482 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
35483 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
35484 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
35485 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
35486 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
35487 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
35488 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
35489 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
35490 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
35491 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
35492
35493 @item qXfer:osdata:read
35494 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
35495 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
35496
35497 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
35498 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
35499 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
35500 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
35501
35502 @item ConditionalTracepoints
35503 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
35504 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
35505
35506 @item ReverseContinue
35507 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
35508 (@pxref{bc}).
35509
35510 @item ReverseStep
35511 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
35512 (@pxref{bs}).
35513
35514 @item TracepointSource
35515 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
35516 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
35517
35518 @item QAgent
35519 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
35520
35521 @item QAllow
35522 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
35523
35524 @item QDisableRandomization
35525 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
35526
35527 @item StaticTracepoint
35528 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
35529 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
35530
35531 @item InstallInTrace
35532 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
35533 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
35534
35535 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
35536 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
35537 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
35538 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
35539
35540 @item QTBuffer:size
35541 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
35542 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
35543
35544 @item tracenz
35545 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
35546 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
35547 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
35548
35549 @item BreakpointCommands
35550 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
35551 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
35552 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
35553
35554 @item Qbtrace:off
35555 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
35556
35557 @item Qbtrace:bts
35558 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
35559
35560 @end table
35561
35562 @item qSymbol::
35563 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
35564 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
35565 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
35566 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
35567
35568 Reply:
35569 @table @samp
35570 @item OK
35571 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
35572 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
35573 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
35574 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
35575 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
35576 below.
35577 @end table
35578
35579 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
35580 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
35581
35582 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
35583 target has previously requested.
35584
35585 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
35586 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
35587 will be empty.
35588
35589 Reply:
35590 @table @samp
35591 @item OK
35592 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
35593 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
35594 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
35595 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
35596 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
35597 @end table
35598
35599 @item qTBuffer
35600 @itemx QTBuffer
35601 @itemx QTDisconnected
35602 @itemx QTDP
35603 @itemx QTDPsrc
35604 @itemx QTDV
35605 @itemx qTfP
35606 @itemx qTfV
35607 @itemx QTFrame
35608 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
35609
35610 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
35611
35612 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
35613 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
35614 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
35615 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
35616 the target OS. @var{thread-id} is a thread ID;
35617 see @ref{thread-id syntax}. This
35618 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
35619 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
35620 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
35621 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
35622 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
35623
35624 Reply:
35625 @table @samp
35626 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
35627 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
35628 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
35629 the thread's attributes.
35630 @end table
35631
35632 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
35633 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
35634 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
35635 packets.)
35636
35637 @item QTNotes
35638 @itemx qTP
35639 @itemx QTSave
35640 @itemx qTsP
35641 @itemx qTsV
35642 @itemx QTStart
35643 @itemx QTStop
35644 @itemx QTEnable
35645 @itemx QTDisable
35646 @itemx QTinit
35647 @itemx QTro
35648 @itemx qTStatus
35649 @itemx qTV
35650 @itemx qTfSTM
35651 @itemx qTsSTM
35652 @itemx qTSTMat
35653 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
35654
35655 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35656 @cindex read special object, remote request
35657 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
35658 @anchor{qXfer read}
35659 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
35660 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
35661 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
35662 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
35663 additional details about what data to access.
35664
35665 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
35666 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
35667 formats, listed below.
35668
35669 @table @samp
35670 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35671 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
35672 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
35673 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
35674
35675 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35676 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35677
35678 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35679 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
35680
35681 Return a description of the current branch trace.
35682 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
35683 packet may have one of the following values:
35684
35685 @table @code
35686 @item all
35687 Returns all available branch trace.
35688
35689 @item new
35690 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
35691 the last read request.
35692
35693 @item delta
35694 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
35695 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
35696 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
35697 used to stitch traces together.
35698
35699 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
35700 @end table
35701
35702 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
35703 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35704
35705 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35706 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
35707 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
35708 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
35709 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
35710
35711 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35712 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35713
35714 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35715 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
35716 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
35717 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
35718 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35719
35720 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
35721 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
35722 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
35723
35724 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35725 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35726
35727 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35728 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
35729 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
35730 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
35731 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
35732 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
35733 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35734 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
35735
35736 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
35737 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
35738
35739 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35740 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35741
35742 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
35743 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
35744 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
35745 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
35746
35747 @table @code
35748 @item start=@var{address}
35749 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
35750 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
35751 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
35752 chosen as the starting point.
35753
35754 @item prev=@var{address}
35755 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
35756 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
35757 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
35758 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
35759 exists prior to the starting point.
35760
35761 @end table
35762
35763 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
35764 ignored.
35765
35766 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35767 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
35768 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
35769 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
35770 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35771
35772 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35773 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35774
35775 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35776 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
35777
35778 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
35779 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
35780 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
35781 Action Lists}.
35782
35783 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35784 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35785 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35786
35787 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35788 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
35789 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
35790 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
35791 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35792
35793 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35794 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35795 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35796
35797 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35798 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
35799 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
35800 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
35801 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
35802 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
35803 in that context to be accessed.
35804
35805 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35806 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35807 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35808
35809 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35810 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
35811 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
35812 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
35813 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35814
35815 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35816 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35817
35818 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35819 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
35820
35821 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
35822 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
35823 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35824
35825 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35826 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35827
35828 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35829 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
35830
35831 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
35832 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
35833
35834 This packet is not probed by default.
35835
35836 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35837 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
35838 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
35839 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
35840 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
35841
35842 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35843 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35844
35845 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35846 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
35847 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
35848 @xref{Operating System Information}.
35849
35850 @end table
35851
35852 Reply:
35853 @table @samp
35854 @item m @var{data}
35855 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
35856 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
35857 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
35858 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
35859 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
35860 request.
35861
35862 @item l @var{data}
35863 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
35864 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
35865 than the @var{length} in the request.
35866
35867 @item l
35868 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
35869 There is no more data to be read.
35870
35871 @item E00
35872 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
35873
35874 @item E @var{nn}
35875 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
35876 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
35877
35878 @item @w{}
35879 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
35880 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
35881 @end table
35882
35883 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
35884 @cindex write data into object, remote request
35885 @anchor{qXfer write}
35886 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
35887 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
35888 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
35889 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
35890 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
35891 to access.
35892
35893 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
35894 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
35895 formats, listed below.
35896
35897 @table @samp
35898 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
35899 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
35900 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
35901 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
35902 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
35903
35904 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35905 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35906 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35907
35908 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
35909 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
35910 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
35911 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
35912 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
35913 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
35914 in that context to be accessed.
35915
35916 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35917 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35918 @end table
35919
35920 Reply:
35921 @table @samp
35922 @item @var{nn}
35923 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
35924 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
35925
35926 @item E00
35927 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
35928
35929 @item E @var{nn}
35930 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
35931 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
35932
35933 @item @w{}
35934 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
35935 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
35936 @end table
35937
35938 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
35939 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
35940 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
35941 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
35942 must respond with an empty packet.
35943
35944 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
35945 @cindex query attached, remote request
35946 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
35947 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
35948 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
35949 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
35950 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
35951 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
35952 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
35953
35954 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
35955 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
35956 the @code{quit} command.
35957
35958 Reply:
35959 @table @samp
35960 @item 1
35961 The remote server attached to an existing process.
35962 @item 0
35963 The remote server created a new process.
35964 @item E @var{NN}
35965 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
35966 @end table
35967
35968 @item Qbtrace:bts
35969 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using bts tracing.
35970
35971 Reply:
35972 @table @samp
35973 @item OK
35974 Branch tracing has been enabled.
35975 @item E.errtext
35976 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
35977 @end table
35978
35979 @item Qbtrace:off
35980 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
35981
35982 Reply:
35983 @table @samp
35984 @item OK
35985 Branch tracing has been disabled.
35986 @item E.errtext
35987 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
35988 @end table
35989
35990 @end table
35991
35992 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
35993 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
35994
35995 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
35996 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
35997 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
35998
35999 @menu
36000 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
36001 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
36002 @end menu
36003
36004 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
36005 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
36006
36007 @menu
36008 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
36009 @end menu
36010
36011 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
36012 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
36013 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
36014
36015 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
36016
36017 @table @r
36018
36019 @item 2
36020 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
36021
36022 @item 3
36023 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
36024
36025 @item 4
36026 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
36027
36028 @end table
36029
36030 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
36031 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
36032
36033 @menu
36034 * MIPS Register packet Format::
36035 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
36036 @end menu
36037
36038 @node MIPS Register packet Format
36039 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
36040 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
36041
36042 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
36043 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
36044 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
36045 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
36046 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
36047 most-significant -- least-significant.
36048
36049 @table @r
36050
36051 @item MIPS32
36052 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
36053 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
36054 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
36055
36056 @item MIPS64
36057 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
36058 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
36059 as @code{MIPS32}.
36060
36061 @end table
36062
36063 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
36064 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
36065 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
36066
36067 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
36068
36069 @table @r
36070
36071 @item 2
36072 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
36073
36074 @item 3
36075 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
36076
36077 @item 4
36078 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
36079
36080 @item 5
36081 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
36082
36083 @end table
36084
36085 @node Tracepoint Packets
36086 @section Tracepoint Packets
36087 @cindex tracepoint packets
36088 @cindex packets, tracepoint
36089
36090 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
36091 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
36092
36093 @table @samp
36094
36095 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
36096 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
36097 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
36098 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
36099 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
36100 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
36101 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
36102 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
36103 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
36104 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
36105 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
36106 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
36107 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
36108 actions.
36109
36110 Replies:
36111 @table @samp
36112 @item OK
36113 The packet was understood and carried out.
36114 @item qRelocInsn
36115 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
36116 @item @w{}
36117 The packet was not recognized.
36118 @end table
36119
36120 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
36121 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
36122 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
36123 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
36124 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
36125 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
36126 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
36127
36128 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
36129 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
36130 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
36131 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
36132 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
36133 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
36134 tracepoint actions.
36135
36136 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
36137 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
36138 following forms:
36139
36140 @table @samp
36141
36142 @item R @var{mask}
36143 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
36144 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
36145 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
36146 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
36147 not fit in a 32-bit word.
36148
36149 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
36150 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
36151 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
36152 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
36153 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
36154 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
36155 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
36156
36157 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
36158 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
36159 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
36160 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
36161 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
36162 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
36163 packet).
36164
36165 @end table
36166
36167 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
36168 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
36169 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
36170 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
36171 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
36172 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
36173 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
36174 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
36175
36176 Replies:
36177 @table @samp
36178 @item OK
36179 The packet was understood and carried out.
36180 @item qRelocInsn
36181 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
36182 @item @w{}
36183 The packet was not recognized.
36184 @end table
36185
36186 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
36187 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
36188 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
36189 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
36190 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. @var{type}
36191 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
36192 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
36193 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
36194
36195 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
36196 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
36197 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
36198 fit in a single packet.
36199 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
36200 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
36201
36202 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
36203 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
36204 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
36205 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
36206
36207 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
36208 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
36209 query packets.
36210
36211 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
36212 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
36213 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
36214 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
36215 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
36216 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
36217 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
36218 be found.
36219
36220 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}
36221 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
36222 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
36223 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
36224 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
36225 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
36226 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
36227 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
36228 mentioned in expressions.
36229
36230 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
36231 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
36232 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
36233 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
36234 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
36235
36236 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
36237 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
36238 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
36239 one of the following forms:
36240
36241 @table @samp
36242 @item F @var{f}
36243 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
36244 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
36245 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
36246
36247 @item T @var{t}
36248 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
36249 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
36250
36251 @end table
36252
36253 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
36254 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
36255 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
36256 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
36257
36258 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
36259 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
36260 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
36261 is a hexadecimal number.
36262
36263 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
36264 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
36265 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
36266 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
36267 numbers.
36268
36269 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
36270 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
36271 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
36272
36273 @item qTMinFTPILen
36274 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
36275 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
36276 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
36277 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
36278 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
36279 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
36280 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
36281 arrange for that.
36282
36283 Replies:
36284
36285 @table @samp
36286 @item 0
36287 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
36288 @item @var{length}
36289 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length} is greater
36290 or equal to 1. @var{length} is a hexadecimal number. A reply of 1 means
36291 that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction regardless of size.
36292 @item E
36293 An error has occurred.
36294 @item @w{}
36295 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
36296 @end table
36297
36298 @item QTStart
36299 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
36300 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
36301 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
36302 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
36303 instruction reply packet}).
36304
36305 @item QTStop
36306 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
36307 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
36308
36309 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
36310 @anchor{QTEnable}
36311 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
36312 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
36313 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
36314 of data from it will resume.
36315
36316 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
36317 @anchor{QTDisable}
36318 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
36319 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
36320 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
36321 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
36322
36323 @item QTinit
36324 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
36325 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
36326
36327 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
36328 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
36329 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
36330 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
36331 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
36332
36333 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
36334 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
36335 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
36336 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
36337
36338 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
36339 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
36340 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
36341 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
36342 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
36343 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
36344
36345 @item qTStatus
36346 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
36347 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
36348
36349 The reply has the form:
36350
36351 @table @samp
36352
36353 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
36354 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
36355 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
36356 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
36357
36358 @end table
36359
36360 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
36361 explanations as one of the optional fields:
36362
36363 @table @samp
36364
36365 @item tnotrun:0
36366 No trace has been run yet.
36367
36368 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
36369 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
36370 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
36371 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
36372 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
36373
36374 @item tfull:0
36375 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
36376
36377 @item tdisconnected:0
36378 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
36379
36380 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
36381 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
36382
36383 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
36384 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
36385 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
36386 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression).
36387 @var{text} is hex encoded.
36388
36389 @item tunknown:0
36390 The trace stopped for some other reason.
36391
36392 @end table
36393
36394 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
36395 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
36396 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
36397 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
36398 trace.
36399
36400 @table @samp
36401
36402 @item tframes:@var{n}
36403 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
36404
36405 @item tcreated:@var{n}
36406 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
36407 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
36408
36409 @item tsize:@var{n}
36410 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
36411
36412 @item tfree:@var{n}
36413 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
36414
36415 @item circular:@var{n}
36416 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
36417 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
36418 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
36419 and may fill up.
36420
36421 @item disconn:@var{n}
36422 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
36423 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
36424 that the trace run will stop.
36425
36426 @end table
36427
36428 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
36429 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
36430 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
36431 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
36432 address @var{addr}.
36433
36434 Replies:
36435 @table @samp
36436 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
36437 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
36438 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
36439 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
36440 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
36441
36442 @end table
36443
36444 @item qTV:@var{var}
36445 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
36446 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
36447 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
36448
36449 Replies:
36450 @table @samp
36451 @item V@var{value}
36452 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
36453 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
36454 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
36455 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
36456 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
36457 program is running.
36458
36459 @item U
36460 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
36461 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
36462 was not collected.
36463 @end table
36464
36465 @item qTfP
36466 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
36467 @itemx qTsP
36468 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
36469 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
36470 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
36471 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
36472 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
36473 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
36474
36475 @item qTfV
36476 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
36477 @itemx qTsV
36478 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
36479 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
36480 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
36481 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
36482 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
36483 trace state variables.
36484
36485 @item qTfSTM
36486 @itemx qTsSTM
36487 @anchor{qTfSTM}
36488 @anchor{qTsSTM}
36489 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
36490 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
36491 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
36492 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
36493 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
36494 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
36495
36496 Reply:
36497 @table @samp
36498 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
36499 A single marker
36500 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
36501 a comma-separated list of markers
36502 @item l
36503 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
36504 @item E @var{nn}
36505 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
36506 @item @w{}
36507 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
36508 stub.
36509 @end table
36510
36511 @var{address} is encoded in hex.
36512 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
36513
36514 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
36515 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
36516 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
36517 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
36518 @dfn{last}).
36519
36520 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
36521 @anchor{qTSTMat}
36522 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
36523 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
36524 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
36525 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
36526 tracepoint markers.
36527
36528 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
36529 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
36530 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
36531 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. @var{filename} is encoded
36532 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
36533 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
36534
36535 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
36536 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
36537 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
36538 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
36539 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
36540 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
36541 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
36542 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
36543 available.
36544
36545 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
36546 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
36547 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
36548
36549 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
36550 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
36551 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
36552 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
36553 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
36554 use whatever size it prefers.
36555
36556 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
36557 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
36558 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
36559 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
36560 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
36561
36562 @end table
36563
36564 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
36565 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
36566 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
36567 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
36568 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
36569 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
36570 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
36571 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
36572 it had executed in the original location.
36573
36574 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
36575 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
36576 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
36577 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
36578 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
36579 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
36580 format of the request is:
36581
36582 @table @samp
36583 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
36584
36585 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
36586 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
36587 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
36588 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
36589 memory starting at @var{to}.
36590 @end table
36591
36592 Replies:
36593 @table @samp
36594 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
36595 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. @var{adjusted_size} is
36596 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
36597 @item E @var{NN}
36598 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
36599 relocating the instruction.
36600 @end table
36601
36602 @node Host I/O Packets
36603 @section Host I/O Packets
36604 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
36605 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
36606
36607 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
36608 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
36609 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
36610 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
36611 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
36612 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
36613 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
36614 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
36615 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
36616 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
36617
36618 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
36619 its arguments. They have this format:
36620
36621 @table @samp
36622
36623 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
36624 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
36625 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
36626 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
36627 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
36628 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
36629 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
36630 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
36631 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
36632
36633 @end table
36634
36635 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
36636
36637 @table @samp
36638
36639 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
36640 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
36641 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
36642 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
36643 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
36644 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
36645 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
36646 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
36647 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
36648 @var{attachment}.
36649
36650 @item @w{}
36651 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
36652
36653 @end table
36654
36655 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
36656
36657 @table @samp
36658 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
36659 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
36660 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
36661 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
36662 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
36663 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
36664 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
36665
36666 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
36667 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
36668 -1 if an error occurs.
36669
36670 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
36671 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
36672 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
36673 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
36674 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
36675 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
36676 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
36677 @var{count} was zero.
36678
36679 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
36680 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
36681 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
36682 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
36683 some characters were escaped.
36684
36685 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
36686 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
36687 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
36688 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
36689 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
36690 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
36691 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
36692 error occurred.
36693
36694 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
36695 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
36696 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
36697
36698 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
36699 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
36700 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
36701
36702 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
36703 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
36704 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
36705 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
36706 some characters were escaped.
36707
36708 @end table
36709
36710 @node Interrupts
36711 @section Interrupts
36712 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
36713
36714 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
36715 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or
36716 a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g},
36717 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
36718
36719 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
36720 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
36721 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
36722 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
36723 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
36724
36725 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
36726 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
36727 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
36728 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
36729 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
36730 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
36731 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
36732 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
36733
36734 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
36735 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
36736 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
36737
36738 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
36739 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
36740 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
36741 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
36742 currently-executing threads and processes.
36743 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
36744 running program, it should send one of the stop
36745 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
36746 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
36747 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
36748 Interrupts received while the
36749 program is stopped are discarded.
36750
36751 @node Notification Packets
36752 @section Notification Packets
36753 @cindex notification packets
36754 @cindex packets, notification
36755
36756 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
36757 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
36758 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
36759 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
36760 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
36761 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
36762 is not a problem.
36763
36764 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
36765 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
36766 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
36767 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
36768 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
36769 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
36770 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
36771
36772 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
36773 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
36774
36775 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
36776 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
36777 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
36778 not they understand it.
36779
36780 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
36781 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
36782 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
36783 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
36784 recipients.
36785
36786 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
36787 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
36788 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
36789 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
36790 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
36791
36792 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
36793 @table @samp
36794 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
36795 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
36796 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
36797 carrying the specific information about the notification.
36798 @var{name} is the name of the notification.
36799 @item @var{ack}
36800 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
36801 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
36802 @end table
36803
36804 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
36805 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
36806
36807 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
36808 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
36809 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
36810 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
36811 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
36812 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
36813 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
36814 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
36815 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
36816 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
36817
36818 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
36819 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
36820 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
36821 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
36822 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
36823 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
36824
36825 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
36826 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
36827 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
36828 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
36829 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
36830
36831 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
36832 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
36833 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
36834 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
36835 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
36836 normally.
36837
36838 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
36839 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
36840 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
36841 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
36842 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
36843 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
36844 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
36845 the process shall be repeated.
36846
36847 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
36848 following example:
36849 @smallexample
36850 <- @code{%%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
36851 @code{...}
36852 -> @code{vStopped}
36853 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
36854 -> @code{vStopped}
36855 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
36856 -> @code{vStopped}
36857 <- @code{OK}
36858 @end smallexample
36859
36860 The following notifications are defined:
36861 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
36862
36863 @item Notification
36864 @tab Ack
36865 @tab Event
36866 @tab Description
36867
36868 @item Stop
36869 @tab vStopped
36870 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
36871 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
36872 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
36873 @value{GDBN}.
36874 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
36875
36876 @end multitable
36877
36878 @node Remote Non-Stop
36879 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
36880
36881 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
36882 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
36883 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
36884 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36885
36886 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
36887 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
36888 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
36889 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
36890 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
36891 probe the target state after a mode change.
36892
36893 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
36894 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
36895 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
36896 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
36897 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
36898 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
36899 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
36900 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
36901 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
36902 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
36903 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
36904
36905 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
36906 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
36907 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
36908 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
36909 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
36910 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
36911 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
36912 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
36913 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
36914 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
36915 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
36916 @samp{OK}.
36917
36918 @node Packet Acknowledgment
36919 @section Packet Acknowledgment
36920
36921 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
36922 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
36923 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
36924 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
36925 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
36926 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
36927 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
36928
36929 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
36930 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
36931 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
36932 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
36933 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
36934
36935 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
36936 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
36937 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
36938 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
36939
36940 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
36941 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
36942 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
36943 @pxref{qSupported}.
36944 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
36945 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
36946 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
36947 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
36948 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
36949 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
36950 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
36951
36952 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
36953 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
36954 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
36955 connection.
36956 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
36957 new connection is established,
36958 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
36959 for the current connection, once disabled.
36960
36961 @node Examples
36962 @section Examples
36963
36964 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
36965 does not get any direct output:
36966
36967 @smallexample
36968 -> @code{R00}
36969 <- @code{+}
36970 @emph{target restarts}
36971 -> @code{?}
36972 <- @code{+}
36973 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
36974 -> @code{+}
36975 @end smallexample
36976
36977 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
36978
36979 @smallexample
36980 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
36981 <- @code{+}
36982 -> @code{s}
36983 <- @code{+}
36984 @emph{time passes}
36985 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
36986 -> @code{+}
36987 -> @code{g}
36988 <- @code{+}
36989 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
36990 -> @code{+}
36991 @end smallexample
36992
36993 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
36994 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
36995 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
36996
36997 @menu
36998 * File-I/O Overview::
36999 * Protocol Basics::
37000 * The F Request Packet::
37001 * The F Reply Packet::
37002 * The Ctrl-C Message::
37003 * Console I/O::
37004 * List of Supported Calls::
37005 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
37006 * Constants::
37007 * File-I/O Examples::
37008 @end menu
37009
37010 @node File-I/O Overview
37011 @subsection File-I/O Overview
37012 @cindex file-i/o overview
37013
37014 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
37015 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
37016 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
37017 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
37018 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
37019 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
37020
37021 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
37022 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
37023 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
37024 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
37025 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
37026
37027 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
37028 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
37029 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
37030 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
37031 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
37032 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
37033 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
37034
37035 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
37036 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
37037 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
37038 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
37039 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
37040
37041 @smallexample
37042 (@value{GDBP}) continue
37043 <- target requests 'system call X'
37044 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
37045 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
37046 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
37047 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
37048 @end smallexample
37049
37050 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
37051 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
37052 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
37053 system are not supported by this protocol.
37054
37055 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
37056
37057 @node Protocol Basics
37058 @subsection Protocol Basics
37059 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
37060
37061 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
37062 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
37063 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
37064 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
37065 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
37066 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
37067 to call the appropriate host system call:
37068
37069 @itemize @bullet
37070 @item
37071 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
37072
37073 @item
37074 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
37075 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
37076 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
37077 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
37078
37079 @end itemize
37080
37081 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
37082
37083 @itemize @bullet
37084 @item
37085 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
37086 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
37087 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
37088 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
37089 packet.
37090
37091 @item
37092 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
37093 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
37094
37095 @item
37096 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
37097
37098 @item
37099 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
37100
37101 @item
37102 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
37103 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
37104 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
37105 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
37106 packet.
37107
37108 @end itemize
37109
37110 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
37111 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
37112
37113 @itemize @bullet
37114 @item
37115 Return value.
37116
37117 @item
37118 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
37119
37120 @item
37121 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
37122
37123 @end itemize
37124
37125 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
37126 the latest continue or step action.
37127
37128 @node The F Request Packet
37129 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
37130 @cindex file-i/o request packet
37131 @cindex @code{F} request packet
37132
37133 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
37134
37135 @table @samp
37136 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
37137
37138 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
37139 This is just the name of the function.
37140
37141 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
37142 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
37143 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
37144 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
37145 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
37146 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
37147 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
37148
37149 @end table
37150
37151
37152
37153 @node The F Reply Packet
37154 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
37155 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
37156 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
37157
37158 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
37159
37160 @table @samp
37161
37162 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
37163
37164 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
37165
37166 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
37167 representation.
37168 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
37169
37170 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
37171 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
37172 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
37173
37174 @smallexample
37175 F0,0,C
37176 @end smallexample
37177
37178 @noindent
37179 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
37180
37181 @smallexample
37182 F-1,4,C
37183 @end smallexample
37184
37185 @noindent
37186 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
37187
37188 @end table
37189
37190
37191 @node The Ctrl-C Message
37192 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
37193 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
37194
37195 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
37196 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
37197 the target should behave as if it had
37198 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
37199 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
37200 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
37201 packet.
37202
37203 It's important for the target to know in which
37204 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
37205
37206 @itemize @bullet
37207 @item
37208 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
37209
37210 @item
37211 The system call on the host has been finished.
37212
37213 @end itemize
37214
37215 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
37216 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
37217 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
37218 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
37219 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
37220 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
37221
37222 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
37223 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
37224 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
37225 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
37226 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
37227 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
37228 or the full action has been completed.
37229
37230 @node Console I/O
37231 @subsection Console I/O
37232 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
37233
37234 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
37235 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
37236 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
37237 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
37238 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
37239 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
37240 conditions is met:
37241
37242 @itemize @bullet
37243 @item
37244 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
37245 @code{read}
37246 system call is treated as finished.
37247
37248 @item
37249 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
37250 newline.
37251
37252 @item
37253 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
37254 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
37255
37256 @end itemize
37257
37258 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
37259 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
37260 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
37261 is stopped at the user's request.
37262
37263
37264 @node List of Supported Calls
37265 @subsection List of Supported Calls
37266 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
37267
37268 @menu
37269 * open::
37270 * close::
37271 * read::
37272 * write::
37273 * lseek::
37274 * rename::
37275 * unlink::
37276 * stat/fstat::
37277 * gettimeofday::
37278 * isatty::
37279 * system::
37280 @end menu
37281
37282 @node open
37283 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
37284 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
37285
37286 @table @asis
37287 @item Synopsis:
37288 @smallexample
37289 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
37290 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
37291 @end smallexample
37292
37293 @item Request:
37294 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
37295
37296 @noindent
37297 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
37298
37299 @table @code
37300 @item O_CREAT
37301 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
37302 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
37303 are concerned.
37304
37305 @item O_EXCL
37306 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
37307 an error and open() fails.
37308
37309 @item O_TRUNC
37310 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
37311 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
37312 truncated to zero length.
37313
37314 @item O_APPEND
37315 The file is opened in append mode.
37316
37317 @item O_RDONLY
37318 The file is opened for reading only.
37319
37320 @item O_WRONLY
37321 The file is opened for writing only.
37322
37323 @item O_RDWR
37324 The file is opened for reading and writing.
37325 @end table
37326
37327 @noindent
37328 Other bits are silently ignored.
37329
37330
37331 @noindent
37332 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
37333
37334 @table @code
37335 @item S_IRUSR
37336 User has read permission.
37337
37338 @item S_IWUSR
37339 User has write permission.
37340
37341 @item S_IRGRP
37342 Group has read permission.
37343
37344 @item S_IWGRP
37345 Group has write permission.
37346
37347 @item S_IROTH
37348 Others have read permission.
37349
37350 @item S_IWOTH
37351 Others have write permission.
37352 @end table
37353
37354 @noindent
37355 Other bits are silently ignored.
37356
37357
37358 @item Return value:
37359 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
37360 occurred.
37361
37362 @item Errors:
37363
37364 @table @code
37365 @item EEXIST
37366 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
37367
37368 @item EISDIR
37369 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
37370
37371 @item EACCES
37372 The requested access is not allowed.
37373
37374 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37375 @var{pathname} was too long.
37376
37377 @item ENOENT
37378 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
37379
37380 @item ENODEV
37381 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
37382
37383 @item EROFS
37384 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
37385 write access was requested.
37386
37387 @item EFAULT
37388 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
37389
37390 @item ENOSPC
37391 No space on device to create the file.
37392
37393 @item EMFILE
37394 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
37395
37396 @item ENFILE
37397 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
37398 has been reached.
37399
37400 @item EINTR
37401 The call was interrupted by the user.
37402 @end table
37403
37404 @end table
37405
37406 @node close
37407 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
37408 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
37409
37410 @table @asis
37411 @item Synopsis:
37412 @smallexample
37413 int close(int fd);
37414 @end smallexample
37415
37416 @item Request:
37417 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
37418
37419 @item Return value:
37420 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
37421
37422 @item Errors:
37423
37424 @table @code
37425 @item EBADF
37426 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
37427
37428 @item EINTR
37429 The call was interrupted by the user.
37430 @end table
37431
37432 @end table
37433
37434 @node read
37435 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
37436 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
37437
37438 @table @asis
37439 @item Synopsis:
37440 @smallexample
37441 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
37442 @end smallexample
37443
37444 @item Request:
37445 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
37446
37447 @item Return value:
37448 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
37449 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
37450 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
37451
37452 @item Errors:
37453
37454 @table @code
37455 @item EBADF
37456 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
37457 reading.
37458
37459 @item EFAULT
37460 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37461
37462 @item EINTR
37463 The call was interrupted by the user.
37464 @end table
37465
37466 @end table
37467
37468 @node write
37469 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
37470 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
37471
37472 @table @asis
37473 @item Synopsis:
37474 @smallexample
37475 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
37476 @end smallexample
37477
37478 @item Request:
37479 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
37480
37481 @item Return value:
37482 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
37483 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
37484 is returned.
37485
37486 @item Errors:
37487
37488 @table @code
37489 @item EBADF
37490 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
37491 writing.
37492
37493 @item EFAULT
37494 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37495
37496 @item EFBIG
37497 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
37498 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
37499
37500 @item ENOSPC
37501 No space on device to write the data.
37502
37503 @item EINTR
37504 The call was interrupted by the user.
37505 @end table
37506
37507 @end table
37508
37509 @node lseek
37510 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
37511 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
37512
37513 @table @asis
37514 @item Synopsis:
37515 @smallexample
37516 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
37517 @end smallexample
37518
37519 @item Request:
37520 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
37521
37522 @var{flag} is one of:
37523
37524 @table @code
37525 @item SEEK_SET
37526 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
37527
37528 @item SEEK_CUR
37529 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
37530 bytes.
37531
37532 @item SEEK_END
37533 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
37534 bytes.
37535 @end table
37536
37537 @item Return value:
37538 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
37539 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
37540 value of -1 is returned.
37541
37542 @item Errors:
37543
37544 @table @code
37545 @item EBADF
37546 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
37547
37548 @item ESPIPE
37549 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
37550
37551 @item EINVAL
37552 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
37553
37554 @item EINTR
37555 The call was interrupted by the user.
37556 @end table
37557
37558 @end table
37559
37560 @node rename
37561 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
37562 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
37563
37564 @table @asis
37565 @item Synopsis:
37566 @smallexample
37567 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
37568 @end smallexample
37569
37570 @item Request:
37571 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
37572
37573 @item Return value:
37574 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
37575
37576 @item Errors:
37577
37578 @table @code
37579 @item EISDIR
37580 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
37581 directory.
37582
37583 @item EEXIST
37584 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
37585
37586 @item EBUSY
37587 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
37588 process.
37589
37590 @item EINVAL
37591 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
37592 of itself.
37593
37594 @item ENOTDIR
37595 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
37596 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
37597 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
37598
37599 @item EFAULT
37600 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
37601
37602 @item EACCES
37603 No access to the file or the path of the file.
37604
37605 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37606
37607 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
37608
37609 @item ENOENT
37610 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
37611
37612 @item EROFS
37613 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
37614
37615 @item ENOSPC
37616 The device containing the file has no room for the new
37617 directory entry.
37618
37619 @item EINTR
37620 The call was interrupted by the user.
37621 @end table
37622
37623 @end table
37624
37625 @node unlink
37626 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
37627 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
37628
37629 @table @asis
37630 @item Synopsis:
37631 @smallexample
37632 int unlink(const char *pathname);
37633 @end smallexample
37634
37635 @item Request:
37636 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
37637
37638 @item Return value:
37639 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
37640
37641 @item Errors:
37642
37643 @table @code
37644 @item EACCES
37645 No access to the file or the path of the file.
37646
37647 @item EPERM
37648 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
37649
37650 @item EBUSY
37651 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
37652 being used by another process.
37653
37654 @item EFAULT
37655 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37656
37657 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37658 @var{pathname} was too long.
37659
37660 @item ENOENT
37661 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
37662
37663 @item ENOTDIR
37664 A component of the path is not a directory.
37665
37666 @item EROFS
37667 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
37668
37669 @item EINTR
37670 The call was interrupted by the user.
37671 @end table
37672
37673 @end table
37674
37675 @node stat/fstat
37676 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
37677 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
37678 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
37679
37680 @table @asis
37681 @item Synopsis:
37682 @smallexample
37683 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
37684 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
37685 @end smallexample
37686
37687 @item Request:
37688 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
37689 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
37690
37691 @item Return value:
37692 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
37693
37694 @item Errors:
37695
37696 @table @code
37697 @item EBADF
37698 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
37699
37700 @item ENOENT
37701 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
37702 path is an empty string.
37703
37704 @item ENOTDIR
37705 A component of the path is not a directory.
37706
37707 @item EFAULT
37708 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37709
37710 @item EACCES
37711 No access to the file or the path of the file.
37712
37713 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37714 @var{pathname} was too long.
37715
37716 @item EINTR
37717 The call was interrupted by the user.
37718 @end table
37719
37720 @end table
37721
37722 @node gettimeofday
37723 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
37724 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
37725
37726 @table @asis
37727 @item Synopsis:
37728 @smallexample
37729 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
37730 @end smallexample
37731
37732 @item Request:
37733 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
37734
37735 @item Return value:
37736 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
37737
37738 @item Errors:
37739
37740 @table @code
37741 @item EINVAL
37742 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
37743
37744 @item EFAULT
37745 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37746 @end table
37747
37748 @end table
37749
37750 @node isatty
37751 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
37752 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
37753
37754 @table @asis
37755 @item Synopsis:
37756 @smallexample
37757 int isatty(int fd);
37758 @end smallexample
37759
37760 @item Request:
37761 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
37762
37763 @item Return value:
37764 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
37765
37766 @item Errors:
37767
37768 @table @code
37769 @item EINTR
37770 The call was interrupted by the user.
37771 @end table
37772
37773 @end table
37774
37775 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
37776 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
37777 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
37778 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
37779 needed.
37780
37781
37782 @node system
37783 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
37784 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
37785
37786 @table @asis
37787 @item Synopsis:
37788 @smallexample
37789 int system(const char *command);
37790 @end smallexample
37791
37792 @item Request:
37793 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
37794
37795 @item Return value:
37796 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
37797 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
37798 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
37799 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
37800 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
37801 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
37802 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
37803
37804 @item Errors:
37805
37806 @table @code
37807 @item EINTR
37808 The call was interrupted by the user.
37809 @end table
37810
37811 @end table
37812
37813 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
37814 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
37815 the host is simplified before it's returned
37816 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
37817 is discarded, and the return value consists
37818 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
37819
37820 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
37821 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
37822 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
37823
37824 @table @code
37825 @item set remote system-call-allowed
37826 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
37827 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
37828 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
37829
37830 @item show remote system-call-allowed
37831 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
37832 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
37833 protocol.
37834 @end table
37835
37836 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
37837 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
37838 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
37839
37840 @menu
37841 * Integral Datatypes::
37842 * Pointer Values::
37843 * Memory Transfer::
37844 * struct stat::
37845 * struct timeval::
37846 @end menu
37847
37848 @node Integral Datatypes
37849 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
37850 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
37851
37852 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
37853 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
37854 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
37855
37856 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
37857 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
37858
37859 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
37860
37861 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
37862 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
37863
37864 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
37865
37866 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
37867 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
37868 byte order.
37869
37870 @node Pointer Values
37871 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
37872 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
37873
37874 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
37875 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
37876 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
37877 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
37878
37879 @smallexample
37880 @code{1aaf/12}
37881 @end smallexample
37882
37883 @noindent
37884 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
37885 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
37886 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
37887 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
37888
37889 @smallexample
37890 @code{123456/d}
37891 @end smallexample
37892
37893 @node Memory Transfer
37894 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
37895 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
37896
37897 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
37898 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
37899 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
37900 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
37901 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
37902 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
37903 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
37904
37905
37906 @node struct stat
37907 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
37908 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
37909
37910 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
37911 is defined as follows:
37912
37913 @smallexample
37914 struct stat @{
37915 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
37916 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
37917 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
37918 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
37919 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
37920 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
37921 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
37922 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
37923 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
37924 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
37925 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
37926 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
37927 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
37928 @};
37929 @end smallexample
37930
37931 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
37932 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
37933 structure is of size 64 bytes.
37934
37935 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
37936 range of values.
37937
37938 @table @code
37939
37940 @item st_dev
37941 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
37942
37943 @item st_ino
37944 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
37945
37946 @item st_mode
37947 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
37948 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
37949
37950 @item st_uid
37951 @itemx st_gid
37952 @itemx st_rdev
37953 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
37954
37955 @item st_atime
37956 @itemx st_mtime
37957 @itemx st_ctime
37958 These values have a host and file system dependent
37959 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
37960 support exact timing values.
37961 @end table
37962
37963 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
37964 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
37965 continuing.
37966
37967 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
37968 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
37969 get truncated on the target.
37970
37971 @node struct timeval
37972 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
37973 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
37974
37975 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
37976 is defined as follows:
37977
37978 @smallexample
37979 struct timeval @{
37980 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
37981 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
37982 @};
37983 @end smallexample
37984
37985 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
37986 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
37987 structure is of size 8 bytes.
37988
37989 @node Constants
37990 @subsection Constants
37991 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
37992
37993 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
37994 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
37995 values before and after the call as needed.
37996
37997 @menu
37998 * Open Flags::
37999 * mode_t Values::
38000 * Errno Values::
38001 * Lseek Flags::
38002 * Limits::
38003 @end menu
38004
38005 @node Open Flags
38006 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
38007 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
38008
38009 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
38010
38011 @smallexample
38012 O_RDONLY 0x0
38013 O_WRONLY 0x1
38014 O_RDWR 0x2
38015 O_APPEND 0x8
38016 O_CREAT 0x200
38017 O_TRUNC 0x400
38018 O_EXCL 0x800
38019 @end smallexample
38020
38021 @node mode_t Values
38022 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
38023 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
38024
38025 All values are given in octal representation.
38026
38027 @smallexample
38028 S_IFREG 0100000
38029 S_IFDIR 040000
38030 S_IRUSR 0400
38031 S_IWUSR 0200
38032 S_IXUSR 0100
38033 S_IRGRP 040
38034 S_IWGRP 020
38035 S_IXGRP 010
38036 S_IROTH 04
38037 S_IWOTH 02
38038 S_IXOTH 01
38039 @end smallexample
38040
38041 @node Errno Values
38042 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
38043 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
38044
38045 All values are given in decimal representation.
38046
38047 @smallexample
38048 EPERM 1
38049 ENOENT 2
38050 EINTR 4
38051 EBADF 9
38052 EACCES 13
38053 EFAULT 14
38054 EBUSY 16
38055 EEXIST 17
38056 ENODEV 19
38057 ENOTDIR 20
38058 EISDIR 21
38059 EINVAL 22
38060 ENFILE 23
38061 EMFILE 24
38062 EFBIG 27
38063 ENOSPC 28
38064 ESPIPE 29
38065 EROFS 30
38066 ENAMETOOLONG 91
38067 EUNKNOWN 9999
38068 @end smallexample
38069
38070 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
38071 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
38072
38073 @node Lseek Flags
38074 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
38075 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
38076
38077 @smallexample
38078 SEEK_SET 0
38079 SEEK_CUR 1
38080 SEEK_END 2
38081 @end smallexample
38082
38083 @node Limits
38084 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
38085 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
38086
38087 All values are given in decimal representation.
38088
38089 @smallexample
38090 INT_MIN -2147483648
38091 INT_MAX 2147483647
38092 UINT_MAX 4294967295
38093 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
38094 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
38095 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
38096 @end smallexample
38097
38098 @node File-I/O Examples
38099 @subsection File-I/O Examples
38100 @cindex file-i/o examples
38101
38102 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
38103 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
38104
38105 @smallexample
38106 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
38107 @emph{request memory read from target}
38108 -> @code{m1234,6}
38109 <- XXXXXX
38110 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
38111 -> @code{F6}
38112 @end smallexample
38113
38114 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
38115 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
38116
38117 @smallexample
38118 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38119 @emph{request memory write to target}
38120 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
38121 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
38122 -> @code{F6}
38123 @end smallexample
38124
38125 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
38126 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
38127
38128 @smallexample
38129 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38130 -> @code{F-1,9}
38131 @end smallexample
38132
38133 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
38134 host is called:
38135
38136 @smallexample
38137 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38138 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
38139 <- @code{T02}
38140 @end smallexample
38141
38142 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
38143 host is called:
38144
38145 @smallexample
38146 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38147 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
38148 <- @code{T02}
38149 @end smallexample
38150
38151 @node Library List Format
38152 @section Library List Format
38153 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
38154
38155 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
38156 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
38157 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
38158 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
38159 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
38160 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
38161 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
38162 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
38163 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
38164 are loaded.
38165
38166 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
38167 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
38168 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
38169 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
38170
38171 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
38172 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
38173 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
38174 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
38175 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
38176 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
38177
38178 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38179 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
38180
38181 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
38182 offset, looks like this:
38183
38184 @smallexample
38185 <library-list>
38186 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
38187 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
38188 </library>
38189 </library-list>
38190 @end smallexample
38191
38192 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
38193 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
38194
38195 @smallexample
38196 <library-list>
38197 <library name="sharedlib.o">
38198 <section address="0x10000000"/>
38199 <section address="0x20000000"/>
38200 <section address="0x30000000"/>
38201 </library>
38202 </library-list>
38203 @end smallexample
38204
38205 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
38206
38207 @smallexample
38208 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
38209 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
38210 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38211 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
38212 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
38213 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
38214 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
38215 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
38216 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
38217 @end smallexample
38218
38219 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
38220 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
38221 section for each library.
38222
38223 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
38224 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
38225 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
38226
38227 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
38228 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
38229 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
38230 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
38231
38232 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
38233 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
38234 target, the following parameters are reported:
38235
38236 @itemize @minus
38237 @item
38238 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
38239 @code{struct link_map}.
38240 @item
38241 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
38242 (Thread Local Storage) access.
38243 @item
38244 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
38245 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
38246 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
38247 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
38248 @item
38249 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
38250 @end itemize
38251
38252 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
38253 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
38254 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
38255
38256 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38257 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
38258
38259 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
38260 looks like this:
38261
38262 @smallexample
38263 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
38264 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
38265 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
38266 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
38267 l_ld="0x152350"/>
38268 </library-list-svr>
38269 @end smallexample
38270
38271 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
38272
38273 @smallexample
38274 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
38275 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
38276 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38277 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
38278 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
38279 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
38280 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
38281 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
38282 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
38283 @end smallexample
38284
38285 @node Memory Map Format
38286 @section Memory Map Format
38287 @cindex memory map format
38288
38289 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
38290 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
38291 memory map.
38292
38293 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
38294 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
38295 lists memory regions.
38296
38297 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38298 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
38299
38300 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
38301
38302 @smallexample
38303 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38304 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
38305 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
38306 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
38307 <memory-map>
38308 region...
38309 </memory-map>
38310 @end smallexample
38311
38312 Each region can be either:
38313
38314 @itemize
38315
38316 @item
38317 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
38318 bytes from there:
38319
38320 @smallexample
38321 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
38322 @end smallexample
38323
38324
38325 @item
38326 A region of read-only memory:
38327
38328 @smallexample
38329 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
38330 @end smallexample
38331
38332
38333 @item
38334 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
38335 bytes in length:
38336
38337 @smallexample
38338 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
38339 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
38340 </memory>
38341 @end smallexample
38342
38343 @end itemize
38344
38345 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
38346 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
38347 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
38348
38349 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
38350
38351 @smallexample
38352 <!-- ................................................... -->
38353 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
38354 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
38355 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
38356 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
38357 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
38358 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
38359 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
38360 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
38361 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
38362 and its type, or device. -->
38363 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
38364 start CDATA #REQUIRED
38365 length CDATA #REQUIRED
38366 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
38367 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
38368 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
38369 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
38370 @end smallexample
38371
38372 @node Thread List Format
38373 @section Thread List Format
38374 @cindex thread list format
38375
38376 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
38377 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
38378 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
38379 the following structure:
38380
38381 @smallexample
38382 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38383 <threads>
38384 <thread id="id" core="0">
38385 ... description ...
38386 </thread>
38387 </threads>
38388 @end smallexample
38389
38390 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
38391 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
38392 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
38393 the thread was last executing on. The content of the of @samp{thread}
38394 element is interpreted as human-readable auxilliary information.
38395
38396 @node Traceframe Info Format
38397 @section Traceframe Info Format
38398 @cindex traceframe info format
38399
38400 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
38401 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
38402 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
38403 collected in a traceframe.
38404
38405 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
38406 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
38407
38408 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38409 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
38410
38411 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
38412
38413 @smallexample
38414 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38415 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
38416 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
38417 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
38418 <traceframe-info>
38419 block...
38420 </traceframe-info>
38421 @end smallexample
38422
38423 Each traceframe block can be either:
38424
38425 @itemize
38426
38427 @item
38428 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
38429 @var{length} bytes from there:
38430
38431 @smallexample
38432 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
38433 @end smallexample
38434
38435 @item
38436 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
38437 collected:
38438
38439 @smallexample
38440 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
38441 @end smallexample
38442
38443 @end itemize
38444
38445 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
38446
38447 @smallexample
38448 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
38449 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38450
38451 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
38452 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
38453 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
38454 <!ELEMENT tvar>
38455 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
38456 @end smallexample
38457
38458 @node Branch Trace Format
38459 @section Branch Trace Format
38460 @cindex branch trace format
38461
38462 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
38463 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
38464 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
38465 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
38466
38467 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
38468 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
38469
38470 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38471 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
38472
38473 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
38474
38475 @smallexample
38476 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38477 <!DOCTYPE btrace
38478 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
38479 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
38480 <btrace>
38481 block...
38482 </btrace>
38483 @end smallexample
38484
38485 @itemize
38486
38487 @item
38488 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
38489 and ending at @var{end}:
38490
38491 @smallexample
38492 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
38493 @end smallexample
38494
38495 @end itemize
38496
38497 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
38498
38499 @smallexample
38500 <!ELEMENT btrace (block)* >
38501 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38502
38503 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
38504 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
38505 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
38506 @end smallexample
38507
38508 @include agentexpr.texi
38509
38510 @node Target Descriptions
38511 @appendix Target Descriptions
38512 @cindex target descriptions
38513
38514 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
38515 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
38516 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
38517 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
38518 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
38519 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
38520 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
38521
38522 @itemize @bullet
38523 @item
38524 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
38525 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
38526 @item
38527 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
38528 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
38529 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
38530 @item
38531 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
38532 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
38533 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
38534 @end itemize
38535
38536 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
38537 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
38538 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
38539 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
38540 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
38541
38542 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38543 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
38544
38545 @menu
38546 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
38547 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
38548 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
38549 descriptions.
38550 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
38551 @end menu
38552
38553 @node Retrieving Descriptions
38554 @section Retrieving Descriptions
38555
38556 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
38557 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
38558 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
38559 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
38560 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
38561 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
38562 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
38563 Format}.
38564
38565 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
38566 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
38567 specify a file are:
38568
38569 @table @code
38570 @cindex set tdesc filename
38571 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
38572 Read the target description from @var{path}.
38573
38574 @cindex unset tdesc filename
38575 @item unset tdesc filename
38576 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
38577 will use the description supplied by the current target.
38578
38579 @cindex show tdesc filename
38580 @item show tdesc filename
38581 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
38582 @end table
38583
38584
38585 @node Target Description Format
38586 @section Target Description Format
38587 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
38588
38589 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
38590 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
38591 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
38592 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
38593 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
38594 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
38595 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
38596
38597 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
38598 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
38599 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
38600 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
38601 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
38602
38603 Here is a simple target description:
38604
38605 @smallexample
38606 <target version="1.0">
38607 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
38608 </target>
38609 @end smallexample
38610
38611 @noindent
38612 This minimal description only says that the target uses
38613 the x86-64 architecture.
38614
38615 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
38616 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
38617 are explained further below.
38618
38619 @smallexample
38620 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38621 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
38622 <target version="1.0">
38623 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
38624 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
38625 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
38626 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
38627 </target>
38628 @end smallexample
38629
38630 @noindent
38631 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
38632 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
38633 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
38634 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
38635 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
38636 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
38637 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
38638 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
38639 the version mismatch.
38640
38641 @subsection Inclusion
38642 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
38643 @cindex XInclude
38644 @ifnotinfo
38645 @cindex <xi:include>
38646 @end ifnotinfo
38647
38648 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
38649 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
38650 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
38651 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
38652 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
38653
38654 @smallexample
38655 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
38656 @end smallexample
38657
38658 @noindent
38659 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
38660 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
38661 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
38662 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
38663 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
38664 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
38665 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
38666 original description.
38667
38668 @subsection Architecture
38669 @cindex <architecture>
38670
38671 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
38672
38673 @smallexample
38674 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
38675 @end smallexample
38676
38677 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
38678 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
38679
38680 @subsection OS ABI
38681 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
38682
38683 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
38684 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
38685
38686 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
38687
38688 @smallexample
38689 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
38690 @end smallexample
38691
38692 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
38693 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
38694
38695 @subsection Compatible Architecture
38696 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
38697
38698 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
38699 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
38700
38701 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
38702
38703 @smallexample
38704 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
38705 @end smallexample
38706
38707 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
38708 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
38709
38710 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
38711 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
38712 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
38713 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
38714 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
38715 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
38716 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
38717
38718 @smallexample
38719 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
38720 <compatible>spu</compatible>
38721 @end smallexample
38722
38723 @subsection Features
38724 @cindex <feature>
38725
38726 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
38727 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
38728 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
38729 has this form:
38730
38731 @smallexample
38732 <feature name="@var{name}">
38733 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
38734 @var{reg}@dots{}
38735 </feature>
38736 @end smallexample
38737
38738 @noindent
38739 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
38740 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
38741 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
38742 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
38743
38744 @subsection Types
38745
38746 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
38747 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
38748 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
38749 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
38750 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
38751
38752 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
38753 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
38754 Types must be defined before they are used.
38755
38756 @cindex <vector>
38757 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
38758 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
38759 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
38760 @var{count}:
38761
38762 @smallexample
38763 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
38764 @end smallexample
38765
38766 @cindex <union>
38767 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
38768 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
38769 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
38770 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
38771
38772 @smallexample
38773 <union id="@var{id}">
38774 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
38775 @dots{}
38776 </union>
38777 @end smallexample
38778
38779 @cindex <struct>
38780 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
38781 it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
38782 element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
38783 or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
38784 its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
38785 explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
38786 integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
38787 equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
38788
38789 @smallexample
38790 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
38791 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
38792 @dots{}
38793 </struct>
38794 @end smallexample
38795
38796 If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
38797 explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
38798
38799 @smallexample
38800 <struct id="@var{id}">
38801 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
38802 @dots{}
38803 </struct>
38804 @end smallexample
38805
38806 @cindex <flags>
38807 If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
38808 a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
38809 and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
38810 @var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
38811 are supported.
38812
38813 @smallexample
38814 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
38815 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
38816 @dots{}
38817 </flags>
38818 @end smallexample
38819
38820 @subsection Registers
38821 @cindex <reg>
38822
38823 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
38824
38825 @smallexample
38826 <reg name="@var{name}"
38827 bitsize="@var{size}"
38828 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
38829 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
38830 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
38831 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
38832 @end smallexample
38833
38834 @noindent
38835 The components are as follows:
38836
38837 @table @var
38838
38839 @item name
38840 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
38841
38842 @item bitsize
38843 The register's size, in bits.
38844
38845 @item regnum
38846 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
38847 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
38848 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
38849 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
38850 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
38851 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
38852 in order of increasing register number.
38853
38854 @item save-restore
38855 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
38856 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
38857 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
38858 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
38859 ABI.
38860
38861 @item type
38862 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
38863 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
38864 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
38865 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
38866 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
38867 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
38868
38869 @item group
38870 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
38871 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
38872 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
38873 in @code{info registers}.
38874
38875 @end table
38876
38877 @node Predefined Target Types
38878 @section Predefined Target Types
38879 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
38880
38881 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
38882 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
38883 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
38884 types. The currently supported types are:
38885
38886 @table @code
38887
38888 @item int8
38889 @itemx int16
38890 @itemx int32
38891 @itemx int64
38892 @itemx int128
38893 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
38894
38895 @item uint8
38896 @itemx uint16
38897 @itemx uint32
38898 @itemx uint64
38899 @itemx uint128
38900 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
38901
38902 @item code_ptr
38903 @itemx data_ptr
38904 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
38905 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
38906 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
38907 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
38908 may be marked as data pointers.
38909
38910 @item ieee_single
38911 Single precision IEEE floating point.
38912
38913 @item ieee_double
38914 Double precision IEEE floating point.
38915
38916 @item arm_fpa_ext
38917 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
38918
38919 @item i387_ext
38920 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
38921
38922 @item i386_eflags
38923 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
38924
38925 @item i386_mxcsr
38926 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
38927
38928 @end table
38929
38930 @node Standard Target Features
38931 @section Standard Target Features
38932 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
38933
38934 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
38935 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
38936 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
38937 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
38938 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
38939 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
38940 can recognize them.
38941
38942 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
38943 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
38944 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
38945 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
38946 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
38947 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
38948 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
38949 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
38950
38951 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
38952 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
38953 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
38954
38955 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
38956 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
38957 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
38958 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
38959
38960 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
38961 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
38962 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
38963
38964 @menu
38965 * AArch64 Features::
38966 * ARM Features::
38967 * i386 Features::
38968 * MIPS Features::
38969 * M68K Features::
38970 * Nios II Features::
38971 * PowerPC Features::
38972 * S/390 and System z Features::
38973 * TIC6x Features::
38974 @end menu
38975
38976
38977 @node AArch64 Features
38978 @subsection AArch64 Features
38979 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
38980
38981 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
38982 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
38983 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
38984
38985 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
38986 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
38987 and @samp{fpcr}.
38988
38989 @node ARM Features
38990 @subsection ARM Features
38991 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
38992
38993 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
38994 ARM targets.
38995 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
38996 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
38997
38998 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
38999 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
39000 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
39001 and @samp{xpsr}.
39002
39003 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
39004 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
39005
39006 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
39007 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
39008 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
39009 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
39010
39011 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
39012 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
39013 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
39014 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
39015 halves of the double-precision registers.
39016
39017 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
39018 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
39019 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
39020 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
39021 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
39022 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
39023
39024 @node i386 Features
39025 @subsection i386 Features
39026 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
39027
39028 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
39029 targets. It should describe the following registers:
39030
39031 @itemize @minus
39032 @item
39033 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
39034 @item
39035 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
39036 @item
39037 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
39038 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
39039 @item
39040 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
39041 @item
39042 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
39043 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
39044 @end itemize
39045
39046 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
39047
39048 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
39049 describe registers:
39050
39051 @itemize @minus
39052 @item
39053 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
39054 @item
39055 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
39056 @item
39057 @samp{mxcsr}
39058 @end itemize
39059
39060 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
39061 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
39062 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
39063
39064 @itemize @minus
39065 @item
39066 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
39067 @item
39068 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
39069 @end itemize
39070
39071 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel(R)
39072 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
39073
39074 @itemize @minus
39075 @item
39076 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
39077 @item
39078 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
39079 @end itemize
39080
39081 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
39082 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
39083
39084 @node MIPS Features
39085 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
39086 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
39087
39088 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
39089 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
39090 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
39091 on the target.
39092
39093 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
39094 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
39095 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39096
39097 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
39098 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
39099 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
39100 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39101
39102 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
39103 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
39104 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
39105 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39106
39107 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
39108 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
39109 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
39110
39111 @node M68K Features
39112 @subsection M68K Features
39113 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
39114
39115 @table @code
39116 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
39117 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
39118 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
39119 One of those features must be always present.
39120 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
39121 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
39122 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
39123 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
39124
39125 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
39126 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
39127 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
39128 @samp{fpiaddr}.
39129 @end table
39130
39131 @node Nios II Features
39132 @subsection Nios II Features
39133 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
39134
39135 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
39136 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
39137 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
39138 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
39139 @samp{mpuacc}).
39140
39141 @node PowerPC Features
39142 @subsection PowerPC Features
39143 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
39144
39145 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
39146 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
39147 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
39148 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39149
39150 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
39151 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
39152
39153 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
39154 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
39155 and @samp{vrsave}.
39156
39157 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
39158 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
39159 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
39160 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
39161 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
39162 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
39163
39164 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
39165 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
39166 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
39167 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
39168 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
39169 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
39170 user.
39171
39172 @node S/390 and System z Features
39173 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
39174 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
39175 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
39176
39177 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
39178 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
39179 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
39180 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
39181 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
39182 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
39183 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
39184 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
39185 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
39186
39187 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
39188 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
39189 @samp{fpc}.
39190
39191 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
39192 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
39193
39194 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
39195 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
39196 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
39197 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
39198 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
39199 32-bit wide.
39200
39201 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
39202 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
39203 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
39204
39205 @node TIC6x Features
39206 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
39207 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
39208 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
39209 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
39210 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
39211 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
39212
39213 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
39214 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
39215 through @samp{B31}.
39216
39217 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
39218 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
39219
39220 @node Operating System Information
39221 @appendix Operating System Information
39222 @cindex operating system information
39223
39224 @menu
39225 * Process list::
39226 @end menu
39227
39228 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
39229 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
39230 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
39231 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
39232 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
39233 on a different aspect of target.
39234
39235 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
39236 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
39237 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
39238 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
39239
39240 @node Process list
39241 @appendixsection Process list
39242 @cindex operating system information, process list
39243
39244 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
39245 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
39246 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
39247 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
39248
39249 An example document is:
39250
39251 @smallexample
39252 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39253 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
39254 <osdata type="processes">
39255 <item>
39256 <column name="pid">1</column>
39257 <column name="user">root</column>
39258 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
39259 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
39260 </item>
39261 </osdata>
39262 @end smallexample
39263
39264 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
39265 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
39266 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
39267 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
39268 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
39269 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
39270 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
39271
39272 @node Trace File Format
39273 @appendix Trace File Format
39274 @cindex trace file format
39275
39276 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
39277 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
39278
39279 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
39280 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
39281 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
39282 in the future.
39283
39284 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
39285 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
39286 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
39287 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
39288 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
39289 of this section.
39290
39291 @c FIXME add some specific types of data
39292
39293 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
39294 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
39295 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
39296 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
39297 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
39298 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
39299 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
39300 endianness.
39301
39302 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
39303
39304 @table @code
39305 @item R @var{bytes}
39306 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
39307 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
39308 actual bytes, in target order and @value{GDBN} register order, not a
39309 hexadecimal encoding.
39310
39311 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
39312 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
39313 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
39314 @var{length} bytes.
39315
39316 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
39317 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
39318 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
39319
39320 @end table
39321
39322 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
39323 of blocks.
39324
39325 @node Index Section Format
39326 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
39327 @cindex .gdb_index section format
39328 @cindex index section format
39329
39330 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
39331 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
39332 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
39333 description.
39334
39335 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
39336 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
39337 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
39338 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
39339 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
39340 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
39341
39342 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
39343
39344 @enumerate
39345 @item
39346 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
39347 unless otherwise noted:
39348
39349 @enumerate
39350 @item
39351 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
39352 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
39353 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
39354 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
39355 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
39356 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
39357 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
39358
39359 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
39360 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
39361 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
39362 currently not flagged as deprecated.
39363
39364 @item
39365 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
39366
39367 @item
39368 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
39369 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
39370 to the next offset.
39371
39372 @item
39373 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
39374
39375 @item
39376 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
39377
39378 @item
39379 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
39380 @end enumerate
39381
39382 @item
39383 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
39384 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
39385 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
39386 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
39387 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
39388 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
39389 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
39390 CU indices.
39391
39392 @item
39393 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
39394 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
39395 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
39396 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
39397
39398 @item
39399 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
39400 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
39401
39402 @enumerate
39403 @item
39404 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
39405
39406 @item
39407 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
39408 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
39409
39410 @item
39411 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
39412 @end enumerate
39413
39414 @item
39415 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
39416 the hash table is always a power of 2.
39417
39418 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
39419 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
39420 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
39421 constant pool.
39422
39423 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
39424 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
39425 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
39426
39427 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
39428 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
39429 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
39430 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
39431 index version:
39432
39433 @table @asis
39434 @item Version 4
39435 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
39436
39437 @item Versions 5 to 7
39438 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
39439 @end table
39440
39441 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
39442
39443 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
39444 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
39445 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
39446 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
39447 collision.
39448
39449 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
39450 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
39451 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
39452 the code.
39453
39454 @item
39455 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
39456 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
39457 strings.
39458
39459 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
39460 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
39461 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
39462 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
39463 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
39464 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
39465
39466 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
39467 @end enumerate
39468
39469 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
39470 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
39471 CU index+attributes value for each use.
39472
39473 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
39474 (bit 0 = LSB):
39475
39476 @table @asis
39477
39478 @item Bits 0-23
39479 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
39480 @item Bits 24-27
39481 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
39482 @item Bits 28-30
39483 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
39484
39485 @table @asis
39486 @item 0
39487 This value is reserved and should not be used.
39488 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
39489 with previous versions of the index.
39490 @item 1
39491 The symbol is a type.
39492 @item 2
39493 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
39494 @item 3
39495 The symbol is a function.
39496 @item 4
39497 Any other kind of symbol.
39498 @item 5,6,7
39499 These values are reserved.
39500 @end table
39501
39502 @item Bit 31
39503 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
39504
39505 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
39506 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
39507 @value{GDBN} sources.
39508
39509 @end table
39510
39511 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
39512 global/static attributes in the index.
39513
39514 @smallexample
39515 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
39516 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
39517 switch (die->tag)
39518 @{
39519 case DW_TAG_typedef:
39520 case DW_TAG_base_type:
39521 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
39522 kind = TYPE;
39523 is_static = 1;
39524 break;
39525 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
39526 kind = VARIABLE;
39527 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
39528 break;
39529 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
39530 kind = FUNCTION;
39531 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
39532 break;
39533 case DW_TAG_constant:
39534 kind = VARIABLE;
39535 is_static = ! is_external;
39536 break;
39537 case DW_TAG_variable:
39538 kind = VARIABLE;
39539 is_static = ! is_external;
39540 break;
39541 case DW_TAG_namespace:
39542 kind = TYPE;
39543 is_static = 0;
39544 break;
39545 case DW_TAG_class_type:
39546 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
39547 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
39548 case DW_TAG_union_type:
39549 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
39550 kind = TYPE;
39551 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
39552 break;
39553 default:
39554 assert (0);
39555 @}
39556 @end smallexample
39557
39558 @node Man Pages
39559 @appendix Manual pages
39560 @cindex Man pages
39561
39562 @menu
39563 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
39564 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
39565 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
39566 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
39567 @end menu
39568
39569 @node gdb man
39570 @heading gdb man
39571
39572 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
39573
39574 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
39575 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
39576 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
39577 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
39578 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
39579 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
39580 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
39581 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
39582 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
39583 @c man end
39584
39585 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
39586 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
39587 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
39588 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
39589
39590 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
39591 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
39592
39593 @itemize @bullet
39594 @item
39595 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
39596
39597 @item
39598 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
39599
39600 @item
39601 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
39602
39603 @item
39604 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
39605 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
39606 @end itemize
39607
39608 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
39609 Modula-2.
39610
39611 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
39612 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
39613 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
39614 by using the command @code{help}.
39615
39616 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
39617 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
39618 executable program as the argument:
39619
39620 @smallexample
39621 gdb program
39622 @end smallexample
39623
39624 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
39625
39626 @smallexample
39627 gdb program core
39628 @end smallexample
39629
39630 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
39631 to debug a running process:
39632
39633 @smallexample
39634 gdb program 1234
39635 gdb -p 1234
39636 @end smallexample
39637
39638 @noindent
39639 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
39640 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
39641 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
39642
39643 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
39644
39645 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
39646 @table @env
39647 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{functiop}
39648 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
39649
39650 @item run [@var{arglist}]
39651 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
39652
39653 @item bt
39654 Backtrace: display the program stack.
39655
39656 @item print @var{expr}
39657 Display the value of an expression.
39658
39659 @item c
39660 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
39661
39662 @item next
39663 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
39664 function calls in the line.
39665
39666 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
39667 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
39668
39669 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
39670 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
39671
39672 @item step
39673 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
39674 function calls in the line.
39675
39676 @item help [@var{name}]
39677 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
39678 about using @value{GDBN}.
39679
39680 @item quit
39681 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
39682 @end table
39683
39684 @ifset man
39685 For full details on @value{GDBN},
39686 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
39687 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
39688 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
39689 @end ifset
39690 @c man end
39691
39692 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
39693 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
39694 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
39695 encountered with no
39696 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
39697 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
39698 Many options have
39699 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
39700 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
39701 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
39702 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
39703 more usual convention.)
39704
39705 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
39706 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
39707 option is used.
39708
39709 @table @env
39710 @item -help
39711 @itemx -h
39712 List all options, with brief explanations.
39713
39714 @item -symbols=@var{file}
39715 @itemx -s @var{file}
39716 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
39717
39718 @item -write
39719 Enable writing into executable and core files.
39720
39721 @item -exec=@var{file}
39722 @itemx -e @var{file}
39723 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
39724 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
39725 dump.
39726
39727 @item -se=@var{file}
39728 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
39729 file.
39730
39731 @item -core=@var{file}
39732 @itemx -c @var{file}
39733 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
39734
39735 @item -command=@var{file}
39736 @itemx -x @var{file}
39737 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
39738
39739 @item -ex @var{command}
39740 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
39741
39742 @item -directory=@var{directory}
39743 @itemx -d @var{directory}
39744 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
39745
39746 @item -nh
39747 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
39748
39749 @item -nx
39750 @itemx -n
39751 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
39752
39753 @item -quiet
39754 @itemx -q
39755 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
39756 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
39757
39758 @item -batch
39759 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
39760 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
39761 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
39762 commands in the command files.
39763
39764 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
39765 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
39766 more useful, the message
39767
39768 @smallexample
39769 Program exited normally.
39770 @end smallexample
39771
39772 @noindent
39773 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
39774 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
39775
39776 @item -cd=@var{directory}
39777 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
39778 instead of the current directory.
39779
39780 @item -fullname
39781 @itemx -f
39782 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
39783 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
39784 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
39785 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
39786 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
39787 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
39788 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
39789 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
39790
39791 @item -b @var{bps}
39792 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
39793 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
39794
39795 @item -tty=@var{device}
39796 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
39797 @end table
39798 @c man end
39799
39800 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
39801 @ifset man
39802 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
39803 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
39804 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
39805
39806 @smallexample
39807 info gdb
39808 @end smallexample
39809
39810 @noindent
39811 should give you access to the complete manual.
39812
39813 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
39814 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
39815 @end ifset
39816 @c man end
39817
39818 @node gdbserver man
39819 @heading gdbserver man
39820
39821 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
39822 @format
39823 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
39824 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
39825
39826 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
39827
39828 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
39829 @c man end
39830 @end format
39831
39832 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
39833 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
39834 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
39835
39836 @ifclear man
39837 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
39838 @end ifclear
39839 @ifset man
39840 Usage (server (target) side):
39841 @end ifset
39842
39843 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
39844 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
39845 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
39846 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
39847
39848 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
39849 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
39850 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
39851
39852 @smallexample
39853 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
39854 @end smallexample
39855
39856 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
39857
39858 @smallexample
39859 @ifset man
39860 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
39861 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
39862 @end ifset
39863 @ifclear man
39864 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
39865 @end ifclear
39866 @end smallexample
39867
39868 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
39869 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
39870 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
39871
39872 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
39873
39874 @smallexample
39875 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
39876 @end smallexample
39877
39878 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
39879 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
39880 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
39881 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
39882 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
39883 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
39884 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
39885 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
39886 print an error message and exit.
39887
39888 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
39889 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
39890
39891 @smallexample
39892 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
39893 @end smallexample
39894
39895 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
39896 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
39897
39898 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
39899 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
39900 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
39901 the program you want to debug.
39902
39903 @smallexample
39904 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
39905 @end smallexample
39906
39907 @ifclear man
39908 @subheading Usage (host side)
39909 @end ifclear
39910 @ifset man
39911 Usage (host side):
39912 @end ifset
39913
39914 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
39915 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
39916 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
39917 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
39918 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
39919 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
39920 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
39921 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
39922 descriptor. For example:
39923
39924 @smallexample
39925 @ifset man
39926 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
39927 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
39928 @end ifset
39929 @ifclear man
39930 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
39931 @end ifclear
39932 @end smallexample
39933
39934 @noindent
39935 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
39936
39937 @smallexample
39938 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
39939 @end smallexample
39940
39941 @noindent
39942 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
39943 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
39944 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
39945 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
39946 `Connection refused'.
39947
39948 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
39949 described in
39950 @ifset man
39951 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
39952 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
39953 @end ifset
39954 @ifclear man
39955 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
39956 @end ifclear
39957 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
39958
39959 @smallexample
39960 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
39961 @end smallexample
39962
39963 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
39964 case.
39965 @c man end
39966
39967 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
39968 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
39969
39970 @itemize @bullet
39971
39972 @item
39973 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
39974
39975 @smallexample
39976 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
39977 @end smallexample
39978
39979 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
39980 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
39981 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
39982 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
39983 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
39984 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
39985 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
39986
39987 @item
39988 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
39989 program:
39990
39991 @smallexample
39992 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
39993 @end smallexample
39994
39995 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
39996 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
39997 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
39998 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
39999
40000 @item
40001 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
40002
40003 @smallexample
40004 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40005 @end smallexample
40006
40007 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
40008 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
40009 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
40010 debug several processes in the same session.
40011 @end itemize
40012
40013 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
40014
40015 @table @env
40016
40017 @item --help
40018 List all options, with brief explanations.
40019
40020 @item --version
40021 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
40022
40023 @item --attach
40024 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
40025
40026 @smallexample
40027 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40028 @end smallexample
40029
40030 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
40031 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
40032
40033 @item --multi
40034 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
40035 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
40036 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
40037 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
40038
40039 @smallexample
40040 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40041 @end smallexample
40042
40043 @item --debug
40044 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
40045 process.
40046 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
40047 the developers.
40048
40049 @item --remote-debug
40050 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
40051 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
40052 the developers.
40053
40054 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
40055 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
40056 of debugging output.
40057 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
40058
40059 @item --wrapper
40060 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
40061 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
40062 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
40063 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
40064
40065 @item --once
40066 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
40067 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
40068 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
40069 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
40070
40071 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
40072
40073 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
40074 @c QDisableRandomization.
40075
40076 @end table
40077 @c man end
40078
40079 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
40080 @ifset man
40081 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40082 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40083 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40084
40085 @smallexample
40086 info gdb
40087 @end smallexample
40088
40089 should give you access to the complete manual.
40090
40091 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40092 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40093 @end ifset
40094 @c man end
40095
40096 @node gcore man
40097 @heading gcore
40098
40099 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
40100
40101 @format
40102 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
40103 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
40104 @c man end
40105 @end format
40106
40107 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
40108 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
40109 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
40110 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
40111 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
40112 running without any change.
40113 @c man end
40114
40115 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
40116 @table @env
40117 @item -o @var{filename}
40118 The optional argument
40119 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
40120 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
40121 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
40122 @end table
40123 @c man end
40124
40125 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
40126 @ifset man
40127 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40128 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40129 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40130
40131 @smallexample
40132 info gdb
40133 @end smallexample
40134
40135 @noindent
40136 should give you access to the complete manual.
40137
40138 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40139 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40140 @end ifset
40141 @c man end
40142
40143 @node gdbinit man
40144 @heading gdbinit
40145
40146 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
40147
40148 @format
40149 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
40150 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
40151 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
40152 @end ifset
40153
40154 ~/.gdbinit
40155
40156 ./.gdbinit
40157 @c man end
40158 @end format
40159
40160 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
40161 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
40162 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
40163 described in
40164 @ifset man
40165 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
40166 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
40167 @end ifset
40168 @ifclear man
40169 @ref{Sequences}.
40170 @end ifclear
40171
40172 Please read more in
40173 @ifset man
40174 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
40175 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
40176 @end ifset
40177 @ifclear man
40178 @ref{Startup}.
40179 @end ifclear
40180
40181 @table @env
40182 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
40183 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
40184 @end ifset
40185 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
40186 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
40187 @end ifclear
40188 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
40189 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
40190 See more in
40191 @ifset man
40192 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
40193 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
40194 @end ifset
40195 @ifclear man
40196 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
40197 @end ifclear
40198
40199 @item ~/.gdbinit
40200 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
40201 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
40202
40203 @item ./.gdbinit
40204 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
40205 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
40206 See more in
40207 @ifset man
40208 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
40209 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
40210 @end ifset
40211 @ifclear man
40212 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
40213 @end ifclear
40214 @end table
40215 @c man end
40216
40217 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
40218 @ifset man
40219 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
40220
40221 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40222 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40223 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40224
40225 @smallexample
40226 info gdb
40227 @end smallexample
40228
40229 should give you access to the complete manual.
40230
40231 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40232 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40233 @end ifset
40234 @c man end
40235
40236 @include gpl.texi
40237
40238 @node GNU Free Documentation License
40239 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
40240 @include fdl.texi
40241
40242 @node Concept Index
40243 @unnumbered Concept Index
40244
40245 @printindex cp
40246
40247 @node Command and Variable Index
40248 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
40249
40250 @printindex fn
40251
40252 @tex
40253 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
40254 % meantime:
40255 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
40256 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
40257 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
40258 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
40259 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
40260 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
40261 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
40262 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
40263 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
40264 \page\colophon
40265 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
40266 @end tex
40267
40268 @bye